10-K
Table of Contents

UNITED STATES SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

FORM 10-K

Annual Report Pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934

For the year ended December 31, 2016

Commission File Number 1-11758

 

LOGO

(Exact name of Registrant as specified in its charter)

 

 

 

Delaware

(State or other jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)

 

1585 Broadway

New York, NY 10036

(Address of principal executive

offices, including zip code)

 

36-3145972

(I.R.S. Employer Identification No.)

    

(212) 761-4000

(Registrant’s telephone number,

including area code)

 

 

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:

 

Title of each class   

Name of exchange on

which registered

Common Stock, $0.01 par value

  

New York Stock Exchange

Depositary Shares, each representing 1/1,000th interest in a share of Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series A, $0.01 par value

  

New York Stock Exchange

Depositary Shares, each representing 1/1,000th interest in a share of Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series E, $0.01 par value

  

New York Stock Exchange

Depositary Shares, each representing 1/1,000th interest in a share of Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series F, $0.01 par value

  

New York Stock Exchange

Depositary Shares, each representing 1/1,000th interest in a share of 6.625% Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series G, $0.01 par value

  

New York Stock Exchange

Depositary Shares, each representing 1/1,000th interest in a share of Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series I, $0.01 par value

  

New York Stock Exchange

Depositary Shares, each representing 1/1,000th interest in a share of Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series K, $0.01 par value

  

New York Stock Exchange

Global Medium-Term Notes, Series A, Fixed Rate Step-Up Senior Notes Due 2026 of Morgan Stanley Finance LLC (and Registrant’s guarantee with respect thereto)

  

New York Stock Exchange

Market Vectors ETNs due March 31, 2020 (2 issuances); Market Vectors ETNs due April 30, 2020 (2 issuances)

  

NYSE Arca, Inc.

Morgan Stanley Cushing® MLP High Income Index ETNs due March 21, 2031

  

NYSE Arca, Inc.

Indicate by check mark if Registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.    YES  ☒    NO  ☐

Indicate by check mark if Registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Act.    YES  ☐    NO  ☒

Indicate by check mark whether Registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that Registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.    YES  ☒    NO  ☐

Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the Registrant was required to submit and post such files).    YES  ☒    NO  ☐

Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of Registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K.    ☒

Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one):

 

Large Accelerated Filer  ☒

 

Accelerated Filer  ☐

Non-Accelerated Filer  ☐

 

Smaller reporting company  ☐

(Do not check if a smaller reporting company)

Indicate by check mark whether Registrant is a shell company (as defined in Exchange Act Rule 12b-2).    YES  ☐    NO  ☒

As of June 30, 2016, the aggregate market value of the common stock of Registrant held by non-affiliates of Registrant was approximately $47,247,843,093. This calculation does not reflect a determination that persons are affiliates for any other purposes.

As of January 31, 2017, there were 1,866,164,899 shares of Registrant’s common stock, $0.01 par value, outstanding.

Documents Incorporated by Reference: Portions of Registrant’s definitive proxy statement for its 2017 annual meeting of shareholders are incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K.


Table of Contents

LOGO

ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 10-K

for the year ended December 31, 2016

 

Table of Contents   Page

Part I

 

Item 1.     Business

  1

Overview

  1

Business Segments

  1

Competition

  1

Supervision and Regulation

  2

Executive Officers of Morgan Stanley

  10

Item 1A. Risk Factors

  12

Item 1B.  Unresolved Staff Comments

  22

Item 2.     Properties

  22

Item 3.     Legal Proceedings

  23

Item 4.     Mine Safety Disclosures

  28

Part II

 

Item 5.     Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

  29

Item 6.     Selected Financial Data

  31

Item 7.     Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

  32

Introduction

  32

Executive Summary

  33

Business Segments

  37

Supplemental Financial Information and Disclosures

  52

Accounting Development Updates

  53

Critical Accounting Policies

  54

Liquidity and Capital Resources

  58

Item 7A.  Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk

  75

Item 8.     Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

  94

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

  94

Consolidated Income Statements

  95

Consolidated Comprehensive Income Statements

  96

Consolidated Balance Sheets

  97

Consolidated Statements of Changes in Total Equity

  98

Consolidated Cash Flow Statements

  99

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

  100

  1. Introduction and Basis of Presentation

  100

  2. Significant Accounting Policies

  101

  3. Fair Values

  112

   4. Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities

  129

  5. Investment Securities

  136

  6. Collateralized Transactions

  140

  7. Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses

  143

  8. Equity Method Investments

  147

  9. Goodwill and Intangible Assets

  148

 

i


Table of Contents
Table of Contents   Page

10. Deposits

  149

11. Borrowings and Other Secured Financings

  149

12. Commitments, Guarantees and Contingencies

  152

13. Variable Interest Entities and Securitization Activities

  160

14. Regulatory Requirements

  166

15. Total Equity

  168

16. Earnings per Common Share

  173

17. Interest Income and Interest Expense

  173

18. Deferred Compensation Plans

  173

19. Employee Benefit Plans

  176

20. Income Taxes

  182

21. Segment and Geographic Information

  185

22. Parent Company

  187

23. Quarterly Results (Unaudited)

  190

24. Subsequent Events

  190

Financial Data Supplement (Unaudited)

  191

Item 9.     Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure

  195

Item 9A.  Controls and Procedures

  195

Item 9B.  Other Information

  197

Part III

 

Item 10.  Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance

  197

Item 11.  Executive Compensation

  197

Item 12.  Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters

  197

Item 13.  Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence

  197

Item 14.  Principal Accountant Fees and Services

  197

Part IV

 

Item 15.  Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules

  198

Item 16. Form 10-K Summary

  198

Signatures

  S-1

Exhibit Index

  E-1

 

ii


Table of Contents

Forward-Looking Statements

We have included in or incorporated by reference into this report, and from time to time may make in our public filings, press releases or other public statements, certain statements, including (without limitation) those under “Legal Proceedings” in Part I, Item 3, “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” in Part II, Item 7 and “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk” in Part II, Item 7A, that may constitute “forward-looking statements” within the meaning of the safe harbor provisions of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. In addition, our management may make forward-looking statements to analysts, investors, representatives of the media and others. These forward-looking statements are not historical facts and represent only our beliefs regarding future events, many of which, by their nature, are inherently uncertain and beyond our control.

The nature of our business makes predicting the future trends of our revenues, expenses and net income difficult. The risks and uncertainties involved in our businesses could affect the matters referred to in such statements, and it is possible that our actual results may differ, possibly materially, from the anticipated results indicated in these forward-looking statements. Important factors that could cause actual results to differ from those in the forward-looking statements include (without limitation):

 

   

the effect of economic and political conditions and geopolitical events, including the United Kingdom’s (the “U.K.”) anticipated withdrawal from the European Union (the “E.U.”);

   

sovereign risk;

   

the effect of market conditions, particularly in the global equity, fixed income, currency, credit and commodities markets, including corporate and mortgage (commercial and residential) lending and commercial real estate markets and energy markets;

   

the impact of current, pending and future legislation (including with respect to the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (the “Dodd-Frank Act”)) or changes thereto, regulation (including capital, leverage, funding, liquidity and tax requirements), policies (including fiscal and monetary policies established by central banks and financial regulators, and changes to global trade policies), and other legal and regulatory actions in the United States of America (“U.S.”) and worldwide;

   

the level and volatility of equity, fixed income and commodity prices (including oil prices), interest rates, currency values and other market indices;

   

the availability and cost of both credit and capital as well as the credit ratings assigned to our unsecured short-term and long-term debt;

   

investor, consumer and business sentiment and confidence in the financial markets;

   

the performance and results of our acquisitions, divestitures, joint ventures, strategic alliances or other strategic arrangements;

   

our reputation and the general perception of the financial services industry;

   

inflation, natural disasters, pandemics and acts of war or terrorism;

   

the actions and initiatives of current and potential competitors as well as governments, central banks, regulators and self-regulatory organizations;

   

the effectiveness of our risk management policies;

   

technological changes instituted by us, our competitors or counterparties and technological risks, including cybersecurity, business continuity and related operational risks;

   

our ability to provide innovative products and services and execute our strategic objectives; and

   

other risks and uncertainties detailed under “Business—Competition” and “Business—Supervision and Regulation” in Part I, Item 1, “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A and elsewhere throughout this report.

Accordingly, you are cautioned not to place undue reliance on forward-looking statements, which speak only as of the date on which they are made. We undertake no obligation to update publicly or revise any forward-looking statements to reflect the impact of circumstances or events that arise after the dates they are made, whether as a result of new information, future events or otherwise except as required by applicable law. You should, however, consult further disclosures we may make in future filings of our Annual Reports on Form 10-K, Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q and Current Reports on Form 8-K and any amendments thereto or in future press releases or other public statements.

 

iii


Table of Contents

Available Information

We file annual, quarterly and current reports, proxy statements and other information with the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”). You may read and copy any document we file with the SEC at the SEC’s public reference room at 100 F Street, NE, Washington, DC 20549. Please call the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330 for information on the public reference room. The SEC maintains an internet site that contains annual, quarterly and current reports, proxy and information statements, and other information that issuers (including Morgan Stanley) file electronically with the SEC. Our electronic SEC filings are available to the public at the SEC’s internet site, www.sec.gov.

Our internet site is www.morganstanley.com. You can access our Investor Relations webpage at www.morganstanley.com/about-us-ir. We make available free of charge, on or through our Investor Relations webpage, proxy statements, Annual Reports on Form 10-K, Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q, Current Reports on Form 8-K and any amendments to those reports filed or furnished pursuant to the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”), as soon as reasonably practicable after such material is electronically filed with, or furnished to, the SEC. We also make available, through our Investor Relations webpage, via a link to the SEC’s internet site, statements of beneficial ownership of our equity securities filed by our directors, officers, 10% or greater shareholders and others under Section 16 of the Exchange Act.

You can access information about our corporate governance at www.morganstanley.com/about-us-governance. Our Corporate Governance webpage includes:

 

   

Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation;

   

Amended and Restated Bylaws;

   

Charters for our Audit Committee, Compensation, Management Development and Succession Committee, Nominating and Governance Committee, Operations and Technology Committee, and Risk Committee;

   

Corporate Governance Policies;

   

Policy Regarding Communication with the Board of Directors;

   

Policy Regarding Director Candidates Recommended by Shareholders;

   

Policy Regarding Corporate Political Activities;

   

Policy Regarding Shareholder Rights Plan;

   

Equity Ownership Commitment;

   

Code of Ethics and Business Conduct;

   

Code of Conduct;

   

Integrity Hotline information; and

   

Environmental and Social Policies.

Our Code of Ethics and Business Conduct applies to all directors, officers and employees, including our Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer and Deputy Chief Financial Officer. We will post any amendments to the Code of Ethics and Business Conduct and any waivers that are required to be disclosed by the rules of either the SEC or the New York Stock Exchange LLC (“NYSE”) on our internet site. You can request a copy of these documents, excluding exhibits, at no cost, by contacting Investor Relations, 1585 Broadway, New York, NY 10036 (212-761-4000). The information on our internet site is not incorporated by reference into this report.

 

iv


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

Part I

Item  1. Business

Overview

We are a global financial services firm that, through our subsidiaries and affiliates, advises, and originates, trades, manages and distributes capital for, governments, institutions and individuals. We were originally incorporated under the laws of the State of Delaware in 1981, and our predecessor companies date back to 1924. We are a financial holding company (“FHC”) regulated by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (the “Federal Reserve”) under the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended (the “BHC Act”). We conduct our business from our headquarters in and around New York City, our regional offices and branches throughout the U.S. and our principal offices in London, Tokyo, Hong Kong and other world financial centers. As of December 31, 2016, we had 55,311 employees worldwide. Unless the context otherwise requires, the terms “Morgan Stanley,” the “Firm,” “us,” “we,” and “our” mean Morgan Stanley (the “Parent Company”) together with its consolidated subsidiaries.

Financial information concerning us, our business segments and geographic regions for each of the 12 months ended December 31, 2016, December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014 is included in the consolidated financial statements and the notes thereto in “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” in Part II, Item 8.

Business Segments

We are a global financial services firm that maintains significant market positions in each of our business segments—Institutional Securities, Wealth Management and Investment Management. Through our subsidiaries and affiliates, we provide a wide variety of products and services to a large and diversified group of clients and customers, including corporations, governments, financial institutions and individuals. Additional information related to our business segments, respective clients, and products and services provided is included under “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” in Part II, Item 7.

Competition

All aspects of our businesses are highly competitive, and we expect them to remain so. We compete in the U.S. and globally for clients, market share and human talent. Operating within the financial services industry on a global basis presents, among other things, technological, risk management, regulatory and other infrastructure challenges that

require effective resource allocation in order for us to remain competitive. Our competitive position depends on our reputation and the quality and consistency of our long-term investment performance. Our ability to sustain or improve our competitive position also depends substantially on our ability to continue to attract and retain highly qualified employees while managing compensation and other costs. We compete with commercial banks, brokerage firms, insurance companies, electronic trading and clearing platforms, financial data repositories, sponsors of mutual funds, hedge funds and private equity funds, energy companies and other companies offering financial or ancillary services in the U.S., globally and through the internet. In addition, restrictive laws and regulations applicable to certain U.S. financial services institutions, such as Morgan Stanley, which may prohibit us from engaging in certain transactions and impose more stringent capital and liquidity requirements, can put us at a competitive disadvantage to competitors in certain businesses not subject to these same requirements. See also “—Supervision and Regulation” below and “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A.

Institutional Securities and Wealth Management

Our competitive position for our Institutional Securities and Wealth Management business segments depends on innovation, execution capability and relative pricing. We compete directly in the U.S. and globally with other securities and financial services firms and broker-dealers and with others on a regional or product basis. Additionally, there is increased competition driven by established firms as well as the emergence of new firms and business models (including innovative uses of technology) competing for the same clients and assets or offering similar products and services.

Our ability to access capital at competitive rates (which is generally impacted by our credit ratings), to commit and to deploy capital efficiently, particularly in our capital-intensive underwriting and sales, trading, financing and market-making activities, also affects our competitive position. Corporate clients may request that we provide loans or lending commitments in connection with certain investment banking activities and such requests are expected to continue.

It is possible that competition may become even more intense as we continue to compete with financial institutions that may be larger, or better capitalized, or may have a stronger local presence and longer operating history in certain geographies or products. Many of these firms have the ability to offer a wide range of products and services that may enhance their competitive position and could result in pricing pressure on our businesses. In addition, our business is subject to extensive regulation in the U.S. and abroad, while certain of our competitors may be subject to less stringent legal and regulatory regimes than us, thereby putting us at a competitive disadvantage.

 

 

  1   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

We continue to experience intense price competition in some of our businesses. In particular, the ability to execute securities trades electronically on exchanges and through other automated trading markets has increased the pressure on trading commissions and comparable fees. The trend toward direct access to automated, electronic markets will likely increase as additional trading moves to more automated platforms. It is also possible that we will experience competitive pressures in these and other areas in the future as some of our competitors seek to obtain market share by reducing prices (in the form of commissions or pricing).

Investment Management

Our ability to compete successfully in the asset management industry is affected by several factors, including our reputation, investment objectives, quality of investment professionals, performance of investment strategies or product offerings relative to peers and appropriate benchmark indices, advertising and sales promotion efforts, fee levels, the effectiveness of and access to distribution channels and investment pipelines, and the types and quality of products offered. Our investment products, including alternative investment products, may compete with investments offered by other investment managers with passive investment products or who may be subject to less stringent legal and regulatory regimes than us.

Supervision and Regulation

As a major financial services firm, we are subject to extensive regulation by U.S. federal and state regulatory agencies and securities exchanges and by regulators and exchanges in each of the major markets where we conduct our business. Moreover, in response to the 2007-2008 financial crisis, legislators and regulators, both in the U.S. and worldwide, have adopted, continue to propose or are in the process of implementing a wide range of reforms that have resulted or that may in the future result in major changes to the way we are regulated and conduct our business. These reforms include the Dodd-Frank Act; risk-based capital, leverage and liquidity standards adopted or being developed by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (the “Basel Committee”), including Basel III, and the national implementation of those standards; capital planning and stress testing requirements; and new resolution regimes that are being developed in the U.S. and other jurisdictions. While certain portions of these reforms are effective, others are still subject to final rulemaking or transition periods.

We continue to monitor the changing political, tax and regulatory environment; it is likely that there will be further material changes in the way major financial institutions are regulated in both the U.S. and other markets in which we operate,

although it remains difficult to predict the exact impact these changes will have on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows for a particular future period.

Financial Holding Company

Consolidated Supervision.    We have operated as a bank holding company and FHC under the BHC Act since September 2008. As a bank holding company, we are subject to comprehensive consolidated supervision, regulation and examination by the Federal Reserve. Under existing regulation, the Federal Reserve has heightened authority to examine, prescribe regulations and take action with respect to all of our subsidiaries. In particular, we are, or will become, subject to (among other things): significantly revised and expanded regulation and supervision; more intensive scrutiny of our businesses and plans for expansion of those businesses; new activities limitations; a systemic risk regime that imposes heightened capital and liquidity requirements; restrictions on activities and investments imposed by a section of the BHC Act added by the Dodd-Frank Act referred to as the “Volcker Rule”; and comprehensive derivatives regulation. In addition, the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau has primary rulemaking, enforcement and examination authority over us and our subsidiaries with respect to federal consumer protection laws, to the extent applicable.

Scope of Permitted Activities.    The BHC Act limits the activities of bank holding companies and financial holding companies and grants the Federal Reserve authority to limit our ability to conduct activities. We must obtain the Federal Reserve’s approval before engaging in certain banking and other financial activities both in the U.S. and internationally. Since becoming a bank holding company, we have disposed of certain nonconforming assets and conformed certain activities to the requirements of the BHC Act.

The BHC Act grandfathers “activities related to the trading, sale or investment in commodities and underlying physical properties,” provided that we were engaged in “any of such activities as of September 30, 1997 in the United States” and provided that certain other conditions that are within our reasonable control are satisfied. We currently engage in our commodities activities pursuant to the BHC Act grandfather exemption as well as other authorities under the BHC Act.

Activities Restrictions under the Volcker Rule.    The Volcker Rule prohibits “banking entities,” including the Firm and its affiliates, from engaging in certain “proprietary trading” activities, as defined in the Volcker Rule, subject to exemptions for underwriting, market-making-related activities, risk-mitigating hedging and certain other activities. The Volcker Rule also prohibits certain investments and relationships by banking entities with “covered funds,” with a number of

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   2  


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

exemptions and exclusions. Banking entities were required to bring all of their activities and investments into conformance with the Volcker Rule by July 21, 2015, subject to certain extensions. For more information about the conformance periods applicable to certain covered funds, see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Liquidity and Capital Resources—Regulatory Developments.” In addition, the Volcker Rule requires banking entities to have comprehensive compliance programs reasonably designed to ensure and monitor compliance with the Volcker Rule.

The Volcker Rule also requires that deductions be made from a bank holding company’s Tier 1 capital for certain permissible investments in covered funds. Beginning with the three months ended September 30, 2015, the required deductions are reflected in our relevant regulatory capital tiers and ratios. Given its complexity, the full impact of the Volcker Rule is still uncertain and will ultimately depend on the interpretation and implementation by the five regulatory agencies responsible for its oversight.

Capital Standards.    The Federal Reserve establishes capital requirements for large bank holding companies and evaluates our compliance with such requirements. The Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (the “OCC”) establishes similar capital requirements and standards for our U.S. bank subsidiaries, Morgan Stanley Bank, N.A. (“MSBNA”) and Morgan Stanley Private Bank, National Association (“MSPBNA”) (collectively, “U.S. Bank Subsidiaries”).

Regulatory Capital Framework.    The Federal Reserve establishes capital requirements for large bank holding companies, including well-capitalized standards, and evaluates our compliance with such capital requirements. The OCC establishes similar capital requirements and standards for our U.S. Bank Subsidiaries. The regulatory capital requirements are largely based on the Basel III capital standards established by the Basel Committee and also implement certain provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act. After completion of certain transitional arrangements in the regulatory capital framework, we will be subject to various risk-based capital requirements, measured against our Common Equity Tier 1 capital, Tier 1 capital and Total capital bases, leverage-based capital requirements, including the Supplementary Leverage Ratio, and additional capital buffers above generally applicable minimum standards for bank holding companies.

The Basel Committee is in the process of considering revisions to various provisions of the capital framework that, if adopted by the U.S. banking agencies, could result in substantial changes to our regulatory capital framework.

Regulated Subsidiaries.    In addition, many of our regulated subsidiaries are, or are expected to be in the future, subject to regulatory capital requirements, including regulated subsidiaries registered as “swap dealers” with the U.S. Commodity Futures Trading Commission (the “CFTC”) or “security-based swap dealers” with the SEC (collectively, “Swaps Entities”) or registered as broker-dealers or futures commission merchants. Specific regulatory capital requirements vary by regulated subsidiary, and in many cases these standards are not yet established or are subject to ongoing rulemakings that could substantially modify requirements.

Commodities-Related Capital Requirements.    In September 2016, the Federal Reserve issued a proposed rulemaking that would increase risk-based capital requirements for certain commodities-related activities and commodities-related merchant banking investments of U.S. FHCs, including the Firm; impose new limitations on the physical commodity trading activities of certain U.S. FHCs; and enhance reporting requirements with respect to U.S. FHCs’ commodities-related activities and investments. If adopted in its current form, the proposed rulemaking would result in increases in our risk-weighted assets (“RWAs”) with respect to certain commodities-related investments and physical commodity holdings. However, we expect that the proposed rule, if finalized in its proposed form, would not have a material impact on our aggregate RWAs or risk-based capital ratios.

For more information about the specific capital requirements applicable to us and our U.S. Bank Subsidiaries, see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Liquidity and Capital Resources—Regulatory Requirements” in Part II, Item 7.

Capital Planning, Stress Tests and Capital Distributions.    Pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act, the Federal Reserve has adopted capital planning and stress test requirements for large bank holding companies, including Morgan Stanley. The Dodd-Frank Act also requires each of our U.S. Bank Subsidiaries to conduct an annual stress test. For more information about the capital planning and stress test requirements, see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Liquidity and Capital Resources—Regulatory Requirements” in Part II, Item 7.

In addition to capital planning requirements, the OCC, the Federal Reserve and the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (“FDIC”) have the authority to prohibit or to limit the payment of dividends by the banking organizations they supervise, including the Firm and its U.S. Bank Subsidiaries, if, in the banking regulator’s opinion, payment of a dividend would constitute an unsafe or unsound practice in light of the financial condition of the banking organization. All of these

 

 

  3   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

policies and other requirements could affect our ability to pay dividends and/or repurchase stock, or require us to provide capital assistance to our U.S. Bank Subsidiaries under circumstances which we would not otherwise decide to do so.

Liquidity Standards.    In addition to capital regulations, the U.S. banking agencies and the Basel Committee have adopted, or are in the process of considering, liquidity standards. The Basel Committee has developed two standards intended for use in liquidity risk supervision, the Liquidity Coverage Ratio (“LCR”) and the Net Stable Funding Ratio (“NSFR”). The Firm and its U.S. Bank Subsidiaries are subject to the LCR requirements issued by the U.S. banking regulators (“U.S. LCR”) and would be subject to the NSFR requirements proposed by the U.S. banking regulators (“U.S. NSFR”).

In addition to the U.S. LCR and U.S. NSFR, we and many of our regulated subsidiaries, including those registered as Swaps Entities with the CFTC or SEC, are, or are expected to be in the future, subject to other liquidity standards, including liquidity stress-testing and associated liquidity reserve requirements.

For more information, see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Liquidity and Capital Resources—Regulatory Liquidity Framework” in Part II, Item 7.

Systemic Risk Regime.    The Dodd-Frank Act established a systemic risk regime to which bank holding companies with $50 billion or more in consolidated assets, such as Morgan Stanley, are subject. Under rules issued by the Federal Reserve to implement certain requirements of the Dodd-Frank Act’s enhanced prudential standards, such bank holding companies must conduct internal liquidity stress tests, maintain unencumbered highly liquid assets to meet projected net cash outflows for 30 days over the range of liquidity stress scenarios used in internal stress tests, and comply with various liquidity risk management requirements. Institutions also must comply with a range of risk management and corporate governance requirements.

In March 2016, the Federal Reserve re-proposed rules that would establish single-counterparty credit limits for large banking organizations (“covered companies”), with more stringent limits for the largest covered companies. U.S. global systemically important banks (“G-SIBs”), including the Firm, would be subject to a limit of 15% of Tier 1 capital for credit exposures to any “major counterparty” (defined as other U.S. G-SIBs, foreign G-SIBs and nonbank systemically important financial institutions supervised by the Federal Reserve) and to a limit of 25% of Tier 1 capital for credit exposures to any other unaffiliated counterparty. We continue to evaluate the potential impact of the proposed rules.

In addition, the Federal Reserve has proposed rules that would create a new early remediation framework to address financial distress or material management weaknesses. The Federal Reserve also has the ability to establish additional prudential standards, including those regarding contingent capital, enhanced public disclosures and limits on short-term debt, including off-balance sheet exposures. For example, see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Liquidity and Capital Resources—Regulatory Requirements—Total Loss-Absorbing Capacity and Long-Term Debt Requirement” in Part II, Item 7.

Under the systemic risk regime, if the Federal Reserve or the Financial Stability Oversight Council determines that a bank holding company with $50 billion or more in consolidated assets poses a “grave threat” to U.S. financial stability, the institution may be, among other things, restricted in its ability to merge or offer financial products and required to terminate activities and dispose of assets.

See also “—Capital Standards” and “—Liquidity Standards” herein and “—Resolution and Recovery Planning” below.

Resolution and Recovery Planning.    Pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act, we are required to submit to the Federal Reserve and the FDIC an annual resolution plan that describes our strategy for a rapid and orderly resolution under the U.S. Bankruptcy Code in the event of our material financial distress or failure. Our preferred resolution strategy, which is set out in our 2015 resolution plan, is a single point of entry (“SPOE”) strategy. An SPOE strategy generally contemplates the provision of additional capital and liquidity by the Parent Company to certain of its subsidiaries so that such subsidiaries have the resources necessary to implement the resolution strategy after the Parent Company has filed for bankruptcy.

Further, we are required to submit an annual recovery plan to the Federal Reserve that outlines the steps that management could take over time to generate or conserve financial resources in times of prolonged financial stress.

Certain of our domestic and foreign subsidiaries are also subject to resolution and recovery planning requirements in the jurisdictions in which they operate. For example, MSBNA must submit to the FDIC an annual resolution plan that describes MSBNA’s strategy for a rapid and orderly resolution in the event of material financial distress or failure of MSBNA. In September 2016, the OCC issued final guidelines that establish enforceable standards for recovery planning by national banks and certain other institutions with total consolidated assets of $50 billion or more, calculated on a rolling four-quarter average basis, including MSBNA. The guidelines were effective on January 1, 2017, and MSBNA must be in compliance by January 1, 2018.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   4  


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

In addition, under the Dodd-Frank Act, certain financial companies, including bank holding companies such as the Firm and certain of its covered subsidiaries, can be subjected to a resolution proceeding under the orderly liquidation authority in Title II of the Dodd-Frank Act with the FDIC being appointed as receiver, provided that certain procedures are met, including certain extraordinary financial distress and systemic risk determinations by the U.S. Treasury Secretary in consultation with the U.S. President. The orderly liquidation authority rulemaking is proceeding in stages, with some regulations now finalized and others not yet proposed. If we were subject to the orderly liquidation authority, the FDIC would have considerable powers, including: the power to remove directors and officers responsible for our failure and to appoint new directors and officers; the power to assign our assets and liabilities to a third party or bridge financial company without the need for creditor consent or prior court review; the ability to differentiate among our creditors, including by treating certain creditors within the same class better than others, subject to a minimum recovery right on the part of disfavored creditors to receive at least what they would have received in bankruptcy liquidation; and broad powers to administer the claims process to determine distributions from the assets of the receivership. The FDIC has been developing an SPOE strategy that could be used to implement the orderly liquidation authority.

Regulators have taken and proposed various actions to facilitate an SPOE strategy under the U.S. Bankruptcy Code, the orderly liquidation authority or other resolution regimes. For more information about our resolution plan-related submissions and associated regulatory actions, see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Regulatory Requirements—Total Loss-Absorbing Capacity, Long-Term Debt and Clean Holding Company Requirements” and “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Liquidity and Capital Resources—Regulatory Developments—Resolution and Recovery Planning” in Part II, Item 7.

Cyber Risk Management.    As a general matter, the financial services industry faces increased regulatory focus regarding cyber risk management practices. In October 2016, the federal banking regulators issued an advance notice of proposed rulemaking regarding enhanced cyber risk management standards, which would apply to a wide range of large financial institutions and their third-party service providers, including the Firm. The proposed standards would expand existing cybersecurity regulations and guidance to focus on cyber risk governance and management; management of internal and external dependencies; and incident response, cyber resilience and situational awareness. In addition, the proposal contemplates more stringent standards for institutions with systems that are critical to the financial sector.

U.S. Bank Subsidiaries

U.S. Bank Subsidiaries.    MSBNA, primarily a wholesale commercial bank, offers commercial lending and certain retail securities-based lending services in addition to deposit products, and also conducts certain foreign exchange activities.

MSPBNA offers certain mortgage and other secured lending products, including retail securities-based lending products, primarily for customers of our affiliate retail broker-dealer, Morgan Stanley Smith Barney LLC (“MSSB LLC”). MSPBNA also offers certain deposit products and prime brokerage custody services.

Both MSBNA and MSPBNA are FDIC-insured national banks subject to supervision, regulation and examination by the OCC. They are both subject to the OCC’s risk governance guidelines, which establish heightened standards for a large national bank’s risk governance framework and the oversight of that framework by the bank’s board of directors.

Prompt Corrective Action.    The Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act of 1991 provides a framework for regulation of depository institutions and their affiliates, including parent holding companies, by their federal banking regulators. Among other things, it requires the relevant federal banking regulator to take “prompt corrective action” (“PCA”) with respect to a depository institution if that institution does not meet certain capital adequacy standards. Current PCA regulations generally apply only to insured banks and thrifts such as MSBNA or MSPBNA and not to their parent holding companies. The Federal Reserve is, however, authorized to take appropriate action at the holding company level, subject to certain limitations. Under the systemic risk regime, as described above, we also would become subject to an early remediation protocol in the event of financial distress. In addition, bank holding companies, such as Morgan Stanley, are required to serve as a source of strength to their U.S. bank subsidiaries and commit resources to support these subsidiaries in the event such subsidiaries are in financial distress.

Transactions with Affiliates.    Our U.S. Bank Subsidiaries are subject to Sections 23A and 23B of the Federal Reserve Act, which impose restrictions on “covered transactions” with any affiliates. Covered transactions include any extension of credit to, purchase of assets from, and certain other transactions by insured banks with an affiliate. These restrictions limit the total amount of credit exposure that our U.S. Bank Subsidiaries may have to any one affiliate and to all affiliates. Other provisions set collateral requirements and require all such transactions to be made on market terms. Derivatives, securities borrowing and securities lending transactions between our U.S. Bank Subsidiaries and their affiliates are

 

 

  5   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

subject to these restrictions. The Federal Reserve has indicated that it will propose a rulemaking to implement these more recent restrictions.

In addition, the Volcker Rule generally prohibits covered transactions between (i) us or any of our affiliates and (ii) covered funds for which we or any of our affiliates serves as the investment manager, investment adviser, commodity trading advisor or sponsor, or other covered funds organized and offered by us or any of our affiliates pursuant to specific exemptions in the Volcker Rule. See also “—Financial Holding Company—Activities Restriction under the Volcker Rule” above.

FDIC Regulation.    An FDIC-insured depository institution is generally liable for any loss incurred or expected to be incurred by the FDIC in connection with the failure of an insured depository institution under common control by the same bank holding company. As commonly controlled FDIC-insured depository institutions, each of MSBNA and MSPBNA could be responsible for any loss to the FDIC from the failure of the other. In addition, both institutions are exposed to changes in the cost of FDIC insurance. Under the Dodd-Frank Act, some of the restoration of the FDIC’s reserve fund must be paid for exclusively by large depository institutions, including MSBNA.

Institutional Securities and Wealth Management

Broker-Dealer and Investment Adviser Regulation.    Our primary U.S. broker-dealer subsidiaries, Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC (“MS&Co.”) and MSSB LLC, are registered broker-dealers with the SEC and in all 50 states, the District of Columbia, Puerto Rico and the U.S. Virgin Islands, and are members of various self-regulatory organizations, including the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority, Inc. (“FINRA”), and various securities exchanges and clearing organizations. Broker-dealers are subject to laws and regulations covering all aspects of the securities business, including sales and trading practices, securities offerings, publication of research reports, use of customers’ funds and securities, capital structure, risk management controls in connection with market access, recordkeeping and retention, and the conduct of their directors, officers, representatives and other associated persons. Broker-dealers are also regulated by securities administrators in those states where they do business. Violations of the laws and regulations governing a broker-dealer’s actions could result in censures, fines, the issuance of cease-and-desist orders, revocation of licenses or registrations, the suspension or expulsion from the securities industry of such broker-dealer or its officers or employees, or other similar consequences by both federal and state securities administrators. Our broker-dealer subsidiaries are also members of the Securities Investor Protection Corporation, which provides certain protections for customers of broker-dealers against losses in the event of the insolvency of a broker-dealer.

MSSB LLC is also a registered investment adviser with the SEC. MSSB LLC’s relationship with its investment advisory clients is subject to the fiduciary and other obligations imposed on investment advisers under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940, and the rules and regulations promulgated thereunder as well as various state securities laws. These laws and regulations generally grant the SEC and other supervisory bodies broad administrative powers to address non-compliance, including the power to restrict or limit MSSB LLC from carrying on its investment advisory and other asset management activities. Other sanctions that may be imposed include the suspension of individual employees, limitations on engaging in certain activities for specified periods of time or for specified types of clients, the revocation of registrations, other censures and significant fines.

The Firm is subject to various regulations that affect broker-dealer sales practices and customer relationships. For example, under the Dodd-Frank Act, the SEC is authorized to impose a fiduciary duty rule applicable to broker-dealers when providing personalized investment advice about securities to retail customers, although the SEC has not yet acted on this authority.

As a separate matter, in April 2016, the U.S. Department of Labor adopted a conflict of interest rule under the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 that broadens the circumstances under which a firm and/or financial adviser is considered a fiduciary when providing certain recommendations to retirement investors and requires that such recommendations be in the best interests of clients. Subject to any potential delays, the new fiduciary standard for investment advice has a scheduled applicability date of April 10, 2017, with certain aspects subject to phased-in compliance, and with full compliance required by January 1, 2018. Given the breadth and scale of our platform and continued investment in technology and infrastructure, we believe that we will be able to provide compliant solutions to meet our clients’ investment needs. However, these developments may impact the manner in which affected businesses are conducted, decrease profitability and increase potential litigation or enforcement risk.

Margin lending by broker-dealers is regulated by the Federal Reserve’s restrictions on lending in connection with customer and proprietary purchases and short sales of securities, as well as securities borrowing and lending activities. Broker-dealers are also subject to maintenance and other margin requirements imposed under FINRA and other self-regulatory organization rules. In many cases, our broker-dealer subsidiaries’ margin policies are more stringent than these rules.

As registered U.S. broker-dealers, certain of our subsidiaries are subject to the SEC’s net capital rule and the net capital requirements of various exchanges, other regulatory author-

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   6  


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

ities and self-regulatory organizations. These rules are generally designed to measure the broker-dealer subsidiary’s general financial integrity and/or liquidity and require that at least a minimum amount of net and/or liquid assets be maintained by the subsidiary. See also “—Financial Holding Company—Consolidated Supervision” and “—Financial Holding Company—Liquidity Standards” above. Rules of FINRA and other self-regulatory organizations also impose limitations and requirements on the transfer of member organizations’ assets.

Research.    Both U.S. and non-U.S. regulators continue to focus on research conflicts of interest. Research-related regulations have been implemented in many jurisdictions, including in the U.S. where FINRA has adopted rules that cover both equity and debt. New and revised requirements resulting from these regulations and the global research settlement with U.S. federal and state regulators (to which we are a party) have necessitated the development or enhancement of corresponding policies and procedures.

Regulation of Futures Activities and Certain Commodities Activities.    MS&Co., as a futures commission merchant, and MSSB LLC, as an introducing broker, are subject to net capital requirements of, and certain of their activities are regulated by, the CFTC, the National Futures Association (the “NFA”), CME Group, and various commodity futures exchanges. MS&Co. and MSSB LLC and certain of their affiliates are registered members of the NFA in various capacities. Rules and regulations of the CFTC, NFA and commodity futures exchanges address obligations related to, among other things, customer protections, the segregation of customer funds and the holding of secured amounts, the use by futures commission merchants of customer funds, recordkeeping and reporting obligations of futures commission merchants, and introducing brokers, risk disclosure, risk management and discretionary trading.

Our commodities activities are subject to extensive and evolving energy, commodities, environmental, health and safety, and other governmental laws and regulations in the U.S. and abroad. Intensified scrutiny of certain energy markets by U.S. federal, state and local authorities in the U.S. and abroad and by the public has resulted in increased regulatory and legal enforcement and remedial proceedings involving companies conducting the activities in which we are engaged. See also “—Financial Holding Company—Scope of Permitted Activities” and “—Capital Standards—Commodities-Related Capital Requirements” above.

Derivatives Regulation.    Under the U.S. regulatory regime for “swaps” and “security-based swaps” (collectively, “Swaps”) implemented pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act, we

are subject to regulations including, among others, public and regulatory reporting, central clearing and mandatory trading on regulated exchanges or execution facilities for certain types of Swaps. While the CFTC has completed the majority of its regulations in this area, most of which are in effect, the SEC has not yet adopted a number of its Swaps regulations. The Dodd-Frank Act also requires the registration of “swap dealers” with the CFTC and “security-based swap dealers” with the SEC. Certain of our subsidiaries have registered with the CFTC as swap dealers and will in the future be required to register with the SEC as security-based swap dealers. Such Swaps Entities are or will be subject to a comprehensive regulatory regime with new obligations for the Swaps activities for which they are registered, including capital requirements, margin requirements for uncleared Swaps and comprehensive business conduct rules. Each of the CFTC and the SEC have proposed rules to impose capital standards on Swaps Entities subject to their respective jurisdictions, which include our subsidiaries, but these rules have not yet been finalized.

The specific parameters of some of these requirements for Swaps have been and continue to be developed through the CFTC, SEC and bank regulator rulemakings. In 2015, the federal banking regulators and the CFTC separately issued final rules establishing uncleared Swap margin requirements for Swaps Entities subject to their respective regulation, including MSBNA, Morgan Stanley Capital Services LLC and Morgan Stanley & Co. International plc (“MSIP”), respectively. These final rules impose variation margin requirements under a phase-in compliance schedule that applied to the largest dealers as of September 1, 2016 and will apply to the remainder of in-scope market participants as of March 1, 2017. Similarly, the final rules phase-in initial margin requirements from September 1, 2016 through September 1, 2020, depending on the level of over-the-counter (“OTC”) derivatives activity of the swap dealer and the relevant counterparty. Margin rules with the same or similar compliance dates have been adopted or are in the process of being finalized by regulators outside the U.S. and certain of our subsidiaries may be subject to such rules.

Although the full impact of global derivatives regulation on us remains unclear, we have already faced, and are expected to continue to face, increased costs and regulatory oversight due to the registration and regulatory requirements indicated above. Complying with the Swaps rules also has required, and is expected to in the future require, us to change our Swaps businesses and has required, and may in the future require, extensive systems and personnel changes. Compliance with Swaps-related regulatory capital requirements may require us to devote more capital to our Swaps business.

 

 

  7   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

Non-U.S. Regulation.    Our Institutional Securities businesses also are regulated extensively by non-U.S. regulators, including governments, securities exchanges, commodity exchanges, self-regulatory organizations, central banks and regulatory bodies, especially in those jurisdictions in which we maintain an office. In addition, certain Morgan Stanley subsidiaries are regulated as broker-dealers under the laws of the jurisdictions in which they operate. Subsidiaries engaged in banking and trust activities outside the U.S. are regulated by various government agencies in the particular jurisdiction where they are chartered, incorporated and/or conduct their business activity. For instance, the Prudential Regulation Authority (“PRA”), the Financial Conduct Authority (“FCA”) and several securities and futures exchanges in the U.K., including the London Stock Exchange and ICE Futures Europe, regulate our activities in the U.K.; the Bundesanstalt für Finanzdienstleistungsaufsicht (the Federal Financial Supervisory Authority) and the Deutsche Börse AG regulate our activities in the Federal Republic of Germany; the Financial Services Agency, the Bank of Japan, the Japanese Securities Dealers Association and several Japanese securities and futures exchanges, regulate our activities in Japan; the Securities and Futures Commission of Hong Kong, the Hong Kong Monetary Authority and the Hong Kong Exchanges and Clearing Limited regulate our operations in Hong Kong; and the Monetary Authority of Singapore and the Singapore Exchange Limited regulate our business in Singapore.

Our largest non-U.S. entity, MSIP, is subject to extensive regulation and supervision by the PRA, which has broad legal authority to establish prudential and other standards applicable to MSIP that seek to ensure its safety and soundness and to minimize adverse effects on the stability of the U.K. financial system. MSIP is also regulated and supervised by the FCA with respect to business conduct matters.

Non-U.S. policymakers and regulators, including the European Commission and European Supervisory Authorities (among others, the European Banking Authority and the European Securities and Markets Authority), continue to propose and adopt numerous reforms, including those that may further impact the structure of banks, and to formulate regulatory standards and measures that will be of relevance and importance to our European operations. In November 2016, the European Commission published proposals that would require certain large, non-E.U. financial groups with two or more institutions established in the E.U., to establish a single E.U. intermediate holding company (“IHC”). The proposals would require E.U. banks and broker-dealers to be held below the E.U. IHC; until more specific regulations are proposed, it remains unclear which other E.U. entities would need to be held beneath the E.U. IHC. The E.U. IHC would be subject to: direct supervision and authorization by the European Central Bank or the relevant national E.U. regu-

lator; the E.U. bank recovery and resolution regime under the E.U. Bank Recovery and Resolution Directive (“BRRD”); and capital, liquidity, leverage and other prudential standards on a consolidated basis. The proposals will now be considered by the European Parliament and the Council of the E.U. The final form of the proposals, as well as the date of their adoption, is not yet certain.

Regulators in the U.K., E.U. and other major jurisdictions have also finalized or are in the process of proposing or finalizing risk-based capital, leverage capital, liquidity, market-based reforms and other regulatory standards applicable to certain of our subsidiaries that operate in those jurisdictions. For instance, European Market Infrastructure Regulation introduces new requirements regarding the central clearing and reporting of derivatives, as well as margin requirements for uncleared derivatives. The Markets in Financial Instrument Regulation and a revision of the Markets in Financial Instruments Directive (together, “MiFID II”), which is now scheduled to take effect on January 3, 2018, will also introduce comprehensive and new trading and market infrastructure reforms in the E.U., including new trading venues, enhancements to pre- and post-trading transparency, and additional investor protection requirements, among others. Although the full impact of these changes remains unclear, complying with MiFID II is expected to require extensive changes to our operations, including systems and controls.

Regulators in the U.K., E.U. and other major jurisdictions have also finalized or are in the process of proposing or finalizing recovery and resolution planning frameworks and related regulatory requirements that will apply to certain of our subsidiaries that operate in those jurisdictions. For instance, the BRRD has established a recovery and resolution framework for E.U. credit institutions and investment firms, including MSIP. E.U. Member States were required to apply provisions implementing the BRRD as of January 1, 2015, subject to certain exemptions. In addition, certain jurisdictions, including the U.K. and other E.U. jurisdictions, have implemented, or are in the process of implementing, changes to resolution regimes to provide resolution authorities with the ability to recapitalize a failing entity organized in such jurisdiction by writing down certain unsecured liabilities or converting certain unsecured liabilities into equity.

Investment Management

Many of the subsidiaries engaged in our asset management activities are registered as investment advisers with the SEC. Many aspects of our asset management activities are subject to federal and state laws and regulations primarily intended to benefit the investor or client. These laws and regulations generally grant supervisory agencies and bodies broad administrative powers, including the power to limit or restrict us

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   8  


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

from carrying on our asset management activities in the event that we fail to comply with such laws and regulations. Sanctions that may be imposed for such failure include the suspension of individual employees, limitations on our engaging in various asset management activities for specified periods of time or specified types of clients, the revocation of registrations, other censures and significant fines. In order to facilitate our asset management business, we own a registered U.S. broker-dealer, Morgan Stanley Distribution, Inc., which acts as distributor to the Morgan Stanley mutual funds and as placement agent to certain private investment funds managed by our Investment Management business segment. In addition, certain of our affiliates are registered as commodity trading advisors and/or commodity pool operators, or are operating under certain exemptions from such registration pursuant to CFTC rules and other guidance, and have certain responsibilities with respect to each pool they advise. Violations of the rules of the CFTC, the NFA or the commodity exchanges could result in remedial actions, including fines, registration restrictions or terminations, trading prohibitions or revocations of commodity exchange memberships. See also “—Institutional Securities and Wealth Management—Broker-Dealer and Investment Adviser Regulation,” “—Institutional Securities and Wealth Management—Regulation of Futures Activities and Certain Commodities Activities,” “—Institutional Securities and Wealth Management—Derivatives Regulation” and “—Institutional Securities and Wealth Management—Non-U.S. Regulation” above for a discussion of other regulations that impact our Investment Management business, including, among other things, the Department of Labor’s conflict of interest rule and MiFID II.

As a result of the passage of the Dodd-Frank Act, our asset management activities are subject to certain additional laws and regulations, including, but not limited to, additional reporting and recordkeeping requirements (including with respect to clients that are private funds) and restrictions on sponsoring or investing in, or maintaining certain other relationships with, “covered funds,” as defined in the Volcker Rule, subject to certain limited exemptions. Many of these requirements may increase the expenses associated with our asset management activities and/or reduce the investment returns we are able to generate for our asset management clients. See also “—Financial Holding Company—Activities Restrictions under the Volcker Rule” and “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Liquidity and Capital Resources—Regulatory Developments.”

Our Investment Management business is also regulated outside the U.S. For example, the FCA is the primary regulator of our business in the U.K.; the Financial Services Agency regulates our business in Japan; the Securities and Futures Commission of Hong Kong regulates our business in

Hong Kong; and the Monetary Authority of Singapore regulates our business in Singapore. See also “—Institutional Securities and Wealth Management—Non-U.S. Regulation” herein.

Financial Crimes Program

Our Financial Crimes program is coordinated on an enterprise-wide basis and supports our financial crime prevention efforts across all regions and business units with responsibility for governance, oversight and execution of our Anti-Money Laundering (“AML”), economic sanctions (“Sanctions”) and anti-corruption programs.

In the U.S., the Bank Secrecy Act, as amended by the USA PATRIOT Act of 2001, imposes significant obligations on financial institutions to detect and deter money laundering and terrorist financing activity, including requiring banks, bank holding companies and their subsidiaries, broker-dealers, futures commission merchants, introducing brokers and mutual funds to implement AML programs, verify the identity of customers that maintain accounts, and monitor and report suspicious activity to appropriate law enforcement or regulatory authorities. Outside the U.S., applicable laws, rules and regulations similarly require designated types of financial institutions to implement AML programs. We have implemented policies, procedures and internal controls that are designed to comply with all applicable AML laws and regulations. Regarding Sanctions, we have implemented policies, procedures and internal controls that are designed to comply with the regulations and economic sanctions programs administered by the U.S. Treasury’s Office of Foreign Assets Control (“OFAC”), which target foreign countries, entities and individuals based on external threats to U.S. foreign policy, national security or economic interests, and to comply, as applicable, similar sanctions programs imposed by foreign governments or global or regional multilateral organizations such as the United Nations Security Council and the E.U. Council.

We are also subject to applicable anti-corruption laws, such as the U.S. Foreign Corrupt Practices Act and the U.K. Bribery Act, in the jurisdictions in which we operate. Anti-corruption laws generally prohibit offering, promising, giving or authorizing others to give anything of value, either directly or indirectly, to a government official or private party in order to influence official action or otherwise gain an unfair business advantage, such as to obtain or retain business. We have implemented policies, procedures and internal controls that are designed to comply with such laws, rules and regulations.

 

 

  9   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

Protection of Client Information

Many aspects of our businesses are subject to legal requirements concerning the use and protection of certain customer information, including those adopted pursuant to the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act and the Fair and Accurate Credit Transactions Act of 2003 in the U.S., the E.U. Data Protection Directive and various laws in Asia, including the Japanese Personal Information (Protection) Law, the Hong Kong Personal Data (Protection) Ordinance and the Australian Privacy Act. We have adopted measures designed to comply with these and related applicable requirements in all relevant jurisdictions.

Compensation Practices and Other Regulation

Our compensation practices are subject to oversight by the Federal Reserve and, with respect to some of our subsidiaries and employees, by other financial regulatory bodies worldwide. In particular, we are subject to the Federal Reserve’s guidance that is designed to help ensure that incentive compensation paid by banking organizations does not encourage imprudent risk taking that threatens the organizations’ safety and soundness. The scope and content of the Federal Reserve’s policies on executive compensation are continuing to develop and may change based on findings from its peer review process, and we expect that these policies will evolve over a number of years.

We are subject to the compensation-related provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act, which may impact our compensation practices. In 2016, pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act, certain federal regulatory agencies reproposed a rule, which, if implemented as written, would require, among other things, the deferral of a percentage of certain incentive-based compensation for senior executives and certain other employees and, under certain circumstances, “clawback” of incentive-based compensation. In addition, pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act, in 2015, the SEC proposed rules that would direct stock exchanges to require listed companies to implement clawback policies to recover incentive-based compensation from current or former executive officers in the event of certain financial restatements and would also require companies to disclose their clawback policies and their actions under those policies. We continue to evaluate the proposed rules, both of which are subject to further rulemaking procedures.

Our compensation practices may also be impacted by regulations in other jurisdictions. Our compensation practices with respect to certain employees whose activities have a material impact on the risk profile of our E.U. operations are subject to the Capital Requirements Directive IV (the “CRD IV”) and related E.U. and Member State regulations, including, among others, a cap on the ratio of variable remuneration to fixed

remuneration and clawback arrangements in relation to variable remuneration paid in the past. In the U.K., the remuneration of certain employees of banks and other firms is governed by the Remuneration Code of the FCA and by the PRA Rulebook (Remuneration Part), including provisions that implement the CRD IV, as well as additional U.K. requirements.

For a discussion of certain risks relating to our regulatory environment, see “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A.

Executive Officers of Morgan Stanley

The executive officers of Morgan Stanley and their ages and titles as of February 27, 2017 are set forth below. Business experience for the past five years is provided in accordance with SEC rules.

Jeffrey S. Brodsky (52).    Executive Vice President and Chief Human Resources Officer of Morgan Stanley (since January 2016). Vice President and Global Head of Human Resources (January 2011 to December 2015). Co-Head of Human Resources (January 2010 to December 2011). Head of Morgan Stanley Smith Barney Human Resources (June 2009 to January 2010).

James P. Gorman (58).    Chairman of the Board of Directors and Chief Executive Officer of Morgan Stanley (since January 2012). President and Chief Executive Officer (January 2010 through December 2011) and member of the Board of Directors (since January 2010). Co-President (December 2007 to December 2009) and Co-Head of Strategic Planning (October 2007 to December 2009). President and Chief Operating Officer of Wealth Management (February 2006 to April 2008).

Eric F. Grossman (50).    Executive Vice President and Chief Legal Officer of Morgan Stanley (since January 2012). Global Head of Legal (September 2010 to January 2012). Global Head of Litigation (January 2006 to September 2010) and General Counsel of the Americas (May 2009 to September 2010). General Counsel of Wealth Management (November 2008 to September 2010). Partner at the law firm of Davis Polk & Wardwell LLP (June 2001 to December 2005).

Keishi Hotsuki (54).    Executive Vice President (since May 2014) and Chief Risk Officer of Morgan Stanley (since May 2011). Interim Chief Risk Officer (January 2011 to May 2011) and Head of Market Risk Department (March 2008 to April 2014). Director of Mitsubishi UFJ Morgan Stanley Securities Co., Ltd. (since May 2010). Global Head of Market Risk Management at Merrill Lynch (June 2005 to September 2007).

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   10  


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

Colm Kelleher (59).    President of Morgan Stanley (since January 2016). Executive Vice President (October 2007 to January 2016). President of Institutional Securities (January 2013 to January 2016). Head of International (January 2011 to January 2016). Co-President of Institutional Securities (January 2010 to December 2012). Chief Financial Officer and Co-Head of Strategic Planning (October 2007 to December 2009). Head of Global Capital Markets (February 2006 to October 2007). Co-Head of Fixed Income Europe (May 2004 to February 2006).

Jonathan M. Pruzan (48).    Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of Morgan Stanley (since May 2015). Co-Head of Global Financial Institutions Group (January 2010 to April 2015). Co-Head of North American Financial Institutions Group M&A (September 2007 to December 2009). Head of the U.S. Bank Group (April 2005 to August 2007).

Daniel A. Simkowitz (51).    Head of Investment Management of Morgan Stanley (since October 2015). Co-Head of Global Capital Markets (March 2013 to September 2015). Chairman of Global Capital Markets (November 2009 to March 2013). Managing Director in Global Capital Markets (December 2000 to November 2009).

 

 

  11   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

Item 1A. Risk Factors

For a discussion of the risks and uncertainties that may affect our future results and strategic objectives, see “Forward-Looking Statements” immediately preceding Part I, Item 1 and “Return on Equity Target” and “Effects of Inflation and Changes in Interest and Foreign Exchange Rates” under “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” in Part II, Item 7.

Market Risk

Market risk refers to the risk that a change in the level of one or more market prices, rates, indices, implied volatilities (the price volatility of the underlying instrument imputed from option prices), correlations or other market factors, such as market liquidity, will result in losses for a position or portfolio owned by us. For more information on how we monitor and manage market risk, see “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk—Risk Management—Market Risk” in Part II, Item 7A.

Our results of operations may be materially affected by market fluctuations and by global and economic conditions and other factors, including changes in asset values.

Our results of operations have been in the past and may, in the future, be materially affected by market fluctuations due to global financial markets, economic conditions, changes to the global trade policies and other factors, including the level and volatility of equity, fixed income and commodity prices (including oil prices), interest rates, currency values and other market indices. The results of our Institutional Securities business segment, particularly results relating to our involvement in primary and secondary markets for all types of financial products, are subject to substantial market fluctuations due to a variety of factors that we cannot control or predict with great certainty. These fluctuations impact results by causing variations in new business flows and in the fair value of securities and other financial products. Fluctuations also occur due to the level of global market activity, which, among other things, affects the size, number and timing of investment banking client assignments and transactions and the realization of returns from our principal investments. During periods of unfavorable market or economic conditions, the level of individual investor participation in the global markets, as well as the level of client assets, may also decrease, which would negatively impact the results of our Wealth Management business segment. In addition, fluctuations in global market activity could impact the flow of investment capital into or from assets under management or supervision and the way customers allocate capital among

money market, equity, fixed income or other investment alternatives, which could negatively impact our Investment Management business segment.

The value of our financial instruments may be materially affected by market fluctuations. Market volatility, illiquid market conditions and disruptions in the credit markets make it extremely difficult to value certain of our financial instruments, particularly during periods of market displacement. Subsequent valuations in future periods, in light of factors then prevailing, may result in significant changes in the values of these instruments and may adversely impact historical or prospective performance-based fees (also known as incentive fees or carried interest) in respect of certain business. In addition, at the time of any sales and settlements of these financial instruments, the price we ultimately realize will depend on the demand and liquidity in the market at that time and may be materially lower than their current fair value. Any of these factors could cause a decline in the value of our financial instruments, which may have an adverse effect on our results of operations in future periods.

In addition, financial markets are susceptible to severe events evidenced by rapid depreciation in asset values accompanied by a reduction in asset liquidity. Under these extreme conditions, hedging and other risk management strategies may not be as effective at mitigating trading losses as they would be under more normal market conditions. Moreover, under these conditions, market participants are particularly exposed to trading strategies employed by many market participants simultaneously and on a large scale. Our risk management and monitoring processes seek to quantify and mitigate risk to more extreme market moves. However, severe market events have historically been difficult to predict and we could realize significant losses if extreme market events were to occur.

Holding large and concentrated positions may expose us to losses.

Concentration of risk may reduce revenues or result in losses in our market-making, investing, block trading, underwriting and lending businesses in the event of unfavorable market movements, or when market conditions are more favorable for our competitors. We commit substantial amounts of capital to these businesses, which often results in our taking large positions in the securities of, or making large loans to, a particular issuer or issuers in a particular industry, country or region. For further information regarding our country risk exposure, see also “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk—Risk Management—Credit Risk—Country Risk Exposure” in Item 7A.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   12  


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

Credit Risk

Credit risk refers to the risk of loss arising when a borrower, counterparty or issuer does not meet its financial obligations to us. For more information on how we monitor and manage credit risk, see “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk—Risk Management—Credit Risk” in Part II, Item 7A.

We are exposed to the risk that third parties that are indebted to us will not perform their obligations.

We incur significant credit risk exposure through our Institutional Securities business segment. This risk may arise from a variety of business activities, including but not limited to extending credit to clients through various lending commitments; entering into swap or other derivative contracts under which counterparties have obligations to make payments to us; providing short or long-term funding that is secured by physical or financial collateral whose value may at times be insufficient to fully cover the loan repayment amount; posting margin and/or collateral and other commitments to clearing houses, clearing agencies, exchanges, banks, securities firms and other financial counterparties; and investing and trading in securities and loan pools whereby the value of these assets may fluctuate based on realized or expected defaults on the underlying obligations or loans.

We also incur credit risk in our Wealth Management business segment lending to mainly individual investors, including, but not limited to, margin and securities-based loans collateralized by securities, residential mortgage loans and home equity lines of credit.

While we believe current valuations and reserves adequately address our perceived levels of risk, adverse economic conditions may negatively impact our clients and our current credit exposures. In addition, as a clearing member of several central counterparties, we finance our customer positions and we could be held responsible for the defaults or misconduct of our customers. Although we regularly review our credit exposures, default risk may arise from events or circumstances that are difficult to detect or foresee.

A default by a large financial institution could adversely affect financial markets.

The commercial soundness of many financial institutions may be closely interrelated as a result of credit, trading, clearing or other relationships among the institutions. For example, increased centralization of trading activities through particular clearing houses, central agents or exchanges as required by provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act may increase our concentration of risk with respect to these entities. As a

result, concerns about, or a default or threatened default by, one institution could lead to significant market-wide liquidity and credit problems, losses or defaults by other institutions. This is sometimes referred to as “systemic risk” and may adversely affect financial intermediaries, such as clearing houses, clearing agencies, exchanges, banks and securities firms, with which we interact on a daily basis, and therefore could adversely affect us. See also “Systemic Risk Regime” under “Business—Supervision and Regulation—Financial Holding Company” in Part I, Item 1.

Operational Risk

Operational risk refers to the risk of loss, or of damage to our reputation, resulting from inadequate or failed processes or systems, human factors or from external events (e.g., fraud, theft, legal and compliance risks, cyber attacks or damage to physical assets). We may incur operational risk across the full scope of our business activities, including revenue-generating activities (e.g., sales and trading) and support and control groups (e.g., information technology and trade processing). Legal, regulatory and compliance risk is included in the scope of operational risk and is discussed below under “Legal, Regulatory and Compliance Risk.” For more information on how we monitor and manage operational risk, see “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk—Risk Management—Operational Risk” in Part II, Item 7A.

We are subject to operational risks, including a failure, breach or other disruption of our operational or security systems, that could adversely affect our businesses or reputation.

Our businesses are highly dependent on our ability to process and report, on a daily basis, a large number of transactions across numerous and diverse markets in many currencies. In some of our businesses, the transactions we process are complex. In addition, we may introduce new products or services or change processes or reporting, including in connection with new regulatory requirements, resulting in new operational risk that we may not fully appreciate or identify. The trend toward direct access to automated, electronic markets and the move to more automated trading platforms has resulted in using increasingly complex technology that relies on the continued effectiveness of the programming code and integrity of the data to process the trades. We perform the functions required to operate our different businesses either by ourselves or through agreements with third parties. We rely on the ability of our employees, our internal systems and systems at technology centers operated by unaffiliated third parties to process a high volume of transactions. Additionally, we are subject to complex and evolving laws and regulations governing privacy and data protection, which may differ, and potentially conflict, in various jurisdictions.

 

 

  13   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

As a major participant in the global capital markets, we maintain extensive controls to reduce the risk of incorrect valuation or risk management of our trading positions due to flaws in data, models, electronic trading systems or processes or due to fraud. Nevertheless, such risk cannot be completely eliminated.

We also face the risk of operational failure or termination of any of the clearing agents, exchanges, clearing houses or other financial intermediaries we use to facilitate our lending. securities and derivatives transactions. In the event of a breakdown or improper operation of our or a third party’s systems or improper or unauthorized action by third parties or our employees, we could suffer financial loss, an impairment to our liquidity, a disruption of our businesses, regulatory sanctions or damage to our reputation. In addition, the interconnectivity of multiple financial institutions with central agents, exchanges and clearing houses, and the increased importance of these entities, increases the risk that an operational failure at one institution or entity may cause an industry-wide operational failure that could materially impact our ability to conduct business.

Despite the business contingency plans we have in place, there can be no assurance that such plans will fully mitigate all potential business continuity risks to us. Our ability to conduct business may be adversely affected by a disruption in the infrastructure that supports our business and the communities where we are located, which are concentrated in the New York metropolitan area, London, Hong Kong and Tokyo as well as Mumbai, Budapest, Glasgow and Baltimore. This may include a disruption involving physical site access, cyber incidents, terrorist activities, disease pandemics, catastrophic events, natural disasters, extreme weather events, electrical outage, environmental hazard, computer servers, communications or other services we use, our employees or third parties with whom we conduct business.

Although we devote significant resources to maintaining and upgrading our systems and networks with measures such as intrusion prevention and detection systems, monitoring firewalls and network traffic to safeguard critical business applications, and supervising third party providers that have access to our systems, there is no guarantee that these measures or any other measures can provide absolute security given the techniques used in cyber attacks are complex and frequently change, and may not be able to be anticipated. Like other financial services firms, the Firm and its third party providers continue to be the subject of attempted unauthorized access, mishandling or misuse of information, computer viruses or malware, cyber attacks designed to obtain confidential information, destroy data, disrupt or degrade service, sabotage

systems or cause other damage, denial of service attacks and other events. These threats may derive from human error, fraud or malice on the part of our employees or third parties, including third party providers, or may result from accidental technological failure. Additional challenges are posed by external extremist parties, including foreign state actors, in some circumstances as a means to promote political ends. Any of these parties may also attempt to fraudulently induce employees, customers, clients, third parties or other users of our systems to disclose sensitive information in order to gain access to our data or that of our customers or clients. There can be no assurance that such unauthorized access or cyber incidents will not occur in the future, and they could occur more frequently and on a more significant scale.

If one or more of these events occur, it could result in a security impact on our systems and jeopardize our or our clients’, partners’ or counterparties’ personal, confidential, proprietary or other information processed and stored in, and transmitted through, our and our third party providers’ computer systems. Furthermore, such events could cause interruptions or malfunctions in our, our clients’, partners’, counterparties’ or third parties’ operations, which could result in reputational damage with our clients and the market, client dissatisfaction, additional costs to us (such as repairing systems or adding new personnel or protection technologies), regulatory investigations, litigation or enforcement, or regulatory fines or penalties, all or any of which could adversely affect our business, financial condition or results of operations.

Given our global footprint and the high volume of transactions we process, the large number of clients, partners and counterparties with which we do business, and the increasing sophistication of cyber attacks, a cyber attack could occur and persist for an extended period of time without detection. We expect that any investigation of a cyber attack would be inherently unpredictable and that it would take time before the completion of any investigation and before there is availability of full and reliable information. During such time we would not necessarily know the extent of the harm or how best to remediate it, and certain errors or actions could be repeated or compounded before they are discovered and remediated, all or any of which would further increase the costs and consequences of a cyber attack.

While many of our agreements with partners and third party vendors include indemnification provisions, we may not be able to recover sufficiently, or at all, under such provisions to adequately offset any losses. In addition, although we maintain insurance coverage that may, subject to policy terms and conditions, cover certain aspects of cyber risks, such insurance coverage may be insufficient to cover all losses.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   14  


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

Liquidity and Funding Risk

Liquidity and funding risk refers to the risk that we will be unable to finance our operations due to a loss of access to the capital markets or difficulty in liquidating our assets. Liquidity and funding risk encompasses the risk that our financial condition or overall soundness is adversely affected by an inability or perceived inability to meet our financial obligations in a timely manner. It also includes the associated funding risks triggered by the market or idiosyncratic stress events that may cause unexpected changes in funding needs or an inability to raise new funding. For more information on how we monitor and manage liquidity and funding risk, see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Liquidity and Capital Resources” in Part II, Item 7 and “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk—Risk Management—Liquidity and Funding Risk” in Part II, Item 7A.

Liquidity is essential to our businesses and we rely on external sources to finance a significant portion of our operations.

Liquidity is essential to our businesses. Our liquidity could be negatively affected by our inability to raise funding in the long-term or short-term debt capital markets or our inability to access the secured lending markets. Factors that we cannot control, such as disruption of the financial markets or negative views about the financial services industry generally, including concerns regarding fiscal matters in the U.S. and other geographic areas, could impair our ability to raise funding.

In addition, our ability to raise funding could be impaired if investors or lenders develop a negative perception of our long-term or short-term financial prospects due to factors such as an incurrence of large trading losses, a downgrade by the rating agencies, a decline in the level of our business activity, or if regulatory authorities take significant action against us or our industry, or we discover significant employee misconduct or illegal activity. If we are unable to raise funding using the methods described above, we would likely need to finance or liquidate unencumbered assets, such as our investment portfolios or trading assets, to meet maturing liabilities. We may be unable to sell some of our assets or we may have to sell assets at a discount to market value, either of which could adversely affect our results of operations, cash flows and financial condition.

Our borrowing costs and access to the debt capital markets depend on our credit ratings.

The cost and availability of unsecured financing generally are impacted by our short-term and long-term credit ratings. The

rating agencies continue to monitor certain issuer specific factors that are important to the determination of our credit ratings, including governance, the level and quality of earnings, capital adequacy, liquidity and funding, risk appetite and management, asset quality, strategic direction, and business mix. Additionally, the rating agencies will look at other industry-wide factors such as regulatory or legislative changes, including, for example, regulatory changes, macro-economic environment, and perceived levels of third party support, and it is possible that they could downgrade our ratings and those of similar institutions.

Our credit ratings also can have a significant impact on certain trading revenues, particularly in those businesses where longer term counterparty performance is a key consideration, such as OTC and other derivative transactions, including credit derivatives and interest rate swaps. In connection with certain OTC trading agreements and certain other agreements associated with our Institutional Securities business segment, we may be required to provide additional collateral to, or immediately settle any outstanding liability balance with, certain counterparties in the event of a credit ratings downgrade. Termination of our trading and other agreements could cause us to sustain losses and impair our liquidity by requiring us to find other sources of financing or to make significant cash payments or securities movements. The additional collateral or termination payments which may occur in the event of a future credit rating downgrade vary by contract and can be based on ratings by either or both of Moody’s Investors Services, Inc. and S&P Global Ratings. See also “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Liquidity and Capital Resources—Credit Ratings—Incremental Collateral or Terminating Payments upon Potential Future Rating Downgrade” in Part II, Item 7.

We are a holding company and depend on payments from our subsidiaries.

The Parent Company has no operations and depends on dividends, distributions and other payments from its subsidiaries to fund dividend payments and to fund all payments on its obligations, including debt obligations. Regulatory, tax restrictions or elections and other legal restrictions may limit our ability to transfer funds freely, either to or from our subsidiaries. In particular, many of our subsidiaries, including our broker-dealer subsidiaries, are subject to laws, regulations and self-regulatory organization rules that limit, as well as authorize regulatory bodies to block or reduce, the flow of funds to the Parent Company, or that prohibit such transfers or dividends altogether in certain circumstances, including steps to “ring fence” entities by regulators outside of the U.S. to protect clients and creditors of such entities in the event of

 

 

  15   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

financial difficulties involving such entities. These laws, regulations and rules may hinder our ability to access funds that we may need to make payments on our obligations. Furthermore, as a bank holding company, we may become subject to a prohibition or to limitations on our ability to pay dividends or repurchase our common stock. The OCC, the Federal Reserve and the FDIC have the authority, and under certain circumstances the duty, to prohibit or to limit the payment of dividends by the banking organizations they supervise, including the Firm and its U.S. Bank Subsidiaries.

Our liquidity and financial condition have in the past been, and in the future could be, adversely affected by U.S. and international markets and economic conditions.

Our ability to raise funding in the long-term or short-term debt capital markets or the equity markets, or to access secured lending markets, has in the past been, and could in the future be, adversely affected by conditions in the U.S. and international markets and economies. Global market and economic conditions have been particularly disrupted and volatile in the last several years and may be in the future. In particular, our cost and availability of funding in the past have been, and may in the future be, adversely affected by illiquid credit markets and wider credit spreads. Significant turbulence in the U.S., the E.U. and other international markets and economies could adversely affect our liquidity and financial condition and the willingness of certain counterparties and customers to do business with us.

Legal, Regulatory and Compliance Risk

Legal, regulatory and compliance risk includes the risk of legal or regulatory sanctions, material financial loss including fines, penalties, judgments, damages and/or settlements, or loss to reputation we may suffer as a result of our failure to comply with laws, regulations, rules, related self-regulatory organization standards and codes of conduct applicable to our business activities. This risk also includes contractual and commercial risk, such as the risk that a counterparty’s performance obligations will be unenforceable. It also includes compliance with AML, anti-corruption and terrorist financing rules and regulations. For more information on how we monitor and manage legal, regulatory and compliance risk, see “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk—Risk Management—Legal and Compliance Risk” in Part II, Item 7A.

The financial services industry is subject to extensive regulation, and changes in regulation will impact our business.

Like other major financial services firms, we are subject to extensive regulation by U.S. federal and state regulatory agencies and securities exchanges and by regulators and

exchanges in each of the major markets where we conduct our business. These laws and regulations significantly affect the way we do business and can restrict the scope of our existing businesses and limit our ability to expand our product offerings and pursue certain investments.

The regulation of major financial firms, including the Firm, as well as of the markets in which we operate, is extensive and subject to ongoing change. We are, or will become, subject to (among other things) wide-ranging regulation and supervision, intensive scrutiny of our businesses and any plans for expansion of those businesses, limitations on new activities, a systemic risk regime that imposes heightened capital and liquidity requirements and other enhanced prudential standards, resolution regimes and resolution planning requirements, new requirements for maintaining minimum amounts of external total loss-absorbing capacity and external long-term debt, restrictions on activities and investments imposed by the Volcker Rule, comprehensive derivatives regulation, tax regulations, antitrust laws, trade and transaction reporting obligations, and broadened fiduciary obligations. In some areas, regulatory standards have not yet been finalized, are subject to final rulemaking or transition periods or may otherwise be revised in whole or in part. Ongoing implementation of, or changes in, laws and regulations could materially impact the profitability of our businesses and the value of assets we hold, expose us to additional costs, require changes to business practices or force us to discontinue businesses, adversely affect our ability to pay dividends and repurchase our stock, or require us to raise capital, including in ways that may adversely impact our shareholders or creditors. In addition, regulatory requirements that are being imposed by foreign policymakers and regulators may be inconsistent or conflict with regulations that we are subject to in the U.S. and may adversely affect us. We expect legal and regulatory requirements to be subject to ongoing change for the foreseeable future, which may result in significant new costs to comply with new or revised requirements as well as to monitor for compliance on an ongoing basis.

The application of regulatory requirements and strategies in the United States or other jurisdictions to facilitate the orderly resolution of large financial institutions may pose a greater risk of loss for our security holders, and subject us to other restrictions.

Pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act, we are required to submit to the Federal Reserve and the FDIC an annual resolution plan that describes our strategy for a rapid and orderly resolution under the U.S. Bankruptcy Code in the event of material financial distress or failure. If the Federal Reserve and the FDIC were to jointly determine that our annual resolution plan submission was not credible or would not facilitate an orderly resolution, and if we were unable to address any defi-

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   16  


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

ciencies identified by the regulators, we or any of our subsidiaries may be subject to more stringent capital, leverage, or liquidity requirements or restrictions on our growth, activities, or operations, or after a two year period, we may be required to divest assets or operations.

In addition, provided that certain procedures are met, we can be subject to a resolution proceeding under the orderly liquidation authority under Title II of the Dodd-Frank Act with the FDIC being appointed as receiver. The FDIC’s power under the orderly liquidation authority to disregard the priority of creditor claims and treat similarly situated creditors differently in certain circumstances, subject to certain limitations, could adversely impact holders of our unsecured debt. See “Business—Supervision and Regulation” in Part I, Item 1 and “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Liquidity and Capital Resources—Regulatory Requirements” in Part II, Item 7.

Further, because both our resolution plan contemplates a an SPOE strategy under the U.S. Bankruptcy Code and the FDIC has proposed an SPOE strategy through which it may apply its orderly liquidation authority powers, we believe that the application of an SPOE strategy is the reasonably likely outcome if either our resolution plan were implemented or a resolution proceeding were commenced under the orderly liquidation authority. An SPOE strategy generally contemplates the provision of additional capital and liquidity by the Parent Company to certain of its subsidiaries so that such subsidiaries have the resources necessary to implement the resolution strategy, and the Parent Company expects to enter into an amended and restated secured support agreement with its material subsidiaries pursuant to which it would provide such capital and liquidity.

Under the amended and restated support agreement, upon the occurrence of a resolution scenario, including one in which an SPOE strategy is used, the Parent Company will be obligated to contribute or loan on a subordinated basis all of its material assets, other than shares in subsidiaries of the Parent Company and certain intercompany payables, to provide capital and liquidity, as applicable, to its material subsidiaries. The obligations of the Parent Company under the amended and restated support agreement will be secured on a senior basis by the assets of the Parent Company (other than shares in subsidiaries of the Parent Company). As a result, claims of our material subsidiaries against the assets of the Parent Company (other than shares in subsidiaries of the Parent Company) will be effectively senior to unsecured obligations of the Parent Company. Such unsecured obligations would be at risk of absorbing losses of the Parent Company and its subsidiaries. Although an SPOE strategy, whether applied pursuant to our resolution plan or in a resolution

proceeding under the orderly liquidation authority, is intended to result in better outcomes for creditors overall, there is no guarantee that the application of an SPOE strategy, including the provision of support to the Parent Company’s material subsidiaries pursuant to the amended and restated secured support agreement, will not result in greater losses for holders of our securities compared to a different resolution strategy for the firm.

Regulators have taken and proposed various actions to facilitate an SPOE strategy under the U.S. Bankruptcy Code, the orderly liquidation authority or other resolution regimes. For example, the Federal Reserve has issued a final rule that requires top-tier bank holding companies of U.S. G-SIBs, including Morgan Stanley, to maintain minimum amounts of equity and eligible long-term debt (“total loss-absorbing capacity” or “TLAC”) in order to ensure that such institutions have enough loss-absorbing resources at the point of failure to be recapitalized through the conversion of debt to equity or otherwise by imposing losses on eligible TLAC where the SPOE strategy is used. The combined implication of the SPOE resolution strategy and the TLAC final rule is that our losses will be imposed on the holders of eligible long-term debt and other forms of eligible TLAC issued by the Parent Company before any losses are imposed on the holders of the debt securities of our operating subsidiaries or before putting U.S. taxpayers at risk.

In addition, certain jurisdictions, including the U.K. and other E.U. jurisdictions, have implemented, or are in the process of implementing, changes to resolution regimes to provide resolution authorities with the ability to recapitalize a failing entity organized in such jurisdiction by writing down certain unsecured liabilities or converting certain unsecured liabilities into equity. Such “bail-in” powers are intended to enable the recapitalization of a failing institution by allocating losses to its shareholders and unsecured creditors. Non-U.S. regulators are also considering requirements that certain subsidiaries of large financial institutions maintain minimum amounts of total loss-absorbing capacity that would pass losses up from the subsidiaries to the Parent Company and, ultimately, to security holders of the Parent Company in the event of failure.

We may be prevented from paying dividends or taking other capital actions because of regulatory constraints or revised regulatory capital standards.

We are subject to comprehensive consolidated supervision, regulation and examination by the Federal Reserve, which requires us to submit, on an annual basis, a capital plan describing proposed dividend payments to shareholders,

 

 

  17   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

proposed repurchases of our outstanding securities, and other proposed capital actions that we intend to take. The Federal Reserve may object to, or otherwise require us to modify, such plan, or may object or require modifications to a resubmitted capital plan, any of which would adversely affect shareholders. In addition, beyond review of the plan, the Federal Reserve may impose other restrictions or conditions on us that prevent us from paying or increasing dividends, repurchasing securities or taking other capital actions that would benefit shareholders. Finally, the Federal Reserve may change regulatory capital standards to impose higher requirements that restrict our ability to take capital actions, or may modify or impose other regulatory standards that increase our operating expenses and reduce our ability to take capital actions.

The financial services industry faces substantial litigation and is subject to extensive regulatory and law enforcement investigations, and we may face damage to our reputation and legal liability.

As a global financial services firm, we face the risk of investigations and proceedings by governmental and self-regulatory organizations in all countries in which we conduct our business. Investigations and proceedings initiated by these authorities may result in adverse judgments, settlements, fines, penalties, injunctions or other relief. In addition to the monetary consequences, these measures could, for example, impact our ability to engage in, or impose limitations on, certain of our businesses. The number of these investigations and proceedings, as well as the amount of penalties and fines sought, has increased substantially in recent years with regard to many firms in the financial services industry, including the Firm, and certain U.S. and international governmental entities have increasingly brought criminal actions against, or have sought criminal convictions, pleas or deferred prosecution agreements from, financial institutions. Significant regulatory or law enforcement action against us could materially adversely affect our business, financial condition or results of operations or cause us significant reputational harm, which could seriously harm our business. The Dodd-Frank Act also provides compensation to whistleblowers who present the SEC or CFTC with information related to securities or commodities law violations that leads to a successful enforcement action. As a result of this compensation, it is possible we could face an increased number of investigations by the SEC or CFTC.

We have been named, from time to time, as a defendant in various legal actions, including arbitrations, class actions, and other litigation, as well as investigations or proceedings brought by regulatory agencies, arising in connection with our activities as a global diversified financial services institution. Certain of the actual or threatened legal or regulatory

actions include claims for substantial compensatory and/or punitive damages, claims for indeterminate amounts of damages, or may result in penalties, fines, or other results adverse to us. In some cases, the issuers that would otherwise be the primary defendants in such cases are bankrupt or are in financial distress. In other cases, including antitrust litigation, we may be subject to claims for joint and several liability with other defendants for treble damages or other relief related to alleged conspiracies involving other institutions. Like any large corporation, we are also subject to risk from potential employee misconduct, including non-compliance with policies and improper use or disclosure of confidential information, or improper sales practices or conduct.

We may be responsible for representations and warranties associated with residential and commercial real estate loans and may incur losses in excess of our reserves.

We originate loans secured by commercial and residential properties. Further, we securitize and trade in a wide range of commercial and residential real estate and real estate-related whole loans, mortgages and other real estate and commercial assets and products, including residential and commercial mortgage-backed securities. In connection with these activities, we have provided, or otherwise agreed to be responsible for, certain representations and warranties. Under certain circumstances, we may be required to repurchase such assets or make other payments related to such assets if such representations and warranties were breached. We have also made representations and warranties in connection with our role as an originator of certain commercial mortgage loans that we securitized in commercial mortgage-backed securities. For additional information, see also Note 12 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8.

We currently have several legal proceedings related to claims for alleged breaches of representations and warranties. If there are decisions adverse to us in those legal proceedings, we may incur losses substantially in excess of our reserves. In addition, our reserves are based, in part, on certain factual and legal assumptions. If those assumptions are incorrect and need to be revised, we may need to adjust our reserves substantially.

Our commodities activities and investments subject us to extensive regulation, and environmental risks and regulation that may expose us to significant costs and liabilities.

In connection with the commodities activities in our Institutional Securities business segment, we engage in the storage, transportation, marketing and execution of transactions in several commodities, including metals, natural gas, electric power, emission credits, and other commodity products. In

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   18  


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

addition, we are an electricity power marketer in the U.S. and own a minority interest in Heidmar Holdings LLC, which owns a group of companies that provide international marine transportation and U.S. marine logistics services. As a result of these activities, we are subject to extensive energy, commodities, environmental, health and safety and other governmental laws and regulations. Further, through these activities we are exposed to regulatory, physical and certain indirect risks associated with climate change.

Although we have attempted to mitigate our environmental risks by, among other measures, selling or ceasing most of our prior petroleum storage and transportation activities, adopting appropriate policies and procedures, and implementing emergency response programs, these actions may not prove adequate to address every contingency. In addition, insurance covering some of these risks may not be available, and the proceeds, if any, from insurance recovery may not be adequate to cover liabilities with respect to particular incidents. As a result, our financial condition, results of operations and cash flows may be adversely affected by these events.

During the past several years, intensified scrutiny of certain energy markets by federal, state and local authorities in the U.S. and abroad and the public has resulted in increased regulatory and legal enforcement, litigation and remedial proceedings involving companies conducting the activities in which we are engaged. In addition, new regulation of OTC derivatives markets in the U.S. and similar legislation proposed or adopted abroad will impose significant new costs and impose new requirements on our commodities derivatives activities. We may incur substantial costs or loss of revenue in complying with current or future laws and regulations and our overall businesses and reputation may be adversely affected by the current legal environment. In addition, failure to comply with these laws and regulations may result in substantial civil and criminal fines and penalties. See also “Financial Holding Company—Capital Standards—Commodities-Related Capital Requirements” under “Business—Supervision and Regulation” in Part I, Item 1.

A failure to address conflicts of interest appropriately could adversely affect our businesses and reputation.

As a global financial services firm that provides products and services to a large and diversified group of clients, including corporations, governments, financial institutions and individuals, we face potential conflicts of interest in the normal course of business. For example, potential conflicts can occur when there is a divergence of interests between us and a client, among clients, between an employee on the one hand

and us or a client on the other, or situations in which we may be a creditor of a client. We have policies, procedures and controls that are designed to identify and address potential conflicts of interest. However, identifying and mitigating potential conflicts of interest can be complex and challenging, and can become the focus of media and regulatory scrutiny. Indeed, actions that merely appear to create a conflict can put our reputation at risk even if the likelihood of an actual conflict has been mitigated. It is possible that potential conflicts could give rise to litigation or enforcement actions, which may lead to our clients being less willing to enter into transactions in which a conflict may occur and could adversely affect our businesses and reputation.

Our regulators have the ability to scrutinize our activities for potential conflicts of interest, including through detailed examinations of specific transactions. For example, our status as a bank holding company supervised by the Federal Reserve subjects us to direct Federal Reserve scrutiny with respect to transactions between our U.S. Bank Subsidiaries and their affiliates. Further, the Volcker Rule subjects us to regulatory scrutiny regarding certain transactions between us and our clients.

Risk Management

Our risk management strategies, models and processes may not be fully effective in mitigating our risk exposures in all market environments or against all types of risk.

We have devoted significant resources to develop our risk management capabilities and expect to continue to do so in the future. Nonetheless, our risk management strategies, models and processes, including our use of various risk models for assessing market exposures and hedging strategies, stress testing and other analysis, may not be fully effective in mitigating our risk exposure in all market environments or against all types of risk, including risks that are unidentified or unanticipated. As our businesses change and grow, and the markets in which we operate evolve, our risk management strategies, models and processes may not always adapt with those changes. Some of our methods of managing risk are based upon our use of observed historical market behavior and management’s judgment. As a result, these methods may not predict future risk exposures, which could be significantly greater than the historical measures indicate. In addition, many models we use are based on assumptions or inputs regarding correlations among prices of various asset classes or other market indicators and therefore cannot anticipate sudden, unanticipated or unidentified market or economic movements, which could cause us to incur losses.

 

 

  19   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

Management of market, credit, liquidity, operational, legal, regulatory and compliance risks requires, among other things, policies and procedures to record properly and verify a large number of transactions and events, and these policies and procedures may not be fully effective. Our trading risk management strategies and techniques also seek to balance our ability to profit from trading positions with our exposure to potential losses. While we employ a broad and diversified set of risk monitoring and risk mitigation techniques, those techniques and the judgments that accompany their application cannot anticipate every economic and financial outcome or the timing of such outcomes. For example, to the extent that our trading or investing activities involve less liquid trading markets or are otherwise subject to restrictions on sales or hedging, we may not be able to reduce our positions and therefore reduce our risk associated with such positions. We may, therefore, incur losses in the course of our trading or investing activities. For more information on how we monitor and manage market and certain other risks and related strategies, models and processes, see “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk—Risk Management—Market Risk” in Part II, Item 7A.

Competitive Environment

We face strong competition from other financial services firms, which could lead to pricing pressures that could materially adversely affect our revenue and profitability.

The financial services industry and all aspects of our businesses are intensely competitive, and we expect them to remain so. We compete with commercial banks, brokerage firms, insurance companies, electronic trading and clearing platforms, financial data repositories, sponsors of mutual funds, hedge funds, energy companies and other companies offering financial or ancillary services in the U.S., globally and through the internet. We compete on the basis of several factors, including transaction execution, capital or access to capital, products and services, innovation, technology, reputation, risk appetite and price. Over time, certain sectors of the financial services industry have become more concentrated, as institutions involved in a broad range of financial services have left businesses, been acquired by or merged into other firms, or have declared bankruptcy. Such changes could result in our remaining competitors gaining greater capital and other resources, such as the ability to offer a broader range of products and services and geographic diversity, or new competitors may emerge. We have experienced and may continue to experience pricing pressures as a result of these factors and as some of our competitors seek to obtain market share by reducing prices. In addition, certain of our competitors may be subject to different, and, in some cases, less stringent, legal and regulatory regimes, than we are, thereby putting us at a competitive disadvantage. For more informa-

tion regarding the competitive environment in which we operate, see “Business—Competition” and “Business—Supervision and Regulation” in Part I, Item 1.

Automated trading markets may adversely affect our business and may increase competition.

We have experienced intense price competition in some of our businesses in recent years. In particular, the ability to execute securities, derivatives and other financial instrument trades electronically on exchanges, swap execution facilities, and other automated trading platforms has increased the pressure on bid-offer spreads, commissions, markups or comparable fees. The trend toward direct access to automated, electronic markets will likely continue and will likely increase as additional markets move to more automated trading platforms. We have experienced and it is likely that we will continue to experience competitive pressures in these and other areas in the future as some of our competitors may seek to obtain market share by reducing bid-offer spreads, commissions, markups or comparable fees.

Our ability to retain and attract qualified employees is critical to the success of our business and the failure to do so may materially adversely affect our performance.

Our people are our most important resource and competition for qualified employees is intense. If we are unable to continue to attract and retain highly qualified employees, or do so at rates or in forms necessary to maintain our competitive position, or if compensation costs required to attract and retain employees become more expensive, our performance, including our competitive position, could be materially adversely affected. The financial industry has experienced and may continue to experience more stringent regulation of employee compensation, including limitations relating to incentive-based compensation, clawback requirements and special taxation, which could have an adverse effect on our ability to hire or retain the most qualified employees.

International Risk

We are subject to numerous political, economic, legal, tax, operational, franchise and other risks as a result of our international operations which could adversely impact our businesses in many ways.

We are subject to political, economic, legal, tax, operational, franchise and other risks that are inherent in operating in many countries, including risks of possible nationalization, expropriation, price controls, capital controls, exchange controls, increased taxes and levies, and other restrictive governmental actions, as well as the outbreak of hostilities or political and governmental instability. In many countries, the

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   20  


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

laws and regulations applicable to the securities and financial services industries are uncertain and evolving, and it may be difficult for us to determine the exact requirements of local laws in every market. Our inability to remain in compliance with local laws in a particular market could have a significant and negative effect not only on our business in that market but also on our reputation generally. We are also subject to the enhanced risk that transactions we structure might not be legally enforceable in all cases.

Various emerging market countries have experienced severe political, economic or financial disruptions, including significant devaluations of their currencies, defaults or potential defaults on sovereign debt, capital and currency exchange controls, high rates of inflation and low or negative growth rates in their economies. Crime and corruption, as well as issues of security and personal safety, also exist in certain of these countries. These conditions could adversely impact our businesses and increase volatility in financial markets generally.

The emergence of a disease pandemic or other widespread health emergency, or concerns over the possibility of such an emergency as well as natural disasters, terrorist activities or military actions, could create economic and financial disruptions in emerging markets and other areas throughout the world, and could lead to operational difficulties (including travel limitations) that could impair our ability to manage our businesses around the world.

As a U.S. company, we are required to comply with the economic sanctions and embargo programs administered by OFAC and similar multi-national bodies and governmental agencies worldwide, as well as applicable anti-corruption laws in the jurisdictions in which we operate, such as the U.S. Foreign Corrupt Practices Act and the U.K. Bribery Act. A violation of a sanction, embargo program, or anti-corruption law could subject us, and individual employees, to a regulatory enforcement action as well as significant civil and criminal penalties.

The U.K.’s anticipated withdrawal from the E.U. could adversely affect us.

On June 23, 2016, the U.K. electorate voted to leave the E.U. It is difficult to predict the future of the U.K.’s relationship with the E.U., which uncertainty may increase the volatility in the global financial markets in the short- and medium-term. The U.K. Prime Minister has confirmed the U.K. will invoke Article 50 of the Lisbon Treaty by no later than the end of March 2017, subject to the passing of necessary legislation by the U.K. Parliament. This will trigger a two-year period, subject to extension, during which the U.K. government is expected to negotiate its withdrawal agreement with the E.U. Absent any changes to this time schedule, the U.K.

is expected to leave the E.U. in early 2019. The terms and conditions of the anticipated withdrawal from the E.U., and which of the several alternative models of relationship that the U.K. might seek to negotiate with the E.U., remain uncertain. However, the U.K. government has stated that the U.K. will leave the E.U. single market and will seek a phased period of implementation for the new relationship that may cover the legal and regulatory framework applicable to financial institutions with significant operations in Europe, such as the Firm. Potential effects of the U.K. exit from the E.U. and potential mitigation actions may vary considerably depending on the timing of withdrawal and the nature of any transition or successor arrangements. Any future limitations on providing financial services into the E.U. from our U.K. operations could require us to make potentially significant changes to our operations in the U.K. and Europe and our legal structure there, which could have an adverse effect on our business and financial results.

Acquisition, Divestiture and Joint Venture Risk

We may be unable to fully capture the expected value from acquisitions, divestitures, joint ventures, minority stakes or strategic alliances.

In connection with past or future acquisitions, divestitures, joint ventures, minority stakes or strategic alliances (including with Mitsubishi UFJ Financial Group, Inc.), we face numerous risks and uncertainties combining, transferring, separating or integrating the relevant businesses and systems, including the need to combine or separate accounting and data processing systems and management controls and to integrate relationships with clients, trading counterparties and business partners. In the case of joint ventures and minority stakes, we are subject to additional risks and uncertainties because we may be dependent upon, and subject to liability, losses or reputational damage relating to systems, controls and personnel that are not under our control.

In addition, conflicts or disagreements between us and any of our joint venture partners may negatively impact the benefits to be achieved by the relevant joint venture.

There is no assurance that any of our acquisitions or divestitures will be successfully integrated or disaggregated or yield all of the positive benefits anticipated. If we are not able to integrate or disaggregate successfully our past and future acquisitions or dispositions, there is a risk that our results of operations, financial condition and cash flows may be materially and adversely affected.

Certain of our business initiatives, including expansions of existing businesses, may bring us into contact, directly or

 

 

  21   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

indirectly, with individuals and entities that are not within our traditional client and counterparty base and may expose us to new asset classes and new markets. These business activities expose us to new and enhanced risks, greater regulatory scrutiny of these activities, increased credit-related, sovereign and operational risks, and reputational concerns regarding the manner in which these assets are being operated or held.

For more information regarding the regulatory environment in which we operate, see also “Business—Supervision and Regulation” in Part I, Item 1.

 

Item 1B. Unresolved Staff Comments

We, like other well-known seasoned issuers, from time to time receive written comments from the staff of the SEC regarding our periodic or current reports under the Exchange Act. There are no comments that remain unresolved that we received not less than 180 days before the end of the year to which this report relates that we believe are material.

 

 

Item 2. Properties

We have offices, operations and data centers located around the world. Our properties that are not owned are leased on terms and for durations that are reflective of commercial standards in the communities where these properties are located. We believe the facilities we own or occupy are adequate for the purposes for which they are currently used and are well maintained. Our principal offices include the following properties:

 

Location   

Owned/

Leased

     Lease
Expiration
     Approximate Square Footage
as of December 31, 20161
 

U.S. Locations

 

1585 Broadway

New York, New York

(Global Headquarters and Institutional Securities Headquarters)

     Owned        N/A        1,335,500 square feet  

2000 Westchester Avenue

Purchase, New York

(Wealth Management Headquarters)

     Owned        N/A        626,100 square feet  

522 Fifth Avenue

New York, New York

(Investment Management Headquarters)

     Owned        N/A        564,900 square feet  

International Locations

     

20 Bank Street

London

(London Headquarters)

     Leased        2038        546,500 square feet  

1 Austin Road West

Kowloon

(Hong Kong Headquarters)

     Leased        2019        499,900 square feet  

Otemachi Financial City South Tower

Otemachi, Chiyoda-ku

(Tokyo Headquarters)

     Leased        2028        245,600 square feet  
1.

The indicated total aggregate square footage leased does not include space leased by our branch offices.

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   22  


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

Item 3. Legal Proceedings

 

In addition to the matters described below, in the normal course of business, the Firm has been named, from time to time, as a defendant in various legal actions, including arbitrations, class actions and other litigation, arising in connection with its activities as a global diversified financial services institution. Certain of the actual or threatened legal actions include claims for substantial compensatory and/or punitive damages or claims for indeterminate amounts of damages. In some cases, the entities that would otherwise be the primary defendants in such cases are bankrupt or are in financial distress.

The Firm is also involved, from time to time, in other reviews, investigations and proceedings (both formal and informal) by governmental and self-regulatory agencies regarding the Firm’s business, and involving, among other matters, sales and trading activities, financial products or offerings sponsored, underwritten or sold by the Firm, and accounting and operational matters, certain of which may result in adverse judgments, settlements, fines, penalties, injunctions or other relief.

The Firm contests liability and/or the amount of damages as appropriate in each pending matter. Where available information indicates that it is probable a liability had been incurred at the date of the consolidated financial statements and the Firm can reasonably estimate the amount of that loss, the Firm accrues the estimated loss by a charge to income. The Firm’s future legal expenses may fluctuate from period to period, given the current environment regarding government investigations and private litigation affecting global financial services firms, including the Firm.

In many proceedings and investigations, however, it is inherently difficult to determine whether any loss is probable or even possible, or to estimate the amount of any loss. The Firm cannot predict with certainty if, how or when such proceedings or investigations will be resolved or what the eventual settlement, fine, penalty or other relief, if any, may be, particularly for proceedings and investigations where the factual record is being developed or contested or where plaintiffs or government entities seek substantial or indeterminate damages, restitution, disgorgement or penalties. Numerous issues may need to be resolved, including through potentially lengthy discovery and determination of important factual matters, determination of issues related to class certification and the calculation of damages or other relief, and by addressing novel or unsettled legal questions relevant to the proceedings or investigations in question, before a loss or additional loss or range of loss or additional loss can be reasonably estimated for a proceeding or investigation. Subject to the foregoing, the Firm believes, based on current

knowledge and after consultation with counsel, that the outcome of such proceedings and investigations will not have a material adverse effect on the consolidated financial condition of the Firm, although the outcome of such proceedings or investigations could be material to the Firm’s operating results and cash flows for a particular period depending on, among other things, the level of the Firm’s revenues or income for such period.

Over the last several years, the level of litigation and investigatory activity (both formal and informal) by government and self-regulatory agencies has increased materially in the financial services industry. As a result, the Firm expects that it will continue to be the subject of elevated claims for damages and other relief and, while the Firm has identified below certain proceedings that the Firm believes to be material, individually or collectively, there can be no assurance that additional material losses will not be incurred from claims that have not yet been asserted or are not yet determined to be material.

Residential Mortgage and Credit Crisis Related Matters

On July 15, 2010, China Development Industrial Bank (“CDIB”) filed a complaint against the Firm, styled China Development Industrial Bank v. Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated et al., which is pending in the Supreme Court of the State of New York, New York County (“Supreme Court of NY”). The complaint relates to a $275 million credit default swap referencing the super senior portion of the STACK 2006-1 CDO. The complaint asserts claims for common law fraud, fraudulent inducement and fraudulent concealment and alleges that the Firm misrepresented the risks of the STACK 2006-1 CDO to CDIB, and that the Firm knew that the assets backing the CDO were of poor quality when it entered into the credit default swap with CDIB. The complaint seeks compensatory damages related to the approximately $228 million that CDIB alleges it has already lost under the credit default swap, rescission of CDIB’s obligation to pay an additional $12 million, punitive damages, equitable relief, fees and costs. On February 28, 2011, the court denied the Firm’s motion to dismiss the complaint.

On August 7, 2012, U.S. Bank, in its capacity as trustee, filed a complaint on behalf of Morgan Stanley Mortgage Loan Trust 2006-4SL and Mortgage Pass-Through Certificates, Series 2006-4SL against the Firm styled Morgan Stanley Mortgage Loan Trust 2006-4SL, et al. v. Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital Inc., pending in the Supreme Court of NY. The complaint asserts claims for breach of contract and alleges, among other things, that the loans in the trust, which had an original principal balance of approximately $303 million, breached various representations and warran-

 

 

  23   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

ties. The complaint seeks, among other relief, rescission of the mortgage loan purchase agreement underlying the transaction, specific performance and unspecified damages and interest. On August 8, 2014, the court granted in part and denied in part the defendants’ motion to dismiss the complaint. On December 2, 2016, the Firm moved for summary judgment and the plaintiffs moved for partial summary judgment.

On August 8, 2012, U.S. Bank, in its capacity as trustee, filed a complaint on behalf of Morgan Stanley Mortgage Loan Trust 2006-14SL, Mortgage Pass-Through Certificates, Series 2006-14SL, Morgan Stanley Mortgage Loan Trust 2007-4SL and Mortgage Pass-Through Certificates, Series 2007-4SL against the Firm styled Morgan Stanley Mortgage Loan Trust 2006-14SL, et al. v. Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital Holdings LLC, as successor in interest to Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital Inc., pending in the Supreme Court of NY. The complaint asserts claims for breach of contract and alleges, among other things, that the loans in the trusts, which had original principal balances of approximately $354 million and $305 million respectively, breached various representations and warranties. The complaint seeks, among other relief, rescission of the mortgage loan purchase agreements underlying the transactions, specific performance and unspecified damages and interest. On August 16, 2013, the court granted in part and denied in part the Firm’s motion to dismiss the complaint. On August 16, 2016, the Firm moved for summary judgment and the plaintiffs moved for partial summary judgment.

On September 28, 2012, U.S. Bank, in its capacity as trustee, filed a complaint on behalf of Morgan Stanley Mortgage Loan Trust 2006-13ARX against the Firm styled Morgan Stanley Mortgage Loan Trust 2006-13ARX v. Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital Holdings LLC, as successor in interest to Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital Inc., pending in the Supreme Court of NY. Plaintiff filed an amended complaint on January 17, 2013, which asserts claims for breach of contract and alleges, among other things, that the loans in the trust, which had an original principal balance of approximately $609 million, breached various representations and warranties. The amended complaint seeks, among other relief, declaratory judgment relief, specific performance and unspecified damages and interest. By order entered September 30, 2014, the court granted in part and denied in part the Firm’s motion to dismiss the amended complaint, which the plaintiff appealed. On August 11, 2016, the Appellate Division, First Department reversed in part the trial court’s order that granted the Firm’s motion to dismiss. On December 13, 2016, the Appellate Division granted the Firm’s motion for leave to appeal to the New York Court of Appeals. The Firm filed its opening letter brief with the Court of Appeals on February 6, 2017.

On December 14, 2012, Royal Park Investments SA/NV filed a complaint against the Firm, certain affiliates, and other defendants in the Supreme Court of NY, styled Royal Park Investments SA/NV v. Merrill Lynch et al. On October 24, 2013, plaintiff filed a new complaint against the Firm in the Supreme Court of NY, styled Royal Park Investments SA/NV v. Morgan Stanley et al., alleging that defendants made material misrepresentations and omissions in the sale to plaintiff of certain mortgage pass-through certificates backed by securitization trusts containing residential mortgage loans. The total amount of certificates allegedly sponsored, underwritten and/or sold by the Firm to plaintiff was approximately $597 million. The complaint raises common law claims of fraud, fraudulent inducement, negligent misrepresentation, and aiding and abetting fraud and seeks, among other things, compensatory and punitive damages. The plaintiff filed an amended complaint on December 1, 2015. On April 29, 2016, the Firm filed a motion to dismiss the amended complaint.

On January 10, 2013, U.S. Bank, in its capacity as trustee, filed a complaint on behalf of Morgan Stanley Mortgage Loan Trust 2006-10SL and Mortgage Pass-Through Certificates, Series 2006-10SL against the Firm styled Morgan Stanley Mortgage Loan Trust 2006-10SL, et al. v. Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital Holdings LLC, as successor in interest to Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital Inc., pending in the Supreme Court of NY. The complaint asserts claims for breach of contract and alleges, among other things, that the loans in the trust, which had an original principal balance of approximately $300 million, breached various representations and warranties. The complaint seeks, among other relief, an order requiring the Firm to comply with the loan breach remedy procedures in the transaction documents, unspecified damages, and interest. On August 8, 2014, the court granted in part and denied in part the Firm’s motion to dismiss the complaint.

On May 3, 2013, plaintiffs in Deutsche Zentral-Genossenschaftsbank AG et al. v. Morgan Stanley et al. filed a complaint against the Firm, certain affiliates, and other defendants in the Supreme Court of NY. The complaint alleges that defendants made material misrepresentations and omissions in the sale to plaintiffs of certain mortgage pass-through certificates backed by securitization trusts containing residential mortgage loans. The total amount of certificates allegedly sponsored, underwritten and/or sold by the Firm to plaintiff was approximately $644 million. The complaint alleges causes of action against the Firm for common law fraud, fraudulent concealment, aiding and abetting fraud, negligent misrepresentation, and rescission and seeks, among other things, compensatory and punitive damages. On June 10, 2014, the court granted in part and denied in part the defendants’ motion to dismiss the complaint. The Firm perfected its appeal from that decision on June 12, 2015.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   24  


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

On May 17, 2013, plaintiff in IKB International S.A. in Liquidation, et al. v. Morgan Stanley, et al. filed a complaint against the Firm and certain affiliates in the Supreme Court of NY. The complaint alleges that defendants made material misrepresentations and omissions in the sale to plaintiff of certain mortgage pass-through certificates backed by securitization trusts containing residential mortgage loans. The total amount of certificates allegedly sponsored, underwritten and/or sold by the Firm to plaintiff was approximately $132 million. The complaint alleges causes of action against the Firm for common law fraud, fraudulent concealment, aiding and abetting fraud, and negligent misrepresentation, and seeks, among other things, compensatory and punitive damages. On October 29, 2014, the court granted in part and denied in part the Firm’s motion to dismiss. All claims regarding four certificates were dismissed. After these dismissals, the remaining amount of certificates allegedly issued by the Firm or sold to plaintiff by the Firm was approximately $116 million. On August 11, 2016, the Appellate Division, First Department affirmed the trial court’s order denying in part the Firm’s motion to dismiss the complaint.

On July 2, 2013, Deutsche Bank, in its capacity as trustee, became the named plaintiff in Federal Housing Finance Agency, as Conservator for the Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation, on behalf of the Trustee of the Morgan Stanley ABS Capital I Inc. Trust, Series 2007-NC1 (MSAC 2007-NC1) v. Morgan Stanley ABS Capital I Inc., and filed a complaint in the Supreme Court of NY under the caption Deutsche Bank National Trust Company, as Trustee for the Morgan Stanley ABS Capital I Inc. Trust, Series 2007-NC1 v. Morgan Stanley ABS Capital I, Inc. On February 3, 2014, the plaintiff filed an amended complaint, which asserts claims for breach of contract and breach of the implied covenant of good faith and fair dealing and alleges, among other things, that the loans in the trust, which had an original principal balance of approximately $1.25 billion, breached various representations and warranties. The amended complaint seeks, among other relief, specific performance of the loan breach remedy procedures in the transaction documents, unspecified damages, rescission and interest. On April 12, 2016, the court granted in part and denied in part the Firm’s motion to dismiss the amended complaint, dismissing all claims except a single claim, regarding which the motion was denied without prejudice. On January 17, 2017, the First Department affirmed the lower court’s April 12, 2016 order.

On July 8, 2013, U.S. Bank National Association, in its capacity as trustee, filed a complaint against the Firm styled U.S. Bank National Association, solely in its capacity as Trustee of the Morgan Stanley Mortgage Loan Trust 2007-2AX (MSM 2007-2AX) v. Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital Holdings LLC, Successor-By-Merger to Morgan

Stanley Mortgage Capital Inc. and GreenPoint Mortgage Funding, Inc., pending in the Supreme Court of NY. The complaint asserts claims for breach of contract and alleges, among other things, that the loans in the trust, which had an original principal balance of approximately $650 million, breached various representations and warranties. The complaint seeks, among other relief, specific performance of the loan breach remedy procedures in the transaction documents, unspecified damages and interest. On November 24, 2014, the court granted in part and denied in part the Firm’s motion to dismiss the complaint.

On August 26, 2013, a complaint was filed against the Firm and certain affiliates in the Supreme Court of NY, styled Phoenix Light SF Limited et al v. Morgan Stanley et al., which was amended on April 23, 2015. The amended complaint alleges that defendants made untrue statements and material omissions in the sale to plaintiffs, or their assignors, of certain mortgage pass-through certificates backed by securitization trusts containing residential mortgage loans. The total amount of certificates allegedly issued by the Firm and/or sold to plaintiffs or their assignors by the Firm was approximately $344 million. The amended complaint raises common law claims of fraud, fraudulent inducement, aiding and abetting fraud, negligent misrepresentation and rescission based on mutual mistake and seeks, among other things, compensatory damages, punitive damages or alternatively rescission or rescissionary damages associated with the purchase of such certificates. On April 23, 2015, the court granted the Firm’s motion to dismiss the amended complaint, and on May 21, 2015, the plaintiffs filed a notice of appeal of that order.

On November 6, 2013, Deutsche Bank, in its capacity as trustee, became the named plaintiff in Federal Housing Finance Agency, as Conservator for the Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation, on behalf of the Trustee of the Morgan Stanley ABS Capital I Inc. Trust, Series 2007-NC3 (MSAC 2007-NC3) v. Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital Holdings LLC, and filed a complaint in the Supreme Court of NY under the caption Deutsche Bank National Trust Company, solely in its capacity as Trustee for Morgan Stanley ABS Capital I Inc. Trust, Series 2007-NC3 v. Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital Holdings LLC, as Successor-by-Merger to Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital Inc. The complaint asserts claims for breach of contract and breach of the implied covenant of good faith and fair dealing and alleges, among other things, that the loans in the trust, which had an original principal balance of approximately $1.3 billion, breached various representations and warranties. The complaint seeks, among other relief, specific performance of the loan breach remedy procedures in the transaction documents, unspecified damages, rescission, interest and costs. On April 12, 2016, the court granted the Firm’s motion

 

 

  25   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

to dismiss the complaint, and granted the plaintiff the ability to seek to replead certain aspects of the complaint. On May 25, 2016, Deutsche Bank filed a notice of appeal of that order. On January 17, 2017, the First Department affirmed the lower court’s order granting the motion to dismiss the complaint.

On December 30, 2013, Wilmington Trust Company, in its capacity as trustee for Morgan Stanley Mortgage Loan Trust 2007-12, filed a complaint against the Firm styled Wilmington Trust Company v. Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital Holdings LLC et al., pending in the Supreme Court of NY. The complaint asserts claims for breach of contract and alleges, among other things, that the loans in the trust, which had an original principal balance of approximately $516 million, breached various representations and warranties. The complaint seeks, among other relief, unspecified damages, interest and costs. On June 14, 2016, the court granted in part and denied in part the Firm’s motion to dismiss the complaint. On August 17, 2016, plaintiff filed a notice of appeal of that order.

On April 28, 2014, Deutsche Bank National Trust Company, in its capacity as trustee for Morgan Stanley Structured Trust I 2007-1, filed a complaint against the Firm styled Deutsche Bank National Trust Company v. Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital Holdings LLC, pending in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York (“SDNY”). The complaint asserts claims for breach of contract and alleges, among other things, that the loans in the trust, which had an original principal balance of approximately $735 million, breached various representations and warranties. The complaint seeks, among other relief, specific performance of the loan breach remedy procedures in the transaction documents, unspecified compensatory and/or rescissory damages, interest and costs. On April 3, 2015, the court granted in part and denied in part the Firm’s motion to dismiss the complaint.

On September 19, 2014, Financial Guaranty Insurance Company (“FGIC”) filed a complaint against the Firm in the Supreme Court of NY, styled Financial Guaranty Insurance Company v. Morgan Stanley ABS Capital I Inc. et al. relating to a securitization issued by Basket of Aggregated Residential NIMS 2007-1 Ltd. The complaint asserts claims for breach of contract and alleges, among other things, that the net interest margin securities (“NIMS”) in the trust breached various representations and warranties. FGIC issued a financial guaranty policy with respect to certain notes that had an original balance of approximately $475 million. The complaint seeks, among other relief, specific performance of the NIMS breach remedy procedures in the transaction documents, unspecified damages, reimbursement of certain payments made pursuant to the transaction documents, attorneys’ fees and interest. On

November 24, 2014, the Firm filed a motion to dismiss the complaint, which the court denied on January 19, 2017.

On September 23, 2014, FGIC filed a complaint against the Firm in the Supreme Court of NY styled Financial Guaranty Insurance Company v. Morgan Stanley ABS Capital I Inc. et al. relating to the Morgan Stanley ABS Capital I Inc. Trust 2007-NC4. The complaint asserts claims for breach of contract and fraudulent inducement and alleges, among other things, that the loans in the trust breached various representations and warranties and defendants made untrue statements and material omissions to induce FGIC to issue a financial guaranty policy on certain classes of certificates that had an original balance of approximately $876 million. The complaint seeks, among other relief, specific performance of the loan breach remedy procedures in the transaction documents, compensatory, consequential and punitive damages, attorneys’ fees and interest. On January 23, 2017, the court denied the Firm’s motion to dismiss the complaint.

On January 23, 2015, Deutsche Bank National Trust Company, in its capacity as trustee, filed a complaint against the Firm styled Deutsche Bank National Trust Company solely in its capacity as Trustee of the Morgan Stanley ABS Capital I Inc. Trust 2007-NC4 v. Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital Holdings LLC as Successor-by-Merger to Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital Inc., and Morgan Stanley ABS Capital I Inc., pending in the Supreme Court of NY. The complaint asserts claims for breach of contract and alleges, among other things, that the loans in the trust, which had an original principal balance of approximately $1.05 billion, breached various representations and warranties. The complaint seeks, among other relief, specific performance of the loan breach remedy procedures in the transaction documents, compensatory, consequential, rescissory, equitable and punitive damages, attorneys’ fees, costs and other related expenses, and interest. On December 11, 2015, the court granted in part and denied in part the Firm’s motion to dismiss the complaint. On February 11, 2016, plaintiff filed a notice of appeal of that order.

On April 1, 2016, the California Attorney General’s Office filed an action against the Firm in California state court styled California v. Morgan Stanley, et al., on behalf of California investors, including the California Public Employees’ Retirement System and the California Teachers’ Retirement System. The complaint alleges that the Firm made misrepresentations and omissions regarding residential mortgage-backed securities and notes issued by the Cheyne SIV, and asserts violations of the California False Claims Act and other state laws and seeks treble damages, civil penalties, disgorgement, and injunctive relief. On September 30, 2016, the court granted the Firm’s demurrer, with leave to replead. On October 21, 2016, the California Attorney General filed

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   26  


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

an amended complaint. On January 25, 2017, the court denied the Firm’s demurrer with respect to the amended complaint.

Currency Related Matters

The Firm is responding to a number of regulatory and governmental inquiries both in the United States and abroad related to its foreign exchange business. In addition, on June 29, 2015, the Firm and a number of other financial institutions were named as respondents in a proceeding before Brazil’s Council for Economic Defense related to alleged anticompetitive activity in the foreign exchange market for the Brazilian Real.

The Firm, as well as other foreign exchange dealers, are defendants in In Re Foreign Exchange Benchmark Rates Antitrust Litigation, pending in the SDNY. On July 16, 2015, plaintiffs filed an amended complaint generally alleging that defendants engaged in a conspiracy to fix, maintain or make artificial prices for key benchmark rates, to manipulate bid/ask spreads, and, by their behavior in the over-the-counter market, to thereby cause corresponding manipulation in the foreign exchange futures market. Plaintiffs seek declaratory relief as well as treble damages in an unspecified amount. On December 16, 2016, the Firm and plaintiffs reached an agreement in principle to settle the litigation with respect to the Firm. After it is finalized by the parties, the settlement will be subject to court approval.

European Matters

On June 26, 2006, the public prosecutor in Parma, Italy brought criminal charges against certain present and former employees of the Firm related to the bankruptcy of Parmalat in 2003. The trial commenced in September 2009 and the evidence phase concluded in January 2017. A verdict is expected during the course of 2017. While the Firm is not a defendant in the criminal proceeding, certain investors have asserted civil claims against the Firm related to the proceedings. These claims seek, among other relief, moral damages and loss of opportunity damages related to their purchase of approximately €327 million in bonds issued by Parmalat. In addition, on October 11, 2011, an Italian financial institution, Banco Popolare Societá Cooperativa (“Banco Popolare”), filed a civil claim against the Firm in the Milan courts, styled Banco Popolare Societá Cooperativa v Morgan Stanley & Co. International plc & others (File number 63671/2011), related to its purchase of €100 million of bonds issued by Parmalat. The claim asserted by Banco Popolare alleges, among other things, that the Firm was aware of Parmalat’s impending insolvency and conspired with others to deceive Banco Popolare into buying bonds by concealing both Parmalat’s true financial condition and certain features

of the bonds from the market and Banco Popolare. Banco Popolare seeks damages of €76 million (approximately $80 million) plus damages for loss of opportunity and moral damages. The Firm filed its answer on April 20, 2012, and the hearing on the parties’ final submissions is scheduled for March 20, 2018.

On May 12, 2016, the Austrian state of Land Salzburg filed a claim against the Firm in the Regional Court in Frankfurt, Germany, styled Land Salzburg v. Morgan Stanley & Co. International plc (the “German Proceedings”) seeking €209 million (approximately $220 million) plus interest, attorneys’ fees and other relief relating to certain fixed income and commodities derivative transactions which Land Salzburg entered into with the Firm between 2005 and 2012. Land Salzburg has alleged that it had neither the capacity nor authority to enter into such transactions, which should be set aside, and that the Firm breached certain advisory and other duties which the Firm had owed to it. On April 28, 2016, the Firm filed an action against Land Salzburg in the High Court in London, England styled Morgan Stanley Capital Services LLC and Morgan Stanley & Co. International plc v. Land Salzburg (the “English Proceedings”) in which the Firm is seeking declarations that Land Salzburg had both the capacity and authority to enter into the transactions, and that the Firm has no liability to Land Salzburg arising from them. On July 25, 2016, the Firm filed an application with the Regional Court in Frankfurt to stay the German Proceedings on the basis that the High Court in London was first seized of the dispute between the parties and, pending determination of that application, filed its statement of defense on December 23, 2016. On December 8, 2016, Land Salzburg filed an application with the High Court in London challenging its jurisdiction to determine the English Proceedings.

On July 11, 2016, the Firm received an invitation to respond to a proposed claim (“Proposed Claim”) by the public prosecutor for Court of Accounts for the Republic of Italy. The Proposed Claim relates to certain derivative transactions between the Republic of Italy and the Firm. The transactions were originally entered into between 1999 and 2005, and were terminated in December 2011 and January 2012. The Proposed Claim alleges, inter alia, that the Firm was acting as an agent of the Republic of Italy, that some or all of the derivative transactions were improper and that the termination of the transactions was also improper. The Proposed Claim indicates that, if a proceeding is initiated against the Firm, the public prosecutor would be asserting administrative claims against the Firm for €2.879 billion (approximately $3 billion). The Firm does not agree with the Proposed Claim and presented its defenses to the public prosecutor.

 

 

  27   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

Other Litigation

On October 20, 2014, a purported class action complaint was filed against the Firm and other defendants styled Genesee County Employees’ Retirement System v. Bank of America Corporation et al. in the SDNY. The action was later consolidated with four similar actions in SDNY under the lead case styled Alaska Electrical Pension Fund v. Bank of America Corporation et al. A consolidated amended complaint was filed on February 2, 2015 asserting claims for alleged violations of the Sherman Act, breach of contract, breach of the implied covenant of good faith and fair dealing, unjust enrichment, and tortious interference with contract. The consolidated amended complaint alleges, among other things, that the defendants engaged in antitrust violations with regards to the process of setting ISDAfix, a financial benchmark and seeks treble damages, injunctive relief, attorneys’ fees and other relief. On March 28, 2016, the court granted in part and denied in part the defendants’ motion to dismiss the consolidated amended complaint. On February 7, 2017, the plaintiffs filed a second consolidated amended complaint.

The following matters were terminated during or following the quarter ended December 31, 2016:

On December 23, 2009, the Federal Home Loan Bank of Seattle filed a complaint against the Firm and another defendant in the Superior Court of the State of Washington, styled Federal Home Loan Bank of Seattle v. Morgan Stanley & Co. Inc., et al. The amended complaint, filed on September 28, 2010, alleges that defendants made untrue statements and material omissions in the sale to plaintiff of certain mortgage pass-through certificates backed by securitization trusts containing residential mortgage loans. The total amount of certificates allegedly sold to plaintiff by the Firm was approximately $233 million. The complaint raises claims under the Washington State Securities Act and seeks, among other

things, to rescind the plaintiff’s purchase of such certificates. On January 23, 2017, the parties reached an agreement to settle the litigation.

On March 15, 2010, the Federal Home Loan Bank of San Francisco filed a complaint against the Firm and other defendants in the Superior Court of the State of California styled Federal Home Loan Bank of San Francisco v. Deutsche Bank Securities Inc. et al. An amended complaint, filed on June 10, 2010, alleges that defendants made untrue statements and material omissions in connection with the sale to plaintiff of certain mortgage pass-through certificates backed by securitization trusts containing residential mortgage loans. The amount of certificates allegedly sold to plaintiff by the Firm was approximately $276 million. The complaint raises claims under both the federal securities laws and California law and seeks, among other things, to rescind the plaintiff’s purchase of such certificates. On December 21, 2016, the parties reached an agreement to settle the litigation.

On January 25, 2011, the Firm was named as a defendant in The Bank of New York Mellon Trust, National Association v. Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital, Inc., a litigation pending in the SDNY. The suit, brought by the trustee of a series of commercial mortgage pass-through certificates, alleges that the Firm breached certain representations and warranties with respect to an $81 million commercial mortgage loan that was originated and transferred to the trust by the Firm in 2007. The complaint seeks, among other things, to have the Firm repurchase the loan and pay additional monetary damages, and interest. On February 17, 2017, the parties reached an agreement in principle to settle the litigation.

Item 4. Mine Safety Disclosures

Not applicable.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   28  


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

Part II

Item 5. Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

Morgan Stanley’s common stock trades under the symbol “MS” on the New York Stock Exchange. As of February 17, 2017, we had 64,798 holders of record; however, we believe the number of beneficial owners of common stock exceeds this number.

The table below sets forth, for each of the last eight quarters, the low and high sales prices per share of our common stock and the amount of dividends declared per common share by our Board of Directors for such quarter.

 

     2016      2015  
      High      Low      Dividend
Declared per
Common Share
     High      Low      Dividend
Declared per
Common Share
 

First quarter

   $   31.70      $   21.16      $ 0.15      $   39.15      $   33.72      $ 0.10  

Second quarter

     28.29        23.11        0.15        40.26        35.36        0.15  

Third quarter

     32.44        24.57        0.20        41.04        30.40        0.15  

Fourth quarter

     44.04        30.96        0.20        35.74        30.15        0.15  

The following table sets forth the information with respect to purchases made by us or on our behalf of our common stock during the fourth quarter of the year ended December 31, 2016.

Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

 

$ in millions, except per share data    Total Number of
Shares
Purchased
    

Average Price

Paid Per Share

     Total Number of
Shares Purchased
as Part of Publicly
Announced Plans
or Programs1
     Approximate
Dollar Value of
Shares that May
Yet be Purchased
Under the Plans or
Programs
 

Month #1 (October 1, 2016-October 31, 2016)

           

Share Repurchase Program2

     4,857,000      $ 33.28        4,857,000      $ 2,088  

Employee transactions3

     63,861      $ 32.21                

Month #2 (November 1, 2016-November 30, 2016)

           

Share Repurchase Program2

     14,074,500      $ 36.09        14,074,500      $ 1,580  

Employee transactions3

     196,639      $ 39.10                

Month #3 (December 1, 2016-December 31, 2016)

           

Share Repurchase Program2

     7,751,467      $ 42.63        7,751,467      $ 1,250  

Employee transactions3

     337,765      $ 42.91                

Quarter ended December 31, 2016

           

Share Repurchase Program2

     26,682,967      $ 37.48        26,682,967      $ 1,250  

Employee transactions3

     598,265      $ 40.52                

 

1.

Share purchases under publicly announced programs are made pursuant to open-market purchases, Rule 10b5-1 plans or privately negotiated transactions (including with employee benefit plans) as market conditions warrant and at prices we deem appropriate and may be suspended at any time.

2.

Our Board of Directors has authorized the repurchase of our outstanding stock under a share repurchase program (the “Share Repurchase Program”). The Share Repurchase Program is a program for capital management purposes that considers, among other things, business segment capital needs, as well as stock-based compensation and benefit plan requirements. The Share Repurchase Program has no set expiration or termination date. Share repurchases are subject to regulatory approval. In June 2016, we received a conditional non-objection from the Federal Reserve to our 2016 capital plan, which included a share repurchase of up to $3.5 billion of our outstanding common stock during the period beginning July 1, 2016 through June 30, 2017. During the quarter ended December 31, 2016, we repurchased approximately $1.0 billion of our outstanding common stock as part of our Share Repurchase Program. For further information, see “Liquidity and Capital Resources—Capital Management” in Part II, Item 7.

3.

Includes shares acquired by us in satisfaction of the tax withholding obligations on stock-based awards and the exercise of stock options granted under our stock-based compensation plans.

 

  29   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

Stock Performance Graph

The following graph compares the cumulative total shareholder return (rounded to the nearest whole dollar) of our common stock, the Standard & Poor’s 500 (“S&P 500”) Stock Index and the S&P 500 Financials Index for the last five years. The graph assumes a $100 investment at the closing price on December 31, 2011 and reinvestment of dividends on the respective dividend payment dates without commissions. This graph does not forecast future performance of our common stock.

Cumulative Total Return

December 31, 2011—December 31, 2016

 

 

LOGO

 

     At December 31,  
      2011      2012      2013      2014      2015      2016  

Morgan Stanley

   $   100.00      $   127.93      $   211.50      $   264.56      $   220.24      $   299.66  

S&P 500 Stock Index

     100.00        115.99        153.55        174.55        176.95        198.10  

S&P 500 Financials Index

     100.00        128.75        174.57        201.07        197.92        242.94  

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   30  


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

Item 6. Selected Financial Data

 

Morgan Stanley Selected Financial Data

 

$ in millions   2016     2015     2014     2013     2012  

Income Statement Data

         

Revenues:

         

Total non-interest revenues

  $   30,933     $   32,062     $   32,540     $   31,715     $   26,383  

Interest income

    7,016       5,835       5,413       5,209       5,692  

Interest expense

    3,318       2,742       3,678       4,431       5,897  

Net interest

    3,698       3,093       1,735       778       (205

Net revenues

    34,631       35,155       34,275       32,493       26,178  

Non-interest expenses:

         

Compensation and benefits

    15,878       16,016       17,824       16,277       15,615  

Other

    9,905       10,644       12,860       11,658       9,967  

Total non-interest expenses

    25,783       26,660       30,684       27,935       25,582  

Income from continuing operations before income taxes

    8,848       8,495       3,591       4,558       596  

Provision for (benefit from) income taxes

    2,726       2,200       (90     902       (161

Income from continuing operations

    6,122       6,295       3,681       3,656       757  

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of income taxes

    1       (16     (14     (43     (41

Net income

    6,123       6,279       3,667       3,613       716  

Net income applicable to redeemable non- controlling interests

                      222       124  

Net income applicable to nonredeemable non- controlling interests

    144       152       200       459       524  

Net income applicable to Morgan Stanley

  $ 5,979     $ 6,127     $ 3,467     $ 2,932     $ 68  

Preferred stock dividends and other

    471       456       315       277       98  

Earnings (loss) applicable to Morgan Stanley common shareholders1

  $ 5,508     $ 5,671     $ 3,152     $ 2,655     $ (30

Amounts applicable to Morgan Stanley:

 

     

Income from continuing operations

  $ 5,978     $ 6,143     $ 3,481     $ 2,975     $ 138  

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

    1       (16     (14     (43     (70

Net income applicable to Morgan Stanley

  $ 5,979     $ 6,127     $ 3,467     $ 2,932     $ 68  
in millions, except per
share amounts
  2016     2015     2014     2013     2012  

Per Share Data

         

Earnings (loss) per basic common share2:

 

     

Income from continuing operations

  $ 2.98     $ 2.98     $ 1.65     $ 1.42     $ 0.02  

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

          (0.01     (0.01     (0.03     (0.04

Earnings (loss) per basic common share

  $ 2.98     $ 2.97     $ 1.64     $ 1.39     $ (0.02

Earnings (loss) per diluted common share2:

 

     

Income from continuing operations

  $ 2.92     $ 2.91     $ 1.61     $ 1.38     $ 0.02  

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

          (0.01     (0.01     (0.02     (0.04

Earnings (loss) per diluted common share

  $ 2.92     $ 2.90     $ 1.60     $ 1.36     $ (0.02

Book value per common share3

  $ 36.99     $ 35.24     $ 33.25     $ 32.24     $ 30.70  

Common shares outstanding at December 31st

    1,852       1,920       1,951       1,945       1,974  

Dividends declared per common share

    0.70       0.55       0.35       0.20       0.20  

Average common shares outstanding1:

 

     

Basic

    1,849       1,909       1,924       1,906       1,886  

Diluted

    1,887       1,953       1,971       1,957       1,919  

Balance Sheet and Other Operating Data

 

     

Trading assets

  $   262,154     $   239,505     $   278,117     $   301,252     $   281,881  

Loans4

    94,248       85,759       66,577       42,874       29,046  

Total assets

    814,949       787,465       801,510       832,702       780,960  

Total deposits

    155,863       156,034       133,544       112,379       83,266  

Long-term borrowings

    164,775       153,768       152,772       153,575       169,571  

Morgan Stanley shareholders’ equity

    76,050       75,182       70,900       65,921       62,109  

Common shareholders’ equity

    68,530       67,662       64,880       62,701       60,601  

Return on average common equity5

    8.0     8.5     4.8     4.3     N/M  

N/M—Not Meaningful

1.

Amounts shown are used to calculate earnings (loss) per basic and diluted common share.

2.

For the calculation of basic and diluted earnings (loss) per common share, see Note 16 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8.

3.

Book value per common share equals common shareholders’ equity divided by common shares outstanding.

4.

Amounts include loans held for investment and loans held for sale but exclude loans at fair value, which are included in Trading assets in the consolidated balance sheets (see Note 7 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8).

5.

The calculation of return on average common equity equals net income applicable to Morgan Stanley less preferred dividends as a percentage of average common equity. The return on average common equity is a non-generally accepted accounting principle financial measure that the Firm considers to be a useful measure to the Firm, investors and analysts to assess operating performance.

 

 

  31   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

Introduction

 

Morgan Stanley, a financial holding company, is a global financial services firm that maintains significant market positions in each of its business segments—Institutional Securities, Wealth Management and Investment Management. Morgan Stanley, through its subsidiaries and affiliates, provides a wide variety of products and services to a large and diversified group of clients and customers, including corporations, governments, financial institutions and individuals. Unless the context otherwise requires, the terms “Morgan Stanley,” “Firm,” “us,” “we,” or “our” mean Morgan Stanley (the “Parent Company”) together with its consolidated subsidiaries.

A description of the clients and principal products and services of each of our business segments is as follows:

Institutional Securities provides investment banking, sales and trading, lending and other services to corporations, governments, financial institutions, and high to ultra-high net worth clients. Investment banking services consist of capital raising and financial advisory services, including services relating to the underwriting of debt, equity and other securities, as well as advice on mergers and acquisitions, restructurings, real estate and project finance. Sales and trading services include sales, financing and market-making activities in equity and fixed income products, including foreign exchange and commodities, as well as prime brokerage services. Lending services include originating and/or purchasing corporate loans, commercial and residential mortgage lending, asset-backed lending, financing extended to equities and commodities customers, and loans to municipalities. Other activities include investments and research.

Wealth Management provides a comprehensive array of financial services and solutions to individual investors and small to medium-sized businesses and institutions covering brokerage and investment advisory services, financial and

wealth planning services, annuity and insurance products, credit and other lending products, banking and retirement plan services.

Investment Management provides a broad range of investment strategies and products that span geographies, asset classes, and public and private markets to a diverse group of clients across institutional and intermediary channels. Strategies and products include equity, fixed income, liquidity and alternative/other products. Institutional clients include defined benefit/defined contribution plans, foundations, endowments, government entities, sovereign wealth funds, insurance companies, third-party fund sponsors and corporations. Individual clients are serviced through intermediaries, including affiliated and non-affiliated distributors.

The results of operations in the past have been, and in the future may continue to be, materially affected by competition; risk factors; and legislative, legal and regulatory developments; as well as other factors. These factors also may have an adverse impact on our ability to achieve our strategic objectives. Additionally, the discussion of our results of operations herein may contain forward-looking statements. These statements, which reflect management’s beliefs and expectations, are subject to risks and uncertainties that may cause actual results to differ materially. For a discussion of the risks and uncertainties that may affect our future results, see “Forward-Looking Statements” immediately preceding Part I, Item 1, “Business—Competition” and “Business—Supervision and Regulation” in Part I, Item 1, “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A and “Liquidity and Capital Resources—Regulatory Requirements” herein.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   32  


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

Executive Summary

Overview of Financial Results

Selected Financial Information and Other Statistical Data

 

$ in millions, except per share
amounts
  2016     2015     2014  

Net revenues by segment

     

Institutional Securities

  $       17,459     $       17,953     $       16,871  

Wealth Management

    15,350       15,100       14,888  

Investment Management

    2,112       2,315       2,712  

Intersegment Eliminations

    (290     (213     (196

Consolidated net revenues

  $ 34,631     $ 35,155     $ 34,275  

Net revenues by region1

     

Americas

  $ 25,487     $ 25,080     $ 25,140  

EMEA

    4,994       5,353       4,772  

Asia-Pacific

    4,150       4,722       4,363  

Consolidated net revenues

  $ 34,631     $ 35,155     $ 34,275  

Income from continuing operations applicable to Morgan Stanley

 

Institutional Securities

  $ 3,650     $ 3,713     $ (77

Wealth Management

    2,104       2,085       3,192  

Investment Management

    223       345       366  

Intersegment Eliminations

    1              

Income from continuing operations applicable to Morgan Stanley

  $ 5,978     $ 6,143     $ 3,481  

Income (loss) from discontinued operations applicable to Morgan Stanley

    1       (16     (14

Net income applicable to Morgan Stanley

    5,979       6,127       3,467  

Preferred stock dividends and other

    471       456       315  

Earnings applicable to Morgan Stanley common shareholders

  $ 5,508     $ 5,671     $ 3,152  

Earnings per basic common share2

  $ 2.98     $ 2.97     $ 1.64  

Earnings per diluted common share2

    2.92       2.90       1.60  

Effective income tax rate from continuing operations

    30.8     25.9     (2.5 )% 
      At December 31,
2016
     At December 31,
2015
 

Capital ratios (Transitional)3

     

Common Equity Tier 1 capital ratio

     16.9%        15.5%  

Tier 1 capital ratio

     19.0%        17.4%  

Total capital ratio

     22.0%        20.7%  

Tier 1 leverage ratio4

     8.4%        8.3%  

 

$ in millions, except per share
amounts
   At December 31,
2016
     At December 31,
2015
 

Loans5

   $ 94,248      $ 85,759  

Total assets

   $ 814,949      $ 787,465  

Global Liquidity Reserve6

   $ 202,297      $ 203,264  

Deposits

   $ 155,863      $ 156,034  

Long-term borrowings

   $ 164,775      $ 153,768  

Common shareholders’ equity

   $ 68,530      $ 67,662  

Common shares outstanding

     1,852        1,920  

Book value per common share7

   $ 36.99      $ 35.24  

Worldwide employees

     55,311        56,218  

EMEA—Europe, Middle East and Africa

1.

For a discussion of how the geographic breakdown for net revenues is determined, see Note 21 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8.

2.

For the calculation of basic and diluted earnings per common share, see Note 16 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8.

3.

For a discussion of our regulatory capital ratios, see “Liquidity and Capital Resources—Regulatory Requirements” herein.

4.

See Note 14 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 for information on the Tier 1 leverage ratio.

5.

Amounts include loans held for investment (net of allowance) and loans held for sale but exclude loans at fair value, which are included in Trading assets in the consolidated balance sheets (see Note 7 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8).

6.

For a discussion of Global Liquidity Reserve, see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Liquidity and Capital Resources—Liquidity Risk Management Framework—Global Liquidity Reserve” herein.

7.

Book value per common share equals common shareholders’ equity divided by common shares outstanding.

Consolidated Results: 2016 Compared with 2015

 

 

We reported net revenues of $34,631 million in 2016, compared with $35,155 million in 2015. For 2016, net income applicable to Morgan Stanley was $5,979 million, or $2.92 per diluted common share, compared with $6,127 million, or $2.90 per diluted common share, in 2015.

 

 

Results for 2016 included net discrete tax benefits of $68 million or $0.04 per diluted common share, primarily related to the remeasurement of reserves and related interest due to new information regarding the status of a multi-year tax authority examination, partially offset by adjustments for other tax matters. Results for 2015 included net discrete tax benefits of $564 million or $0.29 per diluted common share, primarily associated with the repatriation of non-U.S. earnings at a cost lower than originally estimated, and positive revenues due to the impact of debt valuation adjustment (“DVA”) of $618 million or $0.20 per diluted common share. For a further discussion of the net discrete tax bene-

 

 

  33   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

   

fits, see “Supplemental Financial Information and Disclosures—Income Tax Matters” herein.

 

 

Effective January 1, 2016, we early adopted a provision of the accounting update Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities that requires unrealized gains and losses from debt-related credit spreads and other credit factors (i.e., DVA) to be presented in other comprehensive income (loss) (“OCI”) as opposed to Trading revenues. Results for 2015 and 2014 are not restated pursuant to that guidance.

 

 

Net revenues were $34,631 million and net income applicable to Morgan Stanley was $5,979 million, or $2.92 per diluted common share, in 2016 compared with net revenues of $34,537 million and net income applicable to Morgan Stanley of $5,728 million, or $2.70 per diluted common share, excluding DVA in 2015. Excluding the net discrete tax benefits, net income applicable to Morgan Stanley was $5,911 million, or $2.88 per diluted common share, in 2016 compared with net income applicable to Morgan Stanley of $5,164 million, or $2.41 per diluted common share, excluding both DVA and the net discrete tax benefits in 2015. (see “Selected Non-Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (“Non-GAAP”) Financial Information” herein).

Consolidated Results: 2015 Compared with 2014

 

 

We reported net revenues of $35,155 million in 2015, compared with $34,275 million in 2014. In 2015, net income applicable to Morgan Stanley was $6,127 million, or $2.90 per diluted common share, compared with $3,467 million, or $1.60 per diluted common share in 2014.

 

 

Results for 2015 included net discrete tax benefits of $564 million, or $0.29 per diluted common share, primarily associated with the repatriation of non-U.S. earnings at a cost lower than originally estimated, and positive revenues due to the impact of DVA of $618 million, or $0.20 per diluted common share. Results for 2014 included net discrete tax benefits of $2,226 million, or $1.13 per diluted common share, due to the release of a deferred tax liability associated with a legal entity restructuring, remeasurement of reserves and related interest due to new information regarding the status of a multi-year tax examination, and the repatriation of non-U.S. earnings at a cost lower than originally estimated. For a further discussion of these net discrete tax benefits, see “Supplemental Financial Information and Disclosures—Income Tax Matters” herein. Results for 2014 also included positive revenues associated with DVA of $651 million, or $0.21 per diluted common share. Results for 2014 also included litigation costs related to residential mortgage-backed securities and credit crisis matters of $3,083 million, or a loss of $1.47 per diluted common share, 2014 compensation actions of approxi-

   

mately $1,137 million (see also “Supplemental Financial Information and Disclosures—Discretionary Incentive Compensation” herein), or a loss of $0.39 per diluted common share, and a funding valuation adjustment (“FVA”) implementation charge of $468 million, or a loss of $0.17 per diluted common share.

 

 

Excluding DVA, net revenues were $34,537 million and net income applicable to Morgan Stanley was $5,728 million, or $2.70 per diluted common share, in 2015 compared with net revenues of $33,624 million, and net income applicable to Morgan Stanley of $3,049 million, or $1.39 per diluted common share, in 2014. Excluding both DVA and the net discrete tax benefits, net income applicable to Morgan Stanley was $5,164 million, or $2.41 per diluted common share, in 2015 compared with net income applicable to Morgan Stanley of $823 million, or $0.26 per diluted common share, in 2014 (see “Selected Non-Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (“Non-GAAP”) Financial Information” herein). For a further discussion of the net discrete tax benefits, see “Supplemental Financial Information and Disclosures—Income Tax Matters” herein.

Business Segment Net Revenues: 2016 Compared with 2015

 

 

Institutional Securities net revenues of $17,459 million in 2016 decreased 3% compared with $17,953 million in 2015, primarily as a result of lower Investment banking and sales and trading revenues, partially offset by higher Other revenues.

 

 

Wealth Management net revenues of $15,350 million in 2016 increased 2% from $15,100 million in 2015, primarily as a result of growth in Net interest income, partially offset by lower Commissions and fees and Investment banking revenues.

 

 

Investment Management net revenues of $2,112 million in 2016 decreased 9% from $2,315 million in 2015, primarily reflecting weaker investment performance compared with 2015. This was partially offset by carried interest losses in 2015 associated with Asia private equity that did not re-occur in 2016. Asset management fees in 2016 were relatively unchanged from 2015.

Business Segment Net Revenues: 2015 Compared with 2014

 

 

Institutional Securities net revenues of $17,953 million in 2015 increased 6% compared with $16,871 million in 2014, primarily as a result of higher sales and trading net revenues, partially offset by lower Other revenues and lower revenues in Investment banking.

 

 

Wealth Management net revenues of $15,100 million in 2015 increased 1% from $14,888 million in 2014, primarily as a result of higher Net interest income and asset management revenues, partially offset by lower transactional revenues.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   34  


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

 

Investment Management net revenues of $2,315 million in 2015 decreased 15% from $2,712 million in 2014, primarily reflecting the reversal of previously accrued carried interest, reduction in revenues attributable to non-controlling interests and markdowns on principal investments.

Consolidated Non-Interest Expenses: 2016 Compared with 2015

 

 

Compensation and benefits expenses of $15,878 million in 2016 decreased 1% from $16,016 million in 2015, primarily due to a decrease in salaries, severance costs, discretionary incentive compensation and employer taxes, partially offset by an increase in the fair value of deferred compensation plan referenced investments.

 

 

Non-compensation expenses were $9,905 million in 2016 compared with $10,644 million in 2015, representing a 7% decrease, primarily due to lower litigation costs and expense management.

Consolidated Non-Interest Expenses: 2015 Compared with 2014

 

 

Compensation and benefits expenses of $16,016 million in 2015 decreased 10% from $17,824 million in 2014, primarily as a result of the 2014 compensation actions, and a decrease in the fair value of deferred compensation plan referenced investments, related carried interest, and the level of discretionary incentive compensation in 2015 (see also “Supplemental Financial Information and Disclosures—Discretionary Incentive Compensation” herein).

 

 

Non-compensation expenses were $10,644 million in 2015 compared with $12,860 million in 2014, representing a 17% decrease, primarily due to lower litigation costs in the Institutional Securities business segment associated with residential mortgage-backed securities and credit crisis-related matters.

Return on Average Common Equity

 

 

For 2016, the return on average common equity and the return on average common equity, excluding DVA was 8.0%, or 7.9% excluding DVA and the net discrete tax benefits. For 2015, the return on average common equity was 8.5%, or 7.8% excluding DVA, and 7.0% excluding DVA and the net discrete tax benefits. For 2014, the return on average common equity was 4.8%, or 4.1% excluding DVA, and 0.8% excluding DVA and the net discrete tax benefits. See “Selected Non-Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (“Non-GAAP”) Financial Information” herein.

 

Selected Non-Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (“Non-GAAP”) Financial Information

We prepare our consolidated financial statements using accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (“U.S. GAAP”). From time to time, we may disclose certain “non-GAAP financial measures” in this document, or in the course of our earnings releases, earnings and other conference calls, financial presentations and otherwise. A “non-GAAP financial measure” excludes, or includes, amounts from the most directly comparable measure calculated and presented in accordance with U.S. GAAP. Non-GAAP financial measures disclosed by us are provided as additional information to investors and analysts in order to provide them with further transparency about, or as an alternative method for assessing, our financial condition, operating results or prospective regulatory capital requirements. These measures are not in accordance with, or a substitute for, U.S. GAAP and may be different from or inconsistent with non-GAAP financial measures used by other companies. Whenever we refer to a non-GAAP financial measure, we will also generally define it or present the most directly comparable financial measure calculated and presented in accordance with U.S. GAAP, along with a reconciliation of the differences between the U.S. GAAP financial measure and the non-GAAP financial measure.

The principal Non-GAAP financial measures presented in this document are set forth below.

Non-GAAP Financial Measures by Business Segment

 

$ in billions    2016     2015     2014  

Pre-tax profit margin1

      

Institutional Securities

     29     26     N/M  

Wealth Management

     22     22     20

Investment Management

     14     21     24

Consolidated

     26     24     10

Average common equity2

      

Institutional Securities

   $     43.2     $     34.6     $     32.2  

Wealth Management

     15.3       11.2       11.2  

Investment Management

     2.8       2.2       2.9  

Parent Company

     7.6       18.9       19.0  

Consolidated average common equity

   $ 68.9     $ 66.9     $ 65.3  

Return on average common equity2

 

   

Institutional Securities

     7.6     9.9     N/M  

Wealth Management

     13.3     16.9     27.5

Investment Management

     7.7     15.8     13.0

Consolidated

     8.0     8.5     4.8
 

 

  35   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

Reconciliations from U.S. GAAP to Non-GAAP Consolidated Financial Measures

 

$ in millions, except per share data    2016     2015     2014  

Net revenues

 

 

U.S. GAAP

   $ 34,631     $ 35,155     $ 34,275  

Impact of DVA3

           (618     (651

Net revenues, excluding DVA—non-GAAP4

   $ 34,631     $ 34,537     $ 33,624  

Net income applicable to Morgan Stanley

 

 

U.S. GAAP

   $ 5,979     $ 6,127     $ 3,467  

Impact of DVA, net of tax3

           (399     (418

Net income applicable to Morgan Stanley, excluding DVA—non-GAAP4

   $ 5,979     $ 5,728     $ 3,049  

Impact of net discrete tax benefits5

     (68     (564     (2,226

Net income applicable to Morgan Stanley, excluding DVA and net discrete tax benefits—non GAAP4

   $ 5,911     $ 5,164     $ 823  

Earnings per diluted common share

 

 

U.S. GAAP

   $ 2.92     $ 2.90     $ 1.60  

Impact of DVA3

           (0.20     (0.21

Earnings per diluted common share, excluding DVA—non-GAAP4

   $ 2.92     $ 2.70     $ 1.39  

Impact of net discrete tax benefits5

     (0.04     (0.29     (1.13

Earnings per diluted common share, excluding DVA and net discrete tax benefits—non-GAAP4

   $ 2.88     $ 2.41     $ 0.26  

Effective income tax rate

 

 

U.S. GAAP

     30.8     25.9     (2.5 )% 

Impact of net discrete tax benefits5

     0.8     6.6     62.0

Effective income tax rate from continuing operations, excluding net discrete tax benefits—non-GAAP4

     31.6     32.5     59.5

N/M—Not Meaningful

DVA represents the change in the fair value resulting from fluctuations in our credit spreads and other credit factors related to liabilities carried at fair value under the fair value option, primarily certain Long-term and Short-term borrowings.

1.

Pre-tax profit margin is a non-GAAP financial measure that we consider to be a useful measure to us, investors and analysts to assess operating performance and represents income from continuing operations before income taxes as a percentage of net revenues.

2.

Average common equity and return on average common equity are non-GAAP financial measures we consider to be useful measures to us, investors and analysts to assess capital adequacy and to allow better comparability of period-to-period operating performance. Average common equity for each business segment is determined using our Required Capital framework, an internal capital adequacy measure (see “Liquidity and Capital Resources—Regulatory Requirements—Attribution of Average Common Equity according to the Required Capital Framework” herein). Each business segment’s return on average common equity equals net income applicable to Morgan Stanley less an allocation of preferred dividends as a percentage of average common equity for that segment. Consolidated return on average common equity equals consolidated net income applicable to Morgan Stanley less preferred dividends as a percentage of average common equity.

3.

In 2016, in accordance with the early adoption of a provision of the accounting update Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities, unrealized DVA gains (losses) are recorded within OCI in the consolidated comprehensive income statements. For 2015 and 2014, DVA gains (losses) were recorded within Trading revenues in the consolidated income statements. See Notes 2 and 15 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 for further information.

4.

Net revenues, excluding DVA, net income applicable to Morgan Stanley, excluding DVA, net income applicable to Morgan Stanley, excluding DVA and net discrete tax benefits, earnings per diluted common share, excluding DVA, earnings per diluted common share, excluding DVA and net discrete tax benefits and effective income tax rate from continuing operations, excluding net discrete tax benefits, are non-GAAP financial measures we consider to be useful measures to us, investors and analysts to allow better comparability of period-to-period operating performance.

5.

For a discussion of our net discrete tax benefits, see “Supplemental Financial Information and Disclosures—Income Tax Matters” herein.

Consolidated Non-GAAP Financial Measures

 

$ in billions    2016     2015     2014  

Average common equity1, 3

 

 

Unadjusted

   $     68.9     $     66.9     $     65.3  

Excluding DVA

     69.1       67.6       66.4  

Excluding DVA and net discrete tax benefits

     69.1       67.1       65.7  

Return on average common equity1, 2

 

 

Unadjusted

     8.0     8.5     4.8

Excluding DVA

     8.0     7.8     4.1

Excluding DVA and net discrete tax benefits

     7.9     7.0     0.8

Average tangible common equity1, 3

 

 

Unadjusted

   $ 59.5     $ 57.3     $ 55.5  

Excluding DVA

     59.6       57.9       56.7  

Excluding DVA and net discrete tax benefits

     59.7       57.5       55.9  

Return on average tangible common equity1, 4

 

 

Unadjusted

     9.3     9.9     5.7

Excluding DVA

     9.2     9.1     4.8

Excluding DVA and net discrete tax benefits

     9.1     8.2     0.9

 

      At December 31,
2016
     At December 31,
2015
 

Tangible book value per common share1, 5

   $ 31.98      $ 30.26  

 

1.

The Average common equity, return on average common equity, average tangible common equity, return on average tangible common equity and tangible book value per common share measures set forth in this table are all non-GAAP financial measures we consider to be useful measures to us, investors and analysts to assess capital adequacy and to allow better comparability of period-to-period operating performance. For a discussion of tangible common equity, see “Liquidity and Capital Resources—Tangible Equity” herein.

2.

Return on average common equity equals consolidated net income applicable to Morgan Stanley less preferred dividends as a percentage of average common equity. Effective January 1, 2016, as a result of the adoption of a provision of the accounting update related to DVA, we have redefined the calculations of the return on average common equity excluding DVA, and excluding DVA and net discrete tax benefits to adjust for DVA only in the denominator. Prior to January 1, 2016, for the return on average common equity measures, where DVA is excluded, both the numerator and denominator were adjusted to exclude the impact of DVA. When excluding the net discrete tax benefits, both the numerator and denominator are adjusted to exclude that item in all periods.

3.

The impact of DVA on average common equity and average tangible common equity was approximately $(183) million, $(637) million and $(1,108) million in 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively. The impact of the net discrete tax benefits on average common equity and average tangible common equity was approximately $(40) million, $434 million and $713 million in 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

4.

Return on average tangible common equity equals net income applicable to Morgan Stanley less preferred dividends as a percentage of average tangible common equity. Effective January 1, 2016, as a result of the adoption of a provision of the accounting update related to DVA, we have redefined the calculations of return on average tangible common equity excluding DVA, and excluding DVA and net discrete tax benefits to adjust for DVA only in the denominator. Prior to January 1, 2016, for the return on average tangible common equity measures, where DVA is excluded, both the numerator and the denominator were adjusted to exclude the impact of DVA. When excluding the net discrete tax benefits, both the numerator and denominator are adjusted to exclude that item in all periods. The impact of DVA was insignificant in 2016 and 0.8% and 0.9% in 2015 and 2014, respectively. The impact of the net discrete tax benefits was 0.1%, 0.9% and 3.9% in 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

5.

Tangible book value per common share equals tangible common equity of $59,234 million at December 31, 2016 and $58,098 million at December 31, 2015 divided by common shares outstanding of 1,852 million at December 31, 2016 and 1,920 million at December 31, 2015.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   36  


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

Return on Equity Target

We are aiming to improve our return to shareholders and, accordingly, have established a target return on average common equity (“Return on Equity Target”) of 9% to 11%, excluding DVA to be achieved by 2017, subject to the successful execution of our strategic objectives. We plan to progress toward achieving our Return on Equity Target through the following key elements of our strategy:

 

 

Revenue and profitability growth:

 

   

Wealth Management pre-tax margin improvement to approximately 23% to 25% through net interest income growth via continued high-quality lending, expense efficiency and business growth;

 

   

Continued strength in Investment Banking and Equity Sales and Trading results;

 

   

Stable performance in Fixed Income Sales and Trading and Investment Management;

 

 

Expense efficiency:

 

   

Successful completion of Project Streamline, our expense savings program launched in 2016 to reduce expenses by $1 billion by 2017 (not including any outsized litigation expense or penalties) assuming a flat revenue environment, resulting in an expense efficiency target ratio of 74%;

 

 

Sufficient capital:

 

   

Increasing capital returns to shareholders, subject to regulatory approval.

Our Return on Equity Target and the related strategies and goals are forward-looking statements that may be materially affected by many factors, including, among other things: macroeconomic and market conditions; legislative and regulatory developments; industry trading and investment banking volumes; equity market levels; interest rate environment; legal expenses and the ability to reduce expenses in general; capital levels; and discrete tax items. Given the uncertainties surrounding these and other factors, there are significant risks that our Return on Equity Target and the related strategies and goals may not be realized. Actual results may differ from our goals and targets, and the differences may be material and adverse. Accordingly, we caution that undue reliance should not be placed on any of these forward-looking statements. See “Forward-Looking Statements” immediately preceding Part I, Item 1 and “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A for additional information regarding these forward-looking statements.

Return on average common equity and pre-tax margin are non-GAAP financial measures that we consider to be a useful measure to us, investors and analysts to assess operating performance. See “Selected Non-Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (“Non-GAAP”) Financial Information” herein. Our expense efficiency ratio represents total non-interest expenses as a percentage of net revenues. For 2016, our expense efficiency ratio was 74.5%, which was calculated as non-interest expenses of $25,783 million divided by net revenues of $34,631 million.

Business Segments

Substantially all of our operating revenues and operating expenses are directly attributable to our business segments. Certain revenues and expenses have been allocated to each business segment, generally in proportion to its respective net revenues, non-interest expenses or other relevant measures.

As a result of treating certain intersegment transactions as transactions with external parties, we include an Intersegment Eliminations category to reconcile the business segment results to our consolidated results.

Net Revenues

Investment Banking.    Investment banking revenues are composed of fees from advisory services and revenues from the underwriting of securities offerings and syndication of loans, net of syndication expenses.

Trading.    Trading revenues include revenues from customers’ purchases and sales of financial instruments in which we act as a market maker, as well as gains and losses on our related positions and other positions carried at fair value. Trading revenues include the realized gains and losses from sales of cash instruments and derivative settlements, unrealized gains and losses from ongoing fair value changes of our positions related to market-making activities, and gains and losses related to investments associated with certain employee deferred compensation plans and other positions carried at fair value. In many markets, the realized and unrealized gains and losses from the purchase and sale transactions will include any spreads between bids and offers. Certain fees received on loans carried at fair value and dividends from equity securities are also recorded in Trading revenues since they relate to positions carried at fair value.

As a market maker, we stand ready to buy, sell or otherwise transact with customers under a variety of market conditions and to provide firm or indicative prices in response to customer requests. Our liquidity obligations can be explicit in some cases, and in others, customers expect us to be willing to transact with them. In order to most effectively fulfill our

 

 

  37   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

market-making function, we engage in activities across all of our trading businesses that include, but are not limited to:

 

(i)

taking positions in anticipation of, and in response to, customer demand to buy or sell and—depending on the liquidity of the relevant market and the size of the position—to hold those positions for a period of time;

 

(ii)

managing and assuming basis risk (risk associated with imperfect hedging) between customized customer risks and the standardized products available in the market to hedge those risks;

 

(iii)

building, maintaining and rebalancing inventory, through trades with other market participants, and engaging in accumulation activities to accommodate anticipated customer demand;

 

(iv)

trading in the market to remain current on pricing and trends; and

 

(v)

engaging in other activities to provide efficiency and liquidity for markets.

Although not included in Trading revenues, Interest income and expense are also impacted by market-making activities, as debt securities held by us earn interest and securities are loaned, borrowed, sold with agreement to repurchase and purchased with agreement to resell.

We often invest in investments or other financial instruments to economically hedge our obligations under certain deferred compensation plans. Changes in the value of such investments are recorded in either Trading revenues or Investments revenues. Expenses associated with the related deferred compensation plans are recorded in Compensation and benefits. Generally, changes in compensation expense resulting from changes in fair value of the referenced investment will be offset by changes in fair value of the investments made by us.

Investments.    Our investments generally are held for long-term appreciation, or as discussed above, for hedging purposes and generally are subject to significant sales restrictions. Estimates of the fair value of the investments may involve significant judgment and may fluctuate significantly over time in light of business, market, economic and financial conditions generally or in relation to specific transactions. In some cases, such investments are required or are a necessary part of offering other products.

The revenues recorded are the result of realized gains and losses from sales and unrealized gains and losses from ongoing fair value changes of our holdings, as well as from investments associated with certain employee deferred compensation and co-investment plans.

Typically, there are no fee revenues from these investments. The sales restrictions on the investments relate primarily to redemption and withdrawal restrictions on investments in certain Investment Management funds, which include investments made in connection with certain employee deferred compensation plans (see Note 3 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8). Restrictions on interests in exchanges and clearinghouses generally include a requirement to hold those interests for the period of time where we are clearing trades on that exchange or clearinghouse. Additionally, there are certain sponsored Investment Management funds consolidated by us primarily related to holders of noncontrolling interests.

Commissions and Fees.    Commission and fee revenues primarily arise from agency transactions in listed and over-the-counter (“OTC”) equity securities, services related to sales and trading activities, and sales of mutual funds, futures, insurance products and options. Commissions received for purchasing and selling listed equity securities and options are recorded separately in Commissions and fees. Other cash and derivative instruments typically do not have fees associated with them, and fees for any related services are recorded in Commissions and fees.

Asset Management, Distribution and Administration Fees.    Asset management, distribution and administration fees include fees associated with the management and supervision of assets, account services and administration, performance-based fees relating to certain funds, separately managed accounts, shareholder servicing and the distribution of certain open-ended mutual funds.

Asset management, distribution and administration fees in the Wealth Management business segment also include revenues from individual and institutional investors electing a fee-based pricing arrangement and fees for Investment Management. Mutual fund distribution fees in the Wealth Management business segment are based on either the average daily fund net asset balances or average daily aggregate net fund sales and are affected by changes in the overall level and mix of assets under management or supervision.

Asset management fees in the Investment Management business segment arise from investment management services we provide to investment vehicles pursuant to various contractual arrangements. We receive fees primarily based upon mutual fund daily average net assets or based on monthly or quarterly invested equity for other vehicles. Performance-based fees in the Investment Management business segment are earned on certain products as a percentage of appreciation earned by those products and, in certain cases, are based upon the achievement of performance criteria. These fees are normally earned annually and are recognized on a monthly or quarterly basis.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   38  


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

Net Interest.    Interest income and Interest expense are a function of the level and mix of total assets and liabilities, including Trading assets and Trading liabilities; Investment securities, which include available-for-sale (“AFS”) securities and held-to-maturity (“HTM”) securities; Securities borrowed or purchased under agreements to resell; Securities loaned or sold under agreements to repurchase; Loans; Deposits; Other short-term borrowings; Long-term borrowings; trading strategies; customer activity in the prime brokerage business; and the prevailing level, term structure and volatility of interest rates.

Other.    Other revenues include revenues from equity method investments, realized gains and losses on AFS securities, gains and losses on loans held for sale, provision for loan losses, and other miscellaneous revenues.

Net Revenues by Segment

Institutional Securities.    Net revenues are composed of Investment banking revenues, Sales and trading net revenues, Investments and Other revenues.

For information about the composition of Investment banking revenues, see “Net Revenues” herein. 

Sales and trading net revenues are composed of Trading revenues; Commissions and fees; Asset management, distribution and administration fees; and Net interest. In assessing the profitability of our sales and trading activities, we view these net revenues in the aggregate. In addition, decisions relating to trading are based on an overall review of aggregate revenues and costs associated with each transaction or series of transactions. This review includes, among other things, an assessment of the potential gain or loss associated with a transaction, including any associated commissions and fees, dividends, the interest income or expense associated with financing or hedging our positions and other related expenses.

Sales and trading revenues are broken down into major business lines as follows: equity, fixed income and other. See “Sales and Trading Activities—Equity and Fixed Income” for a description of the activities within equity and fixed income. Other sales and trading revenues include impacts from certain central treasury functions, such as liquidity costs and gains (losses) on economic hedges related to long-term borrowings, as well as certain activities associated with corporate lending activities.

For information about revenue from Investments, see “Net Revenues” herein.

Other revenues include revenues from equity method investments, gains and losses on loans held for sale, provision for loan losses, and other miscellaneous revenues.

Wealth Management.    Net revenues are composed of Transactional, Asset management, Net interest and Other revenues.

Transactional revenues include Investment banking, Trading, and Commissions and fees. Investment banking revenues include revenues from the distribution of equity and fixed income securities, including initial public offerings, secondary offerings, closed-end funds and unit trusts. Trading revenues include revenues from customers’ purchases and sales of financial instruments, in which we act as principal, and gains and losses associated with certain employee deferred compensation plans. Revenues from Commissions and fees primarily arise from agency transactions in listed and OTC equity securities and sales of mutual funds, futures, insurance products and options.

Asset management revenues include Asset management, distribution and administration fees, and referral fees related to the bank deposit program.

Net interest income includes interest related to the bank deposit program, interest on AFS securities and HTM securities, interest on lending activities and other net interest. Interest income and Interest expense are a function of the level and mix of total assets and liabilities. Net interest is driven by securities-based lending, mortgage lending, margin loans, securities borrowed and securities loaned transactions, and bank deposit program activity.

Other revenues include revenues from realized gains and losses on AFS securities, provision for loan losses, referral fees and other miscellaneous revenues.

Investment Management.    Investments revenue is primarily earned on investments in certain closed-end funds that generally are held for long-term appreciation and generally subject to sales restrictions. Estimates of the fair value of the investments involve significant judgment and may fluctuate materially over time in light of business, market, economic and financial conditions generally or in relation to specific transactions.

For information about the composition of Asset Management, Distribution and Administration Fees, see “Net Revenues” herein. 

Compensation Expense

Compensation and benefits expense includes accruals for base salaries and fixed allowances, formulaic programs, discretionary incentive compensation, amortization of deferred cash and equity awards, changes in fair value of deferred compensation plan referenced investments, carried interest, severance costs, and other items such as health and welfare benefits. The factors that drive compensation for our employees vary from quarter to quarter, from segment to segment and within a segment. For certain revenue-producing employees in the Wealth Management and Investment Management business segments, compensation is largely paid

 

 

  39   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

on the basis of formulaic payouts that link employee compensation to revenues. Compensation for certain employees, including revenue-producing employees in the Institutional Securities business segment, may also include incentive compensation that is determined following the assessment of the Firm, business unit and individual performance. Compensation for our remaining employees is largely fixed in nature (e.g., base salary, benefits, etc.).

Compensation expense for deferred cash-based compensation plans is calculated based on the notional value of the award granted, adjusted for upward and downward changes in fair value of the referenced investment, and is recognized ratably over the prescribed vesting period for the award. However, there may be a timing difference between the immediate revenue recognition of gains and losses on our investments and the deferred recognition of the related compensation expense over the vesting period.

Income Taxes

The income tax provision for our business segments is generally determined based on the revenues, expenses and activities directly attributable to each business segment. Certain items have been allocated to each business segment, generally in proportion to its respective net revenues or other relevant measures.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   40  


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

Institutional Securities

Income Statement Information

 

          % Change  
$ in millions   2016     2015     2014     2016     2015  

Revenues

         

Investment banking

  $     4,476     $     5,008     $     5,203       (11)%       (4)%  

Trading

    9,387       9,400       8,445             11%  

Investments

    147       274       240       (46)%       14%  

Commissions and fees

    2,456       2,616       2,610       (6)%        

Asset management, distribution and administration fees

    293       281       281       4%        

Other

    535       221       684       142%       (68)%  

Total non-interest revenues

    17,294       17,800       17,463       (3)%       2%  

Interest income

    4,005       3,190       3,389       26%       (6)%  

Interest expense

    3,840       3,037       3,981       26%       (24)%  

Net interest

    165       153       (592     8%       N/M  

Net revenues

    17,459       17,953       16,871       (3)%       6%  

Compensation and benefits

    6,275       6,467       7,786       (3)%       (17)%  

Non-compensation expenses

    6,061       6,815       9,143       (11)%       (25)%  

Total non-interest expenses

    12,336       13,282       16,929       (7)%       (22)%  

Income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes

    5,123       4,671       (58     10%       N/M  

Provision for (benefit from) income taxes

    1,318       825       (90     60%       N/M  

Income from continuing operations

    3,805       3,846       32       (1)%       N/M  

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of income taxes

    (1     (17     (19     94%       11%  

Net income

    3,804       3,829       13       (1)%       N/M  

Net income applicable to noncontrolling interests

    155       133       109       17%       22%  

Net income (loss) applicable to Morgan Stanley

  $ 3,649     $ 3,696     $ (96     (1)%       N/M  

N/M—Not Meaningful

Investment Banking

Investment Banking Revenues

 

          % Change  
$ in millions   2016     2015     2014     2016     2015  

Advisory revenues

  $     2,220     $     1,967     $     1,634       13%       20%  

Underwriting revenues:

         

Equity underwriting revenues

    887       1,398       1,613       (37)%       (13)%  

Fixed income underwriting revenues

    1,369       1,643       1,956       (17)%       (16)%  

Total underwriting revenues

    2,256       3,041       3,569       (26)%       (15)%  

Total investment banking revenues

  $ 4,476     $ 5,008     $ 5,203       (11)%       (4)%  

Investment Banking Volumes

 

$ in billions    20161      20151      20141  

Completed mergers and acquisitions2

   $ 1,006      $ 662      $ 625  

Equity and equity-related offerings3

     45        67        72  

Fixed income offerings4

     239        256        265  

 

1.

Source: Thomson Reuters, data at January 17, 2017. Completed mergers and acquisitions volumes are based on full credit to each of the advisors in a transaction. Equity and equity-related offerings and fixed income offerings are based on full credit for single book managers and equal credit for joint book managers. Transaction volumes may not be indicative of net revenues in a given period. In addition, transaction volumes for prior periods may vary from amounts previously reported due to the subsequent withdrawal or change in the value of a transaction.

2.

Amounts include transactions of $100 million or more.

3.

Amounts include Rule 144A issuances and registered public offerings of common stock and convertible securities and rights offerings.

4.

Amounts include non-convertible preferred stock, mortgage-backed and asset-backed securities, and taxable municipal debt. Amounts include publicly registered and Rule 144A issues. Amounts exclude leveraged loans and self-led issuances.

2016 Compared with 2015

Investment banking revenues of $4,476 million in 2016 decreased 11% from 2015 due to lower underwriting revenues, partially offset by an increase in advisory revenues in 2016.

 

 

Advisory revenues increased reflecting the higher dollar volume of completed merger, acquisition and restructuring transactions (“M&A”) activity (see Investment Banking Volumes table). As the number of completed transactions decreased in 2016 versus 2015, the 2016 revenue increase was at a lower rate than the percentage increase in dollar volume.

 

 

Equity underwriting revenues decreased as a result of lower equity-related offerings in 2016 (see Investment Banking Volumes table). Fixed income underwriting revenues decreased in 2016, primarily due to lower bond and loan fees.

2015 Compared with 2014

Investment banking revenues of $5,008 million in 2015 decreased 4% from 2014 due to lower underwriting revenues, partially offset by higher advisory revenues.

 

 

Advisory revenues increased led primarily by M&A fee realization in the Americas.

 

 

Equity underwriting revenues decreased on reduced volumes driven by lower initial public offerings (see Investment Banking Volumes table). Fixed income underwriting revenues decreased primarily driven by lower non-investment grade bond and loan fees.

 

 

  41   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

Sales and Trading Net Revenues

By Income Statement Line Item

 

$ in millions    2016      2015      2014  

Trading

   $ 9,387      $ 9,400      $ 8,445  

Commissions and fees

     2,456        2,616        2,610  

Asset management, distribution and administration fees

     293        281        281  

Net interest

     165        153        (592

Total sales and trading net revenues

   $     12,301      $     12,450      $     10,744  

By Business

 

                      % Change  
$ in millions   2016     2015     2014     2016     2015  

Equity—U.S. GAAP

  $ 8,037     $ 8,288     $ 7,135       (3 )%      16

Impact of DVA1

          (163     (232     100     30

Impact of FVA2

                2             (100 )% 

Equity—non-GAAP

  $ 8,037     $ 8,125     $ 6,905       (1 )%      18

Fixed income—U.S. GAAP3

  $ 5,117     $ 4,758     $ 4,214       8     13

Impact of DVA1

          (455     (419     100     (9 )% 

Impact of FVA2

                466             (100 )% 

Fixed income—non-GAAP

  $ 5,117     $ 4,303     $ 4,261       19     1

Other—U.S. GAAP

    (853     (596     (605     (43 )%      1

Total—U.S. GAAP

  $ 12,301     $ 12,450     $ 10,744       (1 )%      16

Total—Impact of DVA1

          (618     (651     100     5

Total—Impact of FVA2

                468             (100 )% 

Total—non-GAAP

  $ 12,301     $ 11,832     $ 10,561       4     12

 

1.

In 2016, in accordance with the early adoption of a provision of the accounting update Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities, unrealized DVA gains (losses) are recorded within OCI in the consolidated comprehensive income statements. In 2015 and 2014, DVA gains (losses) were recorded within Trading revenues in the consolidated income statements. See Notes 2 and 15 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 for further information.

2.

Represents the initial implementation of FVA.

3.

Effective in 2016, the Institutional Securities “Fixed Income and Commodities” business has been renamed the “Fixed Income” business.

Sales and trading net revenues, including equity and fixed income sales and trading net revenues that exclude the impact of DVA in 2015, or exclude the impact of DVA and the initial implementation of FVA in 2014, are non-GAAP financial measures that we consider useful for us, investors and analysts to allow further comparability of period-to-period operating performance.

Sales and Trading ActivitiesEquity and Fixed Income

Following is a description of the sales and trading activities within our equities and fixed income businesses as well as

how their results impact the income statement line items, followed by a presentation and explanation of results.

Equities—Financing.    We provide financing and prime brokerage services to our clients active in the equity markets through a variety of products including margin lending, securities lending and swaps. Results from this business are largely driven by the difference between financing income earned and financing costs incurred, which are reflected in Net interest for securities and equity lending products and in Trading revenues for derivative products.

Equities—Execution services.    We make markets for our clients in equity-related securities and derivative products, including providing liquidity and hedging products. A significant portion of the results for this business is generated by commissions and fees from executing and clearing client transactions on major stock and derivative exchanges as well as from OTC transactions. Market-making also generates gains and losses on inventory, which are reflected in Trading revenues.

Fixed income—Within fixed income we make markets in order to facilitate client activity as part of the following products and services.

 

 

Global macro products.    We make markets for our clients in interest rate, foreign exchange and emerging market products, including exchange-traded and OTC securities, loans and derivative instruments. The results of this market-making activity are primarily driven by gains and losses from buying and selling positions to stand ready for and satisfy client demand and are recorded in Trading revenues.

 

 

Credit products.    We make markets in credit-sensitive products, such as corporate bonds and mortgage securities and other securitized products, and related derivative instruments. The value of positions in this business are sensitive to changes in credit spreads and interest rates, which result in gains and losses reflected in Trading revenues. Due to the amount and type of the interest-bearing securities and loans making up this business, a significant portion of the results is also reflected in Net interest revenues.

 

 

Commodities products.    We make markets in various commodity products related primarily to electricity, natural gas, oil, and precious metals, with the results primarily reflected in Trading revenues.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   42  


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

Sales and Trading Net Revenues—Equity and Fixed Income

 

     2016  
$ in millions    Trading      Fees1      Net
Interest2
    Total  

Financing

   $ 3,668      $ 347      $ (283   $   3,732  

Execution services

     2,231        2,241        (167     4,305  

Total Equity

   $ 5,899      $ 2,588      $ (450   $ 8,037  

Total Fixed Income

   $ 4,115      $ 162      $ 840     $ 5,117  

 

     2015  
$ in millions    Trading      Fees1      Net
Interest2
    Total  

Financing

   $ 3,300      $ 322      $ 126     $   3,748  

Execution services

     2,210        2,437        (270     4,377  

Impact of DVA3

     163                     163  

Total Equity

   $ 5,673      $ 2,759      $ (144   $ 8,288  

Fixed Income

   $ 3,333      $ 139      $ 831     $ 4,303  

Impact of DVA3

     455                     455  

Total Fixed Income

   $ 3,788      $ 139      $ 831     $ 4,758  

 

     2014  
$ in millions    Trading     Fees1      Net
Interest2
    Total  

Financing

   $ 2,843     $ 283      $ 23     $   3,149  

Execution services

     1,623       2,473        (340     3,756  

Impact of DVA3

     232                    232  

Impact of FVA

     (2                  (2

Total Equity

   $ 4,696     $ 2,756      $ (317   $ 7,135  

Fixed Income

   $ 3,824     $ 136      $ 301     $ 4,261  

Impact of DVA3

     419                    419  

Impact of FVA

     (466                  (466

Total Fixed Income

   $ 3,777     $ 136      $ 301     $ 4,214  

 

1.

Includes Commissions and fees and Asset management, distribution and administration fees.

2.

Funding costs are allocated to the businesses based on funding usage and are included in Net interest in the previous tables. Such allocations were estimated for prior periods to conform to the current presentation.

3.

In 2016, in accordance with the early adoption of a provision of the accounting update Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities, unrealized DVA gains (losses) are recorded within OCI in the consolidated comprehensive income statements. In 2015 and 2014, the DVA gains (losses) were recorded within Trading revenues in the consolidated income statements. See Notes 2 and 15 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 for further information.

As discussed in “Net Revenues by Segment” herein, we manage each of the sales and trading businesses based on its aggregate net revenues, which are comprised of the consolidated income statement line items quantified in the previous table. Trading revenues are affected by a variety of market dynamics, including volumes, bid-offer spreads, and inventory prices, as well as impacts from hedging activity, which are interrelated. We provide qualitative commentary in the discussion of results that follow on the key drivers of period

over period variances, as the quantitative impact of the various market dynamics typically cannot be disaggregated.

For additional information on total Trading revenues, see the table “Trading Revenues by Product Type” in Note 4 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8.

2016 Compared with 2015

Equity

Excluding the $163 million positive impact of DVA on 2015 results, equity sales and trading net revenues of $8,037 million in 2016 were lower than 2015, reflecting lower results in both financing and execution services revenues.

 

 

Financing revenues were in line with the results from 2015 as Net interest revenues declined from higher net interest costs, reflecting the business’ increased portion of global liquidity reserve requirements, offset by increased client activity in equity swaps reflected in Trading.

 

 

Execution services decreased 2% from 2015, primarily reflecting a decrease in fee revenues of $196 million due to reduced client activity.

Fixed Income

Excluding the $455 million positive impact of DVA on 2015 results, fixed income net revenues of $5,117 million in 2016 were 19% higher than 2015, primarily due to improved results in credit products.

 

 

Credit products Trading revenues were the primary driver for the overall increase in fixed income Trading revenues of $782 million, reflecting an improved credit market environment that resulted in gains on inventory in 2016 compared with losses in 2015.

 

 

Overall results from other fixed income businesses were relatively unchanged. There was a net increase in Trading revenues from global macro products, reflecting gains on inventory in interest rate products, offset by declines in commodities activities, primarily due to the absence of revenues from the global oil merchanting business, which was sold on November 1, 2015. For more information on the sale of the global oil merchanting business, see “Investments, Other Revenues, Non-interest Expenses, Income Tax Items, Dispositions and Other Items—2015 Compared with 2014—Dispositions” herein.

Other

 

 

Other sales and trading net losses of $853 million in 2016 increased from 2015, primarily reflecting losses in 2016 associated with corporate loan hedging activity.

 

 

  43   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

2015 Compared with 2014

Equity

Equity sales and trading net revenues, excluding the impact of DVA and the implementation of FVA, increased reflecting higher results in financing and execution services revenues.

 

 

Financing revenues increased 19% from 2014 with an increase in client balances and derivative activity reflected in the $457 million increase in Trading revenues primarily from equity swaps and a $103 million increase in Net interest revenues for securities.

 

 

Execution services increased 17% from 2014, primarily due to the $587 million increase in Trading revenues from client activity in derivatives and reduced inventory losses compared with the prior year.

Fixed Income

Excluding the $455 million positive impact of DVA on 2015 results, and the $419 million positive impact of DVA and the $466 million negative impact from the implementation of FVA on 2014 results, fixed income net revenues of $4,303 million in 2015 were 1% higher than 2014 due to improved results in global macro and commodities products, offset by lower results in credit products.

 

 

Global macro products results increased from 2014, primarily due to an increase in Trading revenues due to improved results in interest rate products as a result of inventory gains and improved performance in foreign exchange products

 

 

Credit products decreased, primarily driven by a decrease in Trading revenues from lower results in credit and securitized products from a widening credit spread environment, which led to inventory losses. This decrease was partially offset by an increase in Net interest revenues, driven primarily by a change in the product mix in the securitized products group assets.

 

 

Commodities products net revenues increased, primarily reflecting higher revenues from the global oil merchanting business, which was sold on November 1, 2015. The increase was partially offset by credit-driven losses and the absence of revenues from TransMontaigne Inc., which was sold on July 1, 2014 (see “Investments, Other Revenues, Non-interest Expenses, Income Tax Items, Dispositions and Other Items—2015 Compared with 2014—Dispositions” herein).

Investments, Other Revenues, Non-interest Expenses, Income Tax Items, Dispositions and Other Items

2016 Compared with 2015

Investments

 

 

Net investment gains of $147 million in 2016 decreased from 2015 as a result of lower gains on real estate and business-related investments and losses on investments associated with our compensation plans compared with gains in 2015.

Other

 

 

Other revenues of $535 million in 2016 increased from 2015, primarily reflecting mark-to-market gains on loans held for sale in 2016 compared with mark-to-market losses in 2015, partially offset by lower results related to our 40% stake in Mitsubishi UFJ Morgan Stanley Securities Co., Ltd. (“MUMSS”) (see Note 8 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 for further information).

Non-interest Expenses

Non-interest expenses of $12,336 million in 2016 decreased from 2015, primarily reflecting a 3% reduction in Compensation and benefits expenses and an 11% reduction in Non-compensation expenses in 2016.

 

 

Compensation and benefits expenses decreased in 2016, primarily due to a decrease in salaries, severance costs, discretionary incentive compensation and employer taxes, partially offset by an increase in the fair value of deferred compensation plan referenced investments.

 

 

Non-compensation expenses decreased in 2016, primarily due to lower litigation costs and Professional services expense. In 2015, Non-compensation expenses included increases to reserves for the settlement of a credit default swap (“CDS”) antitrust litigation matter and legacy residential mortgage-backed securities matters.

2015 Compared with 2014

Investments

 

 

Net investment gains of $274 million in 2015 increased 14% from 2014 driven by gains on business-related investments.

Other

 

 

Other revenues of $221 million in 2015 decreased 68% from 2014 due to the absence of gains realized on certain assets sold in 2014 (see Note 1 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8) and markdowns and provisions on loans held for sale and held for investment.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   44  


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

Non-interest Expenses

Non-interest expenses of $13,282 million in 2015 decreased 22% from 2014 driven by a 25% reduction in Non-compensation expenses and a 17% reduction in Compensation and benefits expenses.

 

 

Compensation and benefits expenses decreased, primarily due to the 2014 compensation actions, a decrease in the fair value of deferred compensation plan referenced investments and a decrease in the level of discretionary incentive compensation in 2015 (see also “Supplemental Financial Information and Disclosures—Discretionary Incentive Compensation” herein).

 

 

Non-compensation expenses decreased, primarily due to lower litigation costs.

Income Tax Items

In 2016, we recognized in Provision for (benefit from) income taxes net discrete tax benefits of $83 million. These net discrete tax benefits were primarily related to the remeasurement of reserves and related interest due to new information regarding the status of a multi-year tax authority examination, partially offset by adjustments for other tax matters.

In 2015, we recognized in Provision for (benefit from) income taxes net discrete tax benefits of $564 million. These net discrete tax benefits were primarily associated with the repatriation of non-U.S. earnings at a cost lower than originally estimated due to an internal restructuring to simplify our legal entity organization in the United Kingdom (“U.K.”).

In 2014, we recognized in Provision for (benefit from) income taxes net discrete tax benefits of $839 million. This included net discrete tax benefits of $612 million principally associated with remeasurement of reserves and related interest due to new information regarding the status of a multi-year tax authority examination and $237 million primarily associated with the repatriation of non-U.S. earnings at a cost lower than originally estimated. In addition, our Provision for (benefit from) income taxes was impacted by approximately $900 million of tax provision as a result of non-deductible expenses related to litigation and regulatory matters.

Dispositions

On November 1, 2015, we completed the sale of our global oil merchanting unit of the commodities division to Castleton Commodities International LLC. The loss on sale of approximately $71 million was recognized in Other revenues.

On July 1, 2014, we completed the sale of our ownership stake in TransMontaigne Inc., a U.S.-based oil storage, marketing and transportation company, as well as related physical inventory and the assumption of our obligations under certain terminal storage contracts, to NGL Energy Partners LP. The gain on sale of $112 million was recognized in Other revenues.

On March 27, 2014, we completed the sale of Canterm Canadian Terminals Inc., a public storage terminal operator for refined products with two distribution terminals in Canada. The gain on sale was approximately $45 million and was recognized in Other revenues.

Other Items

Japanese Securities Joint Venture

We hold a 40% voting interest and Mitsubishi UFJ Financial Group, Inc. (“MUFG”) holds a 60% voting interest in MUMSS.

To the extent that losses incurred by MUMSS result in a requirement to restore its capital level, MUFG is solely responsible for providing this additional capital to a minimum level, whereas we are not obligated to contribute additional capital to MUMSS. To the extent that MUMSS is required to increase its capital level due to factors other than losses, such as changes in regulatory requirements, both MUFG and we are required to contribute the necessary capital based upon the economic interest as set forth above.

See Note 8 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 for further information.

Noncontrolling Interests

Noncontrolling interests primarily relate to MUFG’s interest in Morgan Stanley MUFG Securities Co., Ltd.

 

 

  45   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

Wealth Management

Income Statement Information

 

                      % change  
$ in millions   20161     2015     2014     2016     2015  

Revenues

         

Investment banking

  $ 484     $ 623     $ 791       (22)%       (21)%  

Trading

    861       731       957       18%       (24)%  

Investments

          18       9       N/M       100%  

Commissions and fees

    1,745       1,981       2,127       (12)%       (7)%  

Asset management, distribution and administration fees

    8,454       8,536       8,345       (1)%       2%  

Other

    277       255       320       9%       (20)%  

Total non-interest revenues

    11,821       12,144       12,549       (3)%       (3)%  

Interest income

    3,888       3,105       2,516       25%       23%  

Interest expense

    359       149       177       141%       (16)%  

Net interest

    3,529       2,956       2,339       19%       26%  

Net revenues

    15,350       15,100       14,888       2%       1%  

Compensation and benefits

    8,666       8,595       8,825       1%       (3)%  

Non-compensation expenses

    3,247       3,173       3,078       2%       3%  

Total non-interest expenses

    11,913       11,768       11,903       1%       (1)%  

Income from continuing operations before income taxes

    3,437       3,332       2,985       3%       12%  

Provision for (benefit from) income taxes

    1,333       1,247       (207     7%       N/M  

Net income applicable to Morgan Stanley

  $ 2,104     $ 2,085     $ 3,192       1%       (35)%  

N/M—Not Meaningful

1.

Effective July 1, 2016, the Institutional Securities and Wealth Management business segments entered into an agreement, whereby Institutional Securities assumed management of Wealth Management’s fixed income client-driven trading activities and employees. Institutional Securities now pays fees to Wealth Management based on distribution activity (collectively, the “Fixed Income Integration”). Prior periods have not been recast for this new intersegment agreement due to immateriality.

Statistical Data

Financial Information and Statistical Data

 

$ in billions    At
December 31,
2016
     At
December 31,
2015
 

Client assets

   $ 2,103      $ 1,985  

Fee-based client assets1

   $ 877      $ 795  

Fee-based client assets as a percentage of total client assets

     42%        40%  

Client liabilities2

   $ 73      $ 64  

Bank deposit program

   $ 153      $ 149  

Investment securities portfolio

   $ 63.9      $ 57.9  

Loans and lending commitments

   $ 68.7      $ 55.3  

Wealth Management representatives

     15,763        15,889  

Retail locations

     601        608  

 

      2016     2015      2014     

Revenues per representative

       

(dollars in thousands)3

   $   968     $   950      $   914     

Client assets per representative

       

(dollars in millions)4

   $ 133     $ 125      $ 126     

Fee-based asset flows5

       

(dollars in billions)

   $ 48.5     $ 46.3      $ 58.8     

 

1.

Fee-based client assets represent the amount of assets in client accounts where the basis of payment for services is a fee calculated on those assets.

2.

Client liabilities include securities-based and tailored lending, residential real estate loans and margin lending.

3.

Revenues per representative equal Wealth Management’s net revenues divided by the average representative headcount.

4.

Client assets per representative equal total period-end client assets divided by period-end representative headcount.

5.

Fee-based asset flows include net new fee-based assets, net account transfers, dividends, interest and client fees and exclude institutional cash management-related activity.

Transactional Revenues

 

                          % Change  
$ in millions    2016      2015      2014      2016      2015  

Investment banking

   $ 484      $ 623      $ 791        (22)%        (21 )% 

Trading

     861        731        957        18%        (24 )% 

Commissions and fees

     1,745        1,981        2,127        (12)%        (7 )% 

Total

   $   3,090      $   3,335      $   3,875        (7)%        (14 )% 
 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   46  


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

2016 Compared with 2015

Net Revenues

Transactional Revenues

Transactional revenues of $3,090 million in 2016 decreased 7% from the prior year, primarily reflecting lower revenues related to commissions and fees and investment banking revenues, partially offset by higher trading revenues.

 

 

Investment banking revenues decreased in 2016, primarily due to lower revenues from the distribution of unit investment trusts, equity and structured products.

 

 

Trading revenues increased in 2016, primarily due to gains related to investments associated with certain employee deferred compensation plans compared with losses in 2015.

 

 

Commissions and fees decreased in 2016 reflecting lower daily average commissions, primarily due to reduced client activity in equity, annuity and mutual fund products. This decrease was partially offset by increased fees due to the Fixed Income Integration.

Asset Management

Asset management, distribution and administration fees of $8,454 million in 2016 decreased 1% from the prior year, primarily due to the decrease in mutual fund fees. Revenues from fee-based accounts were relatively flat with decreased client fee rates, partially offset by positive flows. See “Fee-Based Client Assets Activity and Average Fee Rate by Account Type” herein for more details.

Net Interest

Net interest of $3,529 million in 2016 increased 19% from the prior year, primarily due to higher loan balances and investment portfolio yields.

Other

Other revenues of $277 million in 2016 increased 9% from the prior year due to the combination of higher referral fees in 2016 and a decrease in provision for loan losses in 2016.

Non-interest Expenses

Non-interest expenses of $11,913 million in 2016 increased 1% from the prior year.

 

 

Compensation and benefits expenses increased in 2016, primarily due to an increase in the fair value of deferred compensation plan referenced investments.

 

Non-compensation expenses increased in 2016, primarily as a result of a $70 million provision related to certain brokerage service reporting activities. See “Other Items” herein.

2015 Compared with 2014

Net Revenues

Transactional Revenues

Transactional revenues of $3,335 million in 2015 decreased 14% from the prior year due to lower revenues in each of Trading, Investment banking, and Commissions and fees.

 

 

Investment banking revenues decreased, primarily due to lower revenues from the distribution of underwritten offerings.

 

 

Trading revenues decreased, primarily due to losses related to investments associated with certain employee deferred compensation plans and lower revenues from fixed income products.

 

 

Commissions and fees decreased, primarily due to lower revenues from equity, mutual fund and annuity products, partially offset by higher revenues from alternative asset classes.

Asset Management

Asset management, distribution and administration fees of $8,536 million in 2015 increased 2% from the prior year, primarily due to higher fee-based revenues that resulted from positive flows and higher average market values over 2015 as compared with the average market values during 2014. The increase in fee-based revenues was partially offset by lower referral fees from the bank deposit program, reflecting the completion of the transfer of deposits from Citigroup Inc. (“Citi”) to us in connection with the former retail securities joint venture between the Firm and Citi. See “Fee-Based Client Assets Activity and Average Fee Rate by Account Type” herein for more details.

Net Interest

Net interest of $2,956 million in 2015 increased 26% from the prior year, primarily due to higher balances in the bank deposit program and growth in loans and lending commitments.

Other

Other revenues of $255 million in 2015 decreased 20% from the prior year, primarily due to a $40 million gain on sale of a retail property space in the prior year and an increase in the provision for loan losses in 2015.

 

 

  47   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

Non-interest Expenses

Non-interest expenses of $11,768 million in 2015 decreased 1% from the prior year, primarily due to lower Compensation and benefit expenses, partially offset by higher Non-compensation expenses.

 

 

Compensation and benefits expenses decreased, primarily due to the 2014 compensation actions, a decrease in the fair value of deferred compensation plan referenced investments and a decrease in the level of discretionary incentive compensation in 2015 (see also “Supplemental Financial Information and Disclosures—Discretionary Incentive Compensation” herein).

 

 

Non-compensation expenses increased, primarily due to an increase in Professional services, resulting from increased consulting and legal fees, partially offset by a provision related to a rescission offer in the prior year. Other expenses in 2014 included $50 million related to a rescission offer to Wealth Management clients who may not have received a prospectus for certain securities transactions, for which delivery of a prospectus was required.

Income Tax Items

In 2014, we recognized in Provision for (benefit from) income taxes net discrete tax benefits of $1,390 million due

to the release of a deferred tax liability as a result of an internal restructuring to simplify our legal entity organization. For a further discussion of these net discrete tax benefits, see “Supplemental Financial Information and Disclosures—Income Tax Matters” herein.

Other Items

The Firm has identified operational issues that resulted in the reporting of incorrect cost basis tax information to the Internal Revenue Service (“IRS”) and retail brokerage clients for tax years 2011 through 2016. Most of our clients are not impacted by these issues. However, these issues have affected a significant number of client accounts. In the case of clients for whom the Firm has determined that there have been tax underpayments to the IRS as a result of these issues, the Firm is in advanced discussions with the IRS to resolve client tax underpayments to the IRS caused by these issues at no expense to our clients. In the case of clients for whom the Firm has determined that there have been tax overpayments to the IRS as a result of these issues, the Firm plans to notify them and to offer to pay them an amount equivalent to their overpayment to the IRS. The $70 million provision referred to above is based on currently available information and analyses, and our review of these issues is continuing.

 

 

Fee-Based Client Assets Activity and Average Fee Rate by Account Type

Wealth Management earns fees based on a contractual percentage of fee-based client assets related to certain account types that we offer. These fees, which we record in the Asset management, distribution and administration fees line on its income statement, are earned based on the client assets in the specific account types in which the client participates and are generally not driven by asset class. For most account types, fees are billed in the first month of each quarter based on the related client assets as of the end of the prior quarter. Across the account types, fees will vary based on both the distinct services provided within each account type and on the level of household assets under supervision in Wealth Management.

 

$ in billions, fee rate in bps    At
December 31,
2015
     Inflows      Outflows      Market
Impact
     At
December 31,
2016
     Average for the
Year Ended
December 31, 2016
 
                  Fee Rate  

Separately managed accounts1

   $ 283      $ 33      $ (97    $ 3      $ 222        27  

Unified managed accounts

     105        107        (17      9        204        105  

Mutual fund advisory

     25        2        (6             21        121  

Representative as advisor

     115        31        (26      5        125        88  

Representative as portfolio manager

     252        63        (41      11        285        101  

Subtotal

   $ 780      $ 236      $ (187    $ 28      $ 857        74  

Cash management

     15        14        (9             20        6  

Total fee-based client assets

   $ 795      $ 250      $ (196    $ 28      $ 877        72  

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   48  


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

$ in billions, fee rate in bps    At
December 31,
2014
     Inflows      Outflows      Market
Impact
     At
December 31,
2015
     Average for the
Year Ended
December 31, 2015
 
                  Fee Rate  

Separately managed accounts1

   $ 285      $ 42      $ (32    $ (12    $ 283        34  

Unified managed accounts

     93        29        (14      (3      105        113  

Mutual fund advisory

     31        3        (6      (3      25        121  

Representative as advisor

     119        29        (25      (8      115        89  

Representative as portfolio manager

     241        58        (38      (9      252        104  

Subtotal

   $ 769      $ 161      $ (115    $ (35    $ 780        76  

Cash management

     16        9        (10             15        6  

Total fee-based client assets

   $ 785      $ 170      $ (125    $ (35    $ 795        74  

 

$ in billions, fee rate in bps    At
December 31,
2013
     Inflows      Outflows      Market
Impact
     At
December 31,
2014
     Average for the
Year Ended
December 31, 2014
 
                  Fee Rate  

Separately managed accounts1

   $ 260      $ 41      $ (31    $ 15      $ 285        35  

Unified managed accounts

     78        24        (11      2        93        116  

Mutual fund advisory

     34        5        (8             31        121  

Representative as advisor

     111        30        (23      1        119        90  

Representative as portfolio manager

     201        60        (28      8        241        106  

Subtotal

   $ 684      $ 160      $ (101    $ 26      $ 769        77  

Cash management

     13        12        (9             16        6  

Total fee-based client assets

   $ 697      $ 172      $ (110    $ 26      $ 785        75  

bps—Basis points

1.

Includes non-custody account values reflecting prior quarter-end balances due to a lag in the reporting of asset values by third-party custodians.

 

 

Inflows—include new accounts, account transfers, deposits, dividends and interest.

 

 

Outflows—include closed or terminated accounts, account transfers, withdrawals and client fees.

 

 

Market impact—includes realized and unrealized gains and losses on portfolio investments.

 

 

Separately managed accounts—Accounts by which third-party asset managers are engaged to manage clients’ assets with investment decisions made by the asset manager. One third-party asset manager strategy can be held per account.

 

 

Unified managed accounts—Accounts that provide the client with the ability to combine separately managed accounts, mutual funds and exchange traded funds all in one aggregate account. Unified managed accounts can be client-directed, financial advisor-directed or directed by us (with “directed” referring to the investment direction or decision/discretion/power of attorney).

 

Mutual fund advisory—Accounts that give the client the ability to systematically allocate assets across a wide range of mutual funds. Investment decisions are made by the client.

 

 

Representative as advisor—Accounts where the investment decisions must be approved by the client and the financial advisor must obtain approval each time a change is made to the account or its investments.

 

 

Representative as portfolio manager—Accounts where a financial advisor has discretion (contractually approved by the client) to make ongoing investment decisions without the client’s approval for each individual change.

 

 

Cash management—Accounts where the financial advisor provides discretionary cash management services to institutional clients, whereby securities or proceeds are invested and reinvested in accordance with the client’s investment criteria. Generally, the portfolio will be invested in short- term fixed income and cash equivalent investments.

 

 

  49   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

Investment Management

Income Statement Information

 

                      % Change  
$ in millions   2016     2015     2014     2016     2015  
Revenues          
Investment banking   $     $ 1     $ 5       N/M       (80)%  
Trading     (2     (1     (19     (100)%       95%  
Investments     13       249       587       (95)%       (58)%  
Commissions and fees     3       1             200%       N/M  

Asset management, distribution and administration fees

    2,063       2,049       2,049       1%        
Other     31       32       106       (3)%       (70)%  
Total non-interest revenues     2,108       2,331       2,728       (10)%       (15)%  
Interest income     5       2       2       150%        
Interest expense     1       18       18       (94)%        
Net interest     4       (16     (16     N/M        
Net revenues     2,112       2,315       2,712       (9)%       (15)%  
Compensation and benefits     937       954       1,213       (2)%       (21)%  
Non-compensation expenses     888       869       835       2%       4%  
Total non-interest expenses     1,825       1,823       2,048             (11)%  

Income from continuing operations before income taxes

    287       492       664       (42)%       (26)%  
Provision for income taxes     75       128       207       (41)%       (38)%  
Income from continuing operations     212       364       457       (42)%       (20)%  

Income from discontinued operations, net of income taxes

    2       1       5       100%       (80)%  
Net income     214       365       462       (41)%       (21)%  

Net income (loss) applicable to noncontrolling interests

    (11     19       91       N/M       (79)%  

Net income applicable to Morgan Stanley

  $ 225     $ 346     $ 371       (35)%       (7)%  

N/M—Not Meaningful

2016 Compared with 2015

Net Revenues

Investments

 

 

Investments gains of $13 million in 2016 decreased 95% from the prior year reflecting weaker investment performance compared with the prior year. This was partially offset by carried interest losses in 2015 associated with Asia private equity that did not re-occur in 2016.

Asset Management, Distribution and Administration Fees

 

 

Asset management, distribution and administration fees of $2,063 million in 2016 were relatively unchanged from the prior year, as increases in management fees resulting from higher assets under management or supervision (“AUM”) and average fee rates in certain products were offset by lower performance fees (see “AUM and Average Fee Rate by Asset Class” herein).

Non-interest Expenses

Non-interest expenses of $1,825 million in 2016 were relatively unchanged from the prior year, primarily due to higher

Non-compensation expenses offset by lower Compensation and benefits expenses.

 

 

Compensation and benefits expenses decreased, primarily due to a decrease in salaries.

 

 

Non-compensation expenses increased, primarily due to higher brokerage clearing and exchange fees, partially offset by lower litigation costs and expense management.

2015 Compared with 2014

Net Revenues

Investments

 

 

Investments gains of $249 million in 2015 decreased 58% from the prior year reflecting the reversal of previously accrued carried interest associated with Asia private equity and additional net markdowns on principal investments.

Asset Management, Distribution and Administration Fees

 

 

Asset management, distribution and administration fees were unchanged from the prior year as the impact of positive net flows was offset by a shift in the asset class mix from equity and fixed income products to liquidity products (see “AUM and Average Fee Rate by Asset Class” herein).

Other

 

 

Other revenues of $32 million in 2015 decreased 70% from the prior year due to lower revenues associated with our minority investment in certain third-party investment managers.

Non-interest Expenses

Non-interest expenses of $1,823 million in 2015 decreased 11% from the prior year, primarily due to lower Compensation and benefit expenses, partially offset by higher Non-compensation expenses.

 

 

Compensation and benefits expenses decreased, primarily due to the 2014 compensation actions, a decrease in deferred compensation associated with carried interest and a decrease in the level of incentive compensation in 2015 (see also “Supplemental Financial Information and Disclosures—Discretionary Incentive Compensation” herein).

 

 

Non-compensation expenses increased, primarily due to higher brokerage clearing and exchange fees, and professional services resulting from higher consulting and legal fees and information processing and communications expenses.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   50  


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

Assets Under Management or Supervision

Effective in 2016, the presentation of AUM for Investment Management has been revised to better align asset classes with its present organizational structure. All prior period information has been recast in the new format.

AUM and Average Fee Rate by Asset Class

 

$ in billions, Fee Rate in bps

  At
December 31,
2015
    Inflows     Outflows     Distributions     Market
Impact
    Foreign
Currency
Impact
   

At

December 31,
2016

   

Average for the

Year Ended

December 31, 2016

 
                Total
AUM
    Fee
Rate
 

Equity

  $ 83     $ 19     $ (24   $     $ 1     $     $ 79     $ 81       72  

Fixed income

    60       25       (26           2       (1     60       61       32  

Liquidity

    149       1,325       (1,310                 (1     163       151       18  

Alternative / Other products

    114       27       (27     (3     4             115       115       75  

Total assets under management or supervision

  $ 406     $ 1,396     $ (1,387   $ (3   $ 7     $ (2   $ 417     $ 408       47  

Shares of minority stake assets

    8                                               8       8          

 

$ in billions, Fee Rate in bps

 

At

December 31,
2014

    Inflows1     Outflows     Distributions     Market
Impact
    Foreign
Currency
Impact
   

At

December 31,
2015

   

Average for the

Year Ended

December 31, 2015

 
                Total
AUM
    Fee
Rate
 

Equity

  $ 99     $ 15     $ (30   $     $     $ (1   $ 83     $ 93       69  

Fixed income

    65       21       (23           (1     (2     60       63       32  

Liquidity

    128       1,259       (1,238                       149       136       10  

Alternative / Other products

    111       28       (18     (6           (1     114       113       79  

Total assets under management or supervision

  $ 403     $ 1,323     $ (1,309   $ (6   $ (1   $ (4   $ 406     $ 405       46  

Shares of minority stake assets

    7                                               8       7          

 

$ in billions, Fee Rate in bps

 

At

December 31,
2013

    Inflows     Outflows     Distributions    

Market

Impact

   

Foreign

Currency

Impact

   

At

December 31,
2014

   

Average for
the

Year Ended

December 31,
2014

 
                Total
AUM
    Fee
Rate
 

Equity

  $ 106     $ 16     $ (24   $ (1   $ 3     $ (1   $ 99     $ 102       67  

Fixed income

    60       26       (20           1       (2     65       63       32  

Liquidity

    112       963       (945           (2           128       119       8  

Alternative / Other products

    99       31       (20     (2     4       (1     111       110       81  

Total assets under management or supervision

  $ 377     $ 1,036     $ (1,009   $ (3   $ 6     $ (4   $ 403     $ 394       47  

Shares of minority stake assets

    6                                               7       7          

bps—Basis points

1.

Includes $4.6 billion related to the transfer of certain equity portfolio managers and their portfolios from the Wealth Management business segment to the Investment Management business segment.

 

 

Inflows—represent investments or commitments from new and existing clients in new or existing investment products, including reinvestments of client dividends and increases in invested capital. Excludes the impact of exchanges occurring, whereby a client changes positions within the same asset class.

 

Outflows—represent redemptions from clients’ funds, transition of funds from the committed capital period to the invested capital period and decreases in invested capital. Excludes the impact of exchanges occurring, whereby a client changes positions within the same asset class.

 

 

  51   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

 

Distributions—represent decreases in invested capital due to returns of capital after the investment period of a fund. It also includes fund dividends for which the client has not elected to reinvest.

 

 

Market impact—includes realized and unrealized gains and losses on portfolio investments. This excludes any funds where market impact does not impact management fees.

 

 

Foreign currency impact—reflects foreign currency changes for non-U.S. dollar denominated funds.

 

 

Average fee rate—based on asset management and administration fees, net of waivers. It excludes performance-based fees and other non-management fees. For certain non-U.S. funds, it includes the portion of advisory fees that the advisor collects on behalf of third-party distributors. The payment of those fees to the distributor is included in Non-compensation expenses in the consolidated income statements.

 

 

Alternative / Other products—asset class includes products in fund of funds, real estate, private equity and credit strategies as well as multi-asset portfolios.

 

 

Shares of minority stake assets—represent the Investment Management business segment’s proportional share of assets managed by entities in which it owns a minority stake.

Supplemental Financial Information and Disclosures

Legal

We incurred legal expenses of $263 million in 2016, $563 million in 2015 and $3,364 million in 2014. Legal expenses are included in Other expenses in the consolidated income statements.

Legal expenses incurred in 2015 were primarily related to increases in reserves for the settlement of a credit default swap antitrust litigation matter and for legacy residential mortgage-backed securities matters. The legal expenses incurred in 2014 were principally due to reserve additions and settlements related to legacy residential mortgage-backed securities and credit crisis related matters, including our $2,600 million agreement with the United States Department of Justice, Civil Division, which was reached on February 25, 2015 and finalized on February 10, 2016 (see “Contingencies—Legal” in Note 12 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8).

U.S. Bank Subsidiaries

We provide loans to a variety of customers, from large corporate and institutional clients to high net worth individuals, primarily through our U.S. bank subsidiaries, Morgan Stanley Bank, N.A. (“MSBNA”) and Morgan Stanley Private Bank, National Association (“MSPBNA”) (collectively, “U.S. Bank Subsidiaries”). The lending activities in the Institutional Securities business segment primarily include loans or lending commitments to corporate clients. The lending activities in the Wealth Management business segment primarily include securities-based lending that allows clients to borrow money against the value of qualifying securities and also include residential real estate loans. We expect our lending activities to continue to grow through further market penetration of the Wealth Management business segment’s client base. For a further discussion of our credit risks, see “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk—Risk Management—Credit Risk” in Item 7A. For further discussion about loans and lending commitments, see Notes 7 and 12 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8.

U.S. Bank Subsidiaries’ Supplemental Financial Information Excluding Transactions with the Parent Company

 

$ in billions    At
December 31,
2016
     At
December 31,
2015
 

U.S. Bank Subsidiaries assets

   $ 180.7      $ 174.2  

U.S. Bank Subsidiaries investment securities portfolio1

     63.9        57.9  

Wealth Management U.S. Bank Subsidiaries data

 

Securities-based lending and other loans2

   $ 36.0      $ 28.6  

Residential real estate loans

     24.4        20.9  

Total

   $ 60.4      $ 49.5  

Institutional Securities U.S. Bank Subsidiaries data

 

Corporate loans

   $ 20.3      $ 22.9  

Wholesale real estate loans

     9.9        8.9  

Total

   $ 30.2      $ 31.8  

 

1.

The U.S. Bank Subsidiaries investment securities portfolio includes AFS investment securities of $50.3 billion at December 31, 2016 and $53.0 billion at December 31, 2015. The remaining balance represents held to maturity investment securities of $13.6 billion at December 31, 2016 and $4.9 billion at December 31, 2015.

2.

Other loans primarily include tailored lending.

Income Tax Matters

Effective Tax Rate

 

      2016     2015     2014  

From continuing operations

     30.8     25.9     (2.5 )% 
 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   52  


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

2016

Included in the effective tax rate for 2016 were net discrete tax benefits of $68 million, primarily related to the remeasurement of reserves and related interest due to new information regarding the status of a multi-year tax authority examination, partially offset by adjustments for other tax matters. Excluding these net discrete tax benefits, the effective tax rate from continuing operations for 2016 would have been 31.6%, which is generally reflective of the geographic mix of earnings.

2015

Included in the effective tax rate for 2015 were net discrete tax benefits of $564 million, primarily associated with the repatriation of non-U.S. earnings at a cost lower than originally estimated due to an internal restructuring to simplify the legal entity organization in the U.K. Excluding these net discrete tax benefits, the effective tax rate from continuing operations for 2015 would have been 32.5%.

2014

Included in the effective tax rate for 2014 were net discrete tax benefits of $2,226 million. These net discrete tax benefits consisted of: $1,380 million primarily due to the release of a deferred tax liability, previously established as part of the acquisition of Smith Barney in 2009 through a charge to Additional paid-in capital, as a result of the legal entity restructuring that included a change in tax status of Morgan Stanley Smith Barney Holdings LLC from a partnership to a corporation; $609 million principally associated with the remeasurement of reserves and related interest due to new information regarding the status of a multi-year tax authority examination; and $237 million primarily associated with the repatriation of non-U.S. earnings at a cost lower than originally estimated. Excluding these net discrete tax benefits, the effective tax rate from continuing operations for 2014 would have been 59.5%, which is primarily attributable to approximately $900 million of tax provision from non-deductible expenses for litigation and regulatory matters.

Discretionary Incentive Compensation

On December 1, 2014, the Compensation, Management Development and Succession Committee (“CMDS Committee”) of our Board of Directors (the “Board”) approved an approach for awards of discretionary incentive compensation for the 2014 performance year that were granted in 2015, which reduced the average deferral of such awards to an approximate baseline of 50%. Additionally, the CMDS Committee approved the acceleration of vesting for certain outstanding deferred cash-based incentive compensation awards. The deferred cash-based incentive compensation

awards subject to accelerated vesting will be distributed on their regularly scheduled future distribution dates and will continue to be subject to cancellation and clawback provisions. The following table presents the increase in Compensation and benefits expense for the Firm and each of the business segments as a result of these actions in 2014 (“2014 compensation actions”).

2014 Compensation and Benefits Expense

 

$ in millions  

Institutional

Securities

   

Wealth

Management

   

Investment

Management

    Total  

2014 compensation and benefits expense before fourth quarter actions1

  $ 6,882     $ 8,737     $ 1,068     $ 16,687  

Fourth quarter actions:

       

Change in 2014 level of deferrals2

    610       66       80       756  

Acceleration of prior-year cash-based deferred awards3

    294       22       65       381  

Fourth quarter actions total

  $ 904     $ 88     $ 145     $ 1,137  

2014 compensation and benefits expense

  $ 7,786     $ 8,825     $ 1,213     $     17,824  

 

1.

Amount represents compensation and benefits expense at pre-adjustment accrual levels (i.e., at an approximate average baseline 74% deferral rate and with no acceleration of cash-based award vesting that was utilized for the first three quarters of 2014).

2.

Amounts reflect reduction in deferral level from an approximate average baseline of 74% to an approximate average baseline of 50%.

3.

Amounts represent acceleration of vesting for certain cash-based awards.

Accounting Development Updates

The Financial Accounting Standards Board issued the following accounting updates that apply to us.

We consider the applicability and impact of all accounting updates. Accounting updates not listed below were assessed and determined to be either not applicable or are not expected to have a significant impact on our consolidated financial statements.

The following accounting update was adopted on January 1, 2017.

 

 

Improvements to Employee Share-Based Payment Accounting.    This accounting update simplifies the accounting for employee share-based payments, including the recognition of forfeitures, the classification of income tax consequences, and the classification within the cash flow statements. This guidance became effective for us as of January 1, 2017, and the transition impact was not significant. With this update, the income tax consequences for these payments are required to be recognized in Provision for income taxes in the consolidated income statements instead of additional paid-in capital. The impact of the income tax consequences may be either a benefit or a provision, and will primarily occur in the first quarter of each year as share-based awards to employees are

 

 

  53   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

   

converted to Morgan Stanley shares. The impact of recognizing excess tax benefits upon conversion of awards in January 2017 was an approximate $110 million benefit to the Provision for income taxes.

The following accounting updates are currently being evaluated to determine the potential impact of adoption:

 

 

Revenue from Contracts with Customers.    This accounting update aims to clarify the principles of revenue recognition, to develop a common revenue recognition standard across all industries for U.S. GAAP and International Financial Reporting Standards, and to provide enhanced disclosures for users of the financial statements. The core principle of this guidance is that an entity should recognize revenues to depict the transfer of promised goods or services to customers in an amount that reflects the consideration to which the entity expects to be entitled in exchange for those goods or services. We will adopt the guidance on January 1, 2018 and are currently evaluating the method of adoption.

We expect this accounting update to potentially change the timing and presentation of certain revenues, as well as the timing and presentation of certain related costs, for Investment banking fees and Asset management, distribution and administration fees. Outside of Investment Management performance fees in the form of carried interest, discussed further in the following paragraph, these changes are not expected to be significant.

Regarding the recognition of performance fees from fund management activities in the form of carried interest that are subject to reversal, there are alternative views in the industry which include consideration as to whether these arrangements are in the scope of the new revenue guidance or are financial instruments under the scope of equity method of accounting. If we follow the equity method of accounting principles, the current recognition of such fees would remain essentially unchanged. If the fees are deemed in the scope of the new revenue guidance, we would defer recognition until such fees are no longer subject to reversal, which would cause a significant delay in the recognition of these fees as revenue. We are currently assessing the alternative accounting approaches and continue to closely monitor developments in this still-evolving area.

We will continue to assess the impact of the new rule as we progress through the implementation of the new standard; therefore, additional impacts may be identified prior to adoption.

 

 

Financial Instruments—Credit Losses.    This accounting update impacts the impairment model for certain financial assets measured at amortized cost such as loans held for investment and HTM securities. The amendments in this

   

update will accelerate the recognition of credit losses by replacing the incurred loss impairment methodology with a current expected credit loss (“CECL”) methodology that requires an estimate of expected credit losses over the entire life of the financial asset. Additionally, although the CECL methodology will not apply to AFS debt securities, the update will require establishment of an allowance to reflect impairment of these securities, thereby eliminating the concept of a permanent write-down. This update is effective as of January 1, 2020.

 

 

Leases.    This accounting update requires lessees to recognize on the balance sheet all leases with terms exceeding one year, which results in the recognition of a right of use asset and corresponding lease liability, including for those leases that we currently classify as operating leases. The right of use asset and lease liability will initially be measured using the present value of the remaining rental payments. The accounting for leases where we are the lessor is largely unchanged. This update is effective as of January 1, 2019.

 

 

Gains and Losses from the Derecognition of Nonfinancial Assets.    This accounting update clarifies the guidance on how to account for the derecognition of nonfinancial assets and in substance nonfinancial assets and also provides guidance on the accounting for partial sales of nonfinancial assets. This update is effective as of January 1, 2018.

Critical Accounting Policies

Our consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with U.S. GAAP, which require us to make estimates and assumptions (see Note 1 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8). We believe that of our significant accounting policies (see Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8), the following policies involve a higher degree of judgment and complexity.

Fair Value

Financial Instruments Measured at Fair Value

A significant number of our financial instruments are carried at fair value. We make estimates regarding valuation of assets and liabilities measured at fair value in preparing the consolidated financial statements. These assets and liabilities include, but are not limited to:

 

 

Trading assets and Trading liabilities;

 

 

Investment Securities—AFS securities;

 

 

Certain Securities purchased under agreements to resell;

 

 

Certain Deposits, primarily structured certificates of deposits;

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   54  


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

 

Certain Short-term borrowings, primarily structured notes;

 

 

Certain Securities sold under agreements to repurchase;

 

 

Certain Other secured financings; and

 

 

Certain Long-term borrowings, primarily structured notes.

Fair value is defined as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability (i.e., the exit price) in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date.

In determining fair value, we use various valuation approaches. A hierarchy for inputs is used in measuring fair value that maximizes the use of observable prices and inputs and minimizes the use of unobservable prices and inputs by requiring that the relevant observable inputs be used when available. The hierarchy is broken down into three levels, wherein Level 1 represents quoted prices in active markets, Level 2 represents valuations based on quoted prices in markets that are not active or for which all significant inputs are observable, and Level 3 consists of valuation techniques that incorporate significant unobservable inputs and, therefore, require the greatest use of judgment. In periods of market disruption, the observability of prices and inputs may be reduced for many instruments. This condition could cause an instrument to be recategorized from Level 1 to Level 2 or from Level 2 to Level 3. In addition, a downturn in market conditions could lead to declines in the valuation of many instruments. For further information on the valuation process, fair value definition, Level 1, Level 2, Level 3 and related valuation techniques, and quantitative information about and sensitivity of significant unobservable inputs used in Level 3 fair value measurements, see Notes 2 and 3 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8.

Where appropriate, valuation adjustments are made to account for various factors such as liquidity risk (bid-ask adjustments), credit quality, model uncertainty and concentration risk in order to arrive at fair value. For a further discussion of valuation adjustments that we apply, see Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8.

Assets and Liabilities Measured at Fair Value on a Non-recurring Basis

At December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, certain of our assets and liabilities were measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis, primarily relating to loans, other investments, premises, equipment and software costs, intangible assets, other assets and other liabilities, and accrued expenses. We incur losses or gains for any adjustments of these assets to fair value. A downturn in market conditions could result in impairment charges in future periods.

For assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis, fair value is determined by using various valuation approaches. The same hierarchy as described above, which maximizes the use of observable inputs and minimizes the use of unobservable inputs by generally requiring that the observable inputs be used when available, is used in measuring fair value for these items.

See Note 3 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 for further information on assets and liabilities that are measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis.

Fair Value Control Processes

We employ control processes designed to validate the fair value of our financial instruments, including those derived from pricing models. These control processes are designed to ensure that the values used for financial reporting are based on observable inputs wherever possible. In the event that observable inputs are not available, the control processes are designed to ensure that the valuation approach utilized is appropriate and consistently applied and that the assumptions are reasonable.

See Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 for additional information regarding our valuation policies, processes and procedures.

Goodwill and Intangible Assets

Goodwill

We test goodwill for impairment on an annual basis on July 1 and on an interim basis when certain events or circumstances exist. We test for impairment at the reporting unit level, which is generally at the level of or one level below its business segments. Goodwill no longer retains its association with a particular acquisition once it has been assigned to a reporting unit. As such, all the activities of a reporting unit, whether acquired or organically developed, are available to support the value of the goodwill. For both the annual and interim tests, we have the option to first assess qualitative factors to determine whether the existence of events or circumstances leads to a determination that it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying amount.

If after assessing the totality of events or circumstances, we determine it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is greater than its carrying amount, then performing the two-step impairment test is not required. However, if we conclude otherwise, then we are required to perform the first step of the two-step impairment test. Goodwill impairment is determined by comparing the estimated fair value of a reporting unit with its respective carrying value. If the estimated fair value exceeds the carrying value,

 

 

  55   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

goodwill at the reporting unit level is not deemed to be impaired. If the estimated fair value is below carrying value, however, further analysis is required to determine the amount of the impairment.

The estimated fair value of the reporting units is derived based on valuation techniques we believe market participants would use for each of the reporting units. The estimated fair value is generally determined by utilizing a discounted cash flow methodology or methodologies that incorporate price-to-book and price-to-earnings multiples of certain comparable companies. At each annual goodwill impairment testing date, each of our reporting units with goodwill had a fair value that was substantially in excess of its carrying value.

Intangible Assets

Amortizable intangible assets are amortized over their estimated useful life and are reviewed for impairment on an interim basis when certain events or circumstances exist. An impairment exists when the carrying amount of the intangible asset exceeds its fair value. An impairment loss will be recognized only if the carrying amount of the intangible asset is not recoverable and exceeds its fair value. The carrying amount of the intangible asset is not recoverable if it exceeds the sum of the expected undiscounted cash flows.

For both goodwill and intangible assets, to the extent an impairment loss is recognized, the loss establishes the new cost basis of the asset. Subsequent reversal of impairment losses is not permitted. For amortizable intangible assets, the new cost basis is amortized over the remaining useful life of that asset. Adverse market or economic events could result in impairment charges in future periods.

See Notes 2, 3 and 9 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 for additional information about goodwill and intangible assets.

Legal and Regulatory Contingencies

In the normal course of business, we have been named, from time to time, as a defendant in various legal actions, including arbitrations, class actions and other litigation, arising in connection with our activities as a global diversified financial services institution.

Certain of the actual or threatened legal actions include claims for substantial compensatory and/or punitive damages or claims for indeterminate amounts of damages. In some cases, the entities that would otherwise be the primary defendants in such cases are bankrupt or in financial distress.

We are also involved, from time to time, in other reviews, investigations and proceedings (both formal and informal) by

governmental and self-regulatory agencies regarding our business and involving, among other matters, sales and trading activities, wealth and investment management services, financial products or offerings sponsored, underwritten or sold by us, and accounting and operational matters, certain of which may result in adverse judgments, settlements, fines, penalties, injunctions or other relief.

Accruals for litigation and regulatory proceedings are generally determined on a case-by-case basis. Where available information indicates that it is probable a liability had been incurred at the date of the consolidated financial statements and we can reasonably estimate the amount of that loss, we accrue the estimated loss by a charge to income. In many proceedings, however, it is inherently difficult to determine whether any loss is probable or even possible or to estimate the amount of any loss.

For certain legal proceedings and investigations, we can estimate possible losses, additional losses, ranges of loss or ranges of additional loss in excess of amounts accrued. For certain other legal proceedings and investigations, we cannot reasonably estimate such losses, particularly for proceedings and investigations where the factual record is being developed or contested or where plaintiffs or government entities seek substantial or indeterminate damages, restitution, disgorgement or penalties. Numerous issues may need to be resolved before a loss or additional loss or range of loss or additional range of loss can be reasonably estimated for a proceeding or investigation, including through potentially lengthy discovery and determination of important factual matters, determination of issues related to class certification and the calculation of damages or other relief, and addressing novel or unsettled legal questions relevant to the proceedings or investigations in question.

Significant judgment is required in deciding when and if to make these accruals, and the actual cost of a legal claim or regulatory fine/penalty may ultimately be materially different from the recorded accruals.

See Note 12 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 for additional information on legal proceedings.

Income Taxes

We are subject to the income and indirect tax laws of the U.S., its states and municipalities and those of the foreign jurisdictions in which we have significant business operations. These tax laws are complex and subject to different interpretations by the taxpayer and the relevant governmental taxing authorities. We must make judgments and interpretations about the application of these inherently complex tax laws when determining the provision for income taxes and the expense for indirect taxes and must also make estimates about when certain items affect taxable income in the various

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   56  


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

tax jurisdictions. Disputes over interpretations of the tax laws may be settled with the taxing authority upon examination or audit. We periodically evaluate the likelihood of assessments in each taxing jurisdiction resulting from current and subsequent years’ examinations, and unrecognized tax benefits related to potential losses that may arise from tax audits are established in accordance with the guidance on accounting for unrecognized tax benefits. Once established, unrecognized tax benefits are adjusted when there is more information available or when an event occurs requiring a change.

Our provision for income taxes is composed of current and deferred taxes. Current income taxes approximate taxes to be paid or refunded for the current period. Our deferred income taxes reflect the net tax effects of temporary differences between the financial reporting and tax bases of assets and liabilities and are measured using the applicable enacted tax rates and laws that will be in effect when such differences are expected to reverse. Our deferred tax balances also include deferred assets related to tax attribute carryforwards, such as net operating losses and tax credits that will be realized through reduction of future tax liabilities and, in some cases, are subject to expiration if not utilized within certain periods. We perform regular reviews to ascertain whether deferred tax assets are realizable. These reviews include management’s

estimates and assumptions regarding future taxable income and incorporate various tax planning strategies, including strategies that may be available to tax attribute carryforwards before they expire. Once the deferred tax asset balances have been determined, we may record a valuation allowance against the deferred tax asset balances to reflect the amount of these balances (net of valuation allowance) that we estimate it is more likely than not to realize at a future date. Both current and deferred income taxes could reflect adjustments related to our unrecognized tax benefits.

Significant judgment is required in estimating the consolidated provision for (benefit from) income taxes, current and deferred tax balances (including valuation allowance, if any), accrued interest or penalties and uncertain tax positions. Revisions in estimates and/or the actual costs of a tax assessment may ultimately be materially different from the recorded accruals and unrecognized tax benefits, if any.

See Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 for additional information on our significant assumptions, judgments and interpretations associated with the accounting for income taxes and Note 20 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 for additional information on our tax examinations.

 

 

  57   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

Liquidity and Capital Resources

Senior management establishes liquidity and capital policies. Through various risk and control committees, senior management reviews business performance relative to these policies, monitors the availability of alternative sources of financing, and oversees the liquidity, interest rate and currency sensitivity of our asset and liability position. The Treasury Department, Firm Risk Committee, Asset and Liability Management Committee, and other committees and control groups assist in evaluating, monitoring and controlling the impact that our business activities have on our consolidated balance sheets, liquidity and capital structure. Liquidity and capital matters are reported regularly to the Board and the Board’s Risk Committee.

The Balance Sheet

We monitor and evaluate the composition and size of our balance sheet on a regular basis. Our balance sheet management process includes quarterly planning, business-specific thresholds, monitoring of business-specific usage versus key performance metrics and new business impact assessments.

We establish balance sheet thresholds at the consolidated, business segment and business unit levels. We monitor balance sheet utilization and review variances resulting from business activity or market fluctuations. On a regular basis, we review current performance versus established thresholds and assess the need to re-allocate our balance sheet based on business unit needs. We also monitor key metrics, including asset and liability size and capital usage.

Total Assets by Business Segment

 

    At December 31, 2016  
$ in millions   Institutional
Securities
    Wealth
Management
    Investment
Management
    Total  

Assets

       

Cash and cash equivalents1

  $ 25,291     $ 18,022     $ 68     $ 43,381  

Trading assets at fair value

    259,680       64       2,410       262,154  

Investment securities

    16,222       63,870       —         80,092  

Securities purchased under agreements to resell

    96,735       5,220       —         101,955  

Securities borrowed

    124,840       396       —         125,236  

Customer and other receivables

    26,624       19,268       568       46,460  

Loans, net of allowance

    33,816       60,427       5       94,248  

Other assets2

    45,941       13,868       1,614       61,423  

Total assets

  $ 629,149     $ 181,135     $ 4,665     $   814,949  
    At December 31, 2015  
$ in millions   Institutional
Securities
    Wealth
Management
    Investment
Management
    Total  

Assets

       

Cash and cash equivalents1

  $ 22,356     $ 31,216     $ 511     $ 54,083  

Trading assets at fair value

    236,174       883       2,448       239,505  

Investment securities

    14,124       57,858       1       71,983  

Securities purchased under agreements to resell

    83,205       4,452       —         87,657  

Securities borrowed

    141,971       445       —         142,416  

Customer and other receivables

    23,390       21,406       611       45,407  

Loans, net of allowance

    36,237       49,522       —         85,759  

Other assets2

    45,257       13,926       1,472       60,655  

Total assets

  $ 602,714     $ 179,708     $ 5,043     $   787,465  

 

1.

Cash and cash equivalents include cash and due from banks and interest bearing deposits with banks.

2.

Other assets primarily includes Cash deposited with clearing organizations or segregated under federal and other regulations or requirements; Other investments; Premises, equipment and software costs; Goodwill; Intangible assets and deferred tax assets.

A substantial portion of total assets consists of liquid marketable securities and short-term receivables arising principally from sales and trading activities in the Institutional Securities business segment. Total assets increased to $815 billion at December 31, 2016 from $787 billion at December 31, 2015, primarily due to increases in Trading assets within Institutional Securities, including increases in highly liquid U.S. government and agency securities and corporate equities. These increases were partially offset by a reduction in Securities borrowed driven by a decrease in Trading liabilities. Cash and cash equivalent balances resulting from bank deposits continued to be redeployed into Investment securities and lending activity primarily within the Wealth Management business segment.

Securities Repurchase Agreements and Securities Lending

Securities borrowed or securities purchased under agreements to resell and securities loaned or securities sold under agreements to repurchase are treated as collateralized financings (see Notes 2 and 6 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8).

Collateralized Financing Transactions

 

$ in millions    At
December 31,
2016
     At
December 31,
2015
 

Securities purchased under agreements to resell and Securities borrowed

   $ 227,191      $ 230,073  

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase and Securities loaned

   $ 70,472      $ 56,050  
 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   58  


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

    

Daily Average Balance

Three Months Ended

 
$ in millions    December 31,
2016
     December 31,
2015
 

Securities purchased under agreements to resell and Securities borrowed

   $ 224,355      $ 250,605  

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase and Securities loaned

   $ 68,908      $ 62,373  

At December 31, 2016, differences between period end balances and average balances during the three months ended December 31, 2016 in the previous table were not significant. Securities purchased under agreements to resell and Securities borrowed and Securities sold under agreements to repurchase and Securities loaned at December 31, 2015 were lower than the average balances during 2015. The balances moved in line with client financing activity and with general movements in Trading assets and liabilities. Additionally, included within securities financing transactions were $14 billion and $11 billion at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively, related to fully collateralized securities-for-securities lending transactions represented in Trading assets.

Customer Securities Financing

The customer receivable portion of the securities financing transactions primarily includes customer margin loans, collateralized by customer-owned securities, which are segregated in accordance with regulatory requirements. The customer payable portion of the securities financing transactions primarily includes payables to our prime brokerage customers. Our risk exposure on these transactions is mitigated by collateral maintenance policies that limit our credit exposure to customers and liquidity reserves held against this risk exposure.

Liquidity Risk Management Framework

The primary goal of our Liquidity Risk Management Framework is to ensure that we have access to adequate funding across a wide range of market conditions and time horizons. The framework is designed to enable us to fulfill our financial obligations and support the execution of our business strategies.

The following principles guide our Liquidity Risk Management Framework:

 

 

Sufficient liquid assets should be maintained to cover maturing liabilities and other planned and contingent outflows;

 

 

Maturity profile of assets and liabilities should be aligned, with limited reliance on short-term funding;

 

 

Source, counterparty, currency, region and term of funding should be diversified; and

 

Liquidity Stress Tests should anticipate, and account for, periods of limited access to funding.

The core components of our Liquidity Risk Management Framework are the Required Liquidity Framework, Liquidity Stress Tests and the Global Liquidity Reserve (as defined below), which support our target liquidity profile.

Required Liquidity Framework

Our Required Liquidity Framework reflects the amount of liquidity we must hold in both normal and stressed environments to ensure that our financial condition and overall soundness are not adversely affected by an inability (or perceived inability) to meet our financial obligations in a timely manner. The Required Liquidity Framework considers the most constraining liquidity requirement to satisfy all regulatory and internal limits at a consolidated and legal entity level.

Liquidity Stress Tests

We use Liquidity Stress Tests to model external and intercompany liquidity flows across multiple scenarios and a range of time horizons. These scenarios contain various combinations of idiosyncratic and systemic stress events of different severity and duration. The methodology, implementation, production and analysis of our Liquidity Stress Tests are important components of the Required Liquidity Framework.

The scenarios or assumptions used by us in our Liquidity Stress Tests include, but are not limited to, the following:

 

 

No government support;

 

 

No access to equity and unsecured debt markets;

 

 

Repayment of all unsecured debt maturing within the stress horizon;

 

 

Higher haircuts for and significantly lower availability of secured funding;

 

 

Additional collateral that would be required by trading counterparties, certain exchanges and clearing organizations related to credit rating downgrades;

 

 

Additional collateral that would be required due to collateral substitutions, collateral disputes and uncalled collateral;

 

 

Discretionary unsecured debt buybacks;

 

 

Drawdowns on lending commitments provided to third parties;

 

 

  59   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

 

Client cash withdrawals and reduction in customer short positions that fund long positions;

 

 

Limited access to the foreign exchange swap markets; and

 

 

Maturity roll-off of outstanding letters of credit with no further issuance.

Liquidity Stress Tests are produced for the Parent Company and major operating subsidiaries, as well as at major currency levels, to capture specific cash requirements and cash availability across the Firm, including a limited number of asset sales in a stressed environment. The Liquidity Stress Tests assume that subsidiaries will use their own liquidity first to fund their obligations before drawing liquidity from the Parent Company and that the Parent Company will support its subsidiaries and will not have access to subsidiaries’ liquidity reserves. In addition to the assumptions underpinning the Liquidity Stress Tests, we take into consideration settlement risk related to intraday settlement and clearing of securities and financing activities.

At December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, we maintained sufficient liquidity to meet current and contingent funding obligations as modeled in our Liquidity Stress Tests.

Global Liquidity Reserve

We maintain sufficient liquidity reserves to cover daily funding needs and to meet strategic liquidity targets sized by the Required Liquidity Framework and Liquidity Stress Tests. The size of the Global Liquidity Reserve is actively managed by us considering the following components: unsecured debt maturity profile; balance sheet size and composition; funding needs in a stressed environment, inclusive of contingent cash outflows; legal entity, regional and segment liquidity requirements; regulatory requirements; and collateral requirements. In addition, our Global Liquidity Reserve includes a discretionary surplus based on risk tolerance and is subject to change dependent on market and Firm-specific events. The Global Liquidity Reserve is held within the Parent Company and its major operating subsidiaries.

Global Liquidity Reserve by Type of Investment

 

$ in millions   

At

December 31,
2016

    

At

December 31,
2015

 

Cash deposits with banks

   $ 8,679      $ 10,187  

Cash deposits with central banks

     30,568        39,774  

Unencumbered highly liquid securities:

     

U.S. government obligations

     78,615        72,265  

U.S. agency and agency mortgage-backed securities

     46,360        37,678  

Non-U.S. sovereign obligations1

     30,884        28,999  

Other investment grade securities

     7,191        14,361  

Global Liquidity Reserve

   $ 202,297      $ 203,264  

 

1.

Non-U.S. sovereign obligations are primarily composed of unencumbered German, French, Dutch, U.K. and Japanese government obligations.

Global Liquidity Reserve Managed by Bank and Non-Bank Legal Entities

 

                Daily Average Balance Three
Months Ended
 
$ in millions  

At

December 31,
2016

   

At

December 31,
2015

    December 31,
2016
    December 31,
2015
 

Bank legal entities

       

Domestic

  $ 74,411     $ 88,432     $ 72,553     $ 84,356  

Foreign

    4,238       5,896       5,041       5,752  

Total Bank legal entities

    78,649       94,328       77,594       90,108  

Non-Bank legal
entities

       

Domestic:

       

Parent Company

    66,514       54,810       65,657       53,298  

Non-Parent Company

    18,801       20,001       19,255       17,168  

Total Domestic

    85,315       74,811       84,912       70,466  

Foreign

    38,333       34,125       37,131       35,013  

Total Non-Bank legal entities

    123,648       108,936       122,043       105,479  

Total

  $ 202,297     $ 203,264     $ 199,637     $ 195,587  

Regulatory Liquidity Framework

Liquidity Coverage Ratio

The Basel Committee on Banking Supervision’s (“Basel Committee”) Liquidity Coverage Ratio (“LCR”) standard is designed to ensure that banking organizations have sufficient high-quality liquid assets to cover net cash outflows arising from significant stress over 30 calendar days. The standard’s objective is to promote the short-term resilience of the liquidity risk profile of banking organizations.

We and our U.S. Bank Subsidiaries are subject to the LCR requirements issued by U.S. banking regulators (“U.S. LCR”), which are based on the Basel Committee’s LCR, including a requirement to calculate each entity’s U.S. LCR on each business day. As of January 1, 2017, we and our U.S. Bank Subsidiaries are required to maintain a minimum of 100% of the fully phased-in U.S. LCR. In addition, effective April 1, 2017, we will be required to disclose certain quantitative and qualitative information related to our U.S. LCR calculation after each calendar quarter. We and our U.S. Bank Subsidiaries are compliant with the minimum required U.S. LCR based on current interpretations.

Net Stable Funding Ratio

The objective of the Net Stable Funding Ratio (“NSFR”) is to reduce funding risk over a one-year horizon by requiring banking organizations to fund their activities with sufficiently stable sources of funding in order to mitigate the risk of future funding stress.

 

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   60  


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

The Basel Committee finalized the NSFR framework in 2014. In May 2016, the U.S. banking regulators issued a proposal to implement the NSFR in the U.S. The proposal would require a covered company to maintain an amount of available stable funding, which is measured with reference to sources of funding, including deposit and debt liabilities, that is no less than the amount of its required stable funding, which is measured by applying standardized weightings to its assets, derivatives exposures and certain other items.

If adopted as proposed, the requirements would apply to us and our U.S. Bank Subsidiaries beginning January 1, 2018. We continue to evaluate the potential impact of the proposal, which is subject to further rulemaking procedures following the closing of the public comment period. Our preliminary estimates, based on the current proposal, indicate that actions will be necessary to meet the requirement, which we expect to accomplish by the effective date of the final rule. Our preliminary estimates are subject to risks and uncertainties that may cause actual results based on the final rule to differ materially from estimates. For a discussion of risks and uncertainties that may affect our future results, see “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A.

Funding Management

We manage our funding in a manner that reduces the risk of disruption to our operations. We pursue a strategy of diversification of secured and unsecured funding sources (by product, investor and region) and attempt to ensure that the tenor of our liabilities equals or exceeds the expected holding period of the assets being financed.

We fund our balance sheet on a global basis through diverse sources. These sources may include our equity capital, long-term borrowings, securities sold under agreements to repurchase (“repurchase agreements”), securities lending, deposits, letters of credit and lines of credit. We have active financing programs for both standard and structured products targeting global investors and currencies.

Secured Financing

A substantial portion of our total assets consist of liquid marketable securities and short-term receivables arising principally from sales and trading activities in the Institutional Securities business. The liquid nature of these assets provides us with flexibility in managing the composition and size of our balance sheet. Our goal is to achieve an optimal mix of durable secured and unsecured financing. Secured financing investors principally focus on the quality of the eligible collateral posted. Accordingly, we actively manage the secured financing book based on the quality of the assets being funded.

We utilize shorter-term secured financing only for highly liquid assets and have established longer tenor limits for less liquid asset classes, for which funding may be at risk in the event of a market disruption. We define highly liquid assets as government-issued or government-guaranteed securities with a high degree of fundability and less liquid assets as those that do not meet these criteria. At December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, the weighted average maturity of our secured financing of less liquid assets was greater than 120 days. To further minimize the refinancing risk of secured financing for less liquid assets, we have established concentration limits to diversify our investor base and reduce the amount of monthly maturities for secured financing of less liquid assets. Furthermore, we obtain term secured funding liabilities in excess of less liquid inventory as an additional risk mitigant to replace maturing trades in the event that secured financing markets, or our ability to access them, become limited. As a component of the Liquidity Risk Management Framework, we hold a portion of our Global Liquidity Reserve against the potential disruption to our secured financing capabilities.

We also maintain a pool of liquid and easily fundable securities, which provide a valuable future source of liquidity. With the implementation of liquidity standards, we have also incorporated high-quality liquid asset classifications that are consistent with the U.S. LCR definitions into our encumbrance reporting, which further substantiates the demonstrated liquidity characteristics of the unencumbered asset pool and our ability to readily identify new funding sources for such assets.

Unsecured Financing

We view long-term debt and deposits as stable sources of funding. Unencumbered securities and non-security assets are financed with a combination of long-term and short-term debt and deposits. Our unsecured financings include structured borrowings, whose payments and redemption values are based on the performance of certain underlying assets, including equity, credit, foreign exchange, interest rates and commodities. When appropriate, we may use derivative products to conduct asset and liability management and to make adjustments to our interest rate and structured borrowings risk profile (see Note 4 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8).

Deposits

Available funding sources to our U.S. Bank Subsidiaries include demand deposit accounts, money market deposit accounts, time deposits, repurchase agreements, federal funds purchased and Federal Home Loan Bank advances. The vast majority of deposits in our U.S. Bank Subsidiaries are

 

 

  61   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

sourced from our retail brokerage accounts and are considered to have stable, low-cost funding characteristics. At December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, deposits were $155,863 million and $156,034 million, respectively (see Note 10 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8).

Short-Term Borrowings

Our unsecured short-term borrowings may primarily consist of structured notes, bank loans and bank notes with original maturities of 12 months or less. At December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, we had approximately $941 million and $2,173 million, respectively, in short-term borrowings.

Long-Term Borrowings

We believe that accessing debt investors through multiple distribution channels helps provide consistent access to the unsecured markets. In addition, the issuance of long-term borrowings allows us to reduce reliance on short-term credit sensitive instruments. Long-term borrowings are generally managed to achieve staggered maturities, thereby mitigating refinancing risk, and to maximize investor diversification through sales to global institutional and retail clients across regions, currencies and product types. Availability and cost of financing to us can vary depending on market conditions, the volume of certain trading and lending activities, our credit ratings and the overall availability of credit.

We may engage in various transactions in the credit markets (including, for example, debt retirements) that we believe are in our investors’ best interests.

Long-term Borrowings by Maturity Profile

 

$ in millions    Parent
Company
     Subsidiaries      Total  

Due in 2017

   $     21,489      $ 4,638      $     26,127  

Due in 2018

     17,640        1,652        19,292  

Due in 2019

     21,389        1,008        22,397  

Due in 2020

     15,698        1,038        16,736  

Due in 2021

     15,658        1,521        17,179  

Thereafter

     58,461        4,583        63,044  

Total

   $ 150,335      $ 14,440      $ 164,775  

Subsequent to December 31, 2016 and through February 21, 2017, long-term borrowings increased by approximately $7.1 billion, net of maturities. This amount includes the issuances of senior debt; $7.0 billion on January 20, 2017 and $3.0 billion on February 17, 2017.

Trust Preferred Securities

During 2016, Morgan Stanley Capital Trust III, Morgan Stanley Capital Trust IV, Morgan Stanley Capital Trust V and Morgan Stanley Capital Trust VIII redeemed all of their issued and outstanding Capital Securities pursuant to the

optional redemption provisions provided in the respective governing documents. In the aggregate, $2.8 billion was redeemed. We concurrently redeemed the related underlying junior subordinated debentures.

For further information on long-term borrowings, see Note 11 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8.

Credit Ratings

We rely on external sources to finance a significant portion of our day-to-day operations. The cost and availability of financing generally are impacted by our credit ratings, among other things. In addition, our credit ratings can have an impact on certain trading revenues, particularly in those businesses where longer-term counterparty performance is a key consideration, such as OTC derivative transactions, including credit derivatives and interest rate swaps. Rating agencies consider company-specific factors; other industry factors such as regulatory or legislative changes and the macroeconomic environment, among other things.

Our credit ratings do not include any uplift from perceived government support from any rating agency given the significant progress of the U.S. financial reform legislation and regulations. Meanwhile, some rating agencies have stated that they currently incorporate various degrees of credit rating uplift from non-governmental third-party sources of potential support.

Parent Company and MSBNA’s Senior Unsecured Ratings at February 21, 2017

 

    Parent Company
     Short-Term
Debt
  Long-Term
Debt
  Rating
Outlook

DBRS, Inc.

  R-1 (middle)   A(high)   Stable

Fitch Ratings, Inc.

  F1   A   Stable

Moody’s Investors Service, Inc.

  P-2   A3   Stable

Rating and Investment Information, Inc.

  a-1   A-   Stable

Standard & Poor’s Global Ratings

  A-2   BBB+   Stable

 

    Morgan Stanley Bank, N.A.
     Short-Term
Debt
  Long-Term
Debt
  Rating
Outlook

Fitch Ratings, Inc.

  F1   A+   Stable

Moody’s Investors Service, Inc.

  P-1   A1   Stable

Standard & Poor’s Global Ratings1

  A-1   A+   Stable

 

1.

On December 16, 2016, Standard & Poor’s Global Ratings upgraded the long-term rating of MSBNA by one notch to A+ from A following the release of the final total loss-absorbing capacity (”TLAC”) rule. The rating outlook was changed to Stable from Positive Watch.

In connection with certain OTC trading agreements and certain other agreements where we are a liquidity provider to certain financing vehicles associated with the Institutional Securities business segment, we may be required to provide

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   62  


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

additional collateral or immediately settle any outstanding liability balances with certain counterparties or pledge additional collateral to certain exchanges and clearing organizations in the event of a future credit rating downgrade irrespective of whether we are in a net asset or net liability position.

The additional collateral or termination payments that may be called in the event of a future credit rating downgrade vary by contract and can be based on ratings by either or both of Moody’s Investors Service, Inc. (“Moody’s”) and Standard & Poor’s Global Ratings (“S&P”). The following table shows the future potential collateral amounts and termination payments that could be called or required by counterparties or exchanges and clearing organizations in the event of one-notch or two-notch downgrade scenarios, from the lowest of Moody’s or S&P ratings, based on the relevant contractual downgrade triggers.

Incremental Collateral or Terminating Payments upon Potential Future Rating Downgrade

 

$ in millions    At December 31,
2016
     At December 31,
2015
 

One-notch downgrade

   $ 1,292      $ 1,169  

Two-notch downgrade

     875        1,465  

While certain aspects of a credit rating downgrade are quantifiable pursuant to contractual provisions, the impact it would have on our business and results of operations in future periods is inherently uncertain and would depend on a number of interrelated factors, including, among others, the magnitude of the downgrade, the rating relative to peers, the rating assigned by the relevant agency pre-downgrade, individual client behavior and future mitigating actions we might take. The liquidity impact of additional collateral requirements is included in our Liquidity Stress Tests.

Capital Management

We view capital as an important source of financial strength and actively manage our consolidated capital position based upon, among other things, business opportunities, risks, capital availability and rates of return together with internal capital policies, regulatory requirements and rating agency guidelines and, therefore, in the future may expand or contract our capital base to address the changing needs of our businesses. We attempt to maintain total capital, on a consolidated basis, at least equal to the sum of our operating subsidiaries’ required equity.

Common Stock

We repurchased approximately $3,500 million of our outstanding common stock as part of our share repurchase program during 2016 and $2,125 million during 2015 (see Note 15 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8). Pursuant to the share repurchase program, we consider, among other things, business segment capital needs, as well as stock-based compensation and benefit plan requirements. Share repurchases under our program will be exercised from time to time at prices we deem appropriate subject to various factors, including our capital position and market conditions. The share repurchases may be effected through open market purchases or privately negotiated transactions, including through Rule 10b5-1 plans, and may be suspended at any time. Share repurchases by us are subject to regulatory approval (see “Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities” in Part II, Item 5).

The Board determines the declaration and payment of dividends on a quarterly basis. On January 17, 2017, we announced that the Board declared a quarterly dividend per common share of $0.20. The dividend was paid on February 15, 2017 to common shareholders of record on January 31, 2017.

Preferred Stock

On December 15, 2016, we announced that the Board declared quarterly dividends for preferred stock shareholders of record on December 30, 2016 that were paid on January 17, 2017.

Series K Preferred Stock. In January 2017, we issued 40,000,000 Depositary Shares, for an aggregate price of $1,000 million. Each Depositary Share represents a 1/1,000th interest in a share of Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series K, $0.01 par value (“Series K Preferred Stock”). The Series K Preferred Stock is redeemable at our option, (i) in whole or in part, from time to time, on any dividend payment date on or after April 15, 2027 or (ii) in whole but not in part at any time within 90 days following a regulatory capital treatment event (as described in the terms of that series), in each case at a redemption price of $25,000 per share (equivalent to $25 per Depositary Share), plus any declared and unpaid dividends to, but excluding, the date fixed for redemption, without accumulation of any undeclared dividends. The Series K Preferred Stock also has a preference over our common stock upon liquidation. The Series K Preferred Stock offering (net of related issuance costs) resulted in proceeds of approximately $969 million.

 

 

  63   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

Preferred Stock Dividends

 

Series    Preferred Stock Description    Quarterly
Dividend
per Share
 

    A    

   Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock (represented by depositary shares, each representing a 1/1,000th interest in a share of preferred stock and each having a dividend of $0.25556)    $ 255.56  

    C    

   10% Non-Cumulative Non-Voting Perpetual Preferred Stock      25.00  

    E    

   Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock (represented by depositary shares, each representing a 1/1,000th interest in a share of preferred stock and each having a dividend of $0.44531)      445.31  

    F    

   Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock (represented by depositary shares, each representing a 1/1,000th interest in a share of preferred stock and each having a dividend of $0.42969)      429.69  

    G    

   6.625% Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock (represented by depositary shares, each representing a 1/1,000th interest in a share of preferred stock and each having a dividend of $0.41406)      414.06  

    H    

   Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock (represented by depositary shares, each representing a 1/25th interest in a share of preferred stock and each having a dividend of $27.25000)1      681.25  

    I    

   Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock (represented by depositary shares, each representing a 1/1,000th interest in a share of preferred stock and each having a dividend of $0.39844)      398.44  

    J    

   Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock (represented by depositary shares, each representing a 1/25th interest in a share of preferred stock and each having a dividend of $27.75000)2      693.75  

 

1.

Dividend on Series H Preferred Stock is payable semiannually until July 15, 2019 and quarterly thereafter.

2.

Dividend on Series J Preferred Stock is payable semiannually until July 15, 2020 and quarterly thereafter.

 

Tangible Equity

 

               

Monthly Average Balance

Twelve Months Ended

 
$ in millions  

At December 31,

2016

   

At December 31,

2015

   

December 31,

2016

   

December 31,

2015

 

Common equity

  $ 68,530     $ 67,662     $ 68,870     $ 66,936  

Preferred equity

    7,520       7,520       7,520       7,174  

Morgan Stanley shareholders’ equity

    76,050       75,182       76,390       74,110  

Junior subordinated debentures issued to capital trusts

          2,870       1,753       3,640  

Less: Goodwill and net intangible assets

    (9,296     (9,564     (9,410     (9,661

Tangible Morgan Stanley shareholders’ equity1

  $         66,754     $ 68,488     $         68,733     $ 68,089  

Common equity

  $ 68,530     $ 67,662     $ 68,870     $ 66,936  

Less: Goodwill and net intangible assets

    (9,296     (9,564     (9,410     (9,661

Tangible common equity1

  $ 59,234     $ 58,098     $ 59,460     $ 57,275  

 

1.

Tangible Morgan Stanley shareholders’ equity and tangible common equity are non-GAAP financial measures that we and investors consider to be a useful measure to assess capital adequacy.

Regulatory Requirements

Regulatory Capital Framework

We are a financial holding company under the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended (the “BHC Act”), and are subject to the regulation and oversight of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (the “Federal Reserve”). The Federal Reserve establishes capital requirements for us, including well-capitalized standards, and evaluates our compliance with such capital requirements. The Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (“OCC”) establishes similar capital requirements and standards for our U.S. Bank Subsidiaries. The regulatory capital requirements are largely based on the Basel III capital standards established by the Basel Committee and also implement certain provisions of the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (the “Dodd-Frank Act”).

The Basel Committee has recently published revisions to certain standards in its capital framework, including with respect to counterparty credit risk exposures in derivatives transactions, market risk, interest rate risk in the banking book, and securitization capital standards, although these revisions have not yet been adopted by the U.S. banking agencies. In addition, the Basel Committee is actively considering other potential revisions to other capital standards that would substantially change the framework. The impact on us of any revisions to the Basel Committee’s capital standards could be substantial but is uncertain and depends on future rulemakings by the U.S. banking agencies.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   64  


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

Regulatory Capital Requirements

We are required to maintain minimum risk-based and leverage capital ratios under the regulatory capital requirements. A summary of the calculations of regulatory capital, risk-weighted assets (“RWAs”) and transition provisions follows.

Regulatory Capital. Minimum risk-based capital ratio requirements apply to Common Equity Tier 1 capital, Tier 1 capital and Total capital. Certain adjustments to and deductions from capital are required for purposes of determining these ratios, such as goodwill, intangibles, certain deferred tax assets, other amounts in Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) (“AOCI”) and investments in the capital instruments of unconsolidated financial institutions. Certain of these adjustments and deductions are also subject to transitional provisions.

In addition to the minimum risk-based capital ratio requirements, on a fully phased-in basis by 2019, we will be subject to:

 

 

A greater than 2.5% Common Equity Tier 1 capital conservation buffer;

 

 

The Common Equity Tier 1 global systemically important bank (“G-SIB”) capital surcharge, currently at 3%; and

 

 

Up to a 2.5% Common Equity Tier 1 countercyclical capital buffer (“CCyB”), currently set by banking regulators at zero (collectively, the “buffers”).

In 2017, the phase-in amount for each of the buffers is 50% of the fully phased-in buffer requirement. Failure to maintain the buffers would result in restrictions on our ability to make capital distributions, including the payment of dividends and the repurchase of stock, and to pay discretionary bonuses to

executive officers. For a further discussion of the G-SIB capital surcharge, see “G-SIB Capital Surcharge” herein.

Risk-Weighted Assets. RWAs reflect both our on- and off-balance sheet risk as well as capital charges attributable to the risk of loss arising from the following:

 

 

Credit risk: The failure of a borrower, counterparty or issuer to meet its financial obligations to us;

 

 

Market risk: Adverse changes in the level of one or more market prices, rates, indices, implied volatilities, correlations or other market factors, such as market liquidity; and

 

 

Operational risk: Inadequate or failed processes or systems, human factors or from external events (e.g., fraud, theft, legal and compliance risks, cyber attacks or damage to physical assets).

For a further discussion of our market, credit and operational risks, see “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk” in Item 7A.

Our binding risk-based capital ratios for regulatory purposes are the lower of the capital ratios computed under (i) the standardized approaches for calculating credit risk and market risk RWAs (the “Standardized Approach”) and (ii) the applicable advanced approaches for calculating credit risk, market risk and operational risk RWAs (the “Advanced Approach”). At December 31, 2016, our binding ratios are based on the Advanced Approach transitional rules.

The methods for calculating each of our risk-based capital ratios will change through January 1, 2022 as aspects of the capital rules are phased in. These changes may result in differences in our reported capital ratios from one reporting period to the next that are independent of changes to our capital base, asset composition, off-balance sheet exposures or risk profile.

 

 

  65   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

Minimum Risk-Based Capital Ratios: Transitional Provisions

 

 

LOGO

 

1.

These ratios assume the requirements for the G-SIB capital surcharge (3.0%) and CCyB (zero) remain at current levels. See “Total Loss-Absorbing Capacity, Long-Term Debt and Clean Holding Company Requirements” herein for additional capital requirements effective January 1, 2019.

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   66  


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

Transitional and Fully Phased-In Regulatory Capital Ratios

 

    At December 31, 2016  
    Transitional     Pro Forma Fully Phased-In  
$ in millions   Standardized     Advanced     Standardized         Advanced      

Risk-based capital

       

Common Equity Tier 1 capital

  $ 60,398     $ 60,398     $ 58,616     $ 58,616  

Tier 1 capital

    68,097       68,097       66,315       66,315  

Total capital

    78,917       78,642       77,155       76,881  

Total RWAs

    340,191       358,141       351,101       369,709  

Common Equity Tier 1 capital ratio

    17.8     16.9     16.7     15.9

Tier 1 capital ratio

    20.0     19.0     18.9     17.9

Total capital ratio

    23.2     22.0     22.0     20.8

Leverage-based capital

       

Adjusted average assets1

  $ 811,402       N/A     $ 810,288       N/A  

Tier 1 leverage ratio2

    8.4     N/A       8.2     N/A  

 

    At December 31, 2015  
    Transitional     Pro Forma Fully Phased-In  
$ in millions   Standardized     Advanced     Standardized         Advanced      

Risk-based capital

       

Common Equity Tier 1 capital

  $ 59,409     $ 59,409     $ 55,441     $ 55,441  

Tier 1 capital

    66,722       66,722       63,000       63,000  

Total capital

    79,663       79,403       73,858       73,598  

Total RWAs

    362,920       384,162       373,421       395,277  

Common Equity Tier 1 capital ratio

    16.4     15.5     14.8     14.0

Tier 1 capital ratio

    18.4     17.4     16.9     15.9

Total capital ratio

    22.0     20.7     19.8     18.6

Leverage-based capital

       

Adjusted average assets1

  $ 803,574       N/A     $ 801,346       N/A  

Tier 1 leverage ratio2

    8.3     N/A       7.9     N/A  

N/A—Not Applicable

1.

Adjusted average assets represent the denominator of the Tier 1 leverage ratio and are composed of the average daily balance of consolidated on-balance sheet assets under U.S. GAAP during the calendar quarter ended December 31, 2016 and 2015 adjusted for disallowed goodwill, transitional intangible assets, certain deferred tax assets, certain investments in the capital instruments of unconsolidated financial institutions and other adjustments.

2.

The minimum Tier 1 leverage ratio requirement is 4.0%.

The fully phased-in pro forma estimates in the previous tables are based on our current understanding of the capital rules and other factors, which may be subject to change as we receive additional clarification and implementation guidance from the Federal Reserve and as the interpretation of the regulations evolves over time. These fully phased-in pro forma estimates are non-GAAP financial measures that we consider to be useful measures for us, investors and analysts in evaluating compliance with new regulatory capital requirements that were not yet effective at December 31, 2016. These preliminary estimates are subject to risks and uncertainties that may cause actual results to differ materially and should not be taken as a projection of what our capital, capital ratios, RWAs, earnings or other results will actually be at future dates. For a discussion of risks and uncertainties that may affect our future results, see “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A.

Well-Capitalized Minimum Regulatory Capital Ratios for U.S. Bank Subsidiaries

 

      At December 31, 2016  

Common Equity Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio

     6.5%  

Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio

     8.0%  

Total risk-based capital ratio

     10.0%  

Tier 1 leverage ratio

     5.0%  

For us to remain a financial holding company, our U.S. Bank Subsidiaries must qualify as well-capitalized by maintaining the minimum ratio requirements set forth in the previous table. The Federal Reserve has not yet revised the well-capitalized standard for financial holding companies to reflect the higher capital standards required for us under the capital rules. Assuming that the Federal Reserve would apply the same or very similar well-capitalized standards to financial holding companies, each of our risk-based capital ratios and Tier 1 leverage ratio at December 31, 2016 would have exceeded the revised well-capitalized standard. The Federal Reserve may require us to maintain risk- and leverage-based capital ratios substantially in excess of mandated minimum levels, depending upon general economic conditions and a financial holding company’s particular condition, risk profile and growth plans.

 

 

  67   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

Regulatory Capital Calculated under Advanced Approach Transitional Rules

 

$ in millions   

At

December 31,
2016

   

At

December 31,

2015

 

Common Equity Tier 1 capital

    

Common stock and surplus

   $               17,494     $               20,114  

Retained earnings

     53,679       49,204  

AOCI

     (2,643     (1,656

Regulatory adjustments and deductions:

    

Net goodwill

     (6,526     (6,582

Net intangible assets (other than goodwill and mortgage servicing assets)

     (1,631     (1,192

Credit spread premium over risk-free rate for derivative liabilities

     (271     (202

Net deferred tax assets

     (304     (675

Net after-tax DVA1

     357       156  

Adjustments related to AOCI

     422       411  

Other adjustments and deductions

     (179     (169

Total Common Equity Tier 1 capital

   $ 60,398     $ 59,409  

Additional Tier 1 capital

    

Preferred stock

   $ 7,520     $ 7,520  

Trust preferred securities

           702  

Noncontrolling interests

     613       678  

Regulatory adjustments and deductions:

                

Net deferred tax assets

     (202     (1,012

Credit spread premium over risk-free rate for derivative liabilities

     (181     (303

Net after-tax DVA1

     238       233  

Other adjustments and deductions

     (101     (253

Additional Tier 1 capital

   $ 7,887     $ 7,565  

Deduction for investments in covered funds

     (188     (252

Total Tier 1 capital

   $ 68,097     $ 66,722  

Tier 2 capital

    

Subordinated debt

   $ 10,303     $ 10,404  

Trust preferred securities

           2,106  

Other qualifying amounts

     62       35  

Regulatory adjustments and deductions

     180       136  

Total Tier 2 capital

   $ 10,545     $ 12,681  

Total capital

   $ 78,642     $ 79,403  

Rollforward of Regulatory Capital Calculated under Advanced Approach Transitional Rules

 

$ in millions   2016  

Common Equity Tier 1 capital

 

Common Equity Tier 1 capital at December 31, 2015

  $                 59,409  

Change related to the following items:

 

Value of shareholders’ common equity

    868  

Net goodwill

    56  

Net intangible assets (other than goodwill and mortgage servicing assets)

    (439

Credit spread premium over risk-free rate for derivative liabilities

    (69

Net deferred tax assets

    371  

Net after-tax DVA1

    201  

Adjustments related to AOCI

    11  

Other deductions and adjustments

    (10

Common Equity Tier 1 capital at December 31, 2016

  $ 60,398  

Additional Tier 1 capital

 

Additional Tier 1 capital at December 31, 2015

  $ 7,565  

Change related to the following items:

 

Trust preferred securities

    (702

Noncontrolling interests

    (65

Net deferred tax assets

    810  

Credit spread premium over risk-free rate for derivative liabilities

    122  

Net after-tax DVA1

    5  

Other adjustments and deductions

    152  

Additional Tier 1 capital at December 31, 2016

    7,887  

Deduction for investments in covered funds at December 31, 2015

    (252

Deduction for investments in covered funds

    64  

Deduction for investments in covered funds at December 31, 2016

    (188

Tier 1 capital at December 31, 2016

  $ 68,097  

Tier 2 capital

 

Tier 2 capital at December 31, 2015

  $ 12,681  

Change related to the following items:

 

Subordinated debt

    (101

Trust preferred securities

    (2,106

Noncontrolling interests

    27  

Other adjustments and deductions

    44  

Tier 2 capital at December 31, 2016

  $ 10,545  

Total capital at December 31, 2016

  $ 78,642  

 

1.

In connection with the early adoption of a provision of the accounting update Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities, related to DVA, the aggregate balance of net after-tax valuation adjustments was reduced by $77 million as of January 1, 2016.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   68  


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

Rollforward of RWAs Calculated under Advanced Approach Transitional Rules

 

$ in millions    20161  

Credit risk RWAs

  

Balance at December 31, 2015

   $                 173,586  

Change related to the following items:

  

Derivatives

     (446

Securities financing transactions

     745  

Other counterparty credit risk

     45  

Securitizations

     (1,997

Credit valuation adjustment

     1,023  

Investment securities

     1,183  

Loans

     (1,792

Cash

     757  

Equity investments

     (2,908

Other credit risk2

     (965

Total change in credit risk RWAs

   $ (4,355

Balance at December 31, 2016

   $ 169,231  

Market risk RWAs

  

Balance at December 31, 2015

   $ 71,476  

Change related to the following items:

  

Regulatory VaR

     (2,094

Regulatory stressed VaR

     (1,286

Incremental risk charge

     292  

Comprehensive risk measure

     (2,763

Specific risk:

        

Non-securitizations

     (654

Securitizations

     (4,099

Total change in market risk RWAs

   $ (10,604

Balance at December 31, 2016

   $ 60,872  

Operational risk RWAs

  

Balance at December 31, 2015

   $ 139,100  

Change in operational risk RWAs3

     (11,062

Balance at December 31, 2016

   $ 128,038  

Total RWAs

   $ 358,141  

VaR—Value-at-Risk

1.

The RWAs for each category in the table reflect both on- and off-balance sheet exposures, where appropriate.

2.

Amount reflects assets not in a defined category, non-material portfolios of exposures and unsettled transactions.

3.

Amount reflects a reduction in the internal loss data related to litigation utilized in the operational risk capital model.

Supplementary Leverage Ratio

We and our U.S. Bank Subsidiaries are required to publicly disclose our supplementary leverage ratios, which will become effective as a capital standard on January 1, 2018. By January 1, 2018, we must also maintain a Tier 1 supplementary leverage capital buffer of at least 2% in addition to the 3% minimum supplementary leverage ratio (for a total of at least 5%), in order to avoid limitations on capital distributions, including dividends and stock repurchases, and discretionary bonus payments to executive officers. In addition,

beginning in 2018, our U.S. Bank Subsidiaries must maintain a supplementary leverage ratio of 6% to be considered well-capitalized.

Pro Forma Supplementary Leverage Exposure and Ratio on a Transitional Basis

 

$ in millions   

At December 31,

2016

    

At December 31,

2015

 

Average total assets1

   $ 820,536      $ 813,715  

Adjustments2, 3

     242,113        284,090  

Pro forma supplementary leverage exposure

   $ 1,062,649      $ 1,097,805  

Pro forma supplementary leverage ratio

     6.4%        6.1%  

 

1.

Computed as the average daily balance of consolidated total assets under U.S. GAAP during the calendar quarter ended December 31, 2016 and 2015.

2.

Computed as the arithmetic mean of the month-end balances over the calendar quarter ended December 31, 2016 and 2015.

3.

Adjustments are to: (i) incorporate derivative exposures, including adding the related potential future exposure (including for derivatives cleared for clients), grossing up cash collateral netting where qualifying criteria are not met and adding the effective notional principal amount of sold credit protection offset by qualifying purchased credit protection; (ii) reflect the counterparty credit risk for repo-style transactions; (iii) add the credit equivalent amount for off-balance sheet exposures; and (iv) apply other adjustments to Tier 1 capital, including disallowed goodwill, transitional intangible assets, certain deferred tax assets and certain investments in the capital instruments of unconsolidated financial institutions.

Based on our current understanding of the rules and other factors, we estimate our pro forma fully phased-in supplementary leverage ratio to be approximately 6.2% at December 31, 2016 and 5.8% at December 31, 2015. These estimates utilize a fully phased-in Tier 1 capital numerator and a fully phased-in denominator of approximately $1,061.5 billion at December 31, 2016 and $1,095.6 billion at December 31, 2015, which takes into consideration the Tier 1 capital deductions that would be applicable in 2018 after the phase-in period has ended.

U.S. Subsidiary Banks’ Pro Forma Supplementary Leverage Ratios on a Transitional Basis

 

      At December 31, 2016     At December 31, 2015  

MSBNA

     7.7     7.3%  

MSPBNA

     10.2     10.3%  

The pro forma supplementary leverage exposures and pro forma supplementary leverage ratios, both on transitional and fully phased-in bases, are non-GAAP financial measures that we consider to be useful measures for us, investors and analysts in evaluating prospective compliance with new regulatory capital requirements that have not yet become effective. Our estimates are subject to risks and uncertainties that may cause actual results to differ materially from estimates based on these regulations. Further, these expectations should not be taken as projections of what our supplementary leverage ratios, earnings, assets or exposures will actually be at future dates. For a discussion of risks and uncertainties that may affect our future results, see “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A.

 

 

  69   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

G-SIB Capital Surcharge

We and other U.S. G-SIBs are subject to a risk-based capital surcharge. A G-SIB must calculate its G-SIB capital surcharge under two methods and use the higher of the two surcharges. The first method considers the G-SIB’s size, interconnectedness, cross-jurisdictional activity, substitutability and complexity, which is generally consistent with the methodology developed by the Basel Committee (“Method 1”). The second method uses similar inputs, but replaces substitutability with the use of short-term wholesale funding (“Method 2”) and generally results in higher surcharges than the first method. The G-SIB capital surcharge must be satisfied using Common Equity Tier 1 capital and functions as an extension of the capital conservation buffer. Our current G-SIB surcharge is 3%. The surcharge is being phased in between January 1, 2016 and January 1, 2019, and the phase-in amount for 2017 is 50% of the applicable surcharge (see “Minimum Risk-Based Capital Ratios: Transitional Provisions” herein).

Total Loss-Absorbing Capacity, Long-Term Debt and Clean Holding Company Requirements

On December 15, 2016, the Federal Reserve adopted a final rule for top-tier bank holding companies of U.S. G-SIBs (“covered BHCs”), including the Parent Company, that establishes external TLAC, long-term debt (“LTD”) and clean holding company requirements. The final rule contains various definitions and restrictions, such as requiring eligible LTD to be issued by the covered BHC and be unsecured, have a maturity of one year or more from the date of issuance and not have certain derivative-linked features, typically associated with certain types of structured notes. Covered BHCs must comply with all requirements under the rule by January 1, 2019, which we expect to accomplish.

The main purpose of the Federal Reserve’s minimum external TLAC and LTD requirements is to ensure that covered BHCs, including the Parent Company, will have enough loss-absorbing resources at the point of failure to be recapitalized through the conversion of eligible LTD to equity or otherwise by imposing losses on eligible LTD or other forms of TLAC where a single point of entry (“SPOE”) resolution strategy is used (see “Business—Supervision and Regulation—Financial Holding Company—Resolution and Recovery Planning” in Part I, Item 1 and “Risk Factors—Legal, Regulatory and Compliance Risk” in Part I, Item 1A).

Under the final rule, a covered BHC is required to maintain minimum external TLAC equal to the greater of 18% of total RWAs and 7.5% of its total leverage exposure (the denominator of its supplementary leverage ratio). In addition, covered BHCs must meet a separate external LTD requirement equal to the greater of 6% of total RWAs plus the

greater of the Method 1 and Method 2 G-SIB capital surcharge applicable to the Parent Company and 4.5% of its total leverage exposure.

In addition, the final rule imposes TLAC buffer requirements on top of both the risk-based and leverage-exposure-based external TLAC minimum requirements. The risk-based TLAC buffer is equal to the sum of 2.5%, the covered BHC’s Method 1 G-SIB surcharge and the countercyclical capital buffer, if any, as a percentage of total RWAs. The leverage-exposure-based TLAC buffer is equal to 2% of the covered BHC’s total leverage exposure. Failure to maintain the TLAC buffers would result in restrictions on capital distributions and discretionary bonus payments to executive officers.

The final rule provides permanent grandfathering for debt instruments issued prior to December 31, 2016 that would be eligible LTD but for having impermissible acceleration clauses or being governed by foreign law.

Furthermore, under the clean holding company requirements of the final rule, a covered BHC is prohibited from incurring any external short-term debt or certain other liabilities, regardless of whether the liabilities are fully secured or otherwise senior to eligible LTD, or entering into certain other prohibited transactions. Certain other external liabilities, including structured notes, are subject to a cap equal to 5% of the covered BHC’s outstanding external TLAC amount.

Capital Plans and Stress Tests

Pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act, the Federal Reserve has adopted capital planning and stress test requirements for large bank holding companies, including us, which form part of the Federal Reserve’s annual Comprehensive Capital Analysis and Review (“CCAR”) framework.

We must submit an annual capital plan to the Federal Reserve, taking into account the results of separate stress tests designed by us and the Federal Reserve, so that the Federal Reserve may assess our systems and processes that incorporate forward-looking projections of revenues and losses to monitor and maintain our internal capital adequacy.

The capital plan must include a description of all planned capital actions over a nine-quarter planning horizon, including any issuance of a debt or equity capital instrument, any capital distribution (i.e., payments of dividends or stock repurchases) and any similar action that the Federal Reserve determines could impact our consolidated capital. The capital plan must include a discussion of how we will maintain capital above the minimum regulatory capital ratios, including the requirements that are phased in over the planning horizon, and serve as a source of strength to our U.S. Bank Subsidiaries under supervisory stress scenarios. In

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   70  


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

addition, the Federal Reserve has issued guidance setting out its heightened expectations for capital planning practices at certain large financial institutions, including us.

In November 2015, the Federal Reserve amended its capital plan and stress test rules to delay until 2017 the use of the supplementary leverage ratio requirement, defer indefinitely the use of the Advanced Approach risk-based capital framework in capital planning and company-run stress tests, and incorporate the Tier 1 capital deductions for certain investments in Volcker Rule covered funds into the pro forma minimum capital requirements for capital plan and stress testing purposes.

The capital plan rule requires that large bank holding companies receive no objection from the Federal Reserve before making a capital distribution. In addition, even with an approved capital plan, the bank holding company must seek the approval of the Federal Reserve before making a capital distribution if, among other reasons, the bank holding company would not meet its regulatory capital requirements after making the proposed capital distribution. A bank holding company’s ability to make capital distributions (other than scheduled payments on Additional Tier 1 and Tier 2 capital instruments) is also limited if its net capital issuances are less than the amount indicated in its capital plan.

In addition, we must conduct semiannual company-run stress tests and are subject to an annual Dodd-Frank Act supervisory stress test conducted by the Federal Reserve.

On April 5, 2016, we submitted our 2016 CCAR capital plan, and summary results of the CCAR and Dodd-Frank Act supervisory stress tests were published by the Federal Reserve in June. We exceeded all stressed capital ratio minimum requirements in the Federal Reserve severely adverse scenario, and our quantitative capital results improved from our prior-year submission. In June 2016, we received a conditional non-objection from the Federal Reserve to our 2016 capital plan (see “Capital Management” herein). On December 29, 2016, we resubmitted our capital plan, as required by the Federal Reserve, to address weaknesses identified in our capital planning process.

Future capital distributions may be restricted if these identified weaknesses are not satisfactorily addressed when the Federal Reserve reviews our resubmitted capital plan. Pursuant to the conditional non-objection, we are able to execute the capital actions set forth in our 2016 capital plan, which included increasing our common stock dividend to $0.20 per share beginning in the third quarter of 2016 and executing share repurchases of $3.5 billion during the period July 1, 2016 through June 30, 2017. In addition, we submitted the results of our mid-cycle company-run stress test to the

Federal Reserve on October 5, 2016, and we disclosed a summary of the results on October 31, 2016.

For the 2017 capital planning and stress test cycle, we are required to submit our capital plan and company-run stress test results to the Federal Reserve by April 5, 2017. We expect that the Federal Reserve will provide its response to our 2017 capital plan by June 30, 2017. The Federal Reserve is expected to publish summary results of the CCAR and Dodd-Frank Act supervisory stress tests of each large bank holding company, including us, by June 30, 2017. We are required to disclose a summary of the results of our company-run stress tests within 15 days of the date the Federal Reserve discloses the results of the supervisory stress tests. In addition, we must submit the results of our mid-cycle company-run stress test to the Federal Reserve by October 5, 2017 and disclose a summary of the results between October 5, 2017 and November 4, 2017.

In January 2017, the Federal Reserve adopted revisions to the capital plan and stress test rules that, among other things, reduce the de minimis threshold for additional capital distributions that a firm may make during a capital plan cycle without seeking the Federal Reserve’s prior approval. The final rule also establishes a “blackout period” beginning in March of each year while the Federal Reserve is conducting CCAR reviews during which firms are not permitted to submit de minimis exception notices or prior approval requests for additional capital distributions. The Federal Reserve is currently considering making further changes to CCAR requirements, which may increase minimum capital requirements for the Firm.

The Dodd-Frank Act also requires each of our U.S. Bank Subsidiaries to conduct an annual stress test. MSBNA and MSPBNA submitted their 2016 annual company-run stress tests to the OCC on April 5, 2016 and published a summary of their stress test results on June 23, 2016. For the 2017 stress test cycle, MSBNA and MSPBNA must submit their 2017 annual company-run stress tests to the OCC by April 5, 2017 and publish the summary results between June 15, 2017 and July 15, 2017.

Attribution of Average Common Equity According to the Required Capital Framework

Our required capital (“Required Capital”) estimation is based on the Required Capital framework, an internal capital adequacy measure. Common equity attribution to the business segments is based on capital usage calculated by the Required Capital framework, as well as each business segment’s relative contribution to our total Required Capital. Required Capital is assessed for each business segment and further attributed to product lines. This process is intended to align capital with the

 

 

  71   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

risks in each business segment in order to allow senior management to evaluate returns on a risk-adjusted basis.

The Required Capital framework is a risk-based and leverage use-of-capital measure, which is compared with our regulatory capital to ensure that we maintain an amount of going concern capital after absorbing potential losses from stress events, where applicable, at a point in time. We define the difference between our total average common equity and the sum of the average common equity amounts allocated to our business segments as Parent Company equity. We generally hold Parent Company equity for prospective regulatory requirements, organic growth, acquisitions and other capital needs.

Effective January 1, 2016, the common equity estimation and attribution to the business segments are based on our pro forma fully phased-in regulatory capital, including supplementary leverage and stress losses (which results in more capital being attributed to the business segments), whereas prior periods were attributed based on transitional regulatory capital provisions. Also, beginning in 2016, the amount of capital allocated to the business segments will be set at the beginning of each year and will remain fixed throughout the year until the next annual reset. Differences between available and Required Capital will be attributed to Parent Company equity during the year. Periods prior to 2016 have not been recast under this new methodology.

The Required Capital framework is expected to evolve over time in response to changes in the business and regulatory environment, for example, to incorporate stress testing or enhancements in modeling techniques. We will continue to evaluate the framework with respect to the impact of future regulatory requirements, as appropriate.

Average Common Equity Attribution

 

$ in billions    2016      20151      20141  

Institutional Securities

   $     43.2      $     34.6      $     32.2  

Wealth Management

     15.3        11.2        11.2  

Investment Management

     2.8        2.2        2.9  

Parent Company

     7.6        18.9        19.0  

Total1

   $ 68.9      $ 66.9      $ 65.3  

 

1.

Amounts are calculated on a monthly basis. Average common equity is a non-GAAP financial measure that we consider to be a useful measure for us, investors and analysts to assess capital adequacy.

Regulatory Developments

Resolution and Recovery Planning

Pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act, we are required to submit to the Federal Reserve and the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (“FDIC”) an annual resolution plan that

describes our strategy for a rapid and orderly resolution under the U.S. Bankruptcy Code in the event of our material financial distress or failure.

Our preferred resolution strategy, which is set out in our 2015 resolution plan, is an SPOE strategy. On September 30, 2016, we submitted a status report to the Federal Reserve and the FDIC in respect of certain shortcomings identified in our 2015 resolution plan. Pursuant to the status report, we indicated that the Parent Company will amend and restate its support agreement with its material subsidiaries that is designed to ensure that such subsidiaries have sufficient capital and liquidity as and when needed throughout a resolution scenario.

Under the amended and restated support agreement, upon the occurrence of a resolution scenario, the Parent Company will be obligated to contribute or loan on a subordinated basis all of its material assets, other than shares in subsidiaries of the Parent Company and certain intercompany receivables, to provide capital and liquidity, as applicable, to our material subsidiaries.

The obligations of the Parent Company under the amended and restated support agreement will be secured on a senior basis by the assets of the Parent Company (other than shares in subsidiaries of the Parent Company). As a result, claims of our material subsidiaries against the assets of the Parent Company (other than shares in subsidiaries of the Parent Company) will be effectively senior to unsecured obligations of the Parent Company.

Our next full resolution plan submission will be on July 1, 2017. If the Federal Reserve and the FDIC were to jointly determine that our 2017 resolution plan is not credible or would not facilitate an orderly resolution, and if we were unable to address any deficiencies identified by the regulators, we or any of our subsidiaries may be subject to more stringent capital, leverage, or liquidity requirements or restrictions on our growth, activities or operations, or, after a two-year period, we may be required to divest assets or operations.

In September 2016, the OCC issued final guidelines that establish enforceable standards for recovery planning by national banks and certain other institutions with total consolidated assets of $50 billion or more, calculated on a rolling four-quarter average basis, including MSBNA. The guidelines were effective on January 1, 2017, and MSBNA must be in compliance by January 1, 2018.

In May 2016, the Federal Reserve proposed a rule that would impose contractual requirements on certain “qualified financial contracts” (“covered QFCs”) to which U.S. G-SIBs,

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   72  


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

including us, and their subsidiaries are parties. In August 2016, the OCC proposed a rule that would subject national banks that are subsidiaries of U.S. G-SIBs, including our U.S. Bank Subsidiaries, as well as certain other institutions (collectively with U.S. G-SIBs and their other subsidiaries, “covered entities”), to substantively identical requirements.

Under the proposals, covered QFCs must expressly provide that transfer restrictions and default rights against a covered entity are limited to the same extent as provided under the Federal Deposit Insurance Act and Title II of the Dodd-Frank Act and their implementing regulations. In addition, covered QFCs may not permit the exercise of cross-default rights against a covered entity based on an affiliate’s entry into insolvency, resolution or similar proceedings. If adopted as proposed, the requirements would take effect at the start of the first calendar quarter that begins at least one year after the final rules are issued. We continue to evaluate the potential impact of the proposals, which are subject to public comment and further rulemaking procedures.

For more information about resolution and recovery planning requirements and our activities in these areas, see “Business—Supervision and Regulation—Financial Holding Company—Resolution and Recovery Planning” in Part I, Item 1.

Legacy Covered Funds under the Volcker Rule

The Volcker Rule prohibits “banking entities,” including us and our affiliates, from engaging in certain “proprietary trading” activities, as defined in the Volcker Rule, subject to exemptions for underwriting, market-making-related activities, risk-mitigating hedging and certain other activities. The Volcker Rule also prohibits certain investments and relationships by banking entities with “covered funds,” with a number of exemptions and exclusions.

Banking entities were required to bring all of their activities and investments into conformance with the Volcker Rule by July 21, 2015, subject to certain extensions. The Federal Reserve has extended the conformance period until July 21, 2017 for investments in, and relationships with, covered funds that were in place before December 31, 2013, referred to as “legacy covered funds.” The Volcker Rule also permits the Federal Reserve to provide an additional transition period of up to five years for banking entities to conform investments in certain legacy covered funds that are also illiquid funds.

On December 12, 2016, the Federal Reserve issued a policy statement with information about how banking entities may seek this further statutory extension. Additionally, the Federal Reserve stated that it expects the illiquid funds of banking entities to generally qualify for extensions, although they may not be granted if the banking entity has not demonstrated meaningful progress to conform or divest its illiquid funds, or has a deficient compliance program under the Volcker Rule, or if the Federal Reserve has concerns about evasion. We submitted our application for illiquid funds extension in January 2017, covering essentially all of our approximately $1.9 billion of non-conforming investments in, and relationships with, legacy covered funds subject to the Volcker Rule.

Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements and Contractual Obligations

Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

We enter into various off-balance sheet arrangements, including through unconsolidated special purpose entities (“SPEs”) and lending-related financial instruments (e.g., guarantees and commitments), primarily in connection with the Institutional Securities and Investment Management business segments.

We utilize SPEs primarily in connection with securitization activities. For information on our securitization activities, see Note 13 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8.

For information on our commitments, obligations under certain guarantee arrangements and indemnities, see Note 12 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8. For further information on our lending commitments, see “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk—Risk Management—Credit Risk—Lending Activities” in Item 7A.

Contractual Obligations

In the normal course of business, we enter into various contractual obligations that may require future cash payments. Contractual obligations include long-term borrowings, other secured financings, contractual interest payments, contractual payments on time deposits, operating leases and purchase obligations.

 

 

  73   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Management’s Discussion and Analysis   LOGO

 

    At December 31, 2016  
    Payments Due in:  
$ in millions   2017     2018-2019     2020-2021     Thereafter     Total  

Long-term borrowings1

  $ 26,127     $ 41,689     $ 33,915     $ 63,044     $ 164,775  

Other secured financings1

    3,377       5,551       270       206       9,404  

Contractual interest payments2

    4,654       7,263       4,954       13,794       30,665  

Time deposits3

    1,210       43       8       50       1,311  

Operating leases— premises4

    649       1,176       949       2,958       5,732  

Purchase obligations5

    438       485       167       208       1,298  

Total6

  $     36,455     $ 56,207     $ 40,263     $ 80,260     $     213,185  

 

1.

For further information on long-term borrowings and other secured financings, see Note 11 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8. Amounts presented for Other secured financings are financings with original maturities greater than one year.

2.

Amounts represent estimated future contractual interest payments related to unsecured long-term borrowings based on applicable interest rates at December 31, 2016.

3.

Amounts represent contractual principal and interest payments related to time deposits primarily held at our U.S. Bank Subsidiaries.

4.

For further information on operating leases covering premises and equipment, see Note 12 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8.

5.

Purchase obligations for goods and services include payments for, among other things, consulting, outsourcing, computer and telecommunications maintenance agreements, and certain transmission, transportation and storage contracts related to the commodities business. Purchase obligations at December 31, 2016 reflect the minimum contractual obligation under legally enforceable contracts with contract terms that are both fixed and determinable. These amounts exclude obligations for goods and services that already have been incurred and are reflected on the consolidated balance sheets.

6.

Amounts exclude unrecognized tax benefits, as the timing and amount of future cash payments are not determinable at this time (see Note 20 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 for further information).

 

Effects of Inflation and Changes in Interest and Foreign Exchange Rates

To the extent that an increased inflation outlook results in rising interest rates or has negative impacts on the valuation of financial instruments that exceed the impact on the value of our liabilities, it may adversely affect our financial position and profitability. Rising inflation may also result in increases in our non-interest expenses that may not be readily recoverable in higher prices of services offered. Other changes in the interest rate environment and related volatility as well as expectations about the level of future interest rates could also impact our results of operations.

A significant portion of our business is conducted in currencies other than the U.S. dollar, and changes in foreign exchange rates relative to the U.S. dollar, therefore, can affect the value of non-U.S. dollar net assets, revenues and expenses. Potential exposures as a result of these fluctuations in currencies are closely monitored, and, where cost-justified, strategies are adopted that are designed to reduce the impact of these fluctuations on our financial performance. These strategies may include the financing of non-U.S. dollar assets with direct or swap-based borrowings in the same currency and the use of currency forward contracts or the spot market in various hedging transactions related to net assets, revenues, expenses or cash flows. For information about cumulative foreign currency translation adjustments, see Note 15 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   74  


Table of Contents

LOGO

Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk

 

Risk Management

Overview

Management believes effective risk management is vital to the success of our business activities. Accordingly, we have established an enterprise risk management (“ERM”) framework to integrate the diverse roles of risk management into a holistic enterprise structure and to facilitate the incorporation of risk assessment into decision-making processes across the Firm. Risk is an inherent part of our businesses and activities. We have policies and procedures in place to identify, measure, monitor, advise, challenge and control the principal risks involved in the activities of the Institutional Securities, Wealth Management and Investment Management business segments, as well as at the Parent Company level. The principal risks involved in our business activities include market (including non-trading interest rate risk), credit, operational, liquidity, model, compliance, strategic and reputational risk. Strategic risk is integrated into our business planning, embedded in the evaluation of all principal risks and overseen by our Board of Directors (the “Board”).

The cornerstone of our risk management philosophy is the pursuit of risk-adjusted returns through prudent risk taking that protects our capital base and franchise. This philosophy is implemented through the ERM framework. Five key principles underlie this philosophy: integrity, comprehensiveness, independence, accountability and transparency. To help ensure the efficacy of risk management, which is an essential component of our reputation, senior management requires thorough and frequent communication and the appropriate escalation of risk matters. The fast-paced, complex and constantly evolving nature of global financial markets

requires us to maintain a risk management culture that is incisive, knowledgeable about specialized products and markets, and subject to ongoing review and enhancement.

Our risk appetite defines the types of risk that the Firm is willing to accept in pursuit of our strategic objectives and business plan, taking into account the interest of clients and fiduciary duties to shareholders, as well as capital and other regulatory requirements. This risk appetite is embedded in our risk culture and linked to our short-term and long-term strategic, capital and financial plans, as well as compensation programs. This risk appetite and the related Board-level risk limits and risk tolerance statements are reviewed and approved by the Risk Committee of the Board (“BRC”), and the Board on, at least, an annual basis.

Risk Governance Structure

Risk management at the Firm requires independent Firm-level oversight, accountability of our business divisions, and effective communication of risk matters across the Firm, to senior management and ultimately to the Board. Our risk governance structure is composed of the Board; the BRC, the Audit Committee of the Board (“BAC”), and the Operations and Technology Committee of the Board (“BOTC”); the Firm Risk Committee (“FRC”); the functional risk and control committees; senior management oversight (including the Chief Executive Officer, Chief Risk Officer, Chief Financial Officer, Chief Legal Officer and Chief Compliance Officer); the Internal Audit Department and risk managers, committees, and groups within and across the business segments and operating legal entities. The ERM framework, composed of independent but complementary entities, facilitates efficient and comprehensive supervision of our risk exposures and processes.

 

 

  75   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Risk Disclosures   LOGO

 

LOGO

 

1.

Committees include Securities Risk Committee, Wealth Management Risk Committee and Investment Management Risk Committee

2.

Committees include Capital Commitment Committee, Global Large Loan Committee, Equity Underwriting Committee, Leveraged Finance Underwriting Committee, Municipal Capital Commitment Committee

 

Morgan Stanley Board of Directors.    The Board has oversight for the ERM framework and is responsible for helping to ensure that our risks are managed in a sound manner. The Board has authorized the committees within the ERM framework to help facilitate our risk oversight responsibilities. As set forth in our Corporate Governance Policies, the Board also oversees, and receives reports on, our financial performance, strategy and business plans as well as our practices and procedures relating to culture, values and conduct.

Risk Committee of the Board.    The BRC is composed of non-management directors. The BRC oversees our global ERM framework; oversees the major risk exposures of the Firm, including market, credit, operational, model, liquidity, and reputational risk, against established risk measurement methodologies and the steps management has taken to monitor and control such exposures; oversees our risk appetite statement, including risk limits and tolerances; reviews capital, liquidity and funding strategy and related guidelines and policies; reviews the contingency funding plan and internal capital adequacy assessment process and capital plan; oversees our significant risk management and risk assessment guidelines and policies; oversees the performance of the Chief Risk Officer; reviews reports from our Strategic Transactions Committee, Comprehensive Capital Analysis and Review (“CCAR”) Committee, and Resolution and Recovery Planning (“RRP”) Committee; reviews significant reputational risk, franchise risk, new product risk, emerging risks and regulatory matters; and reviews results of Internal Audit reviews and assessment of the risk management, liquidity and capital functions. The BRC reports to the entire Board on a regular basis, coordinates with other Board committees with

respect to oversight of risk management and risk assessment guidelines and the entire Board attends quarterly meetings with the BRC.

Audit Committee of the Board.    The BAC is composed of independent directors. The BAC oversees the integrity of our consolidated financial statements, compliance with legal and regulatory requirements and system of internal controls; oversees risk management and risk assessment guidelines in coordination with the Board, BRC and BOTC and reviews the major legal and compliance risk exposures of the Firm and the steps management has taken to monitor and control such exposures; selects, determines the fees, evaluates and when appropriate, replaces the independent auditor; oversees the qualifications, independence and performance of our independent auditor, and pre-approves audit and permitted non-audit services; oversees the performance of our Global Audit Director; and after review, recommends to the Board the acceptance and inclusion of the annual audited consolidated financial statements in the Firm’s Annual Report on Form 10-K. The BAC reports to the entire Board on a regular basis.

Operations and Technology Committee of the Board.    The BOTC is composed of non-management directors. The BOTC oversees our operations and technology strategy, including trends that may affect such strategy; reviews operations and technology budget and significant expenditures and investments in support of such strategy; reviews operations and technology metrics; oversees risk management and risk assessment guidelines and policies regarding operations and technology risk; reviews the major operations and technology

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   76  


Table of Contents
Risk Disclosures   LOGO

 

risk exposures of the Firm, including information security and cybersecurity risks, and the steps management has taken to monitor and control such exposures; and oversees our business continuity planning. The BOTC reports to the entire Board on a regular basis.

Firm Risk Committee.    The Board has also authorized the FRC, a management committee appointed and chaired by the Chief Executive Officer, which includes the most senior officers of the Firm, including the Chief Risk Officer, Chief Legal Officer and Chief Financial Officer, to oversee the global ERM framework. The FRC’s responsibilities include oversight of our risk management principles, procedures and limits and the monitoring of capital levels and material market, credit, operational, model, liquidity, legal, compliance and reputational risk matters, and other risks, as appropriate, and the steps management has taken to monitor and manage such risks. The FRC also establishes and communicates risk tolerance, including aggregate Firm limits and tolerance, as appropriate. The Governance Process Review Subcommittee of the FRC oversees governance and process issues on behalf of the FRC. The FRC reports to the entire Board, the BAC, the BOTC and the BRC through the Chief Risk Officer, Chief Financial Officer and Chief Legal Officer.

Functional Risk and Control Committees.    Functional risk and control committees comprising the ERM framework, including the Firm Credit Risk Committee, the Operational Risk Oversight Committee, the Asset/Liability Management Committee, the Global Compliance Committee, the Technology Governance Committee and the Firm Franchise Committee, facilitate efficient and comprehensive supervision of our risk exposures and processes. The Strategic Transactions Committee reviews large strategic transactions and principal investments for the Firm; the CCAR Committee and oversee our Comprehensive Capital Analysis and Review and Dodd-Frank Act Stress Testing; our RRP Committee oversees our Title I Resolution Plan and Recovery Plan; the Global Legal Entity Oversight and Governance Committee monitors the governance framework that operates over our consolidated legal entity population; the Enterprise Regulatory Oversight Committee oversees significant regulatory and supervisory requirements and assessments; various commitment and underwriting committees are responsible for reviewing capital, lending and underwriting commitments on behalf of us; and the Culture, Values and Conduct Committee oversees Firm-wide standards and initiatives relating to culture, values and conduct, including training and enhancements to performance and compensation processes.

In addition, each business segment has a risk committee that is responsible for helping to ensure that the business segment, as applicable, adheres to established limits for market, credit, operational and other risks; implements risk measurement, monitoring, and management policies, procedures, controls and

systems that are consistent with the risk framework established by the FRC; and reviews, on a periodic basis, our aggregate risk exposures, risk exception experience, and the efficacy of our risk identification, measurement, monitoring and management policies and procedures, and related controls.

Chief Risk Officer.    The Chief Risk Officer, who is independent of business units, reports to the BRC and the Chief Executive Officer. The Chief Risk Officer oversees compliance with our risk limits; approves exceptions to our risk limits; independently reviews material market, credit, liquidity, model and operational risks; and reviews results of risk management processes with the Board, the BRC and the BAC, as appropriate. The Chief Risk Officer also coordinates with the Chief Financial Officer regarding capital and liquidity management and works with the Compensation, Management Development and Succession Committee of the Board to help ensure that the structure and design of incentive compensation arrangements do not encourage unnecessary and excessive risk taking.

Independent Risk Management Functions.    The independent risk management functions (Market Risk, Credit Risk, Operational Risk, Model Risk and Liquidity Risk Management Departments) are independent of our business units. These functions assist senior management and the FRC in monitoring and controlling our risk through a number of control processes. Each function maintains its own risk governance structure with specified individuals and committees responsible for aspects of managing risk. Further discussion about the responsibilities of the risk management functions may be found below under “Market Risk,” “Credit Risk,” “Operational Risk,” “Model Risk,” and “Liquidity Risk.”

Support and Control Groups.    Our support and control groups include the Legal and Compliance Division, the Finance Division, the Operations Division, the Technology and Data Division, the Human Resources Department, Strategy and Execution, and Corporate Services. Our support and control groups coordinate with the business segment control groups to review the risk monitoring and risk management policies and procedures relating to, among other things, controls over financial reporting and disclosure; the business segment’s market, credit and operational risk profile; liquidity risks; model risks; sales practices; reputational, legal enforceability, compliance and regulatory risk; and technological risks. Participation by the senior officers of the Firm and business segment control groups helps ensure that risk policies and procedures, exceptions to risk limits, new products and business ventures, and transactions with risk elements undergo thorough review.

Internal Audit Department.    The Internal Audit Department provides independent risk and control assessment and reports to the BAC. The Internal Audit Department provides an independent assessment of our control environment and risk

 

 

  77   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Risk Disclosures   LOGO

 

management processes using a risk-based audit coverage model and audit execution methodology developed from professional auditing standards. The Internal Audit Department also reviews and tests our compliance with internal guidelines set for risk management and risk monitoring, as well as external rules and regulations governing the industry. It effects these responsibilities through periodic reviews (with specified minimum frequency) of our processes, activities, products or information systems; targeted reviews of specific controls and activities; pre-implementation or initiative reviews of new or significantly changed processes, activities, products or information systems; and special investigations required as a result of internal factors or regulatory requests. In addition to regular reports to the BAC, the Global Audit Director also periodically reports to the BRC and BOTC on risk-related controls.

Culture, Values and Conduct of Employees.    Employees of the Firm are accountable for conducting themselves in accordance with our core values: Putting Clients First, Doing the Right Thing, Leading with Exceptional Ideas and Giving Back. We are committed to building on our strong culture anchored in these core values, and supported by our governance framework, Board and management oversight, effective risk management and controls, training and development programs, policies, procedures, and defined roles and responsibilities, including the role of the Culture, Values and Conduct Committee. Our Code of Conduct (the “Code”) establishes standards for employee conduct that further reinforce the Firm’s commitment to integrity and ethical conduct. Every new hire and every employee annually must certify to their understanding of and adherence to the Code. The employee annual review process includes evaluation of adherence to the Code and our core values. The Global Incentive Compensation Discretion Policy sets forth standards for managers when making annual compensation decisions and specifically provides that managers must consider whether their employees effectively managed and/or supervised risk control practices during the performance year. We also have several mutually reinforcing processes to identify employee conduct that may have an impact on employment status, current-year compensation and/or prior-year compensation. Our clawback and cancellation provisions, which permit recovery of deferred incentive compensation, apply to a broad scope of employee conduct, including any act or omission that constitutes a breach of obligation to the Firm (including failure to comply with internal compliance, ethics or risk management standards, and failure or refusal to perform duties satisfactorily, including supervisory and management duties), causes a restatement of our consolidated financial results, constitutes a violation of our global risk management principles, policies and standards, or causes a loss of revenues associated with a position on which the employee was paid and the employee operated outside of internal control policies.

Risk Management Process

The following is a discussion of our risk management policies and procedures for our principal risks (capital and liquidity risk is discussed in “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Liquidity and Capital Resources” in Item 7). The discussion focuses on our securities activities (primarily our institutional trading activities) and corporate lending and related activities. We believe that these activities generate a substantial portion of our principal risks. This discussion and the estimated amounts of our risk exposure generated by our statistical analyses are forward-looking statements. However, the analyses used to assess such risks are not predictions of future events, and actual results may vary significantly from such analyses due to events in the markets in which we operate and certain other factors described below.

Risk Limits Framework

Risk limits and quantitative metrics provide the basis for monitoring risk-taking activity and avoiding outsized risk-taking. Our risk-taking capacity is sized through the Firm’s capital planning process where losses are estimated under the Firm’s Bank Holding Company Severely Adverse stress testing scenario. We also maintain a comprehensive suite of risk limits and quantitative metrics to support and implement our risk appetite statement. Our risk limits support linkages between the overall risk appetite, which is reviewed by the Board, and more granular risk-taking decisions and activities.

Risk limits, once established, are reviewed and updated on at least an annual basis, with more frequent updates as necessary. Board-level risk limits address the most important Firm-wide aggregations of risk, including, but not limited to, stressed market, credit and liquidity risks. Additional risk limits approved by the FRC address more specific types of risk and are bound by the higher-level Board risk limits.

Market Risk

Market risk refers to the risk that a change in the level of one or more market prices, rates, indices, implied volatilities (the price volatility of the underlying instrument imputed from option prices), correlations or other market factors, such as market liquidity, will result in losses for a position or portfolio. Generally, we incur market risk as a result of trading, investing and client facilitation activities, principally within the Institutional Securities business segment where the substantial majority of our Value-at-Risk (“VaR”) for market risk exposures is generated. In addition, we incur trading-related market risk within the Wealth Management business segment. The Investment Management business segment primarily incurs non-trading market risk from capital investments in real estate funds and investments in private equity

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   78  


Table of Contents
Risk Disclosures   LOGO

 

vehicles. Market risk includes non-trading interest rate risk. Non-trading interest rate risk in the banking book (amounts classified for regulatory capital purposes under the banking book regime) refers to the exposure that a change in interest rates will result in prospective earnings changes for assets and liabilities in the banking book.

Sound market risk management is an integral part of our culture. The various business units and trading desks are responsible for ensuring that market risk exposures are well-managed and prudent. The control groups help ensure that these risks are measured and closely monitored and are made transparent to senior management. The Market Risk Department is responsible for ensuring transparency of material market risks, monitoring compliance with established limits and escalating risk concentrations to appropriate senior management. To execute these responsibilities, the Market Risk Department monitors our risk against limits on aggregate risk exposures, performs a variety of risk analyses, routinely reports risk summaries, and maintains our VaR and scenario analysis systems. These limits are designed to control price and market liquidity risk. Market risk is also monitored through various measures: by use of statistics (including VaR and related analytical measures); by measures of position sensitivity; and through routine stress testing, which measures the impact on the value of existing portfolios of specified changes in market factors, and scenario analyses conducted by the Market Risk Department in collaboration with the business units. The material risks identified by these processes are summarized in reports produced by the Market Risk Department that are circulated to and discussed with senior management, the FRC, the BRC and the Board.

The Chief Risk Officer, among other things, monitors market risk through the Market Risk Department, which reports to the Chief Risk Officer and is independent of the business units, and has close interactions with senior management and the risk management control groups in the business units. The Chief Risk Officer is a member of the FRC, chaired by the Chief Executive Officer, which includes the most senior officers of the Firm, and regularly reports on market risk matters to this committee, as well as to the BRC and the Board.

Sales and Trading and Related Activities

Primary Market Risk Exposures and Market Risk Management.    During 2016, we had exposures to a wide range of interest rates, equity prices, foreign exchange rates and commodity prices—and the associated implied volatilities and spreads—related to the global markets in which we conduct our trading activities.

We are exposed to interest rate and credit spread risk as a result of our market-making activities and other trading in

interest rate-sensitive financial instruments (e.g., risk arising from changes in the level or implied volatility of interest rates, the timing of mortgage prepayments, the shape of the yield curve and credit spreads). The activities from which those exposures arise and the markets in which we are active include, but are not limited to, the following: corporate and government debt across both developed and emerging markets and asset-backed debt (including mortgage-related securities).

We are exposed to equity price and implied volatility risk as a result of making markets in equity securities and derivatives and maintaining other positions (including positions in non-public entities). Positions in non-public entities may include, but are not limited to, exposures to private equity, venture capital, private partnerships, real estate funds and other funds. Such positions are less liquid, have longer investment horizons and are more difficult to hedge than listed equities.

We are exposed to foreign exchange rate and implied volatility risk as a result of making markets in foreign currencies and foreign currency derivatives, from maintaining foreign exchange positions and from holding non-U.S. dollar-denominated financial instruments.

We are exposed to commodity price and implied volatility risk as a result of market-making activities in commodity products related primarily to electricity, natural gas, oil and precious metals. Commodity exposures are subject to periods of high price volatility as a result of changes in supply and demand. These changes can be caused by weather conditions; physical production and transportation; or geopolitical and other events that affect the available supply and level of demand for these commodities.

We manage our trading positions by employing a variety of risk mitigation strategies. These strategies include diversification of risk exposures and hedging. Hedging activities consist of the purchase or sale of positions in related securities and financial instruments, including a variety of derivative products (e.g., futures, forwards, swaps and options). Hedging activities may not always provide effective mitigation against trading losses due to differences in the terms, specific characteristics or other basis risks that may exist between the hedge instrument and the risk exposure that is being hedged. We manage the market risk associated with our trading activities on a Firm-wide basis, on a worldwide trading division level and on an individual product basis. We manage and monitor our market risk exposures in such a way as to maintain a portfolio that we believe is well-diversified in the aggregate with respect to market risk factors and that reflects our aggregate risk tolerance as established by our senior management.

 

 

  79   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Risk Disclosures   LOGO

 

Aggregate market risk limits have been approved for the Firm across all divisions worldwide. Additional market risk limits are assigned to trading desks and, as appropriate, products and regions. Trading division risk managers, desk risk managers, traders and the Market Risk Department monitor market risk measures against limits in accordance with policies set by our senior management.

VaR.    We use the statistical technique known as VaR as one of the tools used to measure, monitor and review the market risk exposures of our trading portfolios. The Market Risk Department calculates and distributes daily VaR-based risk measures to various levels of management.

VaR Methodology, Assumptions and Limitations.    We estimate VaR using a model based on volatility-adjusted historical simulation for general market risk factors and Monte Carlo simulation for name-specific risk in corporate shares, bonds, loans and related derivatives. The model constructs a distribution of hypothetical daily changes in the value of trading portfolios based on the following: historical observation of daily changes in key market indices or other market risk factors; and information on the sensitivity of the portfolio values to these market risk factor changes. Our VaR model uses four years of historical data with a volatility adjustment to reflect current market conditions. VaR for risk management purposes (“Management VaR”) is computed at a 95% level of confidence over a one-day time horizon, which is a useful indicator of possible trading losses resulting from adverse daily market moves. The 95%/one-day VaR corresponds to the unrealized loss in portfolio value that, based on historically observed market risk factor movements, would have been exceeded with a frequency of 5%, or five times in every 100 trading days, if the portfolio were held constant for one day.

Our VaR model generally takes into account linear and non-linear exposures to equity and commodity price risk, interest rate risk, credit spread risk and foreign exchange rates. The model also takes into account linear exposures to implied volatility risks for all asset classes and non-linear exposures to implied volatility risks for equity, commodity and foreign exchange referenced products. The VaR model also captures certain implied correlation risks associated with portfolio credit derivatives, as well as certain basis risks (e.g., corporate debt and related credit derivatives).

We use VaR as one of a range of risk management tools. Among their benefits, VaR models permit estimation of a portfolio’s aggregate market risk exposure, incorporating a range of varied market risks and portfolio assets. One key element of the VaR model is that it reflects risk reduction due to portfolio diversification or hedging activities. However, VaR has various limitations, which include, but are not

limited to: use of historical changes in market risk factors, which may not be accurate predictors of future market conditions and may not fully incorporate the risk of extreme market events that are outsized relative to observed historical market behavior or reflect the historical distribution of results beyond the 95% confidence interval; and reporting of losses in a single day, which does not reflect the risk of positions that cannot be liquidated or hedged in one day. A small proportion of market risk generated by trading positions is not included in VaR. The modeling of the risk characteristics of some positions relies on approximations that, under certain circumstances, could produce significantly different results from those produced using more precise measures. VaR is most appropriate as a risk measure for trading positions in liquid financial markets and will understate the risk associated with severe events, such as periods of extreme illiquidity. We are aware of these and other limitations and, therefore, use VaR as only one component in our risk management oversight process. This process also incorporates stress testing and scenario analyses and extensive risk monitoring, analysis and control at the trading desk, division and Firm levels.

Our VaR model evolves over time in response to changes in the composition of trading portfolios and to improvements in modeling techniques and systems capabilities. We are committed to continuous review and enhancement of VaR methodologies and assumptions in order to capture evolving risks associated with changes in market structure and dynamics. As part of our regular process improvements, additional systematic and name-specific risk factors may be added to improve the VaR model’s ability to more accurately estimate risks to specific asset classes or industry sectors.

Since the reported VaR statistics are estimates based on historical data, VaR should not be viewed as predictive of our future revenues or financial performance or of our ability to monitor and manage risk. There can be no assurance that our actual losses on a particular day will not exceed the VaR amounts indicated below or that such losses will not occur more than five times in 100 trading days for a 95%/one-day VaR. VaR does not predict the magnitude of losses that, should they occur, may be significantly greater than the VaR amount.

VaR statistics are not readily comparable across firms because of differences in the firms’ portfolios, modeling assumptions and methodologies. These differences can result in materially different VaR estimates across firms for similar portfolios. The impact of such differences varies depending on the factor history assumptions, the frequency with which the factor history is updated and the confidence level. As a result, VaR statistics are more useful when interpreted as indicators of trends in a firm’s risk profile rather than as an absolute measure of risk to be compared across firms.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   80  


Table of Contents
Risk Disclosures   LOGO

 

We utilize the same VaR model for risk management purposes, as well as for regulatory capital calculations. Our VaR model has been approved by our regulators for use in regulatory capital calculations.

The portfolio of positions used for Management VaR differs from that used for regulatory capital requirements (“Regulatory VaR”), as Management VaR contains certain positions that are excluded from Regulatory VaR. Examples include counterparty credit valuation adjustment (“CVA”) and related hedges, as well as loans that are carried at fair value and associated hedges.

The following table presents the Management VaR for the Trading portfolio, on a period-end, annual average, and annual high and low basis. To further enhance the transparency of the traded market risk, the Credit Portfolio VaR has been disclosed as a separate category from the Primary Risk Categories. The Credit Portfolio includes counterparty CVA and related hedges, as well as loans that are carried at fair value and associated hedges.

Trading Risks

95%/One-Day Management VaR

 

     95%/One-Day VaR for 2016  
$ in millions   

Period

End

    Average     High      Low  

Interest rate and credit spread

   $ 24     $ 29     $ 39      $ 22   

Equity price

     12       16       43        11   

Foreign exchange rate

     7       8       12         

Commodity price

     8       10       13         

Less: Diversification benefit1, 2

     (21     (27     N/A        N/A   

Primary Risk Categories

   $ 30     $ 36     $ 61      $ 29   

Credit Portfolio

     15       19       24        12   

Less: Diversification benefit1, 2

     (11     (12     N/A        N/A   

Total Management VaR

   $           34     $ 43     $ 68      $ 34   
    

 

95%/One-Day VaR for 2015

 
$ in millions   

Period

End

    Average     High      Low  

Interest rate and credit spread

   $ 28     $ 34     $ 42      $ 27   

Equity price

     17       19       40        14   

Foreign exchange rate

     6       11       20         

Commodity price

     10       16       21        10   

Less: Diversification benefit1, 2

     (23     (33     N/A        N/A   

Primary Risk Categories

   $ 38     $ 47     $ 57      $ 38   

Credit Portfolio

     12       13       20        10   

Less: Diversification benefit1, 2

     (9     (10     N/A        N/A   

Total Management VaR

   $           41     $ 50     $ 61      $ 41   

N/A—Not Applicable

1.

Diversification benefit equals the difference between the total Management VaR and the sum of the component VaRs. This benefit arises because the simulated one-day losses for each of the components occur on different days; similar diversification benefits also are taken into account within each component.

2.

The high and low VaR values for the total Management VaR and each of the component VaRs might have occurred on different days during the year, and therefore, the diversification benefit is not an applicable measure.

The average total Management VaR for 2016 was $43 million compared with $50 million for 2015. The average Management VaR for the Primary Risk Categories for 2016 was $36 million compared with $47 million in 2015. The noted decreases were driven by an overall reduction in risk exposures across the Sales and Trading businesses.

Distribution of VaR Statistics and Net Revenues for 2016.    One method of evaluating the reasonableness of our VaR model as a measure of our potential volatility of net revenues is to compare VaR with actual trading revenues. Assuming no intraday trading, for a 95%/one-day VaR, the expected number of times that trading losses should exceed VaR during the year is 13, and, in general, if trading losses were to exceed VaR more than 21 times in a year, the adequacy of the VaR model would be questioned. We evaluate the reasonableness of our VaR model by comparing the potential declines in portfolio values generated by the model with actual trading results for the Firm, as well as individual business units. For days where losses exceed the VaR statistic, we examine the drivers of trading losses to evaluate the VaR model’s accuracy relative to realized trading results.

The distribution of VaR Statistics and Net Revenues is presented in the following histograms for the Total Trading populations.

Total Trading.    As shown in the 95%/One-Day Management VaR table on the preceding page, the average 95%/one-day total Management VaR for 2016 was $43 million. The following histogram presents the distribution of the daily 95%/one-day total Management VaR for 2016, which was in a range between $30 million and $60 million for approximately 99% of trading days during the year.

 

LOGO

The following histogram shows the distribution for 2016 of daily net trading revenues, including profits and losses from Interest rate and credit spread, Equity price, Foreign exchange rate, Commodity price, and Credit Portfolio positions and intraday trading activities, for our Trading businesses. Daily net trading revenues also include intraday trading activities but exclude certain items not captured in the VaR model, such as fees, commissions and net interest income. Daily net trading revenues

 

 

  81   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Risk Disclosures   LOGO

 

differ from the definition of revenues required for Regulatory VaR backtesting, which further excludes intraday trading. During 2016, we experienced net trading losses on 18 days, of which no day was in excess of the 95%/one-day Total Management VaR.

 

 

LOGO

Non-Trading Risks

We believe that sensitivity analysis is an appropriate representation of our non-trading risks. Reflected below is this analysis covering substantially all of the non-trading risk in our portfolio.

Counterparty Exposure Related to Our Own Credit Spread.    The credit spread risk sensitivity of the counterparty exposure related to our own credit spread corresponded to an increase in value of approximately $6 million for each 1 basis point widening in our credit spread level at both December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015.

Funding Liabilities.    The credit spread risk sensitivity of our mark-to-market funding liabilities corresponded to an increase in value of approximately $17 million and $11 million for each 1 basis point widening in our credit spread level at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively.

Interest Rate Risk Sensitivity.    The following table presents an analysis of selected instantaneous upward and downward parallel interest rate shocks on net interest income over the next 12 months for our U.S. Bank Subsidiaries. These shocks are applied to our 12-month forecast for our U.S. Bank Subsidiaries, which incorporates market expectations of interest rates and our forecasted business activity, including our deposit deployment strategy and asset-liability management hedges.

During the fourth quarter of 2016, we changed the criteria used to determine the pricing for our deposit liabilities to client cash balances from client assets under management. As a result of the change, the U.S. Bank Subsidiaries balance sheet is expected to have greater sensitivity to higher rates than in prior periods.

U.S. Bank Subsidiaries’ Net Interest Income Sensitivity Analysis

 

$ in millions    At December 31, 2016      At December 31, 2015   

+200 basis points

   $ 550     $ (149)  

+100 basis points

     262       (84)  

 -100 basis points

     (655     (512)  

At December 31, 2016, the upward instantaneous interest rate shocks result in a positive impact to our U.S. Bank Subsidiaries’ projected net interest income over the following 12 months.

We do not manage to any single rate scenario but rather manage net interest income in our U.S. Bank Subsidiaries to optimize across a range of possible outcomes. The sensitivity analysis assumes that we take no action in response to these scenarios, assumes there are no changes in other macroeconomic variables normally correlated with changes in interest rates, and includes subjective assumptions regarding customer and market re-pricing behavior and other factors.

Investments.    We have exposure to public and private companies through direct investments, as well as through funds that invest in these assets. These investments are predominantly equity positions with long investment horizons, a portion of which are for business facilitation purposes. The market risk related to these investments is measured by estimating the potential reduction in net income associated with a 10% decline in investment values and related impact on performance fees.

Investments Sensitivity, Including Related Performance Fees

 

     10% Sensitivity  
$ in millions   

At

December 31,
2016

    

At

December 31,

2015

 

Investments related to Investment Management activities

   $              332      $              371  

Other investments:

     

Mitsubishi UFJ Morgan Stanley Securities Co., Ltd.

     158        142  

Other Firm investments

     130        194  

Equity Market Sensitivity.    In the Wealth Management and Investment Management business segments, certain fee-based revenue streams are driven by the value of clients’ equity holdings. The overall level of revenues for these streams also depends on multiple additional factors that include, but are not limited to, the level and duration of the equity market decline, price volatility, the geographic and industry mix of client assets, the rate and magnitude of client investments and redemptions, and the impact of such market decline and price volatility on client behavior. Therefore, overall revenues do not correlate completely with changes in the equity markets.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   82  


Table of Contents
Risk Disclosures   LOGO

 

Credit Risk

Credit risk refers to the risk of loss arising when a borrower, counterparty or issuer does not meet its financial obligations to us. We primarily incur credit risk exposure to institutions and individuals through our Institutional Securities and Wealth Management business segments.

We may incur credit risk in our Institutional Securities business segment through a variety of activities, including, but not limited to, the following:

 

 

extending credit to clients through various lending commitments;

 

 

entering into swap or other derivative contracts under which counterparties have obligations to make payments to us;

 

 

providing short- or long-term funding that is secured by physical or financial collateral whose value may at times be insufficient to fully cover the loan repayment amount;

 

 

posting margin and/or collateral to clearinghouses, clearing agencies, exchanges, banks, securities firms and other financial counterparties;

 

 

placing funds on deposit at other financial institutions to support our clearing and settlement obligations; and

 

 

investing or trading in securities and loan pools, whereby the value of these assets may fluctuate based on realized or expected defaults on the underlying obligations or loans.

We incur credit risk in our Wealth Management business segment, primarily through lending to individuals and entities, including, but not limited to, the following:

 

 

margin loans collateralized by securities;

 

 

securities-based lending and other forms of secured loans, including tailored lending, to high net worth clients; and

 

 

single-family residential mortgage loans in conforming, non-conforming or home equity lines of credit (“HELOC”) form, primarily to existing Wealth Management clients.

Monitoring and Control

In order to help protect us from losses, the Credit Risk Management Department establishes Firm-wide practices to evaluate, monitor and control credit risk exposure at the transaction, obligor and portfolio levels. The Credit Risk Management Department approves extensions of credit, evaluates the creditworthiness of the counterparties and borrowers on a regular basis, and ensures that credit exposure is actively monitored and managed. The evaluation of counterparties and

borrowers includes an assessment of the probability that an obligor will default on its financial obligations and any losses that may occur when an obligor defaults. In addition, credit risk exposure is actively managed by credit professionals and committees within the Credit Risk Management Department and through various risk committees, whose membership includes individuals from the Credit Risk Management Department. A comprehensive and global Credit Limits Framework is utilized to manage credit risk levels across the Firm. The Credit Limits Framework is calibrated within our risk tolerance and includes single-name limits and portfolio concentration limits by country, industry and product type.

The Credit Risk Management Department ensures transparency of material credit risks, compliance with established limits and escalation of risk concentrations to appropriate senior management. The Credit Risk Management Department also works closely with the Market Risk Department and applicable business units to monitor risk exposures and to perform stress tests to identify, analyze and control credit risk concentrations arising in the lending and trading activities. The stress tests shock market factors (e.g., interest rates, commodity prices, credit spreads), risk parameters (e.g., default probabilities and loss given default), recovery rates and expected losses in order to assess the impact of stresses on exposures, profit and loss, and our capital position. Stress and scenario tests are conducted in accordance with our established policies and procedures.

Credit Evaluation

The evaluation of corporate and institutional counterparties and borrowers includes assigning obligor credit ratings, which reflect an assessment of an obligor’s probability of default and loss given default. Credit evaluations typically involve the assessment of financial statements; leverage; liquidity; capital strength; asset composition and quality; market capitalization; access to capital markets; adequacy of collateral, if applicable; and in the case of certain loans, cash flow projections and debt service requirements. The Credit Risk Management Department also evaluates strategy, market position, industry dynamics, management and other factors that could affect the obligor’s risk profile. Additionally, the Credit Risk Management Department evaluates the relative position of our exposure in the borrower’s capital structure and relative recovery prospects, as well as other structural elements of the particular transaction.

The evaluation of consumer borrowers is tailored to the specific type of lending. Margin and securities-based loans are evaluated based on factors that include, but are not limited to, the amount of the loan, the degree of leverage and the quality, diversification, price volatility and liquidity of the collateral. The underwriting of residential real estate loans includes, but is not limited to, review of the obligor’s income,

 

 

  83   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Risk Disclosures   LOGO

 

net worth, liquidity, collateral, loan-to-value ratio and credit bureau information. Subsequent credit monitoring for individual loans is performed at the portfolio level, and collateral values are monitored on an ongoing basis.

Credit risk metrics assigned to our borrowers during the evaluation process are incorporated into the Credit Risk Management Department’s maintenance of the allowance for loan losses for the loans held for the investment portfolio. Such allowance serves as a reserve for probable inherent losses, as well as probable losses related to loans identified for impairment. For more information on the allowance for loan losses, see Notes 2 and 7 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8.

Risk Mitigation

We may seek to mitigate credit risk from our lending and trading activities in multiple ways, including collateral provisions, guarantees and hedges. At the transaction level, we seek to mitigate risk through management of key risk elements such as size, tenor, financial covenants, seniority and collateral. We actively hedge our lending and derivatives exposure through various financial instruments that may include single-name, portfolio and structured credit derivatives. Additionally, we may sell, assign or syndicate loans and lending commitments to other financial institutions in the primary and secondary loan markets. In connection with our derivatives trading activities, we generally enter into master netting agreements and collateral arrangements with counterparties. These agreements provide us with the ability to demand collateral, as well as to liquidate collateral and offset receivables and payables covered under the same master agreement in the event of a counterparty default. A collateral management group monitors collateral levels against requirements and oversees the administration of the collateral function. See Note 6 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 for additional information about our collateralized transactions.

Lending Activities

We provide loans and lending commitments to a variety of customers, from large corporate and institutional clients to high net worth individuals. In addition, we purchase loans in the secondary market. In the consolidated balance sheets, these loans and lending commitments are carried at either fair value with changes in fair value recorded in earnings; held for investment, which are recorded at amortized cost; or held for sale, which are recorded at the lower of cost or fair value. Loans held for investment and loans held for sale are classified in Loans, and loans held at fair value are classified in Trading assets in the consolidated balance sheets. See Notes 3, 7 and 12 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 for further information.

Loan and Lending Commitment Portfolio by Business Segment

 

    At December 31, 2016  
$ in millions   Institutional
Securities
    Wealth
Management
   

Investment

Management1

    Total  

Corporate loans

  $ 13,858     $ 11,162     $ 5       $ 25,025  

Consumer loans

    —         24,866       —         24,866  

Residential real estate loans

    —         24,385       —         24,385  

Wholesale real estate loans

    7,702       —         —         7,702  

Loans held for investment, gross of allowance

    21,560       60,413       5         81,978  

Allowance for loan losses

    (238     (36     —         (274)  

Loans held for investment, net of allowance

    21,322       60,377       5         81,704  

Corporate loans

    10,710       —         —         10,710  

Residential real estate loans

    11       50       —         61  

Wholesale real estate loans

    1,773       —         —         1,773  

Loans held for sale

    12,494       50       —         12,544  

Corporate loans

    7,199       —         18         7,217  

Residential real estate loans

    966       —         —         966  

Wholesale real estate loans

    519       —         —         519  

Loans held at fair value

    8,684       —         18         8,702  

Total loans2

    42,500       60,427       23         102,950  

Lending commitments3,4

    90,143       8,299       —         98,442  

Total loans and lending commitments3,4

  $      132,643     $        68,726       23            $ 201,392  

 

    At December 31, 2015  
$ in millions   Institutional
Securities
    Wealth
Management
    Total  

Corporate loans

  $ 16,452     $ 7,102     $ 23,554  

Consumer loans

          21,528       21,528  

Residential real estate loans

          20,863       20,863  

Wholesale real estate loans

    6,839             6,839  

Loans held for investment, gross of allowance

    23,291       49,493       72,784  

Allowance for loan losses

    (195     (30     (225

Loans held for investment, net of allowance

    23,096       49,463       72,559  

Corporate loans

    11,924             11,924  

Residential real estate loans

    45       59       104  

Wholesale real estate loans

    1,172             1,172  

Loans held for sale

    13,141       59       13,200  

Corporate loans

    7,286             7,286  

Residential real estate loans

    1,885             1,885  

Wholesale real estate loans

    1,447             1,447  

Loans held at fair value

    10,618             10,618  

Total loans2

    46,855       49,522       96,377  

Lending commitments3,4

    95,572       5,821       101,393  

Total loans and lending commitments3,4

  $      142,427     $        55,343     $      197,770  

 

1.

Loans in Investment Management are entered into in conjunction with certain investment advisory activities.

2.

Amounts exclude $24.4 billion and $25.3 billion related to margin loans and $4.7 billion and $4.9 billion related to employee loans at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively. See Notes 6 and 7 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 for further information.

3.

Lending commitments represent the notional amount of legally binding obligations to provide funding to clients for all lending transactions. Since commitments associated with these business activities may expire unused or may not be utilized to full capacity, they do not necessarily reflect the actual future cash funding requirements.

4.

For syndications led by us, the lending commitments accepted by the borrower but not yet closed are net of the amounts agreed to by counterparties that will participate in the syndication. For syndications that we participate in and do not lead, lending commitments accepted by the borrower but not yet closed include only the amount that we expect will be allocated from the lead, syndicate bank. Due to the nature of our obligations under the commitments, these amounts include certain commitments participated to third parties.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   84  


Table of Contents
Risk Disclosures   LOGO

 

Our credit exposure from our loans and lending commitments is measured in accordance with our internal risk management standards. Risk factors considered in determining the aggregate allowance for loan and commitment losses include the borrower’s financial strength, seniority of the loan, collateral type, volatility of collateral value, debt cushion, loan-to-value ratio, debt service ratio, covenants and counterparty type. Qualitative and environmental factors such as economic and business conditions, nature and volume of the portfolio and lending terms, and volume and severity of past due loans may also be considered.

At December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, the allowance for loan losses related to loans that were accounted for as held for investment was $274 million and $225 million, respectively, and the allowance for commitment losses related to lending commitments that were accounted for as held for investment was $190 million and $185 million, respectively. The aggregate allowance for loan and commitment losses increased over the year ended December 31, 2016 primarily due to the energy sector. See “Institutional Securities Lending Exposures Related to the Energy Industry” herein and Note 7 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 for further information.

Institutional Securities Lending Activities.    In connection with certain of our Institutional Securities business segment activities, we provide loans and lending commitments to a diverse group of corporate and other institutional clients. These activities include corporate lending, commercial and residential mortgage lending, asset-backed lending, corporate loans purchased in the secondary market, financing extended to equities and commodities customers, and loans to municipalities. These loans and lending commitments may have varying terms; may be senior or subordinated; may be secured or unsecured; are generally contingent upon representations, warranties and contractual conditions applicable to the borrower; and may be syndicated, traded or hedged by us.

We also participate in securitization activities whereby we extend short-term or long-term funding to clients through loans and lending commitments that are secured by the assets of the borrower and generally provide for over-collateralization. See Note 13 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 for information about our securitization activities.

Institutional Securities loans and lending commitments are mainly related to relationship-based and event-driven lending to select corporate clients. Relationship-based loans and lending commitments are used for general corporate purposes, working capital and liquidity purposes by our investment banking clients and typically consist of revolving lines of credit, letter of credit facilities and term loans. In

connection with the relationship-based lending activities, we had hedges (which included single-name, sector and index hedges) with a notional amount of $20.2 billion and $12.0 billion at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively. Event-driven loans and lending commitments are associated with a particular event or transaction, such as to support client merger, acquisition, recapitalization and project finance activities. Event-driven loans and lending commitments typically consist of revolving lines of credit, term loans and bridge loans.

Institutional Securities Loans and Lending Commitments by Credit Rating1

 

    At December 31, 2016  
    Years to Maturity        
$ in millions   Less than 1     1-3     3-5     Over 5     Total  

AAA

  $ 50     $ 105     $ 50     $     $ 205  

AA

    3,724       451       4,027             8,202  

A

    2,229       5,385       12,526       944       21,084  

BBB

    7,970       15,479       20,916       2,015       46,380  

Investment grade

    13,973       21,420       37,519       2,959       75,871  

Non-investment grade

    7,506       21,048       19,896       5,722       54,172  

Unrated2

    806       132       175       1,487       2,600  

Total

  $     22,285     $     42,600     $     57,590     $     10,168     $     132,643  

 

    At December 31, 2015  
    Years to Maturity        
$ in millions   Less than 1     1-3     3-5     Over 5     Total  

AAA

  $ 287     $ 24     $ 50     $     $ 361  

AA

    5,022       2,553       3,735       63       11,373  

A

    3,996       5,726       11,993       1,222       22,937  

BBB

    5,089       16,720       23,248       4,086       49,143  

Investment grade

    14,394       25,023       39,026       5,371       83,814  

Non-investment grade

    7,768       15,863       22,818       7,779       54,228  

Unrated2

    930       1,091       246       2,118       4,385  

Total

  $     23,092     $     41,977     $     62,090     $     15,268     $     142,427  

 

1.

Obligor credit ratings are determined by the Credit Risk Management Department.

2.

Unrated loans and lending commitments are primarily trading positions that are measured at fair value and risk managed as a component of Market Risk. For a further discussion of our Market Risk, see “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk—Risk Management—Market Risk” herein.

At December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, the aggregate amount of investment grade loans was $15.3 billion and $15.8 billion, respectively, the aggregate amount of non-investment grade loans was $24.7 billion and $26.9 billion, respectively, and the aggregate amount of unrated loans was $2.5 billion and $4.2 billion, respectively.

At December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, approximately 99% of the Institutional Securities business segment loans held for investment were current, while approximately 1% were on nonaccrual status because the loans were past due for a period of 90 days or more or payment of principal or interest was in doubt.

 

 

  85   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Risk Disclosures   LOGO

 

Event-Driven Loans and Lending Commitments

 

$ in millions   At
December 31,
2016
    At
December 31,
2015
 

Event-driven loans

  $ 5,097     $ 5,414  

Event-driven lending commitments

    16,252       17,799  

Total

  $ 21,349     $ 23,213  

Event-driven loans and lending commitments to non-investment grade borrowers

  $ 15,339     $ 13,527  

Maturity Profile of Event-Driven Loans and Lending Commitments

 

      At
December 31,
2016
     At
December 31,
2015
 

Less than 1 year

     34%        24%  

1-3 years

     14%        21%  

3-5 years

     28%        24%  

Over 5 years

     24%        31%  

Institutional Securities Credit Exposure from Loans and Lending Commitments by Industry

 

$ in millions    At December 31,
2016
     At December 31,
2015
 

Industry1

     

Real estate

   $ 19,807      $ 17,847  

Consumer discretionary

     12,059        12,837  

Energy

     11,757        15,921  

Healthcare

     11,534        12,677  

Funds, exchanges and other financial services2

     11,481        11,748  

Industrials

     11,465        10,067  

Utilities

     9,216        12,631  

Information technology

     8,602        11,122  

Materials

     7,630        6,440  

Consumer staples

     7,329        8,597  

Mortgage finance

     6,296        8,260  

Telecommunications services

     6,156        4,403  

Insurance

     4,190        4,682  

Consumer finance

     2,847        2,249  

Other

     2,274        2,946  

Total

   $ 132,643      $ 142,427  

 

1.

Industry categories are based on the Global Industry Classification Standard®.

2.

Includes mutual funds, pension funds, private equity and real estate funds, exchanges and clearinghouses, and diversified financial services.

Institutional Securities Lending Exposures Related to the Energy Industry.    At December 31, 2016, Institutional Securities’ loans and lending commitments related to the energy industry were $11.8 billion, of which approximately

68% are accounted for as held for investment and 32% are accounted for as either held for sale or at fair value. Additionally, approximately 52% of the total energy industry loans and lending commitments were to investment grade counterparties. At December 31, 2016, the energy industry portfolio included $1.3 billion in loans and $2.1 billion in lending commitments to Oil and Gas Exploration and Production (“E&P”) companies.

The E&P loans were to non-investment grade counterparties, which are generally subject to periodic borrowing base reassessments based on the value of the underlying oil and gas reserves pledged as collateral. In limited situations, we may extend the period related to borrowing base reassessments typically in conjunction with taking certain risk mitigating actions with the borrower. Approximately 54% of the E&P lending commitments were to investment grade counterparties. During the year ended December 31, 2016, we increased the allowance for loan and commitment losses on held for investment energy exposures and incurred mark-to-market losses related to energy loans and lending commitments. See “Credit Risk—Lending Activities” herein for further information. To the extent commodities prices, or oil prices, remain at year-end levels, or deteriorate further, we may incur additional lending losses.

Institutional Securities Margin Lending.    In addition to the activities noted above, Institutional Securities provides margin lending, which allows the client to borrow against the value of qualifying securities. At December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, the amounts related to margin lending were $11.9 billion and $10.6 billion, respectively, which were classified within Customer and other receivables in the consolidated balance sheets.

Wealth Management Lending Activities.    The principal Wealth Management lending activities include securities-based lending and residential real estate loans.

Securities-based lending provided to our retail clients is primarily conducted through our Portfolio Loan Account (“PLA”) and Liquidity Access Line (“LAL”) platforms, which had an outstanding loan balance of $29.7 billion and $24.9 billion at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively. These loans allow the client to borrow money against the value of qualifying securities for any purpose other than purchasing securities. We establish approved credit lines against qualifying securities and monitor limits daily and, pursuant to such guidelines, require customers to deposit additional collateral, or reduce debt positions, when necessary. These credit lines are primarily uncommitted loan facilities, as we reserve the right to not make any advances, or may terminate these credit lines at any time. Factors considered in the review of these loans include, but are not limited to, the loan amount, the client’s credit profile, the degree of leverage, collateral diversification, price volatility and liquidity of the collateral.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   86  


Table of Contents
Risk Disclosures   LOGO

 

Residential real estate loans consist of first and second lien mortgages, including HELOC loans. Our underwriting policy is designed to ensure that all borrowers pass an assessment of capacity and willingness to pay, which includes an analysis utilizing industry standard credit scoring models (e.g., Fair Isaac Corporation (“FICO”) scores), debt ratios and assets of the borrower. Loan-to-value ratios are determined based on independent third-party property appraisal/valuations, and security lien position is established through title/ownership reports. The vast majority of mortgage and HELOC loans are held for investment in the Wealth Management business segment’s loan portfolio.

For the year ended December 31, 2016, loans and lending commitments associated with the Wealth Management business segment lending activities increased by approximately 24%, mainly due to growth in LAL and residential real estate loans.

Wealth Management Lending Activities by Remaining Contractual Maturity

 

    At December 31, 2016  
    Years to Maturity        
$ in millions   Less than 1     1-3     3-5     Over 5     Total  

Securities-based lending and other loans

  $ 30,547     $ 2,983     $ 1,304     $ 1,179     $ 36,013  

Residential real estate loans

                45       24,369       24,414  

Total

  $ 30,547     $ 2,983     $ 1,349     $ 25,548     $ 60,427  

Lending commitments

    6,372       1,413       268       246       8,299  

Total loans and lending commitments

  $         36,919     $         4,396     $         1,617     $         25,794     $         68,726  

 

    At December 31, 2015  
    Years to Maturity        
$ in millions   Less than 1     1-3     3-5     Over 5     Total  

Securities-based lending and other loans

  $ 25,975     $ 1,004     $ 889     $ 749     $ 28,617  

Residential real estate loans

                35       20,870       20,905  

Total

  $ 25,975     $ 1,004     $ 924     $ 21,619     $ 49,522  

Lending commitments

    5,143       286       115       277       5,821  

Total loans and lending commitments

  $         31,118     $         1,290     $         1,039     $         21,896     $         55,343  

At December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, approximately 99.9% of the Wealth Management business segment loans held for investment were current, while approximately 0.1% were on nonaccrual status because the loans were past due for a period of 90 days or more or payment of principal or interest was in doubt.

The Wealth Management business segment also provides margin lending to clients and had an outstanding balance of

$12.5 billion and $14.7 billion at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively, which were classified within Customer and other receivables in the consolidated balance sheets.

In addition, the Wealth Management business segment has employee loans of $4.7 billion and $4.9 billion at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively, that are granted in conjunction with programs established by us to retain and recruit certain employees. These loans are recorded in Customer and other receivables in the consolidated balance sheets. These loans are full recourse, generally require periodic payments and have repayment terms ranging from 1 to 12 years. We establish an allowance for loan amounts we do not consider recoverable, which is recorded in Compensation and benefits expense.

Credit Exposure—Derivatives

We incur credit risk as a dealer in OTC derivatives. Credit risk with respect to derivative instruments arises from the failure of a counterparty to perform according to the terms of the contract. In connection with our OTC derivative activities, we generally enter into master netting agreements and collateral arrangements with counterparties. These agreements provide us with the ability to demand collateral, as well as to liquidate collateral and offset receivables and payables covered under the same master netting agreement in the event of counterparty default. We manage our trading positions by employing a variety of risk mitigation strategies. These strategies include diversification of risk exposures and hedging. Hedging activities consist of the purchase or sale of positions in related securities and financial instruments, including a variety of derivative products (e.g., futures, forwards, swaps and options). For credit exposure information on our OTC derivative products, see Note 4 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8.

Credit Derivatives.    A credit derivative is a contract between a seller and buyer of protection against the risk of a credit event occurring on one or more debt obligations issued by a specified reference entity. The buyer typically pays a periodic premium over the life of the contract and is protected for the period. If a credit event occurs, the seller is required to make payment to the beneficiary based on the terms of the credit derivative contract. Credit events, as defined in the contract, may be one or more of the following defined events: bankruptcy, dissolution or insolvency of the referenced entity, failure to pay, obligation acceleration, repudiation, payment moratorium and restructurings.

We trade in a variety of credit derivatives and may either purchase or write protection on a single name or portfolio of referenced entities. In transactions referencing a portfolio of entities or securities, protection may be limited to a tranche of

 

 

  87   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Risk Disclosures   LOGO

 

exposure or a single name within the portfolio. We are an active market maker in the credit derivatives markets. As a market maker, we work to earn a bid-offer spread on client flow business and manage any residual credit or correlation risk on a portfolio basis. Further, we use credit derivatives to manage our exposure to residential and commercial mortgage loans and corporate lending exposures. The effectiveness of our credit default swap (“CDS”) protection as a hedge of our exposures may vary depending upon a number of factors, including the contractual terms of the CDS.

We actively monitor our counterparty credit risk related to credit derivatives. A majority of our counterparties are composed of banks, broker-dealers, insurance and other financial institutions. Contracts with these counterparties may include provisions related to counterparty rating downgrades, which may result in the counterparty posting additional collateral to us. As with all derivative contracts, we consider counterparty credit risk in the valuation of our positions and recognize credit valuation adjustments as appropriate within Trading revenues in the consolidated income statements.

Credit Derivative Portfolio by Counterparty Type

 

    At December 31, 2016  
    Fair Values1     Notionals  
$ in millions   Receivable     Payable     Net     Protection
Purchased
    Protection
Sold
 

Banks and securities firms

  $ 8,516     $ 9,397     $ (881   $ 319,830     $ 273,462  

Insurance and other financial institutions

    3,619       3,901       (282     144,527       151,999  

Non-financial entities

    94       127       (33     5,832       4,269  

Total

  $         12,229     $         13,425     $         (1,196   $         470,189     $         429,730  

 

    At December 31, 2015  
    Fair Values1     Notionals  
$ in millions   Receivable     Payable     Net     Protection
Purchased
    Protection
Sold
 

Banks and securities firms

  $ 16,962     $ 17,295     $ (333   $ 533,557     $ 491,267  

Insurance and other financial institutions

    5,842       6,247       (405     189,439       194,723  

Non-financial entities

    115       123       (8     5,932       3,529  

Total

  $         22,919     $         23,665     $         (746   $         728,928     $         689,519  

 

1.

Our CDSs are classified in either Level 2 or Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy. Approximately 4% and 3%, respectively, of receivable fair values and 7% and 6%, respectively, of payable fair values represented Level 3 amounts at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015 (see Note 3 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8).

The fair values shown in the previous table are before the application of contractual netting or collateral. For additional credit exposure information on our credit derivative portfolio, see Note 4 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8.

OTC Derivative Products at Fair Value, Net of Collateral, by Industry

 

$ in millions    At December 31,
2016
     At December 31,
2015
 

Industry1

  

Funds, exchanges and other financial services2

   $ 5,041      $ 2,029  

Banks and securities firms

     2,856        1,672  

Hedge funds

     2,417        14  

Energy

     1,057        396  

Insurance

     988        380  

Utilities

     719        3,428  

Not-for-profit organizations

     708        794  

Materials

     646        473  

Industrials

     528        2,304  

Consumer discretionary

     457        725  

Healthcare

     412        1,041  

Special purpose vehicles

     395        718  

Private individuals

     378        16  

Information technology

     376        294  

Sovereign governments

     264        524  

Regional governments

     256        1,163  

Consumer staples

     219        506  

Mortgage finance

     208        4  

Other

     210        143  

Total3

   $ 18,135      $ 16,624  

 

1.

Industry categories are based on the Global Industry Classification Standard®.

2.

Amounts include mutual funds, pension funds, private equity and real estate funds, exchanges and clearinghouses, and diversified financial services.

3.

For further information on derivative instruments and hedging activities, see Note 4 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8.

Country Risk Exposure

Country risk exposure is the risk that events in, or that affect, a foreign country (any country other than the U.S.) might adversely affect us. We actively manage country risk exposure through a comprehensive risk management framework that combines credit and market fundamentals and allows us to effectively identify, monitor and limit country risk. Country risk exposure before and after hedging is monitored and managed.

Our obligor credit evaluation process may also identify indirect exposures whereby an obligor has vulnerability or exposure to another country or jurisdiction. Examples of indirect exposures include mutual funds that invest in a single country, offshore companies whose assets reside in another country to that of the offshore jurisdiction and finance company subsidiaries of corporations. Indirect exposures identified through the credit evaluation process may result in a reclassification of country risk.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   88  


Table of Contents
Risk Disclosures   LOGO

 

We conduct periodic stress testing that seeks to measure the impact on our credit and market exposures of shocks stemming from negative economic or political scenarios. When deemed appropriate by our risk managers, the stress test scenarios include possible contagion effects. Second order risks such as the impact for core European banks of their peripheral exposures may also be considered. This analysis, and results of the stress tests, may result in the amendment of limits or exposure mitigation.

In addition to our country risk exposure, we disclose our cross-border risk exposure in “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data—Financial Data Supplement (Unaudited)” in Item 8. It is based on the Federal Financial Institutions Examination Council’s regulatory guidelines for reporting cross-border information and represents the amounts that we may not be able to obtain from a foreign country due to country-specific events, including unfavorable economic and political conditions, economic and social instability, and changes in government policies.

There can be substantial differences between our country risk exposure and cross-border risk exposure. For instance, unlike the cross-border risk exposure, our country risk exposure includes the effect of certain risk mitigants. In addition, the basis for determining the domicile of the country risk exposure is different from the basis for determining the cross-border risk exposure. Cross-border risk exposure is reported based on the country of jurisdiction for the obligor or guarantor. For country risk exposure, we consider factors in

addition to that of country of jurisdiction, including physical location of operations or assets, location and source of cash flows/revenues and location of collateral (if applicable) in order to determine the basis for country risk exposure. Furthermore, cross-border risk exposure incorporates CDS only where protection is purchased, while country risk exposure incorporates CDS where protection is purchased or sold.

Our sovereign exposures consist of financial instruments entered into with sovereign and local governments. Our non-sovereign exposures consist of exposures to primarily corporations and financial institutions. The following table shows our 10 largest non-U.S. country risk net exposures at December 31, 2016. Index credit derivatives are included in the country risk exposure table. Each reference entity within an index is allocated to that reference entity’s country of risk. Index exposures are allocated to the underlying reference entities in proportion to the notional weighting of each reference entity in the index, adjusted for any fair value receivable/payable for that reference entity. Where credit risk crosses multiple jurisdictions, for example, a CDS purchased from an issuer in a specific country that references bonds issued by an entity in a different country, the fair value of the CDS is reflected in the Net Counterparty Exposure column based on the country of the CDS issuer. Further, the notional amount of the CDS adjusted for the fair value of the receivable/payable is reflected in the Net Inventory column based on the country of the underlying reference entity.

 

 

  89   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Risk Disclosures   LOGO

 

Top Ten Country Exposures at December 31, 2016

 

$ in millions    Net Inventory1    

Net

Counterparty

Exposure2,3

    Loans      Lending
Commitments
     Exposure
Before Hedges
    Hedges4     Net Exposure5  

Country

                

United Kingdom:

                

Sovereigns

   $ (1,220   $ 9     $             —        $            —      $ (1,211   $             (255   $ (1,466

Non-sovereigns

     353       9,264       3,208        5,374        18,199       (2,031     16,168  

Total

   $ (867   $ 9,273     $ 3,208      $ 5,374      $ 16,988     $ (2,286   $ 14,702  

France:

                

Sovereigns

   $ 3,325     $ 5     $      $      $ 3,330     $ (50   $ 3,280  

Non-sovereigns

     (105     2,128       168        2,847        5,038       (1,349     3,689  

Total

   $ 3,220     $ 2,133     $ 168      $ 2,847      $ 8,368     $ (1,399   $ 6,969  

Brazil:

                

Sovereigns

   $ 4,644     $     $      $      $ 4,644     $ (11   $ 4,633  

Non-sovereigns

     124       232       945        73        1,374       (792     582  

Total

   $ 4,768     $ 232     $ 945      $ 73      $ 6,018     $ (803   $ 5,215  

Japan:

                

Sovereigns

   $ (260   $ 174     $      $      $ (86   $ (82   $ (168

Non-sovereigns

     486       3,046       319               3,851       (141     3,710  

Total

   $             226     $ 3,220     $ 319      $      $ 3,765     $ (223   $ 3,542  

Canada:

                

Sovereigns

   $ 134     $             56     $      $      $             190     $     $             190  

Non-sovereigns

     (72     1,462       175        1,473        3,038       (423     2,615  

Total

   $ 62     $ 1,518     $ 175      $ 1,473      $ 3,228     $ (423   $ 2,805  

Netherlands:

                

Sovereigns

   $ (39   $     $      $      $ (39   $ (20   $ (59

Non-sovereigns

     289       728       413        1,420        2,850       (344     2,506  

Total

   $ 250     $ 728     $ 413      $ 1,420      $ 2,811     $ (364   $ 2,447  

Italy:

                

Sovereigns

   $ 1,090     $ (2   $      $      $ 1,088     $ 10     $ 1,098  

Non-sovereigns

     119       556       39        647        1,361       (266     1,095  

Total

   $ 1,209     $ 554     $ 39      $ 647      $ 2,449     $ (256   $ 2,193  

China:

                

Sovereigns

   $ 82     $ 274     $      $      $ 356     $ (550   $ (194

Non-sovereigns

     1,036       216       770        257        2,279       (10     2,269  

Total

   $ 1,118     $ 490     $ 770      $ 257      $ 2,635     $ (560   $ 2,075  

Singapore:

                

Sovereigns

   $ 1,600     $ 92     $      $      $ 1,692     $     $ 1,692  

Non-sovereigns

     70       155       39        38        302             302  

Total

   $ 1,670     $ 247     $ 39      $ 38      $ 1,994     $     $ 1,994  

United Arab Emirates:

                

Sovereigns

   $ (27   $ 1,227     $      $      $ 1,200     $ (39   $ 1,161  

Non-sovereigns

     (13     278       32        83        380       (15     365  

Total

   $ (40   $ 1,505     $ 32      $ 83      $ 1,580     $ (54   $ 1,526  

 

1.

Net inventory represents exposure to both long and short single-name and index positions (i.e., bonds and equities at fair value and CDS based on a notional amount assuming zero recovery adjusted for any fair value receivable or payable). As a market maker, we may transact in these CDS positions to facilitate client trading. At December 31, 2016, gross purchased protection, gross written protection, and net exposures related to single-name and index credit derivatives for those countries were $(85.3) billion, $83.7 billion and $(1.6) billion, respectively. For a further description of the triggers for purchased credit protection and whether those triggers may limit the effectiveness of our hedges, see “Credit Exposure—Derivatives” herein.

2.

Net counterparty exposure (i.e., repurchase transactions, securities lending and OTC derivatives) takes into consideration legally enforceable master netting agreements and collateral.

3.

At December 31, 2016, the benefit of collateral received against counterparty credit exposure was $9.5 billion in the U.K., with 96% of collateral consisting of cash and government obligations of the U.K., U.S. and France, and $6.6 billion in Japan with nearly all collateral consisting of cash and government obligations of Japan. The benefit of collateral received against counterparty credit exposure in the other countries totaled approximately $10.6 billion, with collateral primarily consisting of cash and government obligations of the U.S. These amounts do not include collateral received on secured financing transactions.

4.

Amounts represent CDS hedges (purchased and sold) on net counterparty exposure and lending executed by trading desks responsible for hedging counterparty and lending credit risk exposures for us. Amounts are based on the CDS notional amount assuming zero recovery adjusted for any fair value receivable or payable.

5.

In addition, at December 31, 2016, we had exposure to these countries for overnight deposits with banks of approximately $10.2 billion.

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   90  


Table of Contents
Risk Disclosures   LOGO

 

Country Risk Exposures Related to the United Kingdom.    At December 31, 2016, our country risk exposures in the U.K. included net exposures of $14,702 million (shown in the previous table) and overnight deposits of $5,514 million. The $16,168 million (shown in the previous table) of exposures to non-sovereigns were diversified across both names and sectors. Of this exposure, $14,161 million is to investment grade counterparties, with the largest single component ($4,408 million) to exchanges and clearinghouses.

Country Risk Exposures Related to Brazil.    At December 31, 2016, our country risk exposures in Brazil included net exposures of $5,215 million (shown in the previous table). Our sovereign net exposures in Brazil were principally in the form of local currency government bonds held onshore to support client activity. The $582 million (shown in the previous table) of exposures to non-sovereigns were diversified across both names and sectors.

Country Risk Exposures Related to China.    At December 31, 2016, our country risk exposures in China included net exposures of $2,075 million (shown in the previous table) and overnight deposits with international banks of $159 million. The $2,269 million (shown in the previous table) of exposures to non-sovereigns were diversified across both names and sectors and were primarily concentrated in high-quality positions with negligible direct exposure to onshore equities.

Operational Risk

Operational risk refers to the risk of loss, or of damage to our reputation, resulting from inadequate or failed processes or systems, human factors or from external events (e.g., fraud, theft, legal and compliance risks, cyber attacks or damage to physical assets). We may incur operational risk across the full scope of our business activities, including revenue-generating activities (e.g., sales and trading) and support and control groups (e.g., information technology and trade processing). On March 4, 2016, the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (“BCBS”) updated its proposal for calculating operational risk regulatory capital. Under the proposal, which would eliminate the use of an internal model-based approach, required levels of operational risk regulatory capital would generally be determined under a standardized approach based primarily on a financial statement-based measure of operational risk exposure and adjustments based on the particular institution’s historic operational loss record. The revised proposal will be subject to further rulemaking procedures and its timing has not been specified.

We have established an operational risk framework to identify, measure, monitor and control risk across the Firm. Effective operational risk management is essential to reducing the impact of operational risk incidents and mitigating legal, regulatory and reputational risks. The framework is continually evolving to account for changes in the Firm and to respond to the changing regulatory and business environment. We have implemented operational risk data and assessment systems to monitor and analyze internal and external operational risk events, to assess business environment and internal control factors and to perform scenario analysis. The collected data elements are incorporated in the operational risk capital model. The model encompasses both quantitative and qualitative elements. Internal loss data and scenario analysis results are direct inputs to the capital model, while external operational incidents, business environment and internal control factors are evaluated as part of the scenario analysis process.

In addition, we employ a variety of risk processes and mitigants to manage our operational risk exposures. These include a strong governance framework, a comprehensive risk management program and insurance. Operational risks and associated risk exposures are assessed relative to the risk tolerance established by the Board and are prioritized accordingly. The breadth and range of operational risk are such that the types of mitigating activities are wide-ranging. Examples of activities include enhancing defenses against cyberattacks; use of legal agreements and contracts to transfer and/or limit operational risk exposures; due diligence; implementation of enhanced policies and procedures; technology change management controls; exception management processing controls; and segregation of duties.

Primary responsibility for the management of operational risk is with the business segments, the control groups and the business managers therein. The business managers maintain processes and controls designed to identify, assess, manage, mitigate and report operational risk. Each of the business segments has a designated operational risk coordinator. The operational risk coordinator regularly reviews operational risk issues and reports to our senior management within each business. Each control group also has a designated operational risk coordinator and a forum for discussing operational risk matters with our senior management. Oversight of operational risk is provided by the Operational Risk Oversight Committee, legal entity risk committees, regional risk committees and senior management. In the event of a merger; joint venture; divestiture; reorganization; or creation of a new legal entity, a new product or a business activity, operational risks are considered, and any necessary changes in processes or controls are implemented.

 

 

  91   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Risk Disclosures   LOGO

 

The Operational Risk Department is independent of the divisions and reports to the Chief Risk Officer. The Operational Risk Department provides oversight of operational risk management and independently assesses, measures and monitors operational risk. The Operational Risk Department works with the divisions and control groups to help ensure a transparent, consistent and comprehensive framework for managing operational risk within each area and across the Firm. The Operational Risk Department scope includes oversight of the technology and data risk management program (e.g., cybersecurity), fraud risk management and prevention program, and supplier risk management (vendor risk oversight and assessment) program. Furthermore, the Operational Risk Department supports the collection and reporting of operational risk incidents and the execution of operational risk assessments; provides the infrastructure needed for risk measurement and risk management; and ensures ongoing validation and verification of our advanced measurement approach for operational risk capital.

Business Continuity Management is responsible for identifying key risks and threats to our resiliency and planning to ensure that a recovery strategy and required resources are in place for the resumption of critical business functions following a disaster or other business interruption. Disaster recovery plans are in place for critical facilities and resources on a Firm-wide basis, and redundancies are built into the systems as deemed appropriate. The key components of our Business Continuity Management Program include: crisis management; business recovery plans; applications/data recovery; work area recovery; and other elements addressing management, analysis, training and testing.

We maintain an information security program that coordinates the management of information security risks and is designed to address regulatory requirements. Information security policies are designed to protect our information assets against unauthorized disclosure, modification or misuse. These policies cover a broad range of areas, including: application entitlements, data protection, incident response, internet and electronic communications, remote access, mobile banking products, and portable devices. We have also established policies, procedures and technologies to protect our computers and other assets from unauthorized access.

In connection with our ongoing operations, we utilize the services of external vendors, which we anticipate will continue and may increase in the future. These services include, for example, outsourced processing and support functions and other professional services. We manage our exposures to these services through a variety of means such as the performance of due diligence, consideration of operational risk, implementation of service level and other contrac-

tual agreements, and ongoing monitoring of the vendors’ performance. We maintain a supplier risk management program with policies, procedures, organization, governance and supporting technology that satisfies regulatory requirements. The program is designed to ensure that adequate risk management controls over the services exist, including, but not limited to, information security, operational failure, financial stability, disaster recoverability, reputational risk, safeguards against corruption and termination.

Model Risk

Model risk refers to the potential for adverse consequences from decisions based on incorrect or misused model outputs. Model risk can lead to financial loss, poor business and strategic decision making, or damage to a Firm’s reputation. The risk inherent in a model is a function of the materiality, complexity and uncertainty around inputs and assumptions. Model risk is generated from the use of models impacting financial statements, regulatory filings, capital adequacy assessments and the formulation of strategy.

Sound model risk management is an integral part of our Risk Management Framework. Model Risk Management is a distinct department in Risk Management responsible for the independent oversight of model risk. It is independent of the business units and reports to the Chief Risk Officer.

The Model Risk Management Department establishes a model risk tolerance in line with our risk appetite. The tolerance is based on an assessment of the materiality of the risk of financial loss or reputational damage due to errors in design, implementation, and/or inappropriate use of models. The tolerance is monitored through model-specific and aggregate business-level assessments, which are based upon qualitative and quantitative factors.

A guiding principle for managing model risk is the “effective challenge” of models. The effective challenge of models is represented by the critical analysis by objective, informed parties who can identify model limitations and assumptions and drive appropriate changes. The Model Risk Management Department provides effective challenge of models, independently validates and approves models for use, annually recertifies models, reports identified model validation limitations to key stakeholders, tracks remediation plans for model validation limitations, and reports on model risk metrics. The department also develops controls to support a complete and accurate Firm-wide model inventory. The Model Risk Management Department reports on our model risk relative to risk tolerance and presents these reports to the Model Oversight Committee, the FRC, and the Chief Risk Officer. The Chief Risk Officer also provides quarterly updates to the BRC on model risk metrics.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   92  


Table of Contents
Risk Disclosures   LOGO

 

Liquidity Risk

Liquidity risk refers to the risk that we will be unable to finance our operations due to a loss of access to the capital markets or difficulty in liquidating our assets. Liquidity risk also encompasses our ability (or perceived ability) to meet our financial obligations without experiencing significant business disruption or reputational damage that may threaten our viability as a going concern. Liquidity risk also encompasses the associated funding risks triggered by the market or idiosyncratic stress events that may negatively affect our liquidity and may impact our ability to raise new funding. Generally, we incur liquidity and funding risk as a result of our trading, lending, investing and client facilitation activities.

Our Liquidity Risk Management Framework is critical to helping ensure that we maintain sufficient liquidity reserves and durable funding sources to meet our daily obligations and to withstand unanticipated stress events. The Liquidity Risk Department is a distinct area in Risk Management responsible for the oversight and monitoring of liquidity risk. The Liquidity Risk Department is independent of the business units and reports to the Chief Risk Officer. The Liquidity Risk Department ensures transparency of material liquidity and funding risks, compliance with established risk limits and escalation of risk concentrations to appropriate senior management. To execute these responsibilities, the Liquidity Risk Department establishes limits in line with our risk appetite, identifies and analyzes emerging liquidity and funding risks to ensure such risks are appropriately mitigated, monitors and reports risk exposures against metrics and limits, and reviews the methodologies and assumptions underpinning our Liquidity Stress Tests to ensure sufficient liquidity and funding under a range of adverse scenarios. The liquidity and funding risks identified by these processes are summarized in reports produced by the Liquidity Risk Department that are circulated to and discussed with senior management, the FRC, the BRC and the Board, as appropriate.

The Treasury Department and applicable business units have primary responsibility for evaluating, monitoring and controlling the liquidity and funding risks arising from our business activities, and for maintaining processes and controls to manage the key risks inherent in their respective areas. The Liquidity Risk Department coordinates with the Treasury Department and these business units to help ensure a consistent and comprehensive framework for managing liquidity and funding risk across the Firm. See also “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Liquidity and Capital Resources” in Part II, Item 7.

Legal and Compliance Risk

Legal and compliance risk includes the risk of legal or regulatory sanctions, material financial loss, including fines, penalties, judgments, damages and/or settlements, or loss to reputation that we may suffer as a result of failure to comply with laws, regulations, rules, related self-regulatory organization standards and codes of conduct applicable to our business activities. This risk also includes contractual and commercial risk, such as the risk that a counterparty’s performance obligations will be unenforceable. It also includes compliance with anti-money laundering and terrorist financing rules and regulations. We are generally subject to extensive regulation in the different jurisdictions in which we conduct our business (see also “Business—Supervision and Regulation” in Part I, Item 1, and “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A). We have established procedures based on legal and regulatory requirements on a worldwide basis that are designed to facilitate compliance with applicable statutory and regulatory requirements and to require that our policies relating to business conduct, ethics and practices are followed globally. In addition, we have established procedures to mitigate the risk that a counterparty’s performance obligations will be unenforceable, including consideration of counterparty legal authority and capacity, adequacy of legal documentation, the permissibility of a transaction under applicable law and whether applicable bankruptcy or insolvency laws limit or alter contractual remedies. The heightened legal and regulatory focus on the financial services and banking industry presents a continuing business challenge for us.

 

 

  93   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

 

To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of Morgan Stanley:

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Morgan Stanley and subsidiaries (the “Firm”) as of December 31, 2016 and 2015 and the related consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, cash flows, and changes in total equity for the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014. These consolidated financial statements are the responsibility of the Firm’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements based on our audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and

significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, such consolidated financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Firm as of December 31, 2016 and 2015, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.

We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the Firm’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2016, based on the criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission, and our report dated February 27, 2017 expressed an unqualified opinion on the Firm’s internal control over financial reporting.

 

 

/s/ Deloitte & Touche LLP

New York, New York

February 27, 2017

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   94  


Table of Contents
Consolidated Income Statements    LOGO

 

in millions, except per share data          2016                  2015                 2014        

Revenues

       

Investment banking

   $ 4,933      $ 5,594     $ 5,948  

Trading

     10,209        10,114       9,377  

Investments

     160        541       836  

Commissions and fees

     4,109        4,554       4,713  

Asset management, distribution and administration fees

     10,697        10,766       10,570  

Other

     825        493       1,096  

Total non-interest revenues

     30,933        32,062       32,540  

Interest income

     7,016        5,835       5,413  

Interest expense

     3,318        2,742       3,678  

Net interest

     3,698        3,093       1,735  

Net revenues

     34,631        35,155       34,275  

Non-interest expenses

       

Compensation and benefits

     15,878        16,016       17,824  

Occupancy and equipment

     1,308        1,382       1,433  

Brokerage, clearing and exchange fees

     1,920        1,892       1,806  

Information processing and communications

     1,787        1,767       1,635  

Marketing and business development

     587        681       658  

Professional services

     2,128        2,298       2,117  

Other

     2,175        2,624       5,211  

Total non-interest expenses

     25,783        26,660       30,684  

Income from continuing operations before income taxes

     8,848        8,495       3,591  

Provision for (benefit from) income taxes

     2,726        2,200       (90

Income from continuing operations

     6,122        6,295       3,681  

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of income taxes

     1        (16     (14

Net income

   $ 6,123      $ 6,279     $ 3,667  

Net income applicable to noncontrolling interests

     144        152       200  

Net income applicable to Morgan Stanley

   $ 5,979      $ 6,127     $ 3,467  

Preferred stock dividends and other

     471        456       315  

Earnings applicable to Morgan Stanley common shareholders

   $ 5,508      $ 5,671     $ 3,152  

Earnings per basic common share

       

Income from continuing operations

   $ 2.98      $ 2.98     $ 1.65  

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

            (0.01     (0.01

Earnings per basic common share

   $ 2.98      $ 2.97     $ 1.64  

Earnings per diluted common share

       

Income from continuing operations

   $ 2.92      $ 2.91     $ 1.61  

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

            (0.01     (0.01

Earnings per diluted common share

   $ 2.92      $ 2.90     $ 1.60  

Dividends declared per common share

   $ 0.70      $ 0.55     $ 0.35  

Average common shares outstanding

       

Basic

     1,849        1,909       1,924  

Diluted

     1,887        1,953       1,971  

 

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   95   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Consolidated Comprehensive Income Statements    LOGO

 

$ in millions          2016                 2015                 2014        

Net income

   $ 6,123     $ 6,279     $ 3,667  

Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax:

      

Foreign currency translation adjustments

   $ (11   $ (304   $ (491

Change in net unrealized gains (losses) on available for sale securities

     (269     (246     209  

Pension, postretirement and other

     (100     138       33  

Change in net debt valuation adjustment

     (296 )             

Total other comprehensive income (loss)

   $ (676   $ (412   $ (249

Comprehensive income

   $ 5,447     $ 5,867     $ 3,418  

Net income applicable to noncontrolling interests

     144       152       200  

Other comprehensive income (loss) applicable to noncontrolling interests

     (1     (4     (94

Comprehensive income applicable to Morgan Stanley

   $ 5,304     $ 5,719     $ 3,312  

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   96   See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements


Table of Contents
Consolidated Balance Sheets    LOGO

 

$ in millions, except share data   

At

December 31,
2016

   

At

December 31,
2015

 

Assets

    

Cash and due from banks

   $ 22,017     $ 19,827  

Interest bearing deposits with banks

     21,364       34,256  

Trading assets at fair value ($152,548 and $127,627 were pledged to various parties)

     262,154       239,505  

Investment securities (includes $63,170 and $66,759 at fair value)

     80,092       71,983  

Securities purchased under agreements to resell (includes $302 and $806 at fair value)

     101,955       87,657  

Securities borrowed

     125,236       142,416  

Customer and other receivables

     46,460       45,407  

Loans:

 

    

Held for investment (net of allowance of $274 and $225)

     81,704       72,559  

Held for sale

     12,544       13,200  

Goodwill

     6,577       6,584  

Intangible assets (net of accumulated amortization of $2,421 and $2,130)

     2,721       2,984  

Other assets

     52,125       51,087  

Total assets

   $ 814,949     $ 787,465  

Liabilities

    

Deposits (includes $63 and $125 at fair value)

   $ 155,863     $ 156,034  

Short-term borrowings (includes $406 and $1,648 at fair value)

     941       2,173  

Trading liabilities at fair value

     128,194       128,455  

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase (includes $729 and $683 at fair value)

     54,628       36,692  

Securities loaned

     15,844       19,358  

Other secured financings (includes $5,041 and $2,854 at fair value)

     11,118       9,464  

Customer and other payables

     190,513       186,626  

Other liabilities and accrued expenses

     15,896       18,711  

Long-term borrowings (includes $38,736 and $33,045 at fair value)

     164,775       153,768  

Total liabilities

     737,772       711,281  

Commitments and contingent liabilities (see Note 12)

    

Equity

    

Morgan Stanley shareholders’ equity:

    

Preferred stock (see Note 15)

     7,520       7,520  

Common stock, $0.01 par value:

    

Shares authorized: 3,500,000,000; Shares issued: 2,038,893,979; Shares outstanding: 1,852,481,601 and 1,920,024,027

     20       20  

Additional paid-in capital

     23,271       24,153  

Retained earnings

     53,679       49,204  

Employee stock trusts

     2,851       2,409  

Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)

     (2,643     (1,656

Common stock held in treasury at cost, $0.01 par value (186,412,378 and 118,869,952 shares)

     (5,797     (4,059

Common stock issued to employee stock trusts

     (2,851     (2,409

Total Morgan Stanley shareholders’ equity

     76,050       75,182  

Noncontrolling interests

     1,127       1,002  

Total equity

     77,177       76,184  

Total liabilities and equity

   $ 814,949     $ 787,465  

 

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   97   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Total Equity    LOGO

 

$ in millions   Preferred
Stock
    Common
Stock
    Additional
Paid-in
Capital
    Retained
Earnings
    Employee
Stock
Trusts
    Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
Income (Loss)
    Common
Stock
Held in
Treasury
at Cost
    Common
Stock
Issued to
Employee
Stock
Trusts
    Non-
controlling
Interests
    Total
Equity
 

Balance at December 31, 2013

  $ 3,220     $ 20     $ 24,570     $ 42,172     $ 1,718     $ (1,093   $ (2,968   $ (1,718   $ 3,109     $ 69,030  

Net income applicable to Morgan Stanley

                      3,467                                     3,467  

Net income applicable to noncontrolling interests

                                                    200       200  

Dividends

                      (1,014                                   (1,014

Shares issued under employee plans and related tax effects

                (294           409             1,660       (409           1,366  

Repurchases of common stock and employee tax withholdings

                                        (1,458                 (1,458

Net change in Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)

                                  (155                 (94     (249

Issuance of preferred stock

    2,800             (18                                         2,782  

Deconsolidation of certain legal entities associated with a real estate fund

                                                    (1,606     (1,606

Other net decreases

                (9                                   (405     (414

Balance at December 31, 2014

    6,020       20       24,249       44,625       2,127       (1,248     (2,766     (2,127     1,204       72,104  

Net income applicable to Morgan Stanley

                      6,127                                     6,127  

Net income applicable to noncontrolling interests

                                                    152       152  

Dividends

                      (1,548                                   (1,548

Shares issued under employee plans and related tax effects

                (79           282             1,480       (282           1,401  

Repurchases of common stock and employee tax withholdings

                                        (2,773                 (2,773

Net change in Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)

                                  (408                 (4     (412

Issuance of preferred stock

    1,500             (7                                         1,493  

Deconsolidation of certain legal entities associated with a real estate fund

                                                    (191     (191

Other net decreases

                (10                                   (159     (169

Balance at December 31, 2015

    7,520       20       24,153       49,204       2,409       (1,656     (4,059     (2,409     1,002       76,184  

Cumulative adjustment for accounting change related to DVA1

                      312             (312                        

Net adjustment for accounting change related to consolidation2

                                                    106       106  

Net income applicable to Morgan Stanley

                      5,979                                     5,979  

Net income applicable to noncontrolling interests

                                                    144       144  

Dividends

                      (1,816                                   (1,816

Shares issued under employee plans and related tax effects

                (892           442             2,195       (442           1,303  

Repurchases of common stock and employee tax withholdings

                                        (3,933                 (3,933

Net change in Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)

                                  (675                 (1     (676

Other net increases (decreases)

                10                                     (124     (114

Balance at December 31, 2016

  $ 7,520     $ 20     $ 23,271     $ 53,679     $ 2,851     $ (2,643   $ (5,797   $ (2,851   $ 1,127     $ 77,177  

 

1.

Debt valuation adjustment (“DVA”) represents the change in the fair value resulting from fluctuations in the Firm’s credit spreads and other credit factors related to liabilities carried at fair value under the fair value option, primarily related to certain Long-term and Short-term borrowings. In accordance with the early adoption of a provision of the accounting update Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities, a cumulative catch-up adjustment was recorded as of January 1, 2016 to move the cumulative unrealized DVA amount, net of noncontrolling interest and tax, related to outstanding liabilities under the fair value option election from Retained earnings into Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) (“AOCI”). See Notes 2 and 15 for further information.

2.

In accordance with the accounting update Amendments to the Consolidation Analysis, a net adjustment was recorded as of January 1, 2016 to both consolidate and deconsolidate certain entities under the new guidance. See Note 2 for further information.

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   98   See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements


Table of Contents
Consolidated Cash Flow Statements    LOGO

 

$ in millions          2016                 2015                 2014        

Cash flows from operating activities

      

Net income

   $ 6,123     $ 6,279     $ 3,667  

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by (used for) operating activities:

      

Deferred income taxes

     1,579       1,189       (231

(Income) loss from equity method investments

     79       (114     (156

Compensation payable in common stock and options

     1,136       1,104       1,260  

Depreciation and amortization

     1,736       1,433       1,161  

Net gain on sale of available for sale securities

     (112     (84     (40

Impairment charges

     130       69       111  

Provision for credit losses on lending activities

     144       123       23  

Other operating adjustments

     (199     322       (72

Changes in assets and liabilities:

      

Trading assets, net of Trading liabilities

     (24,395     29,471       20,619  

Securities borrowed

     17,180       (5,708     (7,001

Securities loaned

     (3,514     (5,861     (7,580

Customer and other receivables and other assets

     (2,881     8,704       2,204  

Customer and other payables and other liabilities

     1,803       4,373       27,971  

Securities purchased under agreements to resell

     (14,298     (4,369     34,842  

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

     17,936       (33,257     (75,692

Net cash provided by operating activities

     2,447       3,674       1,086  

Cash flows from investing activities

      

Proceeds from (payments for):

      

Other assets—Premises, equipment and software, net

     (1,276     (1,373     (992

Business dispositions, net of cash disposed

           998       989  

Changes in loans, net

     (9,604     (15,816     (20,116

Investment securities:

      

Purchases

     (50,911     (47,291     (32,623

Proceeds from sales

     33,716       37,926       12,980  

Proceeds from paydowns and maturities

     8,367       5,663       4,651  

Other investing activities

     200       (102     (213

Net cash used for investing activities

     (19,508     (19,995     (35,324

Cash flows from financing activities

      

Net proceeds from (payments for):

      

Short-term borrowings

     (1,206     (88     119  

Noncontrolling interests

     (96     (96     (189

Other secured financings

     1,333       (2,370     (2,189

Deposits

     (171     22,490       21,165  

Proceeds from:

      

Excess tax benefits associated with stock-based awards

     61       211       101  

Derivatives financing activities

           512       855  

Issuance of preferred stock, net of issuance costs

           1,493       2,782  

Issuance of long-term borrowings

     43,626       34,182       36,740  

Payments for:

      

Long-term borrowings

     (30,390     (27,289     (33,103

Derivatives financing activities

     (120     (452     (776

Repurchases of common stock and employee tax withholdings

     (3,933     (2,773     (1,458

Cash dividends

     (1,746     (1,455     (904

Other financing activities

     66              

Net cash provided by financing activities

     7,424       24,365       23,143  

Effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents

     (1,065     (945     (1,804

Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

     (10,702     7,099       (12,899

Cash and cash equivalents, at beginning of period

     54,083       46,984       59,883  

Cash and cash equivalents, at end of period

   $ 43,381     $ 54,083     $ 46,984  

Cash and cash equivalents include:

      

Cash and due from banks

   $ 22,017     $ 19,827     $ 21,381  

Interest bearing deposits with banks

     21,364       34,256       25,603  

Cash and cash equivalents, at end of period

   $         43,381     $         54,083     $         46,984  

Supplemental Disclosure of Cash Flow Information

Cash payments for interest were $2,834 million, $2,672 million and $3,575 million for 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

Cash payments for income taxes, net of refunds, were $831 million, $677 million and $886 million for 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

 

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   99   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

1. Introduction and Basis of Presentation

The Firm

Morgan Stanley, a financial holding company, is a global financial services firm that maintains significant market positions in each of its business segments—Institutional Securities, Wealth Management and Investment Management. Morgan Stanley, through its subsidiaries and affiliates, provides a wide variety of products and services to a large and diversified group of clients and customers, including corporations, governments, financial institutions and individuals. Unless the context otherwise requires, the terms “Morgan Stanley” or the “Firm” mean Morgan Stanley (the “Parent Company”) together with its consolidated subsidiaries.

A description of the clients and principal products and services of each of the Firm’s business segments is as follows:

Institutional Securities provides investment banking, sales and trading, lending and other services to corporations, governments, financial institutions, and high to ultra-high net worth clients. Investment banking services consist of capital raising and financial advisory services, including services relating to the underwriting of debt, equity and other securities, as well as advice on mergers and acquisitions, restructurings, real estate and project finance. Sales and trading services include sales, financing and market-making activities in equity and fixed income products, including foreign exchange and commodities, as well as prime brokerage services. Lending services include originating and/or purchasing corporate loans, commercial and residential mortgage lending, asset-backed lending, financing extended to equities and commodities customers, and loans to municipalities. Other activities include investments and research.

Wealth Management provides a comprehensive array of financial services and solutions to individual investors and small to medium-sized businesses and institutions covering brokerage and investment advisory services, financial and wealth planning services, annuity and insurance products, credit and other lending products, banking and retirement plan services.

Investment Management provides a broad range of investment strategies and products that span geographies, asset classes, and public and private markets to a diverse group of clients across institutional and intermediary channels. Strategies and products include equity, fixed income, liquidity and alternative/other products. Institutional clients include defined benefit/defined contribution plans, foundations, endowments, government entities, sovereign wealth

funds, insurance companies, third-party fund sponsors and corporations. Individual clients are serviced through intermediaries, including affiliated and non-affiliated distributors.

Basis of Financial Information

The consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (“U.S. GAAP”), which require the Firm to make estimates and assumptions regarding the valuations of certain financial instruments, the valuation of goodwill and intangible assets, compensation, deferred tax assets, the outcome of legal and tax matters, allowance for credit losses and other matters that affect its consolidated financial statements and related disclosures. The Firm believes that the estimates utilized in the preparation of its consolidated financial statements are prudent and reasonable. Actual results could differ materially from these estimates. Intercompany balances and transactions have been eliminated. Certain reclassifications have been made to prior periods to conform to the current presentation.

Consolidation

The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Firm, its wholly owned subsidiaries and other entities in which the Firm has a controlling financial interest, including certain variable interest entities (“VIE”) (see Note 13). For consolidated subsidiaries that are less than wholly owned, the third-party holdings of equity interests are referred to as noncontrolling interests. The net income attributable to noncontrolling interests for such subsidiaries is presented as Net income applicable to noncontrolling interests in the consolidated income statements. The portion of shareholders’ equity that is attributable to noncontrolling interests for such subsidiaries is presented as noncontrolling interests, a component of total equity, in the consolidated balance sheets.

For entities where (1) the total equity investment at risk is sufficient to enable the entity to finance its activities without additional subordinated financial support and (2) the equity holders bear the economic residual risks and returns of the entity and have the power to direct the activities of the entity that most significantly affect its economic performance, the Firm consolidates those entities it controls either through a majority voting interest or otherwise. For VIEs (i.e., entities that do not meet these criteria), the Firm consolidates those entities where it has the power to make the decisions that most significantly affect the economic performance of the VIE and has the obligation to absorb losses or the right to receive benefits that could potentially be significant to the VIE, except for certain VIEs that are money market funds, investment companies or entities qualifying for accounting purposes as investment companies. Generally, the Firm

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   100  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

consolidates those entities when it absorbs a majority of the expected losses or a majority of the expected residual returns, or both, of the entities.

For investments in entities in which the Firm does not have a controlling financial interest but has significant influence over operating and financial decisions, it generally applies the equity method of accounting with net gains and losses recorded within Other revenues (see Note 8). Where the Firm has elected to measure certain eligible investments at fair value in accordance with the fair value option, net gains and losses are recorded within Investments revenues (see Note 3).

Equity and partnership interests held by entities qualifying for accounting purposes as investment companies are carried at fair value.

The Firm’s significant regulated U.S. and international subsidiaries include Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC (“MS&Co.”), Morgan Stanley Smith Barney LLC (“MSSB LLC”), Morgan Stanley & Co. International plc (“MSIP”), Morgan Stanley MUFG Securities Co., Ltd. (“MSMS”), Morgan Stanley Bank, N.A. (“MSBNA”) and Morgan Stanley Private Bank, National Association (“MSPBNA”).

Consolidated Cash Flow Statements Presentation

For purposes of the consolidated cash flow statements, cash and cash equivalents consist of Cash and due from banks and Interest bearing deposits with banks, which include highly liquid investments with original maturities of three months or less, that are held for investment purposes and are readily convertible to known amounts of cash.

The adoption of the accounting update, Amendments to the Consolidation Analysis (see Note 2) on January 1, 2016 resulted in a net noncash increase in total assets of $126 million. The Firm deconsolidated approximately $244 million and $1.6 billion in 2015 and 2014, respectively, in net assets previously attributable to noncontrolling interests that were primarily related to or associated with real estate funds sponsored by the Firm. The deconsolidations resulted in a noncash reduction of assets of $222 million in 2015 and $1.3 billion in 2014.

Dispositions

The Firm completed the sale of its global oil merchanting unit of the commodities division to Castleton Commodities International LLC on November 1, 2015. The Firm recognized an impairment charge of approximately $71 million in Other revenues. The transaction did not meet the criteria for discontinued operations and did not have a material impact on the Firm’s financial results.

On July 1, 2014, the Firm completed the sale of its ownership stake in TransMontaigne Inc., a U.S.-based oil storage, marketing and transportation company, as well as related physical inventory and the assumption of its obligations under certain terminal storage contracts, to NGL Energy Partners LP. The gain on sale of $112 million is recorded in Other revenues.

On March 27, 2014, the Firm completed the sale of Canterm Canadian Terminals Inc., a public storage terminal operator for refined products with two distribution terminals in Canada. The gain on sale was approximately $45 million and is recorded in Other revenues.

2. Significant Accounting Policies

Revenue Recognition

Investment Banking

Underwriting revenues and advisory fees from mergers, acquisitions and restructuring transactions are recorded when services for the transactions are determined to be substantially completed, generally as set forth under the terms of the engagement. Transaction-related expenses, primarily consisting of legal, travel and other costs directly associated with the transaction, are deferred and recognized in the same period as the related investment banking transaction revenues. Underwriting revenues are presented net of related expenses. Non-reimbursed expenses associated with advisory transactions are recorded within Non-interest expenses.

Commissions and Fees

Commission and fee revenues are recognized on trade date. Commission and fee revenues primarily arise from agency transactions in listed and over-the-counter (“OTC”) equity securities; services related to sales and trading activities; and sales of mutual funds, futures, insurance products and options.

Asset Management, Distribution and Administration Fees

Asset management, distribution and administration fees are recognized over the relevant contract period. Sales commissions paid by the Firm in connection with the sale of certain classes of shares of its open-end mutual fund products are accounted for as deferred commission assets. The Firm periodically tests deferred commission assets for recoverability based on cash flows expected to be received in future periods.

In certain management fee arrangements, the Firm is entitled to receive performance-based fees (which also may be referred to as incentive fees and which include carried interest) when the return on assets under management exceeds certain benchmark returns or other performance targets. In such arrangements, performance fee revenues are accrued (or reversed) quarterly based on measuring account or fund performance to date versus the performance bench-

 

 

  101   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

mark stated in the investment management agreement. Performance-based fees are recorded within Investments or Asset management, distribution and administration fees depending on the nature of the arrangement.

The Firm’s portion of the unrealized cumulative amount of performance-based fee revenues (for which the Firm is not obligated to pay compensation) at risk of reversing if fund performance falls below stated investment management agreement benchmarks was approximately $397 million and $422 million at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively. See Note 12 for information regarding general partner guarantees, which include potential obligations to return performance fee distributions previously received.

Fair Value of Financial Instruments

Instruments within Trading assets and Trading liabilities are measured at fair value, either in accordance with accounting guidance or through the fair value option election (discussed below). These financial instruments primarily represent the Firm’s trading and investment positions and include both cash and derivative products. In addition, debt securities classified as available-for-sale (“AFS”) securities are measured at fair value.

Gains and losses on instruments carried at fair value are reflected in Trading revenues, Investments revenues or Investment banking revenues in the consolidated income statements, except for AFS securities (see “Investment Securities—Available for Sale and Held to Maturity” section herein and Note 5) and derivatives accounted for as hedges (see “Hedge Accounting” section herein and Note 4).

Interest income and interest expense are recorded within the consolidated income statements depending on the nature of the instrument and related market conventions. When interest is included as a component of the instruments’ fair value, interest is included within Trading revenues or Investments revenues. Otherwise, it is included within Interest income or Interest expense. Dividend income is recorded in Trading revenues or Investments revenues depending on the business activity.

The fair value of OTC financial instruments, including derivative contracts related to financial instruments and commodities, is presented in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets on a net-by-counterparty basis, when appropriate. Additionally, the Firm nets the fair value of cash collateral paid or received against the fair value amounts recognized for net derivative positions executed with the same counterparty under the same master netting agreement.

Fair Value Option

The fair value option permits the irrevocable fair value option election at initial recognition of an asset or liability or upon an event that gives rise to a new basis of accounting for that instrument. The Firm applies the fair value option for eligible instruments, including certain Securities purchased under agreements to resell, loans and lending commitments, equity method investments, Deposits (structured certificate of deposits), Short-term borrowings (primarily structured notes), Securities sold under agreements to repurchase, Other secured financings and Long-term borrowings (primarily structured notes).

Fair Value Measurement—Definition and Hierarchy

Fair value is defined as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability (i.e., the “exit price”) in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date.

In determining fair value, the Firm uses various valuation approaches and establishes a hierarchy for inputs used in measuring fair value that maximizes the use of relevant observable inputs and minimizes the use of unobservable inputs by requiring that the most observable inputs be used when available.

Observable inputs are inputs that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability that were developed based on market data obtained from sources independent of the Firm. Unobservable inputs are inputs that reflect assumptions the Firm believes other market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability that are developed based on the best information available in the circumstances. The hierarchy is broken down into three levels based on the observability of inputs as follows:

Level 1.    Valuations based on quoted prices in active markets that the Firm has the ability to access for identical assets or liabilities. Valuation adjustments and block discounts are not applied to Level 1 instruments. Since valuations are based on quoted prices that are readily and regularly available in an active market, valuation of these products does not entail a significant degree of judgment.

Level 2.    Valuations based on one or more quoted prices in markets that are not active or for which all significant inputs are observable, either directly or indirectly.

Level 3.    Valuations based on inputs that are unobservable and significant to the overall fair value measurement.

The availability of observable inputs can vary from product to product and is affected by a wide variety of factors,

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   102  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

including, for example, the type of product, whether the product is new and not yet established in the marketplace, the liquidity of markets and other characteristics particular to the product. To the extent that valuation is based on models or inputs that are less observable or unobservable in the market, the determination of fair value requires more judgment. Accordingly, the degree of judgment exercised by the Firm in determining fair value is greatest for instruments categorized in Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy.

The Firm considers prices and inputs that are current as of the measurement date, including during periods of market dislocation. In periods of market dislocation, the observability of prices and inputs may be reduced for many instruments. This condition could cause an instrument to be reclassified from Level 1 to Level 2 or from Level 2 to Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy (see Note 3).

In certain cases, the inputs used to measure fair value may fall into different levels of the fair value hierarchy. In such cases, for disclosure purposes, the level in the fair value hierarchy within which the fair value measurement falls in its entirety is determined based on the lowest level input that is significant to the fair value measurement in its entirety.

For assets and liabilities that are transferred between levels in the fair value hierarchy during the period, fair values are ascribed as if the assets or liabilities had been transferred as of the beginning of the period.

Valuation Techniques

Many cash instruments and OTC derivative contracts have bid and ask prices that can be observed in the marketplace. Bid prices reflect the highest price that a party is willing to pay for an asset. Ask prices represent the lowest price that a party is willing to accept for an asset. The Firm carries positions at the point within the bid-ask range that meet its best estimate of fair value. For offsetting positions in the same financial instrument, the same price within the bid-ask spread is used to measure both the long and short positions.

Fair value for many cash instruments and OTC derivative contracts is derived using pricing models. Pricing models take into account the contract terms, as well as multiple inputs, including, where applicable, commodity prices, equity prices, interest rate yield curves, credit curves, correlation, creditworthiness of the counterparty, creditworthiness of the Firm, option volatility and currency rates.

Where appropriate, valuation adjustments are made to account for various factors such as liquidity risk (bid-ask adjustments), credit quality, model uncertainty and concentration risk. Adjustments for liquidity risk adjust model-derived mid-market levels of Level 2 and Level 3 financial instru-

ments for the bid-mid or mid-ask spread required to properly reflect the exit price of a risk position. Bid-mid and mid-ask spreads are marked to levels observed in trade activity, broker quotes or other external third-party data. Where these spreads are unobservable for the particular position in question, spreads are derived from observable levels of similar positions.

The Firm applies credit-related valuation adjustments to its short-term and long-term borrowings (primarily structured notes) for which the fair value option was elected and to OTC derivatives. The Firm considers the impact of changes in its own credit spreads based upon observations of the secondary bond market spreads when measuring the fair value for short-term and long-term borrowings.

For OTC derivatives, the impact of changes in both the Firm’s and the counterparty’s credit rating is considered when measuring fair value. In determining the expected exposure, the Firm simulates the distribution of the future exposure to a counterparty, then applies market-based default probabilities to the future exposure, leveraging external third-party credit default swap (“CDS”) spread data. Where CDS spread data are unavailable for a specific counterparty, bond market spreads, CDS spread data based on the counterparty’s credit rating or CDS spread data that reference a comparable counterparty may be utilized. The Firm also considers collateral held and legally enforceable master netting agreements that mitigate its exposure to each counterparty.

Adjustments for model uncertainty are taken for positions whose underlying models are reliant on significant inputs that are neither directly nor indirectly observable, hence requiring reliance on established theoretical concepts in their derivation. These adjustments are derived by making assessments of the possible degree of variability using statistical approaches and market-based information where possible.

The Firm may apply a concentration adjustment to certain of its OTC derivatives portfolios to reflect the additional cost of closing out a particularly large risk exposure. Where possible, these adjustments are based on observable market information, but in many instances, significant judgment is required to estimate the costs of closing out concentrated risk exposures due to the lack of liquidity in the marketplace.

The Firm applies funding valuation adjustments (“FVA”) into the fair value measurements of OTC uncollateralized or partially collateralized derivatives and in collateralized derivatives where the terms of the agreement do not permit the reuse of the collateral received. The Firm’s implementation of FVA reflects the inclusion of FVA in the pricing and valuations by the majority of market participants involved in its principal exit market for these instruments. In general, FVA

 

 

  103   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

reflects a market funding risk premium inherent in the noted derivative instruments. The methodology for measuring FVA leverages the Firm’s existing credit-related valuation adjustment calculation methodologies, which apply to both assets and liabilities.

Fair value is a market-based measure considered from the perspective of a market participant rather than an entity-specific measure. Therefore, even when market assumptions are not readily available, assumptions are set to reflect those that the Firm believes market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability at the measurement date. Where the Firm manages a group of financial assets and financial liabilities on the basis of its net exposure to either market risks or credit risk, the Firm measures the fair value of that group of financial instruments consistently with how market participants would price the net risk exposure at the measurement date.

See Note 3 for a description of valuation techniques applied to the major categories of financial instruments measured at fair value.

Assets and Liabilities Measured at Fair Value on a Non-Recurring Basis

Certain of the Firm’s assets and liabilities are measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis. The Firm incurs losses or gains for any adjustments of these assets or liabilities to fair value.

For assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis, fair value is determined by using various valuation approaches. The same hierarchy for inputs as described above, which maximizes the use of observable inputs and minimizes the use of unobservable inputs by generally requiring that the observable inputs be used when available, is used in measuring fair value for these items.

Valuation Process

The Valuation Review Group (“VRG”) within the Firm’s Financial Control Group (“FCG”) is responsible for the Firm’s fair value valuation policies, processes and procedures. VRG is independent of the business units and reports to the Chief Financial Officer (“CFO”), who has final authority over the valuation of the Firm’s financial instruments. VRG implements valuation control processes designed to validate the fair value of the Firm’s financial instruments measured at fair value, including those derived from pricing models.

Model Review.    VRG, in conjunction with the Model Risk Management Department (“MRM”), which reports to the Chief Risk Officer, independently review valuation models’ theoretical soundness, the appropriateness of the valuation methodology and calibration techniques developed by the business units using observable inputs. Where inputs are not observable, VRG reviews the appropriateness of the proposed valuation methodology to determine that it is consistent with how a market participant would arrive at the unobservable input. The valuation methodologies utilized in the absence of observable inputs may include extrapolation techniques and the use of comparable observable inputs. As part of the review, VRG develops a methodology to independently verify the fair value generated by the business unit’s valuation models. The Firm generally subjects valuations and models to a review process initially and on a periodic basis thereafter.

Independent Price Verification.    The business units are responsible for determining the fair value of financial instruments using approved valuation models and valuation methodologies. Generally on a monthly basis, VRG independently validates the fair values of financial instruments determined using valuation models by determining the appropriateness of the inputs used by the business units and by testing compliance with the documented valuation methodologies approved in the model review process described above.

The results of this independent price verification and any adjustments made by VRG to the fair value generated by the business units are presented to management of the Firm’s three business segments (i.e., Institutional Securities, Wealth Management and Investment Management), the CFO and the Chief Risk Officer on a regular basis.

VRG uses recently executed transactions, other observable market data such as exchange data, broker-dealer quotes, third-party pricing vendors and aggregation services for validating the fair value of financial instruments generated using valuation models. VRG assesses the external sources and their valuation methodologies to determine if the external providers meet the minimum standards expected of a third-party pricing source. Pricing data provided by approved external sources are evaluated using a number of approaches; for example, by corroborating the external sources’ prices to executed trades, by analyzing the methodology and assumptions used by the external source to generate a price, and/or by evaluating how active the third-party pricing source (or originating sources used by the third-party pricing source) is in the market. Based on this analysis, VRG generates a ranking of the observable market data designed to ensure that the highest-ranked market data source is used to validate the business unit’s fair value of financial instruments.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   104  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

VRG reviews the models and valuation methodology used to price new material Level 2 and Level 3 transactions, and both FCG and MRM must approve the fair value of the trade that is initially recognized.

Level 3 Transactions.    VRG reviews the business unit’s valuation techniques to assess whether these are consistent with market participant assumptions.

For further information on financial assets and liabilities that are measured at fair value on a recurring and non-recurring basis, see Note 3.

Offsetting of Derivative Instruments

In connection with its derivative activities, the Firm generally enters into master netting agreements and collateral agreements with its counterparties. These agreements provide the Firm with the right, in the event of a default by the counterparty, to net a counterparty’s rights and obligations under the agreement and to liquidate and set off collateral against any net amount owed by the counterparty.

However, in certain circumstances, the Firm may not have such an agreement in place; the relevant insolvency regime may not support the enforceability of the master netting agreement or collateral agreement; or the Firm may not have sought legal advice to support the enforceability of the agreement. In cases where the Firm has not determined an agreement to be enforceable, the related amounts are not offset in the tabular disclosures (see Note 4).

The Firm’s policy is generally to receive securities and cash posted as collateral (with rights of rehypothecation), irrespective of the enforceability determination regarding the master netting and collateral agreement. In certain cases, the Firm may agree for such collateral to be posted to a third-party custodian under a control agreement that enables it to take control of such collateral in the event of a counterparty default. The enforceability of the master netting agreement is taken into account in the Firm’s risk management practices and application of counterparty credit limits.

For information related to offsetting of derivatives and certain collateralized transactions, see Notes 4 and 6, respectively.

Hedge Accounting

The Firm applies hedge accounting using various derivative financial instruments for the following types of hedges: hedges of changes in fair value of assets and liabilities due to the risk being hedged (fair value hedges); and hedges of net investments in foreign operations whose functional currency is different from the reporting currency of the Parent Company (net investment hedges). These financial instru-

ments are included within Trading assets—Derivative and other contracts or Trading liabilities—Derivative and other contracts in the consolidated balance sheets. For hedges where hedge accounting is being applied, the Firm performs effectiveness testing and other procedures.

Fair Value Hedges—Interest Rate Risk

The Firm’s designated fair value hedges consist primarily of interest rate swaps designated as fair value hedges of changes in the benchmark interest rate of fixed rate senior long-term borrowings. The Firm uses regression analysis to perform an ongoing prospective and retrospective assessment of the effectiveness of these hedging relationships. A hedging relationship is deemed effective if the change in fair value of the hedging instrument (derivative) and the change in fair value of the hedged item (debt liability) due to changes in the benchmark interest rate offset within a range of 80% to 125%. The Firm considers the impact of valuation adjustments related to its own credit spreads and counterparty credit spreads to determine whether they would cause the hedging relationship to be ineffective.

For qualifying fair value hedges of benchmark interest rates, the changes in the fair value of the derivative and the changes in the fair value of the hedged liability provide offset of one another and, together with any resulting ineffectiveness, are recorded in Interest expense. When a derivative is de-designated as a hedge, any basis adjustment remaining on the hedged liability is amortized to Interest expense over the remaining life of the liability using the effective interest method.

Net Investment Hedges

The Firm uses forward foreign exchange contracts to manage a portion of the currency exposure relating to its net investments in non-U.S. dollar functional currency operations. To the extent that the notional amounts of the hedging instruments equal the portion of the investments being hedged and the underlying exchange rate of the derivative hedging instrument relates to the exchange rate between the functional currency of the investee and the Parent Company’s functional currency, no hedge ineffectiveness is recognized in earnings. If these exchange rates are not the same, the Firm uses regression analysis to assess the prospective and retrospective effectiveness of the hedge relationships, and any ineffectiveness is recognized in Interest income. The gain or loss from revaluing hedges of net investments in foreign operations at the spot rate is reported within AOCI. The forward points on the hedging instruments are excluded from hedge effectiveness testing and are recorded in Interest income.

For further information on derivative instruments and hedging activities, see Note 4.

 

 

  105   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Loans

The Firm accounts for loans based on the following categories: loans held for investment; loans held for sale; and loans at fair value.

Loans Held for Investment

Loans held for investment are reported at outstanding principal adjusted for any charge-offs, the allowance for loan losses, any unamortized deferred fees or costs for originated loans, and any unamortized premiums or discounts for purchased loans.

Interest Income.    Interest income on performing loans held for investment is accrued and recognized as interest income at the contractual rate of interest. Purchase price discounts or premiums, as well as net deferred loan fees or costs, are amortized into interest income over the life of the loan to produce a level rate of return.

Allowance for Loan Losses.    The allowance for loan losses estimates probable losses related to loans specifically identified for impairment in addition to the probable losses inherent in the held for investment loan portfolio.

The Firm utilizes the U.S. banking regulators’ definition of criticized exposures, which consist of the special mention substandard, doubtful and loss categories as credit quality indicators. For further information on the credit indicators, see Note 7. Substandard loans are regularly reviewed for impairment. Factors considered by management when determining impairment include payment status, fair value of collateral, and probability of collecting scheduled principal and interest payments when due. The impairment analysis required depends on the nature and type of loans. Loans classified as Doubtful or Loss are considered impaired.

There are two components of the allowance for loan losses: the specific allowance component and the inherent allowance component.

The specific allowance component of the allowance for loan losses is used to estimate probable losses for non-homogeneous exposures that have been specifically identified for impairment analysis by the Firm and determined to be impaired. When a loan is specifically identified for impairment, the impairment is measured based on the present value of expected future cash flows discounted at the loan’s effective interest rate or as a practical expedient, the observable market price of the loan or the fair value of the collateral if the loan is collateral dependent. If the present value of the expected future cash flows (or alternatively, the observable market price of the loan or the fair value of the collateral) is less than the recorded investment in the loan, then the Firm

recognizes an allowance and a charge to the provision for loan losses within Other revenues.

The inherent allowance component of the allowance for loan losses is used to estimate the probable losses inherent in the loan portfolio and includes non-homogeneous loans that have not been identified as impaired and portfolios of smaller balance homogeneous loans. The Firm maintains methodologies by loan product for calculating an allowance for loan losses that estimates the inherent losses in the loan portfolio. Generally, inherent losses in the portfolio for non-impaired loans are estimated using statistical analysis and judgment around the exposure at default, the probability of default and the loss given default. Qualitative and environmental factors such as economic and business conditions, nature and volume of the portfolio, and lending terms and volume and severity of past due loans may also be considered in the calculations. The allowance for loan losses is maintained at a level reasonable to ensure that it can adequately absorb the estimated probable losses inherent in the portfolio. The Firm recognizes an allowance and a charge to the provision for loan losses within Other revenues.

Troubled Debt Restructurings.    The Firm may modify the terms of certain loans for economic or legal reasons related to a borrower’s financial difficulties by granting one or more concessions that the Firm would not otherwise consider. Such modifications are accounted for and reported as troubled debt restructurings (“TDRs”). A loan that has been modified in a TDR is generally considered to be impaired and is evaluated for the extent of impairment using the Firm’s specific allowance methodology. TDRs are also generally classified as nonaccrual and may only be returned to accrual status after considering the borrower’s sustained repayment performance for a reasonable period.

Nonaccrual Loans.    The Firm places loans on nonaccrual status if principal or interest is past due for a period of 90 days or more or payment of principal or interest is in doubt unless the obligation is well-secured and in the process of collection. A loan is considered past due when a payment due according to the contractual terms of the loan agreement has not been remitted by the borrower. Substandard loans, if identified as impaired, are categorized as nonaccrual. Loans classified as Doubtful or Loss are categorized as nonaccrual.

Payments received on nonaccrual loans held for investment are applied to principal if there is doubt regarding the ultimate collectability of principal (i.e., cost recovery method). If collection of the principal of nonaccrual loans held for investment is not in doubt, interest income is recognized on a cash basis. If neither principal nor interest collection is in doubt, loans are on accrual status, and interest income is recognized using the effective interest method. Loans that are on nonac-

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   106  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

crual status may not be restored to accrual status until all delinquent principal and/or interest has been brought current after a reasonable period of performance, typically a minimum of six months.

Charge-offs.    The Firm charges off a loan in the period that it is deemed uncollectible and records a reduction in the allowance for loan losses and the balance of the loan. In general, any portion of the recorded investment in a collateral dependent loan (including any capitalized accrued interest, net deferred loan fees or costs, and unamortized premium or discount) in excess of the fair value of the collateral that can be identified as uncollectible, and is therefore deemed a confirmed loss, is charged off against the allowance for loan losses. A loan is collateral dependent if the repayment of the loan is expected to be provided solely by the sale or operation of the underlying collateral. In addition, for loan transfers from loans held for investment to loans held for sale, at the time of transfer, any reduction in the loan value is reflected as a charge-off of the recorded investment, resulting in a new cost basis.

Lending Commitments.    The Firm records the liability and related expense for the credit exposure related to commitments to fund loans that will be held for investment in a manner similar to outstanding loans disclosed above. The analysis also incorporates a credit conversion factor, which is the expected utilization of the undrawn commitment. The liability is recorded in Other liabilities and accrued expenses in the consolidated balance sheets, and the expense is recorded in Other non-interest expenses in the consolidated income statements. For more information regarding loan commitments, standby letters of credit and financial guarantees, see Note 12.

Loans Held for Sale

Loans held for sale are measured at the lower of cost or fair value, with valuation changes recorded in Other revenues. The Firm determines the valuation allowance on an individual loan basis, except for residential mortgage loans for which the valuation allowance is determined at the loan product level. Any decreases in fair value below the initial carrying amount and any recoveries in fair value up to the initial carrying amount are recorded in Other revenues. However, increases in fair value above initial carrying value are not recognized.

Interest income on loans held for sale is accrued and recognized based on the contractual rate of interest. Loan origination fees or costs and purchase price discounts or premiums are deferred in a contra loan account until the related loan is sold. The deferred fees or costs and discounts or premiums are an adjustment to the basis of the loan and, therefore, are

included in the periodic determination of the lower of cost or fair value adjustments and/or the gain or loss recognized at the time of sale.

Lending Commitments.    Commitments to fund non-mortgage loans held for sale are not derivatives. The Firm records the liability and related expense for the fair value exposure (if the fair value is below the cost) related to commitments to fund non-mortgage loans that will be held for sale in Other liabilities and accrued expenses in the consolidated balance sheets with an offset to Other revenues in the consolidated income statements. Commitments to fund mortgage loans held for sale are derivatives. The Firm records the derivative asset or liability exposure in Trading assets or Trading liabilities in the consolidated balance sheets with an offset to Trading revenues in the consolidated income statements.

Loans and lending commitments held for sale are subject to the nonaccrual policies described above. Because loans and lending commitments held for sale are recognized at the lower of cost or fair value, the allowance for loan losses and charge-off policies does not apply to these loans.

Loans at Fair Value

Loans for which the fair value option is elected are carried at fair value, with changes in fair value recognized in earnings. Loans carried at fair value are not evaluated for purposes of recording an allowance for loan losses. For further information on loans carried at fair value and classified as Trading assets and Trading liabilities, see Note 3.

Lending Commitments.    The Firm records the liability and related expense for the fair value exposure related to commitments to fund loans that will be measured at fair value. The liability is recorded in Trading liabilities in the consolidated balance sheets, and the expense is recorded in Trading revenues in the consolidated income statements.

For further information on loans, see Note 7.

Transfers of Financial Assets

Transfers of financial assets are accounted for as sales when the Firm has relinquished control over the transferred assets. Any related gain or loss on sale is recorded in Net revenues. Transfers that are not accounted for as sales are treated as a collateralized financing, in certain cases referred to as “failed sales.” Securities borrowed or purchased under agreements to resell and securities loaned or sold under agreements to repurchase are treated as collateralized financings (see Note 6). Securities purchased under agreements to resell (“reverse repurchase agreements”) and Securities sold under agreements to repurchase (“repurchase agreements”) are carried on the consolidated balance sheets at the amounts of

 

 

  107   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

cash paid or received, plus accrued interest, except for certain repurchase agreements for which the Firm has elected the fair value option (see Note 3). Where appropriate, repurchase agreements and reverse repurchase agreements with the same counterparty are reported on a net basis. Securities borrowed and securities loaned are recorded at the amount of cash collateral advanced or received.

Premises, Equipment and Software Costs

Premises, equipment and software costs consist of buildings, leasehold improvements, furniture, fixtures, computer and communications equipment, power generation assets, terminals, pipelines and software (externally purchased and developed for internal use). Premises, equipment and software costs are stated at cost less accumulated depreciation and amortization and are included in Other assets in the consolidated balance sheets. Depreciation and amortization are provided by the straight-line method over the estimated useful life of the asset. Estimated useful lives are generally as follows: buildings—39 years; furniture and fixtures—7 years; computer and communications equipment—3 to 9 years; power generation assets—15 to 29 years; and terminals, pipelines and equipment—3 to 30 years. Estimated useful lives for software costs are generally 3 to 10 years.

Leasehold improvements are amortized over the lesser of the estimated useful life of the asset or, where applicable, the remaining term of the lease but generally not exceeding 25 years for building structural improvements and 15 years for other improvements.

Premises, equipment and software costs are tested for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances suggest that an asset’s carrying value may not be fully recoverable in accordance with current accounting guidance.

Goodwill and Intangible Assets

The Firm tests goodwill for impairment on an annual basis and on an interim basis when certain events or circumstances exist. The Firm tests for impairment at the reporting unit level, which is generally at the level of or one level below its business segments. For both the annual and interim tests, the Firm has the option to first assess qualitative factors to determine whether the existence of events or circumstances leads to a determination that it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying amount. If after assessing the totality of events or circumstances, the Firm determines it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is greater than its carrying amount, then performing the two-step impairment test is not required. However, if the Firm concludes otherwise, then it is required to perform the first step of the two-step impairment test.

Goodwill impairment is determined by comparing the estimated fair value of a reporting unit with its respective carrying value. If the estimated fair value exceeds the carrying value, goodwill at the reporting unit level is not deemed to be impaired. If the estimated fair value is below carrying value, however, further analysis is required to determine the amount of the impairment. The estimated fair values of the reporting units are derived based on valuation techniques the Firm believes market participants would use for each of the reporting units.

The estimated fair values are generally determined by utilizing a discounted cash flow methodology or methodologies that incorporate price-to-book and price-to-earnings multiples of certain comparable companies.

Goodwill is not amortized but, as noted above, is reviewed annually (or more frequently when certain events or circumstances exist) for impairment. Other intangible assets are amortized over their estimated useful lives and reviewed for impairment. Impairment losses are recorded within Other expenses in the consolidated income statements.

Income Taxes

The Firm accounts for income tax expense (benefit) using the asset and liability method. Under this method, deferred tax assets and liabilities are recorded based upon the temporary differences between the financial statement and income tax bases of assets and liabilities using currently enacted tax rates in effect for the year in which the differences are expected to reverse. The effect of a change in tax rates on deferred tax assets and liabilities is recognized in income tax expense (benefit) in the period that includes the enactment date.

The Firm recognizes net deferred tax assets to the extent that it believes these assets are more likely than not to be realized. In making such a determination, the Firm considers all available positive and negative evidence, including future reversals of existing taxable temporary differences, projected future taxable income, tax planning strategies and results of recent operations. If a deferred tax asset is determined to be unrealizable, a valuation allowance is established. If the Firm determines that it would be able to realize deferred tax assets in the future in excess of their net recorded amount, it would make an adjustment to the deferred tax asset valuation allowance, which would reduce the provision for income taxes.

Uncertain tax positions are recorded on the basis of a two-step process, whereby (1) the Firm determines whether it is more likely than not that the tax positions will be sustained

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   108  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

on the basis of the technical merits of the position and (2) for those tax positions that meet the more-likely-than-not recognition threshold, the Firm recognizes the largest amount of tax benefit that is more than 50% likely to be realized upon ultimate settlement with the related tax authority. Interest and penalties related to unrecognized tax benefits are classified as provision for income taxes.

Earnings per Common Share

Basic earnings per common share (“EPS”) is computed by dividing earnings available to Morgan Stanley common shareholders by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding for the period. Earnings available to Morgan Stanley common shareholders represents net income applicable to Morgan Stanley reduced by preferred stock dividends and allocations of earnings to participating securities. Common shares outstanding include common stock and vested restricted stock units (“RSUs”) where recipients have satisfied either the explicit vesting terms or retirement-eligibility requirements. Diluted EPS reflects the assumed conversion of all dilutive securities.

Unvested share-based payment awards that contain non-forfeitable rights to dividends or dividend equivalents (whether paid or unpaid) are participating securities and are included in the computation of EPS pursuant to the two-class method. Share-based payment awards that pay dividend equivalents subject to vesting are not deemed participating securities and are included in diluted shares outstanding (if dilutive) under the treasury stock method.

The Firm has granted performance-based stock units (“PSUs”) that vest and convert to shares of common stock only if it satisfies predetermined performance and market goals. Since the issuance of the shares is contingent upon the satisfaction of certain conditions, the PSUs are included in diluted EPS based on the number of shares (if any) that would be issuable if the end of the reporting period was the end of the contingency period.

For the calculation of basic and diluted EPS, see Note 16.

Deferred Compensation

Stock-Based Compensation

The Firm measures compensation cost for stock-based awards at fair value and recognizes compensation cost over the service period, net of estimated forfeitures. The Firm determines the fair value of RSUs (including RSUs with non-market performance conditions) based on the grant-date fair value of its common stock, measured as the volume-weighted average price on the date of grant. RSUs with market-based conditions are valued using a Monte Carlo

valuation model. The fair value of stock options is determined using the Black-Scholes valuation model and the single grant life method. Under the single grant life method, option awards with graded vesting are valued using a single weighted average expected option life.

Compensation expense for stock-based compensation awards is recognized using the graded vesting attribution method. Compensation expense for awards with performance conditions is recognized based on the probable outcome of the performance condition at each reporting date. Compensation expense for awards with market-based conditions is recognized irrespective of the probability of the market condition being achieved and is not reversed if the market condition is not met.

The Firm recognizes the expense for stock-based awards over the requisite service period. These awards generally contain clawback and cancellation provisions. Certain awards provide the Firm discretion to cancel all or a portion of the award under specified circumstances. Compensation expense for those awards is adjusted for changes in the fair value of the Firm’s common stock or the relevant model valuation, as appropriate, until conversion, exercise or expiration.

For year-end stock-based awards anticipated to be granted to retirement-eligible employees under award terms that do not contain a future service requirement, the Firm accrues the estimated cost over the course of the calendar year preceding the grant date. The Firm believes that this method of recognition for retirement-eligible employees reflects the period over which the compensation is earned.

Employee Stock Trusts

In connection with certain stock-based compensation plans, the Firm maintains and utilizes at its discretion trusts, referred to as “Employee stock trusts.” The assets of the Employee stock trusts are consolidated and, as such, are accounted for in a manner similar to treasury stock, where the shares of common stock outstanding are offset by an equal amount in Common stock issued to employee stock trusts.

The Firm uses the grant-date fair value of stock-based compensation as the basis for recognition of the assets in the Employee stock trusts. Subsequent changes in the fair value are not recognized as the Firm’s stock-based compensation plans do not permit diversification and must be settled by the delivery of a fixed number of shares of the Firm’s common stock.

Deferred Cash-Based Compensation

Compensation expense for deferred cash-based compensation plans is calculated based on the notional value of the award

 

 

  109   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

granted, adjusted for changes in the fair value of the referenced investments. For unvested awards, the expense is recognized over the service period using the graded vesting attribution method. For vested awards with only notional earnings on the referenced investments, the expense is fully recognized in the current period. For year-end awards anticipated to be granted to retirement-eligible employees under award terms that do not contain a future service requirement, the Firm accrues the estimated cost over the course of the calendar year preceding the grant date. The Firm believes that this method of recognition for retirement-eligible employees reflects the period over which the compensation is earned.

The Firm often invests directly, as a principal, in investments or other financial instruments to economically hedge its obligations under its deferred cash-based compensation plans. Changes in value of such investments made by the Firm are recorded in Trading revenues and Investments revenues. Changes in compensation expense resulting from changes in the fair value of the referenced investments will generally be offset by changes in the fair value of investments made by the Firm. However, there may be a timing difference between the immediate recognition of gains and losses on the Firm’s investments and the deferred recognition of the related compensation expense over the vesting period.

Foreign Currencies

Assets and liabilities of operations having non-U.S. dollar functional currencies are translated at year-end rates of exchange. Gains or losses resulting from translating foreign currency financial statements, net of hedge gains or losses and related tax effects, are reflected in AOCI, a separate component of Morgan Stanley Shareholders’ equity on the consolidated balance sheets. Gains or losses resulting from remeasurement of foreign currency transactions are included in net income, and amounts recognized in the income statement are translated at the rate of exchange on the respective date of recognition for each amount.

Investment Securities—Available for Sale and Held to Maturity

AFS securities are reported at fair value in the consolidated balance sheets with unrealized gains and losses reported in AOCI, net of tax. Interest and dividend income, including amortization of premiums and accretion of discounts, is included in Interest income in the consolidated income statements. Realized gains and losses on AFS securities are reported in the consolidated income statements (see Note 5). The Firm utilizes the “first-in, first-out” method as the basis for determining the cost of AFS securities.

Held-to-maturity (“HTM”) securities are reported at amortized cost in the consolidated balance sheets. Interest income,

including amortization of premiums and accretion of discounts on HTM securities, is included in Interest income in the consolidated income statements.

Other-than-temporary Impairment

AFS debt securities and HTM securities with a current fair value less than their amortized cost are analyzed as part of the Firm’s periodic assessment of temporary versus other-than-temporary impairment (“OTTI”) at the individual security level. A temporary impairment is recognized in AOCI. OTTI is recognized in the consolidated income statements with the exception of the non-credit portion related to a debt security that the Firm does not intend to sell and is not likely to be required to sell, which is recognized in AOCI.

For AFS debt securities that the Firm either has the intent to sell or that the Firm is likely to be required to sell before recovery of its amortized cost basis, the impairment is considered other-than-temporary.

For those AFS debt securities that the Firm does not have the intent to sell or is not likely to be required to sell, and for all HTM securities, the Firm evaluates whether it expects to recover the entire amortized cost basis of the debt security. If the Firm does not expect to recover the entire amortized cost of those AFS debt securities or HTM securities, the impairment is considered other-than-temporary, and the Firm determines what portion of the impairment relates to a credit loss and what portion relates to non-credit factors.

A credit loss exists if the present value of cash flows expected to be collected (discounted at the implicit interest rate at acquisition of the security or discounted at the effective yield for securities that incorporate changes in prepayment assumptions) is less than the amortized cost basis of the security. Changes in prepayment assumptions alone are not considered to result in a credit loss.

When determining if a credit loss exists, the Firm considers relevant information, including:

 

 

the length of time and the extent to which the fair value has been less than the amortized cost basis;

 

 

adverse conditions specifically related to the security, an industry or geographic area;

 

 

changes in the financial condition of the issuer of the security or, in the case of an asset-backed debt security, changes in the financial condition of the underlying loan obligors;

 

 

the historical and implied volatility of the fair value of the security;

 

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   110  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

 

the payment structure of the debt security and the likelihood of the issuer being able to make payments that increase in the future;

 

 

failure of the issuer of the security to make scheduled interest or principal payments;

 

 

any changes to the rating of the security by a rating agency;

 

 

recoveries or additional declines in fair value after the balance sheet date.

When estimating the present value of expected cash flows, information includes the remaining payment terms of the security, prepayment speeds, financial condition of the issuer(s), expected defaults and the value of any underlying collateral.

For AFS equity securities, the Firm considers various factors, including the intent and ability to hold the equity security for a period of time sufficient to allow for any anticipated recovery in market value in evaluating whether an OTTI exists. If the equity security is considered other-than-temporarily impaired, the entire OTTI (i.e., the difference between the fair value recorded on the balance sheet and the cost basis) will be recognized in the consolidated income statements.

Accounting Standards Adopted

The Firm adopted the following accounting updates as of January 1, 2016:

 

 

Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities.    In January 2016, the Financial

   

Accounting Standards Board (the “FASB”) issued an accounting update that changed the requirements for the recognition and measurement of certain financial assets and financial liabilities. The Firm early adopted the provision in this guidance relating to liabilities measured at fair value pursuant to a fair value option election that requires presenting unrealized DVA in Other comprehensive income (loss) (“OCI”), a change from the previous requirement to present DVA in net income. Realized DVA amounts will be recycled from AOCI to Trading revenues. DVA amounts from periods prior to adoption remain in Trading revenues as previously reported. A cumulative catch-up adjustment, net of noncontrolling interests and tax, of $312 million was recorded as of January 1, 2016 to move the cumulative unrealized DVA loss amount from Retained earnings into AOCI.

Other provisions of this rule may not be early adopted and will be effective January 1, 2018, but they are not expected to have a material impact on the consolidated financial statements.

 

 

Amendments to the Consolidation Analysis.    In February 2015, the FASB issued an accounting update that provides a new consolidation model for certain entities, such as investment funds and limited partnerships. The Firm adopted this guidance on January 1, 2016 by recording a net adjustment to equity on January 1, 2016. This adoption increased total assets by $131 million, reflecting consolidations of $206 million, net of deconsolidations of $75 million. The consolidations resulted primarily from certain funds in Investment Management where the Firm acts as a general partner.

 

 

  111   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

3. Fair Values

Fair Value Measurements

Valuation Techniques for Assets and Liabilities Measured at Fair Value on a Recurring Basis

 

Asset and Liability / Valuation Technique   Valuation Hierarchy Classification

Trading Assets and Trading Liabilities

U.S. Treasury Securities

•Fair value is determined using quoted market prices; valuation adjustments are not applied.

 

•Generally Level 1

U.S. Agency Securities

•Non-callable agency-issued debt securities are generally valued using quoted market prices, and callable agency-issued debt securities are valued by benchmarking model-derived prices to quoted market prices and trade data for comparable instruments.

•The fair value of agency mortgage pass-through pool securities is model-driven based on spreads of a comparable to-be-announced security.

•Collateralized mortgage obligations are generally valued using quoted market prices and trade data adjusted by subsequent changes in related indices for comparable instruments.

 

•Level 1—non-callable agency-issued debt securities

•Generally Level 2—callable agency-issued debt securities, agency mortgage pass-through pool securities and collateralized mortgage obligations

•Level 3—in instances where the inputs are unobservable

Other Sovereign Government Obligations

•Fair value is determined using quoted prices in active markets when available.

 

•Generally Level 1

•Level 2—if the market is less active or prices are dispersed

•Level 3—in instances where the inputs are unobservable

State and Municipal Securities

•Fair value is determined using recently executed transactions, market price quotations or pricing models that factor in, where applicable, interest rates, bond or CDS spreads and volatility and/or volatility skew, adjusted for any basis difference between cash and derivative instruments.

 

•Generally Level 2—if value based on observable market data for comparable instruments

Residential Mortgage-Backed Securities (“RMBS”), Commercial Mortgage-Backed Securities (“CMBS”) and other Asset-Backed Securities (“ABS’)

•RMBS, CMBS and other ABS may be valued based on price or spread data obtained from observed transactions or independent external parties such as vendors or brokers.

•When position-specific external price data are not observable, the fair value determination may require benchmarking to comparable instruments, and/or analyzing expected credit losses, default and recovery rates, and/or applying discounted cash flow techniques. When evaluating the comparable instruments for use in the valuation of each security, security collateral-specific attributes, including payment priority, credit enhancement levels, type of collateral, delinquency rates and loss severity, are considered. In addition, for RMBS borrowers, Fair Isaac Corporation (“FICO”) scores and the level of documentation for the loan are considered.

•Market standard models, such as Intex, Trepp or others, may be deployed to model the specific collateral composition and cash flow structure of each transaction. Key inputs to these models are market spreads, forecasted credit losses, and default and prepayment rates for each asset category.

•Valuation levels of RMBS and CMBS indices are used as an additional data point for benchmarking purposes or to price outright index positions.

 

•Generally Level 2—if value based on observable market data for comparable instruments

•Level 3—if external prices or significant spread inputs are unobservable or if the comparability assessment involves significant subjectivity related to property type differences, cash flows, performance and other inputs

Corporate Bonds

•Fair value is determined using recently executed transactions, market price quotations, bond spreads, CDS spreads, or at the money volatility and/or volatility skew obtained from independent external parties, such as vendors and brokers, adjusted for any basis difference between cash and derivative instruments.

•The spread data used are for the same maturity as the bond. If the spread data do not reference the issuer, then data that reference a comparable issuer are used. When position-specific external price data are not observable, fair value is determined based on either benchmarking to comparable instruments or cash flow models with yield curves, bond or single name CDS spreads and recovery rates as significant inputs.

 

•Level 2—if value based on observable market data for comparable instruments

•Level 3—in instances where prices or significant spread inputs are unobservable

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   112  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Asset and Liability / Valuation Technique   Valuation Hierarchy Classification

Collateralized Debt Obligations (“CDO”) and Collateralized Loan Obligations (“CLO”)

•The Firm holds cash CDOs/CLOs that typically reference a tranche of an underlying synthetic portfolio of single name CDS spreads collateralized by corporate bonds (“credit-linked notes”) or cash portfolio of asset-backed securities/loans (“asset-backed CDOs/CLOs”).

•Credit correlation, a primary input used to determine the fair value of credit-linked notes, is usually unobservable and derived using a benchmarking technique. Other model inputs such as credit spreads, including collateral spreads, and interest rates are typically observable.

•Asset-backed CDOs/CLOs are valued based on an evaluation of the market and model input parameters sourced from comparable instruments as indicated by market activity. Each asset-backed CDO/CLO position is evaluated independently taking into consideration available comparable market levels, underlying collateral performance and pricing, deal structures and liquidity.

 

•Level 2—when either comparable market transactions are observable or credit correlation input is insignificant

•Level 3—when either comparable market transactions are unobservable or the credit correlation input is significant

Loans and Lending Commitments

•Fair value of corporate loans is determined using recently executed transactions, market price quotations (where observable), implied yields from comparable debt, market observable CDS spread levels obtained from independent external parties adjusted for any basis difference between cash and derivative instruments, along with proprietary valuation models and default recovery analysis where such transactions and quotations are unobservable.

•Fair value of contingent corporate lending commitments is determined by using executed transactions on comparable loans and the anticipated market price based on pricing indications from syndicate banks and customers. The valuation of loans and lending commitments also takes into account fee income that is considered an attribute of the contract.

•Fair value of mortgage loans is determined using observable prices based on transactional data or third-party pricing for comparable instruments, when available.

•Where position-specific external prices are not observable, fair value is estimated based on benchmarking to prices and rates observed in the primary market for similar loan or borrower types or based on the present value of expected future cash flows using its best estimates of the key assumptions, including forecasted credit losses, prepayment rates, forward yield curves and discount rates commensurate with the risks involved or a methodology that utilizes the capital structure and credit spreads of recent comparable securitization transactions.

•Fair value of equity margin loans is determined by discounting future interest cash flows, net of estimated credit losses. The estimated credit losses are derived by benchmarking to market observable CDS spreads, implied debt yields or volatility metrics of the loan collateral company.

 

•Level 2—if value based on observable market data for comparable instruments

•Level 3—in instances where prices or significant spread inputs are unobservable

Corporate Equities

•Exchange-traded equity securities are generally valued based on quoted prices from the exchange. To the extent these securities are actively traded, valuation adjustments are not applied.

•Unlisted equity securities are generally valued based on an assessment of each underlying security, considering rounds of financing and third-party transactions, discounted cash flow analyses and market- based information, including comparable Firm transactions, trading multiples and changes in market outlook, among other factors.

•Listed fund units are generally marked to the exchange-traded price, while listed fund units if not actively traded and unlisted fund units are generally marked to Net Asset Value (“NAV”).

 

•Level 1—exchange-traded securities and fund units if actively traded

•Level 2—exchange-traded securities if not actively traded or if undergoing a recent mergers and acquisitions event or corporate action

•Level 3—unlisted equity securities and exchange-traded securities if not actively traded or if marked to an aged mergers and acquisitions event or corporate action

•Certain fund units that are measured at fair value using the NAV per share are not classified in the fair value hierarchy

Listed Derivative Contracts

•Listed derivatives that are actively traded are valued based on quoted prices from the exchange.

•Listed derivatives that are not actively traded are valued using the same approaches as those applied to OTC derivatives.

 

•Level 1—listed derivatives that are actively traded

•Level 2—listed derivatives that are not actively traded

 

  113   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Asset and Liability / Valuation Technique   Valuation Hierarchy Classification

OTC Derivative Contracts

•OTC derivative contracts include forward, swap and option contracts related to interest rates, foreign currencies, credit standing of reference entities, equity prices or commodity prices.

•Depending on the product and the terms of the transaction, the fair value of OTC derivative products can be modeled using a series of techniques, including closed-form analytic formulas, such as the Black-Scholes option-pricing model, simulation models or a combination thereof. Many pricing models do not entail material subjectivity as the methodologies employed do not necessitate significant judgment, since model inputs may be observed from actively quoted markets, as is the case for generic interest rate swaps, many equity, commodity and foreign currency option contracts, and certain CDS. In the case of more established derivative products, the pricing models used by the Firm are widely accepted by the financial services industry.

•More complex OTC derivative products are typically less liquid and require more judgment in the implementation of the valuation technique since direct trading activity or quotes are unobservable. This includes certain types of interest rate derivatives with both volatility and correlation exposure, equity, commodity or foreign currency derivatives which are either longer-dated or include exposure to multiple underlyings, and credit derivatives, including CDS on certain mortgage- or asset-backed securities and basket CDS. Where these inputs are unobservable, relationships to observable data points, based on historic and/or implied observations, may be employed as a technique to estimate the model input values.

•For further information on the valuation techniques for OTC derivative products, see Note 2.

•For further information on derivative instruments and hedging activities, see Note 4.

 

•Generally Level 2—OTC derivative products valued using observable inputs, or where the unobservable input is not deemed significant.

•Level 3—OTC derivative products for which the unobservable input is deemed significant

Investments

•Investments include direct investments in equity securities, as well as various investment management funds, which include investments made in connection with certain employee deferred compensation plans.

•Direct investments are presented in the fair value hierarchy table as Principal investments and Other. Initially, the transaction price is generally considered by the Firm as the exit price and is its best estimate of fair value.

•After initial recognition, in determining the fair value of non-exchange-traded internally and externally managed funds, the Firm generally considers the NAV of the fund provided by the fund manager to be the best estimate of fair value. For non-exchange-traded investments either held directly or held within internally managed funds, fair value after initial recognition is based on an assessment of each underlying investment, considering rounds of financing and third-party transactions, discounted cash flow analyses and market-based information, including comparable Firm transactions, trading multiples and changes in market outlook, among other factors. Exchange-traded direct equity investments are generally valued based on quoted prices from the exchange.

 

•Level 1—exchange-traded direct equity investments in an active market

•Level 2—non-exchange-traded direct equity investments and investments in various investment management funds if valued based on rounds of financing or third-party transactions; exchange-traded direct equity investments if not actively traded

•Level 3—non-exchange-traded direct equity investments and investments in various investment management funds where rounds of financing or third-party transactions are not available

•Certain investments that are measured at fair value using the NAV per share are not classified in the fair value hierarchy. For additional disclosure about such investments, see “Fair Value of Investments Measured at Net Asset Value” herein.

Physical Commodities

•The Firm trades various physical commodities, including natural gas and precious metals.

•Fair value is determined using observable inputs, including broker quotations and published indices.

 

•Generally Level 2 if value based on observable inputs

Investment Securities

AFS Securities

•AFS securities are composed of U.S. government and agency securities (e.g., U.S. Treasury securities, agency-issued debt, agency mortgage pass-through securities and collateralized mortgage obligations), CMBS, Federal Family Education Loan Program (“FFELP”) student loan ABS, auto loan ABS, corporate bonds, CLOs and actively traded equity securities.

•For further information on the determination of fair value, refer to the corresponding asset/liability valuation technique described herein.

•For further information on AFS securities, see Note 5.

 

•For further information on Valuation Hierarchy Classification, see corresponding Valuation Technique described herein.

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   114  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Asset and Liability / Valuation Technique   Valuation Hierarchy Classification

Certificates of Deposit

•The Firm issues Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (“FDIC”) insured certificates of deposit that pay either fixed coupons or that have repayment terms linked to the performance of debt or equity securities, indices or currencies. The fair value of these certificates of deposit is determined using valuation models that incorporate observable inputs referencing identical or comparable securities, including prices to which the deposits are linked, interest rate yield curves, option volatility and currency rates, equity prices, and the impact of the Firm’s own credit spreads, adjusted for the impact of the FDIC insurance, which is based on vanilla deposit issuance rates.

 

•Generally Level 2

Short-Term Borrowings/Long-Term Borrowings

Structured Notes

•The Firm issues structured notes that have coupon or repayment terms linked to the performance of debt or equity securities, indices, currencies or commodities.

•Fair value of structured notes is determined using valuation models for the derivative and debt portions of the notes. These models incorporate observable inputs referencing identical or comparable securities, including prices to which the notes are linked, interest rate yield curves, option volatility and currency rates, and commodity or equity prices.

•Independent, external and traded prices for the notes are considered as well. The impact of the Firm’s own credit spreads is also included based on observed secondary bond market spreads.

 

•Generally Level 2

•Level 3—in instances where the unobservable inputs are deemed significant

Securities Purchased under Agreements to Resell and Securities Sold under Agreements to Repurchase

•Fair value is computed using a standard cash flow discounting methodology.

•The inputs to the valuation include contractual cash flows and collateral funding spreads, which are estimated using various benchmarks, interest rate yield curves and option volatilities.

 

•Generally Level 2

•Level 3—in instances where the unobservable inputs are deemed significant

 

  115   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Assets and Liabilities Measured at Fair Value on a Recurring Basis

 

$ in millions    Level 1     Level 2     Level 3     Counterparty and Cash
Collateral Netting
    At
December 31,
2016
 

Assets at Fair Value

          

Trading assets:

          

U.S. government and agency securities:

          

U.S. Treasury securities

   $ 25,457     $     $     $     $ 25,457  

U.S. agency securities

     2,122       20,392       74             22,588  

Total U.S. government and agency securities

     27,579       20,392       74             48,045  

Other sovereign government obligations

     14,005       5,497       6             19,508  

Corporate and other debt:

          

State and municipal securities

           2,355       250             2,605  

Residential mortgage-backed securities

           767       92             859  

Commercial mortgage-backed securities

           715       123             838  

Asset-backed securities

           209       2             211  

Corporate bonds

           11,051       232             11,283  

Collateralized debt and loan obligations

           602       63             665  

Loans and lending commitments1

           3,580       5,122             8,702  

Other debt

           1,360       180             1,540  

Total corporate and other debt

           20,639       6,064             26,703  

Corporate equities2

     117,857       333       445             118,635  

Securities received as collateral

     13,717       19       1             13,737  

Derivative and other contracts:

          

Interest rate contracts

     1,131       300,406       1,373             302,910  

Credit contracts

           11,727       502             12,229  

Foreign exchange contracts

     231       74,921       13             75,165  

Equity contracts

     1,185       35,736       1,708             38,629  

Commodity and other contracts

     2,808       6,734       3,977             13,519  

Netting3

     (4,378     (353,543     (1,944     (51,381     (411,246

Total derivative and other contracts

     977       75,981       5,629       (51,381     31,206  

Investments4:

          

Principal investments

     20             743             763  

Private equity funds

           43                   43  

Other

     217       154       215             586  

Total investments

     237       197       958             1,392  

Physical commodities

           112                   112  

Total trading assets4

     174,372       123,170       13,177       (51,381     259,338  

Investment securities—AFS securities

     29,120       34,050                   63,170  

Securities purchased under agreements to resell

           302                   302  

Intangible assets

           3                   3  

Total assets measured at fair value

   $ 203,492     $ 157,525     $ 13,177     $ (51,381   $ 322,813  

Liabilities at Fair Value

          

Deposits

   $     $ 21     $ 42     $     $ 63  

Short-term borrowings

           404       2             406  

Trading liabilities:

          

U.S. government and agency securities:

          

U.S. Treasury securities

     10,745                         10,745  

U.S. agency securities

     891       61                   952  

Total U.S. government and agency securities

     11,636       61                   11,697  

Other sovereign government obligations

     20,658       2,430                   23,088  

Corporate and other debt:

          

State and municipal securities

           1                   1  

Asset-backed securities

           533                   533  

Corporate bonds

           5,572       34             5,606  

Lending commitments

           1                   1  

Other debt

           14       2             16  

Total corporate and other debt

           6,121       36             6,157  

Corporate equities2

     37,611       29       34             37,674  

Obligation to return securities received as collateral

     20,236       25       1             20,262  

Derivative and other contracts:

          

Interest rate contracts

     1,244       285,379       953             287,576  

Credit contracts

           12,550       875             13,425  

Foreign exchange contracts

     17       75,510       56             75,583  

Equity contracts

     1,162       37,828       1,524             40,514  

Commodity and other contracts

     2,663       6,845       2,377             11,885  

Netting3

     (4,378     (353,543     (1,944     (39,803     (399,668

Total derivative and other contracts

     708       64,569       3,841       (39,803     29,315  

Physical commodities

           1                   1  

Total trading liabilities

     90,849       73,236       3,912       (39,803     128,194  

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

           580       149             729  

Other secured financings

           4,607       434             5,041  

Long-term borrowings

     47       36,677       2,012             38,736  

Total liabilities measured at fair value

   $             90,896     $             115,525     $             6,551     $ (39,803   $ 173,169  

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   116  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

$ in millions    Level 1     Level 2     Level 3     Counterparty and Cash
Collateral Netting
    At
December 31, 2015
 

Assets at Fair Value

          

Trading assets:

          

U.S. government and agency securities:

          

U.S. Treasury securities

   $ 17,658     $     $     $     $ 17,658  

U.S. agency securities

     797       17,886                   18,683  

Total U.S. government and agency securities

     18,455       17,886                   36,341  

Other sovereign government obligations

     13,559       7,400       4             20,963  

Corporate and other debt:

          

State and municipal securities

           1,651       19             1,670  

Residential mortgage-backed securities

           1,456       341             1,797  

Commercial mortgage-backed securities

           1,520       72             1,592  

Asset-backed securities

           494       25             519  

Corporate bonds

           9,959       267             10,226  

Collateralized debt and loan obligations

           284       430             714  

Loans and lending commitments1

           4,682       5,936             10,618  

Other debt

           2,263       448             2,711  

Total corporate and other debt

           22,309       7,538             29,847  

Corporate equities2

     106,296       379       433             107,108  

Securities received as collateral

     11,221       3       1             11,225  

Derivative and other contracts:

          

Interest rate contracts

     406       323,586       2,052             326,044  

Credit contracts

           22,258       661             22,919  

Foreign exchange contracts

     55       64,608       292             64,955  

Equity contracts

     653       38,552       1,084             40,289  

Commodity and other contracts

     3,140       10,873       3,358             17,371  

Netting3

     (3,840     (380,443     (3,120     (55,562     (442,965

Total derivative and other contracts

     414       79,434       4,327       (55,562     28,613  

Investments4:

          

Principal investments

     20       44       486             550  

Other

     163       310       221             694  

Total investments

     183       354       707             1,244  

Physical commodities

           321                   321  

Total trading assets4

     150,128       128,086       13,010       (55,562     235,662  

Investment securities—AFS securities

     34,351       32,408                   66,759  

Securities purchased under agreements to resell

           806                   806  

Intangible assets

                 5             5  

Total assets measured at fair value

   $ 184,479     $ 161,300     $ 13,015     $ (55,562   $ 303,232  

Liabilities at Fair Value

          

Deposits

   $     $ 106     $ 19     $     $ 125  

Short-term borrowings

           1,647       1             1,648  

Trading liabilities:

          

U.S. government and agency securities:

          

U.S. Treasury securities

     12,932                         12,932  

U.S. agency securities

     854       127                   981  

Total U.S. government and agency securities

     13,786       127                   13,913  

Other sovereign government obligations

     10,970       2,558                   13,528  

Corporate and other debt:

          

Commercial mortgage-backed securities

           2                   2  

Corporate bonds

           5,035                   5,035  

Lending commitments

           3                   3  

Other debt

           5       4             9  

Total corporate and other debt

           5,045       4             5,049  

Corporate equities2

     47,123       35       17             47,175  

Obligation to return securities received as collateral

     19,312       3       1             19,316  

Derivative and other contracts:

          

Interest rate contracts

     466       305,151       1,792             307,409  

Credit contracts

           22,160       1,505             23,665  

Foreign exchange contracts

     22       65,177       151             65,350  

Equity contracts

     570       42,447       3,115             46,132  

Commodity and other contracts

     3,012       9,474       2,308             14,794  

Netting3

     (3,840     (380,443     (3,120     (40,473     (427,876

Total derivative and other contracts

     230       63,966       5,751       (40,473     29,474  

Total trading liabilities

     91,421       71,734       5,773       (40,473     128,455  

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

           532       151             683  

Other secured financings

           2,393       461             2,854  

Long-term borrowings

           31,058       1,987             33,045  

Total liabilities measured at fair value

   $             91,421     $             107,470     $             8,392     $ (40,473   $ 166,810  

 

1.

At December 31, 2016, loans held at fair value consisted of $7,217 million of corporate loans, $966 million of residential real estate loans and $519 million of wholesale real estate loans. At December 31, 2015, loans held at fair value consisted of $7,286 million of corporate loans, $1,885 million of residential real estate loans and $1,447 million of wholesale real estate loans.

2.

For trading purposes, the Firm holds or sells short equity securities issued by entities in diverse industries and of varying sizes.

3.

For positions with the same counterparty that cross over the levels of the fair value hierarchy, both counterparty netting and cash collateral netting are included in the column titled “Counterparty and Cash Collateral Netting.” For contracts with the same counterparty, counterparty netting among positions classified within the same level is included within that shared level. For further information on derivative instruments and hedging activities, see Note 4.

4.

Amounts exclude certain investments that are measured at fair value using the NAV per share, which are not classified in the fair value hierarchy. For additional disclosure about such investments, see “Fair Value of Investments Measured at Net Asset Value” herein.

 

  117   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Changes in Level 3 Assets and Liabilities Measured at Fair Value on a Recurring Basis

The following tables present additional information about Level 3 assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis for 2016, 2015 and 2014. Level 3 instruments may be hedged with instruments classified in Level 1 and Level 2. As a result, the realized and unrealized gains (losses) for assets and liabilities within the Level 3 category presented in the following tables do not reflect the related realized and unrealized gains (losses) on hedging instruments that have been classified by the Firm within the Level 1 and/or Level 2 categories.

Additionally, both observable and unobservable inputs may be used to determine the fair value of positions that the Firm has classified within the Level 3 category. As a result, the unrealized gains (losses) during the period for assets and liabilities within the Level 3 category presented in the following tables herein may include changes in fair value during the period that were attributable to both observable and unobservable inputs. Total realized and unrealized gains (losses) are primarily included in Trading revenues in the consolidated income statements.

 

$ in millions   Beginning
Balance at
December 31,
2015
    Realized
and
Unrealized
Gains
(Losses)
    Purchases1     Sales     Issuances     Settlements     Net
Transfers
    Ending
Balance at
December 31,
2016
    Unrealized
Gains
(Losses) at
December 31,
2016
 

Assets at Fair Value

                 

Trading assets:

                 

U.S. agency securities

  $     $ (4   $ 72     $           —     $             —     $             —     $             6     $             74     $ (4

Other sovereign government obligations

    4       1       4       (7                 4       6                   —  

Corporate and other debt:

                 

State and municipal securities

    19             249       (18                       250        

Residential mortgage-backed securities

    341       (11     35       (265                 (8     92       (10

Commercial mortgage-backed securities

    72       (56     46       (39                 100       123       (66

Asset-backed securities

    25       (2     1       (19                 (3     2       (1

Corporate bonds

    267       9       310       (357                 3       232       (20

Collateralized debt and loan obligations

    430       11       14       (300                 (92     63       (5

Loans and lending commitments

    5,936       (79     2,261       (954           (1,863     (179     5,122       (80

Other debt

    448       20       26       (51                 (263     180       (13

Total corporate and other debt

    7,538       (108     2,942       (2,003           (1,863     (442     6,064       (195

Corporate equities

    433       (2     242       (154                 (74     445        

Securities received as collateral

    1                           —                         1        

Net derivative and other contracts2:

                 

Interest rate contracts

    260       529       1                   (83     (287     420       463  

Credit contracts

    (844     (176                 (4     623       28       (373     (167

Foreign exchange contracts

    141       (27                       (220     63       (43     (23

Equity contracts

    (2,031     539       809       (5     (332     1,073       131       184       376  

Commodity and other contracts

    1,050       544       24             (114     (44     140       1,600       304  

Total net derivative and other contracts

    (1,424     1,409       834       (5     (450     1,349       75       1,788       953  

Investments:

                 

Principal investments

    486       (38     398       (63           (59     19       743       (55

Other

    221       6             (12                       215       5  

Total investments

    707       (32     398       (75           (59     19       958       (50

Intangible assets

    5                                     (5            

Liabilities at Fair Value

                 

Deposits

  $ 19     $     $     $     $ 23     $     $     $ 42     $  

Short-term borrowings

    1                         2       (1           2        

Trading liabilities:

                 

Corporate and other debt:

                 

Corporate bonds

          (4     (97     145                   (18     34        

Other debt

    4             (2                             2        

Total corporate and other debt

    4       (4     (99     145                   (18     36        

Corporate equities

    17       17       (10     89                   (45     34        

Obligation to return securities received as collateral

    1                                           1        

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

    151       2                                     149       2  

Other secured financings

    461       (5                 79       (45     (66     434       (5

Long-term borrowings

    1,987       (19                 646       (304     (336     2,012       (30

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   118  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

$ in millions   Beginning
Balance at
December 31,
2014
    Realized
and
Unrealized
Gains
(Losses)
    Purchases1     Sales     Issuances     Settlements     Net
Transfers
    Ending
Balance at
December 31,
2015
    Unrealized
Gains
(Losses) at
December 31,
2015
 

Assets at Fair Value

                 

Trading assets:

                 

Other sovereign government obligations

  $ 41     $ (1   $ 2     $ (30   $     $     $ (8   $                 4     $             —  

Corporate and other debt:

                 

State and municipal securities

                    —                     2                     3                   —                       —                       —       14       19       2  

Residential mortgage-backed securities

    175       24       176       (83                 49       341       12  

Commercial mortgage-backed securities

    96       (28     27       (23                         —       72       (32

Asset-backed securities

    76       (9     23       (30                 (35     25        

Corporate bonds

    386       (44     374       (381           (53     (15     267       (44

Collateralized debt and loan obligations

    1,152       123       325       (798           (344     (28     430       (19

Loans and lending commitments

    5,874       (42     3,216       (207           (2,478     (427     5,936       (76

Other debt

    285       (23     131       (5           (81     141       448       (9

Total corporate and other debt

    8,044       3       4,275       (1,527           (2,956     (301     7,538       (166

Corporate equities

    272       (1     373       (333                 122       433       11  

Securities received as collateral

                1                               1        

Net derivative and other contracts2:

                 

Interest rate contracts

    (173     (51     58             (54     207       273       260       20  

Credit contracts

    (743     (172     19             (121     196       (23     (844     (179

Foreign exchange contracts

    151       53       4             (2     (18     (47     141       52  

Equity contracts

    (2,165     166       81       (1     (310     22       176       (2,031     62  

Commodity and other contracts

    1,146       433       35             (222     (116     (226     1,050       402  

Total net derivative and other contracts

    (1,784     429       197       (1     (709     291       153       (1,424     357  

Investments:

                 

Principal investments

    835       11       32       (133           (188     (71     486       6  

Other

    323       (12     1       (6                 (85     221       (7

Total investments

    1,158       (1     33       (139           (188     (156     707       (1

Intangible assets

    6                               (1           5        

Liabilities at Fair Value

                 

Deposits

  $     $ (1   $     $     $ 18     $     $     $ 19     $ (1

Short-term borrowings

                            1                   1        

Trading liabilities:

                 

Corporate and other debt:

                 

Corporate bonds

    78             (19     6             (65                  

Lending commitments

    5       5                                           5  

Other debt

    38             (1     7             (39     (1     4        

Total corporate and other debt

    121       5       (20     13             (104     (1     4       5  

Corporate equities

    45       79       (86     32                   105       17       79  

Obligation to return securities received as collateral

                      1                         1        

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

    153       2                                     151       2  

Other secured financings

    149       192                   327       (232     409       461       181  

Long-term borrowings

    1,934       61                   881       (364     (403     1,987       52  

 

  119   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

$ in millions

  Beginning
Balance at
December 31,
2013
    Realized
and
Unrealized
Gains
(Losses)
    Purchases1     Sales     Issuances     Settlements     Net
Transfers
    Ending
Balance at
December 31,
2014
    Unrealized
Gains
(Losses) at
December 31,
2014
 

Assets at Fair Value

                 

Trading assets:

                 

Other sovereign government obligations

  $ 27     $               1     $               48     $ (34   $                 —     $                 —     $ (1   $                 41     $             —  

Corporate and other debt:

                 

Residential mortgage-backed securities

                    47       9       105       (14                 28       175       4  

Commercial mortgage-backed securities

    108       65       16       (102                 9       96       45  

Asset-backed securities

    103       3       66       (96                       76       9  

Corporate bonds

    522       86       106       (306                 (22     386       66  

Collateralized debt and loan obligations

    1,468       142       644       (964           (143     5       1,152       27  

Loans and lending commitments

    5,129       (87     3,784       (415           (2,552     15       5,874       (191

Other debt

    27       21       274       (35           (2           285       20  

Total corporate and other debt

    7,404       239       4,995       (1,932           (2,697     35       8,044       (20

Corporate equities

    190       20       146       (102                 18       272       (3

Net derivative and other contracts2, 3:

                 

Interest rate contracts

    113       (258     18                   —       (14     (43     11       (173     (349

Credit contracts

    (147     (408     68             (179     (15     (62     (743     (474

Foreign exchange contracts

    68       (13     7                   108       (19     151       (17

Equity contracts

    (831     (527     339       (2     (562     (46     (536     (2,165     (600

Commodity and other contracts

    876       158       287             (52     (123           1,146       72  

Total net derivative and other contracts

    79       (1,048     719       (2     (807     (119     (606     (1,784     (1,368

Investments:

                 

Principal investments

    2,160       53       36       (181           (1,258     25       835       49  

Other

    538       17       17       (29                 (220     323       24  

Total investments

    2,698       70       53       (210           (1,258     (195     1,158       73  

Intangible assets

    8                               (2           6       (1

Liabilities at Fair Value

                 

Short-term borrowings

  $ 1     $     $     $     $     $ (1   $     $     $  

Trading liabilities:

                 

Corporate and other debt:

                 

Corporate bonds

    22       1       (46     117                   (14     78       2  

Lending commitments

    2       (3                                   5       (3

Other debt

    48       7       (8                       5       38       (2

Total corporate and other debt

    72       5       (54     117                   (9     121       (3

Corporate equities

    8             (3     39                   1       45        

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

    154       1                                     153       1  

Other secured financings

    278       (9                 21       (201     42       149       (6

Long-term borrowings

    1,887       109                   791       (391     (244     1,934       102  

 

1.

Loan originations and consolidations of VIEs are included in purchases.

2.

Net derivative and other contracts represent Trading assets—Derivative and other contracts, net of Trading liabilities—Derivative and other contracts.

3.

During 2014, the Firm incurred a charge of approximately $468 million related to the implementation of the FVA, which was recognized in Trading revenues. For further information on the implementation of FVA, see Note 2.

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   120  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Significant Unobservable Inputs Used in Recurring Level 3 Fair Value Measurements

The following disclosures provide information on the valuation techniques, significant unobservable inputs, and their ranges and averages for each major category of assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis with a significant Level 3 balance. The level of aggregation and breadth of products cause the range of inputs to be wide and not evenly distributed across the inventory. Further, the range of unobservable inputs may differ across firms in the financial services industry because of diversity in the types of products included in each firm’s inventory. The following disclosures also include qualitative information on the sensitivity of the fair value measurements to changes in the significant unobservable inputs. There are no predictable relationships between multiple significant unobservable inputs attributable to a given valuation technique. A single amount is disclosed when there is no significant difference between the minimum, maximum and average (weighted average or simple average / median).

Valuation Techniques and Sensitivity of Unobservable Inputs Used in Recurring Level 3 Fair Value Measurements

 

     Predominant Valuation Techniques/Significant
Unobservable Inputs
   Range (Weighted Averages or Simple Averages/Median)1
$ in millions       At December 31, 2016    At December 31, 2015

Assets at Fair Value

     

U.S. agency securities ($74 million)

     

Comparable pricing:

   Comparable bond price    96 to 105 points (102 points)    N/M

State and municipal securities ($250 million and $19 million)

     

Comparable pricing:

   Comparable bond price    53 to 100 points (91 points)    N/M

Residential mortgage-backed securities ($92 million and $341 million)

     

Comparable pricing:

   Comparable bond price    0 to 30 points (9 points)    0 to 75 points (32 points)

Commercial mortgage-backed securities ($123 million and $72 million)

     

Comparable pricing:

   Comparable bond price    0 to 86 points (36 points)    0 to 9 points (2 points)

Corporate bonds ($232 million and $267 million)

     

Comparable pricing:

   Comparable bond price    3 to 130 points (70 points)    3 to 119 points (90 points)

Option model:

   At the money volatility    23% to 33% (30%)    N/M

Comparable pricing:

   EBITDA multiple    N/M    7 to 9 times (8 times)

Structured bond model:

   Discount rate    N/M    15%

Collateralized debt and loan obligations ($63 million and $430 million)

     

Comparable pricing:

   Comparable bond price    0 to 103 points (50 points)    47 to 103 points (67 points)

Correlation model:

   Credit correlation    N/M    39% to 60% (49%)

Loans and lending commitments ($5,122 million and $5,936 million)

     

Corporate loan model:

   Credit spread    402 to 672 bps (557 bps)    250 to 866 bps (531 bps)

Expected recovery:

   Asset coverage    43% to 100% (83%)    N/M

Margin loan model:

   Discount rate    2% to 8% (3%)    1% to 4% (2%)
     Volatility skew    21% to 63% (33%)    14% to 70% (33%)
     Credit spread    N/M    62 to 499 bps (145 bps)

Comparable pricing:

   Comparable loan price    45 to 100 points (84 points)    35 to 100 points (88 points)

Discounted cash flow:

   Implied weighted average cost of capital    5%    6% to 8% (7%)
     Capitalization rate    4% to 10% (4%)    4% to 10% (4%)

Option model:

   Volatility skew    N/M    -1%

Other debt ($180 million and $448 million)

     

Option model:

   At the money volatility    16% to 52% (52%)    16% to 53% (53%)

Discounted cash flow:

   Discount rate    7% to 12% (11%)    N/M

Comparable pricing:

   Comparable loan price    1 to 74 points (23 points)    4 to 84 points (59 points)

Comparable pricing:

   Comparable bond price    N/M    8 points

Margin loan model:

   Discount rate    N/M    1%

 

  121   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

     Predominant Valuation Techniques/Significant
Unobservable Inputs
   Range (Weighted Averages or Simple Averages/Median)1
$ in millions       At December 31, 2016    At December 31, 2015

Corporate equities ($445 million and $433 million)

     

Comparable pricing:

   Comparable equity price    100%    100%

Comparable pricing:

   Comparable price    N/M    50% to 80% (72%)

Market approach:

   EBITDA multiple    N/M    9 times

Net derivative and other contracts2:

     

Interest rate contracts ($420 million and $260 million)

     

Option model:

   Interest rate - Foreign exchange correlation    28% to 58% (44% / 43%)    25% to 62% (43% / 43%)
     Interest rate volatility skew    19% to 117% (55% / 56%)    29% to 82% (43% / 40%)
     Interest rate quanto correlation    -17% to 31% (1% / -5%)    -8% to 36% (5% / -6%)
     Interest rate curve correlation    28% to 96% (68% / 72%)    24% to 95% (60% / 69%)
     Inflation volatility    23% to 55% (40% / 39%)    58%
     Interest rate - Inflation correlation    N/M    -41% to -39% (-41% /  -41%)
     Interest rate volatility concentration liquidity multiple    N/M    0 to 3 times (2 times)

Credit contracts ($(373) million and $(844) million)

     

Comparable pricing:

   Cash synthetic basis    5 to 12 points (11 points)    5 to 12 points (9 points)
     Comparable bond price    0 to 70 points (23 points)    0 to 75 points (24 points)

Correlation model:

   Credit correlation    32% to 70% (45%)    39% to 97% (57%)

Foreign exchange contracts3 ($(43) million and $141 million)

     

Option model:

   Interest rate - Foreign exchange correlation    28% to 58% (44% / 43%)    25% to 62% (43% / 43%)
     Interest rate volatility skew    34% to 117% (55% / 56%)    29% to 82% (43% / 40%)
     Interest rate quanto correlation    -17% to 31% (1% / -5%)    N/M
     Interest rate curve    N/M    0%
Equity contracts3 ($184 million and $(2,031) million)      

Option model:

   At the money volatility    7% to 66% (33%)    16% to 65% (32%)
     Volatility skew    -4% to 0% (-1%)    -3% to 0% (-1%)
     Equity - Equity correlation    25% to 99% (73%)    40% to 99% (71%)
     Equity - Foreign exchange correlation    -63% to 30% (-43%)    -60% to -11% (-39%)
     Equity - Interest rate correlation    -8% to 52% (12% / 4%)    -29% to 50% (16% / 8%)

Commodity and other contracts ($1,600 million and $1,050 million)

     

Option model:

   Forward power price    $7 to $90 ($32) per MWh    $3 to $91 ($32) per MWh
     Commodity volatility    6% to 130% (18%)    10% to 92% (18%)
     Cross-commodity correlation    5% to 99% (92%)    43% to 99% (93%)

Investments:

     

Principal investments ($743 million and $486 million)

     

Market approach:

   EBITDA multiple    6 to 24 times (12 times)    8 to 20 times (11 times)
     Forward capacity price    N/M    $5 to $9 ($7)

Comparable pricing:

   Comparable equity price    75% to 100% (88%)    43% to 100% (81%)

Discounted cash flow:

   Implied weighted average cost of capital    N/M    16%
     Exit multiple    N/M    8 to 14 times (9 times)
     Capitalization rate    N/M    5% to 9% (6%)
     Equity discount rate    N/M    20% to 35% (26%)

Other ($215 million and $221 million)

     

Discounted cash flow:

   Implied weighted average cost of capital    10%    10%
     Exit multiple    10 times    13 times

Market approach:

   EBITDA multiple    6 to 13 times (11 times)    7 to 14 times (12 times)

Comparable pricing:

   Comparable equity price    100%    100%

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   122  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

     Predominant Valuation Techniques/Significant
Unobservable Inputs
   Range (Weighted Averages or Simple Averages/Median)1
$ in millions       At December 31, 2016    At December 31, 2015

Liabilities at Fair Value

     

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase ($149 million and $151 million)

     

Discounted cash flow:

   Funding spread    118 to 127 bps (121 bps)    86 to 116 bps (105 bps)

Other secured financings ($434 million and $461 million)

     

Discounted cash flow:

   Funding spread    63 to 92 bps (78 bps)    95 to 113 bps (104 bps)

Option model:

   Volatility skew    -1%    -1%

Discounted cash flow:

   Discount rate    4%    4% to 13% (4%)

Long-term borrowings ($2,012 million and $1,987 million)

     

Option model:

   At the money volatility    7% to 42% (30%)    20% to 50% (29%)
     Volatility skew    -2% to 0% (-1%)    -1% to 0% (-1%)
     Equity - Equity correlation    35% to 99% (84%)    40% to 97% (77%)
     Equity - Foreign exchange correlation    -63% to 13% (-40%)    -70% to -11% (-39%)

Option model:

   Interest rate volatility skew    25%    50%
     Equity volatility discount    7% to 11% (10% / 10%)    10%

Comparable pricing:

   Comparable equity price    N/M    100%

Correlation model:

   Credit correlation    N/M    40% to 60% (52%)

bps—Basis points. A basis point equals 1/100th of 1%.

Points—Percentage of par

MWh—Megawatt hours

N/M—Not Meaningful

EBITDA—Earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation and amortization

1.

Amounts represent weighted averages except where simple averages and the median of the inputs are provided when more relevant.

2.

Credit valuation adjustment (“CVA”) and FVA are included in the balance but excluded from the Valuation Technique(s) and Significant Unobservable Inputs in the previous table. CVA is a Level 3 input when the underlying counterparty credit curve is unobservable. FVA is a Level 3 input in its entirety given the lack of observability of funding spreads in the principal market.

3.

Includes derivative contracts with multiple risks (i.e., hybrid products).

 

Significant Unobservable Inputs — Description   Sensitivity
Asset coverage—The ratio of a borrower’s underlying pledged assets less applicable costs relative to their outstanding debt (while considering the loan’s principal and the seniority and security of the loan commitment).   In general, an increase (decrease) to the asset coverage for an asset would result in a higher (lower) fair value.
Capitalization rate—The ratio between net operating income produced by an asset and its market value at the projected disposition date.   In general, an increase (decrease) to the capitalization rate for an asset would result in a lower (higher) fair value.
Cash synthetic basis—The measure of the price differential between cash financial instruments and their synthetic derivative-based equivalents. The range disclosed in the table above signifies the number of points by which the synthetic bond equivalent price is higher than the quoted price of the underlying cash bonds.   In general, an increase (decrease) to the cash synthetic basis for an asset would result in a lower (higher) fair value.

Comparable bond price—A pricing input used when prices for the identical instrument are not available. Significant subjectivity may be involved when fair value is determined using pricing data available for comparable instruments. Valuation using comparable instruments can be done by calculating an implied yield (or spread over a liquid benchmark) from the price of a comparable bond, then adjusting that yield (or spread) to derive a value for the bond. The adjustment to yield (or spread) should account for relevant differences in the bonds such as maturity or credit quality.

 

Alternatively, a price-to-price basis can be assumed between the comparable instrument and the bond being valued in order to establish the value of the bond. Additionally, as the probability of default increases for a given bond (i.e., as the bond becomes more distressed), the valuation of that bond will increasingly reflect its expected recovery level assuming default. The decision to use price-to-price or yield/spread comparisons largely reflects trading market convention for the financial instruments in question. Price-to-price comparisons are primarily employed for RMBS, CMBS, ABS, CDOs, CLOs, Other debt, interest rate contracts, foreign exchange contracts, Other secured financings and distressed corporate bonds. Implied yield (or spread over a liquid benchmark) is utilized predominately for non-distressed corporate bonds, loans and credit contracts.

  In general, an increase (decrease) to the comparable bond price for an asset would result in a higher (lower) fair value.
Comparable equity price—A price derived from equity raises, share buybacks and external bid levels, etc. A discount or premium may be included in the fair value estimate.   In general, an increase (decrease) to the comparable equity price of an asset would result in a higher (lower) fair value.

 

  123   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Significant Unobservable Inputs—Description   Sensitivity
Correlation—A pricing input where the payoff is driven by more than one underlying risk. Correlation is a measure of the relationship between the movements of two variables (i.e., how the change in one variable influences a change in the other variable). Credit correlation, for example, is the factor that describes the relationship between the probability of individual entities to default on obligations and the joint probability of multiple entities to default on obligations.   In general, an increase (decrease) to the correlation would result in an impact to the fair value, but the magnitude and direction of the impact would depend on whether the Firm is long or short the exposure.
Credit spread—The difference in yield between different securities due to differences in credit quality. The credit spread reflects the additional net yield an investor can earn from a security with more credit risk relative to one with less credit risk. The credit spread of a particular security is often quoted in relation to the yield on a credit risk-free benchmark security or reference rate, typically either U.S. Treasury or London Interbank Offered Rate (“LIBOR”).   In general, an increase (decrease) to the credit spread of an asset would result in a lower (higher) fair value.
EBITDA multiple / Exit multiple—The ratio of the Enterprise Value to EBITDA, where the Enterprise Value is the aggregate value of equity and debt minus cash and cash equivalents. The EBITDA multiple reflects the value of the company in terms of its full-year EBITDA, whereas the exit multiple reflects the value of the company in terms of its full-year expected EBITDA at exit. Either multiple allows comparison between companies from an operational perspective as the effect of capital structure, taxation and depreciation/amortization is excluded.   In general, an increase (decrease) to the EBITDA or Exit multiple of an asset would result in a higher (lower) fair value.
Funding spread—The difference between the general collateral rate (which refers to the rate applicable to a broad class of U.S. Treasury issuances) and the specific collateral rate (which refers to the rate applicable to a specific type of security pledged as collateral, such as a municipal bond). Repurchase agreements and certain other secured financings are discounted based on collateral curves. The curves are constructed as spreads over the corresponding overnight indexed swap (“OIS”) or LIBOR curves, with the short end of the curve representing spreads over the corresponding OIS curves and the long end of the curve representing spreads over LIBOR.   In general, an increase (decrease) to the funding spread of an asset would result in a lower (higher) fair value.
Implied weighted average cost of capital (“WACC”)—The WACC implied by the current value of equity in a discounted cash flow model. The model assumes that the cash flow assumptions, including projections, are fully reflected in the current equity value, while the debt to equity ratio is held constant. The WACC theoretically represents the required rate of return to debt and equity investors.   In general, an increase (decrease) to the Implied weighted cost of capital of an asset would result in a lower (higher) fair value.
Interest rate curve—The term structure of interest rates (relationship between interest rates and the time to maturity) and a market’s measure of future interest rates at the time of observation. An interest rate curve is used to set interest rate and foreign exchange derivative cash flows and is a pricing input used in the discounting of any OTC derivative cash flow.   In general, an increase (decrease) to the interest rate curve would result in an impact to the fair value, but the magnitude and direction of the impact would depend on whether the Firm is long or short the exposure.
Volatility—The measure of the variability in possible returns for an instrument given how much that instrument changes in value over time. Volatility is a pricing input for options, and, generally, the lower the volatility, the less risky the option. The level of volatility used in the valuation of a particular option depends on a number of factors, including the nature of the risk underlying that option (e.g., the volatility of a particular underlying equity security may be significantly different from that of a particular underlying commodity index), the tenor and the strike price of the option.   In general, an increase (decrease) to the volatility would result in an impact to the fair value, but the magnitude and direction of the impact would depend on whether the Firm is long or short the exposure.
Volatility skew—The measure of the difference in implied volatility for options with identical underliers and expiry dates but with different strikes. The implied volatility for an option with a strike price that is above or below the current price of an underlying asset will typically deviate from the implied volatility for an option with a strike price equal to the current price of that same underlying asset.   In general, an increase (decrease) to the volatility skew would result in an impact to the fair value, but the magnitude and direction of the impact would depend on whether the Firm is long or short the exposure.

 

Fair Value of Investments Measured at NAV

Investments in Certain Funds Measured at NAV per Share

 

    At December 31, 2016     At December 31, 2015  
$ in millions   Fair Value     Commitment     Fair Value     Commitment  

Private equity funds

  $           1,566     $                 335     $       1,917     $                 538   

Real estate funds

    1,103       136       1,337       128   

Hedge funds

    147       4       589        

Total

  $ 2,816     $ 475     $ 3,843     $ 670   

Private Equity Funds and Real Estate Funds

Private Equity Funds.    Funds that pursue multiple strategies, including leveraged buyouts, venture capital, infrastructure growth capital, distressed investments and mezzanine capital. In addition, the funds may be structured with a focus on specific domestic or foreign geographic regions.

Real Estate Funds.    Funds that invest in real estate assets such as commercial office buildings, retail properties, multi-family residential properties, developments or hotels. In addition, the funds may be structured with a focus on specific geographic domestic or foreign regions.

Investments in these funds generally are not redeemable due to the closed-ended nature of these funds. Instead, distributions from each fund will be received as the underlying investments of the funds are disposed and monetized.

Nonredeemable Funds by Projected Distribution

 

     Fair Value at December 31, 2016  
$ in millions    Private Equity      Real Estate  

Less than 5 years

   $                              100      $                              81  

5-10 years

     837        618  

Over 10 years

     629        404  

Total

   $ 1,566      $ 1,103  
 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   124  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Hedge Funds

Hedge Funds.    Funds that pursue various investment strategies, including long-short equity, fixed income/credit, event-driven and multi-strategy.

Restrictions.     Investments in hedge funds may be subject to lock-up or gate provisions. A lock-up provision is a provision which provides that during a certain initial period, an investor may not make a withdrawal from the fund. A gate provision restricts the amount of redemption that an investor can demand on any redemption date.

Hedge Funds Redemption Frequency

 

     

Fair Value At

December 31, 2016

 

Quarterly

     52%  

Every six months

     17%  

Greater than six months

     18%  

Subject to lock-up provisions1

     13%  

 

1.

The remaining restriction period for these investments was primarily over three years.

The redemption notice periods for hedge funds were primarily greater than six months. Hedge fund investments representing approximately 20% of the fair value cannot be redeemed as of December 31, 2016 because a gate provision has been imposed by the hedge fund manager primarily for indefinite periods.

Fair Value Option

The Firm elected the fair value option for certain eligible instruments that are risk managed on a fair value basis to mitigate income statement volatility caused by measurement basis differences between the elected instruments and their associated risk management transactions or to eliminate complexities of applying certain accounting models.

Earnings Impact of Instruments under the Fair Value Option

 

$ in millions   Trading
Revenues
    Interest
Income
(Expense)
   

Gains (Losses)
Included in

Net Revenues

 

2016

     

Securities purchased under agreements to resell

  $ (3   $ 7     $  

Deposits1

    (1     (1     (2)  

Short-term borrowings1

    33             33   

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase1

    6       (13     (7)  

Long-term borrowings1

    (740     (483     (1,223)  

2015

     

Securities purchased under agreements to resell

  $ (6   $ 10     $  

Short-term borrowings2

    63             63   

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase2

    13       (6      

Long-term borrowings2

    2,404       (528     1,876   
$ in millions   Trading
Revenues
    Interest
Income
(Expense)
   

Gains (Losses)
Included in

Net Revenues

 

2014

     

Securities purchased under agreements to resell

  $ (4   $ 9     $  

Short-term borrowings2

    (136     1       (135)  

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase2

    (5     (6     (11)  

Long-term borrowings2

    1,867       (638     1,229   

 

1.

Gains (losses) in 2016 are mainly attributable to changes in foreign currency rates or interest rates or movements in the reference price or index for short-term and long-term borrowings before the impact of related hedges. During 2016, in accordance with the early adoption of a provision of the accounting update Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities, unrealized DVA gains (losses) were recorded within OCI in the consolidated comprehensive income statements and, as such, are not included in this table. See Notes 2 and 15 for further information.

2.

In 2015 and 2014, Gains (losses) recorded in Trading revenues are principally attributable to DVA, with the respective remainder attributable to changes in foreign currency rates or interest rates or movements in the reference price or index for primarily structured notes before the impact of related hedges.

The amounts in the previous table are included within Net revenues and do not reflect any gains or losses on related hedging instruments. In addition to the amounts in the previous table, as discussed in Note 2, instruments within Trading assets or Trading liabilities are measured at fair value.

Gains (Losses) Due to Changes in Instrument-Specific Credit Risk

 

    2016  
$ in millions   Trading
Revenues
    OCI  

Short-term and long-term borrowings1

  $                       31     $     (460)  

Loans and other debt2

    (71      

Lending commitments3

    4        

 

    2015  
     Trading
Revenues
    OCI  

Short-term and long-term borrowings1

  $                     618     $          —  

Loans and other debt2

    (193      

Lending commitments3

    12        

 

    2014  
     Trading
Revenues
    OCI  

Short-term and long-term borrowings1

  $                     651     $          —  

Loans and other debt2

    179        

Lending commitments3

    30        

 

1.

In 2016, in accordance with the early adoption of a provision of the accounting update Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities, unrealized DVA gains (losses) are recorded in OCI and when such gains (losses) are realized in Trading revenues. For 2015 and 2014, the realized and unrealized DVA gains (losses) are recorded in Trading revenues. The cumulative pre-tax impact of changes in the Firm’s DVA recognized in AOCI is an unrealized loss of $921 million at December 31, 2016. See Notes 2 and 15 for further information.

2.

Loans and other debt instrument-specific credit gains (losses) were determined by excluding the non-credit components of gains and losses, such as those due to changes in interest rates.

3.

Gains (losses) on lending commitments were generally determined based on the difference between estimated expected client yields and contractual yields at each respective period-end.

 

 

  125   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Short-Term and Long-Term Borrowings Measured at Fair Value on a Recurring Basis

 

$ in millions    At
December 31,
2016
     At
December 31,
2015
 
Business Unit Responsible for Risk Management      

Equity

   $             21,066      $ 17,789  

Interest rates

     16,051        14,255  

Foreign exchange

     1,114        1,866  

Credit

     647        400  

Commodities

     264        383  

Total

   $ 39,142      $ 34,693  

Net Difference of Contractual Principal Amount Over Fair Value

 

$ in millions    At
December 31,
2016
     At December 31,
2015
 

Loans and other debt1

   $                 13,495      $                 14,095  

Loans 90 or more days past due and/or on nonaccrual status1

     11,502        11,651  

Short-term and long-term borrowings2

     720        508  

 

1.

The majority of the difference between principal and fair value amounts for loans and other debt relates to distressed debt positions purchased at amounts well below par.

2.

Short-term and long-term borrowings do not include structured notes where the repayment of the initial principal amount fluctuates based on changes in a reference price or index.

Fair Value of Loans in Nonaccrual Status

 

$ in millions    At
December 31,
2016
     At
December 31,
2015
 

Aggregate fair value of loans in nonaccrual status1

   $ 1,536      $ 1,853  

 

1.

Includes all loans 90 or more days past due in the amount of $787 million and $885 million at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively.

The previous tables exclude non-recourse debt from consolidated VIEs, liabilities related to failed sales of financial assets, pledged commodities and other liabilities that have specified assets attributable to them.

 

 

Assets and Liabilities Measured at Fair Value on a Non-Recurring Basis

 

    December 31, 2016                     
   

Carrying

Value

    Fair Value by Level    

Gains (Losses)

for 2016

          

Income Statement

Classification

$ in millions     Level 1     Level 2     Level 3        

Assets

             

Loans1

  $           4,913     $             —     $         2,470     $         2,443     $                              40             Other revenues

Other assets—Other investments2

    123                   123       (52           Other revenues

Other assets—Premises, equipment and software costs3

    25             22       3       (76          

Other revenues if held for sale, otherwise Other expenses

Intangible assets4

                            (2          

Other revenues if held for sale, otherwise Other expenses

Total assets

  $ 5,061     $     $ 2,492     $ 2,569     $ (90    

Liabilities

             

Other liabilities and accrued
expenses1

  $ 226     $     $ 166     $ 60     $ 121            

Other revenues if held for sale, otherwise Other expenses

Total liabilities

  $ 226     $     $ 166     $ 60     $ 121      

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   126  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

    December 31, 2015                      
   

Carrying

Value

    Fair Value by Level    

Gains (Losses)

for 2015

           

Income Statement

Classification

$ in millions     Level 1     Level 2     Level 3         

Assets

              

Loans1

  $           5,850     $     $         3,400     $         2,450     $ (220            Other revenues

Other assets—Other investments2

                            (3            Other revenues

Other assets—Premises, equipment and software costs3

                            (44           

Other revenues if held for sale, otherwise Other expenses

Other assets5

    31             31             (22           

Other revenues if held for sale, otherwise Other expenses

Total assets

  $ 5,881     $     $ 3,431     $ 2,450     $ (289     

Liabilities

              

Other liabilities and accrued expenses1

  $ 476     $     $ 418     $ 58     $ (207           

Other revenues if held for sale, otherwise Other expenses

Total liabilities

  $ 476     $     $ 418     $ 58     $ (207     
    December 31, 2014                      
   

Carrying

Value

    Fair Value by Level    

Gains (Losses)

for 2014

           

Income Statement

Classification

$ in millions     Level 1     Level 2     Level 3         

Assets

              

Loans1

  $           3,336     $             —     $         2,386     $         950     $ (165            Other revenues

Other Assets—Other investments2

    46                   46       (38            Other revenues

Other assets—Premises, equipment and software costs3

                            (58           

Other revenues if held for sale, otherwise Other expenses

Intangible assets4

    46                   46       (6           

Other revenues if held for sale, otherwise Other expenses

Other assets5

                            (9           

Other revenues if held for sale, otherwise Other expenses

Total assets

  $ 3,428     $     $ 2,386     $ 1,042     $ (276     

Liabilities

              

Other liabilities and accrued
expenses1

  $ 219     $     $ 178     $ 41     $ (165           

Other revenues if held for sale, otherwise Other expenses

Total liabilities

  $ 219     $     $ 178     $ 41     $ (165     

 

1.

Non-recurring changes in the fair value of loans and lending commitments: held for investment were calculated using the value of the underlying collateral; and held for sale were calculated using recently executed transactions, market price quotations, valuation models that incorporate market observable inputs where possible, such as comparable loan or debt prices and credit default swap spread levels adjusted for any basis difference between cash and derivative instruments, or default recovery analysis where such transactions and quotations are unobservable.

2.

Losses related to Other assets—Other investments were determined using techniques that included discounted cash flow models, methodologies that incorporate multiples of certain comparable companies and recently executed transactions. Included in these losses was a loss of approximately $35 million in 2016 in connection with the sale of solar investments and impairments of the remaining unsold solar investments accounted for under the equity method.

3.

Losses related to Other assets—Premises, equipment and software costs were determined using techniques that included a default recovery analysis and recently executed transactions. Included in these losses was an impairment charge of approximately $31 million in 2016 in connection with an oil terminal facility to reduce the carrying value to its estimated fair value less costs to sell.

4.

Losses related to Intangible assets were determined using techniques that included discounted cash flow models and methodologies that incorporate multiples of certain comparable companies.

5.

Losses related to Other assets were determined primarily using a default recovery analysis.

 

  127   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Valuation Techniques for Assets and Liabilities Not Measured at Fair Value

 

Asset and Liability / Valuation Technique

Securities purchased under agreements to resell/Securities sold under agreements to repurchase, Securities borrowed/Securities loaned and Other secured financings

•Typically longer dated instruments for which the fair value is determined using standard cash flow discounting methodology.

•The inputs to the valuation include contractual cash flows and collateral funding spreads, which are estimated using various benchmarks and interest rate yield curves.

Investment securities—HTM securities

•Fair value is determined using quoted market prices.

Customer and other receivables

•For the portion of the customer and other receivables where fair value does not equal carrying value, the fair value is determined using collateral information, historical resolution and recovery rates and employee termination data. The cash flow is then discounted using a market observable spread over LIBOR.

Loans

•The fair value of consumer and residential real estate loans and lending commitments where position-specific external price data are not observable is determined based on the credit risks of the borrower using a probability of default and loss given default method, discounted at the estimated external cost of funding level.

•The fair value of corporate loans and lending commitments is determined using recently executed transactions, market price quotations (where observable), implied yields from comparable debt, market observable credit default swap spread levels along with proprietary valuation models and default recovery analysis where such transactions and quotations are unobservable.

Long-term borrowings

•The fair value is generally determined based on transactional data or third-party pricing for identical or comparable instruments, when available. Where position-specific external prices are not observable, fair value is determined based on current interest rates and credit spreads for debt instruments with similar terms and maturity.

The carrying values of the remaining assets and liabilities not measured at fair value in the following tables approximate fair value due to their short-term nature.

Financial Instruments Not Measured at Fair Value

 

     At December 31, 2016      Fair Value by Level  
$ in millions    Carrying
Value
     Fair Value      Level 1      Level 2      Level 3  

Financial Assets

              

Cash and due from banks

   $ 22,017      $ 22,017      $     22,017      $      $  

Interest bearing deposits with banks

     21,364        21,364        21,364                

Investment securities—HTM securities

     16,922        16,453        5,557        10,896         

Securities purchased under agreements to resell

     101,653        101,655               97,825        3,830  

Securities borrowed

     125,236        125,240                   125,093        147  

Customer and other receivables1

     42,463        42,321               37,746        4,575  

Loans2

     94,248        95,027               20,906        74,121  

Other assets—Cash deposited with clearing organizations or segregated under federal and other regulations or requirements

     33,979        33,979        33,979                

Financial Liabilities

              

Deposits

   $     155,800      $     155,800      $      $ 155,800      $  

Short-term borrowings

     535        535               535         

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

     53,899        53,913               50,941                2,972  

Securities loaned

     15,844        15,853               15,853         

Other secured financings

     6,077        6,082               4,792        1,290  

Customer and other payables1

     187,671        187,671               187,671         

Long-term borrowings

     126,039        129,877               129,826        51  

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   128  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

     At December 31, 2015      Fair Value by Level  
$ in millions    Carrying
Value
     Fair Value      Level 1      Level 2      Level 3  

Financial Assets

              

Cash and due from banks

   $ 19,827      $ 19,827      $     19,827      $      $  

Interest bearing deposits with banks

     34,256        34,256        34,256                

Investment securities—HTM securities

     5,224        5,188        998        4,190         

Securities purchased under agreements to resell

     86,851        86,837               86,186        651  

Securities borrowed

     142,416        142,414                   142,266        148  

Customer and other receivables1

     41,676        41,576               36,752        4,824  

Loans2

     85,759        86,423               19,241              67,182  

Other assets—Cash deposited with clearing organizations or segregated under federal and other regulations or requirements

     31,469        31,469        31,469                

Financial Liabilities

              

Deposits

   $     155,909      $     156,163      $      $ 156,163      $  

Short-term borrowings

     525        525               525         

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

     36,009        36,060               34,150        1,910  

Securities loaned

     19,358        19,382               19,192        190  

Other secured financings

     6,610        6,610               5,333        1,277  

Customer and other payables1

     183,895        183,895               183,895         

Long-term borrowings

     120,723        123,219               123,219         

 

1.

Accrued interest, fees, and dividend receivables and payables where carrying value approximates fair value have been excluded.

2.

Amounts include loans measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis.

 

At December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, notional amounts of approximately $97.4 billion and $99.5 billion, respectively, of the Firm’s lending commitments were held for investment and held for sale, which are not included in the previous table. The estimated fair value of such lending commitments was a liability of $1,241 million and $2,172 million at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively. Had these commitments been accounted for at fair value, $973 million would have been categorized in Level 2 and $268 million in Level 3 at December 31, 2016, and $1,791 million would have been categorized in Level 2 and $381 million in Level 3 at December 31, 2015.

The previous tables exclude certain financial instruments such as equity method investments and all non-financial assets and liabilities such as the value of the long-term relationships with the Firm’s deposit customers.

4. Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities

The Firm trades and makes markets globally in listed futures, OTC swaps, forwards, options and other derivatives referencing, among other things, interest rates, currencies, investment grade and non-investment grade corporate credits, loans, bonds, U.S. and other sovereign securities, emerging market bonds and loans, credit indices, asset-backed security indices, property indices, mortgage-related and other asset-backed securities, and real estate loan products. The Firm uses these instruments for market-making, foreign currency exposure management, and asset and liability management.

The Firm manages its market-making positions by employing a variety of risk mitigation strategies. These strategies include diversification of risk exposures and hedging. Hedging activities consist of the purchase or sale of positions in related securities and financial instruments, including a variety of derivative products (e.g., futures, forwards, swaps and options). The Firm manages the market risk associated with its market-making activities on a Firm-wide basis, on a worldwide trading division level and on an individual product basis.

 

 

  129   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Derivative Assets and Liabilities

 

    Derivative Assets at December 31, 2016  
    Fair Value     Notional  
$ in millions   Bilateral
OTC
    Cleared
OTC
    Exchange-
Traded
    Total     Bilateral
OTC
    Cleared
OTC
    Exchange-
Traded
    Total  

Derivatives designated as accounting hedges

 

Interest rate contracts

  $ 1,924     $ 1,049     $     $ 2,973     $ 30,280     $ 37,632     $     $ 67,912  

Foreign exchange contracts

    249       18             267       6,400       339             6,739  

Total

    2,173       1,067             3,240       36,680       37,971             74,651  

Derivatives not designated as accounting hedges1

 

Interest rate contracts

    200,336       99,217       384       299,937       3,586,279       6,224,104       2,585,772       12,396,155  

Credit contracts

    9,837       2,392             12,229       332,641       111,954             444,595  

Foreign exchange contracts

    73,645       1,022       231       74,898       1,579,718       51,775       13,038       1,644,531  

Equity contracts

    20,710             17,919       38,629       337,791             241,837       579,628  

Commodity and other contracts

    9,792             3,727       13,519       67,216             79,670       146,886  

Total

    314,320       102,631       22,261       439,212       5,903,645       6,387,833       2,920,317       15,211,795  

Total gross derivatives2

  $     316,493     $     103,698     $     22,261     $     442,452     $  5,940,325     $  6,425,804     $  2,920,317     $  15,286,446  

Amounts offset

               

Counterparty netting

    (243,488     (100,477     (19,607     (363,572        

Cash collateral netting

    (45,875     (1,799           (47,674        

Total derivative assets in Trading assets

  $ 27,130     $ 1,422     $ 2,654     $ 31,206          

Amounts not offset3

               

Financial instruments collateral

    (10,293                 (10,293        

Other cash collateral

    (124                 (124        

Net amounts

  $ 16,713     $ 1,422     $ 2,654     $ 20,789          

 

    Derivative Liabilities at December 31, 2016  
    Fair Value     Notional  
$ in millions   Bilateral
OTC
    Cleared
OTC
    Exchange-
Traded
    Total     Bilateral
OTC
    Cleared
OTC
    Exchange-
Traded
    Total  

Derivatives designated as accounting hedges

 

Interest rate contracts

  $ 77     $ 647     $     $ 724     $ 2,024     $ 51,934     $     $ 53,958  

Foreign exchange contracts

    15       25             40       1,480       1,071             2,551  

Total

    92       672             764       3,504       53,005             56,509  

Derivatives not designated as accounting hedges1

 

Interest rate contracts

    183,063       103,392       397       286,852       3,461,927       6,086,774       896,971       10,445,672  

Credit contracts

    11,024       2,401             13,425       358,927       96,397             455,324  

Foreign exchange contracts

    74,575       952       16       75,543       1,556,918       47,647       14,338       1,618,903  

Equity contracts

    22,531             17,983       40,514       320,520             272,669       593,189  

Commodity and other contracts

    8,303             3,582       11,885       77,527             59,387       136,914  

Total

    299,496       106,745       21,978       428,219       5,775,819       6,230,818       1,243,365       13,250,002  

Total gross derivatives2

  $     299,588     $     107,417     $     21,978     $     428,983     $  5,779,323     $  6,283,823     $  1,243,365     $  13,306,511  

Amounts offset

               

Counterparty netting

    (243,488     (100,477     (19,607     (363,572        

Cash collateral netting

    (30,405     (5,691           (36,096        

Total derivative liabilities in Trading liabilities

  $ 25,695     $ 1,249     $ 2,371     $ 29,315          

Amounts not offset3

               

Financial instruments collateral

    (7,638           (585     (8,223        

Other cash collateral

    (10     (1           (11        

Net amounts

  $ 18,047     $ 1,248     $ 1,786     $ 21,081          

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   130  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

    Derivative Assets at December 31, 2015  
    Fair Value     Notional  
$ in millions   Bilateral
OTC
    Cleared
OTC
    Exchange-
Traded
    Total     Bilateral
OTC
    Cleared
OTC
    Exchange-
Traded
    Total  

Derivatives designated as accounting hedges

 

Interest rate contracts

  $ 2,825     $ 1,442     $     $ 4,267     $ 36,999     $ 35,362     $     $ 72,361  

Foreign exchange contracts

    166       1             167       5,996       167             6,163  

Total

    2,991       1,443             4,434       42,995       35,529             78,524  

Derivatives not designated as accounting hedges4

 

Interest rate contracts

    220,289       101,276       212       321,777       4,348,002       5,748,525       1,218,645       11,315,172  

Credit contracts

    19,310       3,609             22,919       585,731       139,301             725,032  

Foreign exchange contracts

    64,438       295       55       64,788       1,907,290       13,402       7,715       1,928,407  

Equity contracts

    20,212             20,077       40,289       316,770             229,859       546,629  

Commodity and other contracts

    13,333             4,038       17,371       73,133             82,313       155,446  

Total

    337,582       105,180       24,382       467,144       7,230,926       5,901,228       1,538,532       14,670,686  

Total gross derivatives2

  $     340,573     $     106,623     $     24,382     $     471,578     $  7,273,921     $  5,936,757     $  1,538,532     $  14,749,210  

Amounts offset

               

Counterparty netting

    (265,707     (104,294     (21,592     (391,593        

Cash collateral netting

    (50,335     (1,037           (51,372        

Total derivative assets in Trading assets

  $ 24,531     $ 1,292     $ 2,790     $ 28,613          

Amounts not offset3

               

Financial instruments collateral

    (9,190                 (9,190        

Other cash collateral

    (9                 (9        

Net amounts

  $ 15,332     $ 1,292     $ 2,790     $ 19,414          

 

    Derivative Liabilities at December 31, 2015  
    Fair Value     Notional  
$ in millions   Bilateral
OTC
    Cleared
OTC
    Exchange-
Traded
    Total    

Bilateral

OTC

   

Cleared

OTC

    Exchange-
Traded
    Total  

Derivatives designated as accounting hedges

 

Interest rate contracts

  $ 20     $ 250     $     $ 270     $ 3,560     $ 9,869     $     $ 13,429  

Foreign exchange contracts

    56       6             62       4,604       455             5,059  

Total

    76       256             332       8,164       10,324             18,488  

Derivatives not designated as accounting hedges4

 

Interest rate contracts

    203,004       103,852       283       307,139       4,030,039       5,682,322       1,077,710       10,790,071  

Credit contracts

    19,942       3,723             23,665       562,027       131,388             693,415  

Foreign exchange contracts

    65,034       232       22       65,288       1,868,015       13,322       2,655       1,883,992  

Equity contracts

    25,708             20,424       46,132       332,734             229,266       562,000  

Commodity and other contracts

    10,907             3,887       14,794       63,283             62,974       126,257  

Total

    324,595       107,807       24,616       457,018       6,856,098       5,827,032       1,372,605       14,055,735  

Total gross derivatives2

  $     324,671     $     108,063     $ 24,616     $     457,350     $  6,864,262     $  5,837,356     $  1,372,605     $  14,074,223  

Amounts offset

               

Counterparty netting

    (265,707     (104,294     (21,592     (391,593        

Cash collateral netting

    (33,332     (2,951           (36,283        

Total derivative liabilities in Trading liabilities

  $ 25,632     $ 818     $ 3,024     $ 29,474          

Amounts not offset3

               

Financial instruments collateral

    (5,384           (405     (5,789        

Other cash collateral

    (5                 (5        

Net amounts

  $ 20,243     $ 818     $ 2,619     $ 23,680          

 

  131   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

1.

Notional amounts include gross notionals related to open long and short futures contracts of $2,088.0 billion and $332.4 billion, respectively. The unsettled fair value on these futures contracts (excluded from this table) of $784 million and $174 million is included in Customer and other receivables and Customer and other payables, respectively, in the consolidated balance sheets.

2.

Amounts include transactions that are either not subject to master netting agreements or collateral agreements or are subject to such agreements but the Firm has not determined the agreements to be legally enforceable as follows: $3.7 billion of derivative assets and $3.5 billion of derivative liabilities at December 31, 2016 and $4.2 billion of derivative assets and $5.2 billion of derivative liabilities at December 31, 2015.

3.

Amounts relate to master netting agreements and collateral agreements that have been determined by the Firm to be legally enforceable in the event of default but where certain other criteria are not met in accordance with applicable offsetting accounting guidance.

4.

Notional amounts include gross notionals related to open long and short futures contracts of $1,009.5 billion and $653.0 billion, respectively. The unsettled fair value on these futures contracts (excluded from this table) of $1,145 million and $437 million is included in Customer and other receivables and Customer and other payables, respectively, in the consolidated balance sheets.

For information related to offsetting of certain collateralized transactions, see Note 6.

Gains (Losses) on Fair Value Hedges

 

    

Gains (Losses) Recognized in

Interest Expense

 
$ in millions        2016             2015             2014      

Derivatives

   $ (1,738   $ (700   $ 1,462  

Borrowings

     1,541       461       (1,616

Total

   $ (197   $ (239   $ (154

Gains (Losses) on Effective Portion of Net Investment Hedges

 

     Gains (Losses) Recognized in
OCI
 
$ in millions        2016             2015              2014      

Foreign exchange contracts1

   $ (1   $ 434      $ 606  

 

1.

Losses of $74 million in 2016, $149 million in 2015 and $186 million in 2014 recognized in Interest income were related to the forward points on the hedging instruments that were excluded from hedge effectiveness testing.

Trading Revenues by Product Type

 

$ in millions        2016              2015              2014      

Interest rate contracts

   $ 1,522      $ 1,249      $ 1,065  

Foreign exchange contracts

     1,156        984        729  

Equity security and index contracts1

     5,690        5,695        4,603  

Commodity and other contracts

     56        793        1,055  

Credit contracts

     1,785        775        1,274  

Subtotal

   $ 10,209      $ 9,496      $ 8,726  

Debt valuation adjustment2

            618        651  

Total trading revenues

   $ 10,209      $ 10,114      $ 9,377  

 

1.

Dividend income is included within equity security and index contracts.

2.

In 2016, in accordance with the early adoption of a provision of the accounting update Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities, unrealized DVA gains (losses) are recorded within OCI in the consolidated comprehensive income statements. In 2015 and 2014, the DVA gains (losses) were recorded within Trading revenues in the consolidated income statements. See Notes 2 and 15 for further information.

The previous table summarizes gains and losses included in Trading revenues in the consolidated income statements from trading activities. These activities include revenues related to derivative and non-derivative financial instruments. The Firm generally utilizes financial instruments across a variety of product types in connection with their market-making and related risk management strategies. Accordingly, the trading revenues presented in the previous table are not representative of the manner in which the Firm manages its business activities and are prepared in a manner similar to the presentation of trading revenues for regulatory reporting purposes.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   132  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

OTC Derivative Products—Trading Assets

Counterparty Credit Rating and Remaining Maturity of OTC Derivative Assets

 

     Fair Value at December 31, 20161  
     Contractual Years to Maturity     

Cross-Maturity

and Cash

Collateral

Netting2

   

Net Amounts

Post-cash

Collateral

    

Net Amounts

Post-
collateral3

 
$ in millions    Less than 1      1-3      3-5      Over 5          

Credit Rating4

 

       

AAA

   $ 150      $ 428      $ 918      $ 2,931      $ (3,900   $ 527      $ 485  

AA

     3,177        2,383        2,942        10,194        (11,813     6,883        4,114  

A

     9,244        6,676        5,495        21,322        (31,425     11,312        6,769  

BBB

     4,423        3,085        2,434        13,023        (16,629     6,336        4,852  

Non-investment grade

     2,283        1,702        1,722        1,794        (4,131     3,370        1,915  

Total

   $ 19,277      $ 14,274      $ 13,511      $ 49,264      $ (67,898   $ 28,428      $ 18,135  

 

     Fair Value at December 31, 20151  
     Contractual Years to Maturity     

Cross-Maturity

and Cash

Collateral
Netting2

    Net Amounts
Post-cash
Collateral
     Net Amounts
Post-
collateral3
 
$ in millions    Less than 1      1-3      3-5      Over 5          

Credit Rating4

 

       

AAA

   $ 203      $ 453      $ 827      $ 3,665      $ (4,319   $ 829      $ 715  

AA

     2,689        2,000        1,876        9,223        (10,981     4,807        2,361  

A

     9,748        8,191        4,774        20,918        (34,916     8,715        5,448  

BBB

     3,614        4,863        1,948        11,801        (15,086     7,140        4,934  

Non-investment grade

     3,982        2,333        1,157        3,567        (6,716     4,323        3,166  

Total

   $ 20,236      $ 17,840      $ 10,582      $ 49,174      $ (72,018   $ 25,814      $ 16,624  

 

1.

Fair values shown represent the Firm’s net exposure to counterparties related to its OTC derivative products.

2.

Amounts represent the netting of receivable balances with payable balances for the same counterparty across maturity categories. Receivable and payable balances with the same counterparty in the same maturity category are netted within such maturity category, where appropriate. Cash collateral received is netted on a counterparty basis, provided legal right of offset exists.

3.

Fair value is shown, net of collateral received (primarily cash and U.S. government and agency securities).

4.

Obligor credit ratings are determined internally by the Credit Risk Management Department.

Credit Risk-Related Contingencies

 

In connection with certain OTC trading agreements, the Firm may be required to provide additional collateral or immediately settle any outstanding liability balances with certain counterparties in the event of a credit rating downgrade of the Firm.

The following table presents the aggregate fair value of certain derivative contracts that contain credit risk-related contingent features that are in a net liability position for which the Firm has posted collateral in the normal course of business.

Net Derivative Liabilities and Collateral Posted

 

$ in millions    At December 31,
2016
     At December 31,
2015
 

Net derivative liabilities with credit risk-related contingent features

   $ 22,939      $ 23,526  

Collateral posted

     17,040        19,070  

The additional collateral or termination payments that may be called in the event of a future credit rating downgrade vary by

contract and can be based on ratings by either or both of Moody’s Investors Service, Inc. (“Moody’s”) and Standard & Poor’s Global Ratings (“S&P”). The following table shows the future potential collateral amounts and termination payments that could be called or required by counterparties or exchange and clearing organizations in the event of one-notch or two-notch downgrade scenarios based on the relevant contractual downgrade triggers.

Incremental Collateral or Termination Payments upon Potential Future Ratings Downgrade

 

$ in millions    At December 31,
2016
1

One-notch downgrade

   $1,269

Two-notch downgrade

   692

 

1.

Amounts include $1,231 million related to bilateral arrangements between the Firm and other parties where upon the downgrade of one party, the downgraded party must deliver collateral to the other party. These bilateral downgrade arrangements are used by the Firm to manage the risk of counterparty downgrades.

 

 

  133   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Credit Derivatives and Other Credit Contracts

The Firm enters into credit derivatives, principally through credit default swaps, under which it receives or provides protection against the risk of default on a set of debt obligations issued by a specified reference entity or entities. A majority of the Firm’s counterparties for these derivatives are banks, broker-dealers, and insurance and other financial institutions.

Protection Sold and Purchased with Credit Default Swaps

 

     At December 31, 2016  
     Protection Sold     Protection Purchased  
$ in millions    Notional     

Fair Value
(Asset)/

Liability

    Notional     

Fair Value
(Asset)/

Liability

 

Credit default swaps

 

       

Single name

   $ 266,918      $ (753   $ 269,623      $ 826  

Index and basket

     130,383        374       122,061        (481

Tranched index and basket

     32,429        (670     78,505        1,900  

Total

   $ 429,730      $ (1,049   $ 470,189      $ 2,245  

 

     At December 31, 2015  
     Protection Sold     Protection Purchased  
$ in millions    Notional     

Fair Value
(Asset)/

Liability

    Notional     

Fair Value
(Asset)/

Liability

 

Credit default swaps

 

       

Single name

   $ 420,806      $ 1,980     $ 405,361      $ (2,079

Index and basket

     199,688        (102     173,936        (82

Tranched index and basket

     69,025        (1,093     149,631        2,122  

Total

   $ 689,519      $ 785     $ 728,928      $ (39

For single name and non-tranched index and basket credit default swaps, the Firm has purchased protection with a notional amount of approximately $389.2 billion and $577.7 billion at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively, compared with a notional amount of approximately $395.5 billion and $619.5 billion (included in the following tables) at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively, of credit protection sold with identical underlying reference obligations.

The purchase of credit protection does not represent the sole manner in which the Firm risk manages its exposure to credit derivatives. The Firm manages its exposure to these derivative contracts through a variety of risk mitigation strategies, which include managing the credit and correlation risk across single name, non-tranched indices and baskets, tranched indices and baskets, and cash positions. Aggregate market risk limits have been established for credit derivatives, and market risk measures are routinely monitored against these limits. The Firm may also recover amounts on the underlying reference obligation delivered to the Firm under credit default swaps where credit protection was sold.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   134  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Credit Ratings of Reference Obligation and Maturities of Credit Protection Sold

 

     At December 31, 2016  
     Maximum Potential Payout/Notional     

Fair Value

(Asset)/

Liability1

 
     Years to Maturity     
$ in millions    Less than 1      1-3      3-5      Over 5      Total     

Single name credit default swaps2

                 

Investment grade

   $ 79,449      $ 70,796      $ 34,529      $ 10,293      $ 195,067      $ (1,060

Non-investment grade

     34,571        25,820        10,436        1,024        71,851        307  

Total single name credit default swaps

   $ 114,020      $ 96,616      $ 44,965      $ 11,317      $ 266,918      $ (753

Index and basket credit default swaps2

                 

Investment grade

   $ 26,530      $ 21,388      $ 35,060      $ 9,096      $ 92,074      $ (846

Non-investment grade

     26,135        22,983        11,759        9,861        70,738        550  

Total index and basket credit default swaps

   $ 52,665      $ 44,371      $ 46,819      $ 18,957      $ 162,812      $ (296

Total credit default swaps sold

   $ 166,685      $ 140,987      $ 91,784      $ 30,274      $ 429,730      $ (1,049

Other credit contracts

     49        6               215        270         

Total credit derivatives and other credit contracts

   $ 166,734      $ 140,993      $ 91,784      $ 30,489      $ 430,000      $ (1,049

 

     At December 31, 2015  
     Maximum Potential Payout/Notional     

Fair Value

(Asset)/

Liability1

 
     Years to Maturity     
$ in millions    Less than 1      1-3      3-5      Over 5      Total     

Single name credit default swaps2

                 

Investment grade

   $ 84,543      $ 138,467      $ 63,754      $ 12,906      $ 299,670      $ (1,831

Non-investment grade

     38,054        56,261        24,432        2,389        121,136        3,811  

Total single name credit default swaps

   $ 122,597      $ 194,728      $ 88,186      $ 15,295      $ 420,806      $ 1,980  

Index and basket credit default swaps2

                 

Investment grade

   $ 33,507      $ 59,403      $ 45,505      $ 5,327      $ 143,742      $ (1,977

Non-investment grade

     52,590        43,899        15,480        13,002        124,971        782  

Total index and basket credit default swaps

   $ 86,097      $ 103,302      $ 60,985      $ 18,329      $ 268,713      $ (1,195

Total credit default swaps sold

   $ 208,694      $ 298,030      $ 149,171      $ 33,624      $ 689,519      $ 785  

Other credit contracts

     19        107        2        332        460        (24

Total credit derivatives and other credit contracts

   $ 208,713      $ 298,137      $ 149,173      $ 33,956      $ 689,979      $ 761  

 

1.

Fair value amounts are shown on a gross basis prior to cash collateral or counterparty netting.

2.

In order to provide an indication of the current payment status or performance risk of the CDS, a breakdown of CDS based on the Firm’s internal credit ratings by investment grade and non-investment grade is provided. Internal credit ratings serve as the Credit Risk Management Department’s assessment of credit risk and the basis for a comprehensive credit limits framework used to control credit risk. The Firm uses quantitative models and judgment to estimate the various risk parameters related to each obligor.

 

Single Name Credit Default Swaps

A credit default swap protects the buyer against the loss of principal on a bond or loan in case of a default by the issuer. The protection buyer pays a periodic premium (generally quarterly) over the life of the contract and is protected for the period. The Firm, in turn, performs under a credit default swap if a credit event as defined under the contract occurs. Typical credit events include bankruptcy, dissolution or insolvency of the referenced entity, failure to pay and restructuring of the obligations of the referenced entity.

Index and Basket Credit Default Swaps

Index and basket credit default swaps are products where credit protection is provided on a portfolio of single name credit default swaps. Generally, in the event of a default on

one of the underlying names, the Firm pays a pro rata portion of the total notional amount of the credit default swap.

The Firm also enters into tranched index and basket credit default swaps where credit protection is provided on a particular portion of the portfolio loss distribution. The most junior tranches cover initial defaults, and once losses exceed the notional of the tranche, they are passed on to the next most senior tranche in the capital structure.

Credit Protection Sold through CLNs and CDOs

The Firm has invested in credit-linked notes (“CLNs”) and CDOs, which are hybrid instruments containing embedded derivatives, in which credit protection has been sold to the issuer of the note. If there is a credit event of a reference entity underlying the instrument, the principal balance of the note may not be repaid in full to the Firm.

 

 

  135   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

5. Investment Securities

AFS and HTM Securities

 

     At December 31, 2016  
$ in millions    Amortized
Cost
     Gross
Unrealized
Gains
     Gross
Unrealized
Losses
     Fair Value  

AFS debt securities

           

U.S. government and agency securities:

           

U.S. Treasury securities

   $ 28,371      $ 1      $ 545      $ 27,827  

U.S. agency securities1

     22,348        14        278        22,084  

Total U.S. government and agency securities

     50,719        15        823        49,911  

Corporate and other debt:

           

Commercial mortgage- backed securities:

           

Agency

     1,850        2        44        1,808  

Non-agency

     2,250        11        16        2,245  

Auto loan asset-backed securities

     1,509        1        1        1,509  

Corporate bonds

     3,836        7        22        3,821  

Collateralized loan obligations

     540               1        539  

FFELP student loan asset- backed securities2

     3,387        5        61        3,331  

Total corporate and other debt

     13,372        26        145        13,253  

Total AFS debt securities

     64,091        41        968        63,164  

AFS equity securities

     15               9        6  

Total AFS securities

     64,106        41        977        63,170  

HTM securities

           

U.S. government securities:

           

U.S. Treasury securities

     5,839        1        283        5,557  

U.S. agency securities1

     11,083        1        188        10,896  

Total HTM securities

     16,922        2        471        16,453  

Total Investment securities

   $ 81,028      $ 43      $ 1,448      $ 79,623  
     At December 31, 2015  
$ in millions    Amortized
Cost
     Gross
Unrealized
Gains
     Gross
Unrealized
Losses
     Fair Value  

AFS debt securities

           

U.S. government and agency securities:

           

U.S. Treasury securities

   $ 31,555      $ 5      $ 143      $ 31,417  

U.S. agency securities1

     21,103        29        156        20,976  

Total U.S. government and agency securities

     52,658        34        299        52,393  

Corporate and other debt:

           

Commercial mortgage- backed securities:

           

Agency

     1,906        1        60        1,847  

Non-agency

     2,220        3        25        2,198  

Auto loan asset-backed securities

     2,556               9        2,547  

Corporate bonds

     3,780        5        30        3,755  

Collateralized loan obligations

     502               7        495  

FFELP student loan asset- backed securities2

     3,632               115        3,517  

Total corporate and other debt

     14,596        9        246        14,359  

Total AFS debt securities

     67,254        43        545        66,752  

AFS equity securities

     15               8        7  

Total AFS securities

     67,269        43        553        66,759  

HTM securities

           

U.S. government securities:

           

U.S. Treasury securities

     1,001               3        998  

U.S. agency securities1

     4,223        1        34        4,190  

Total HTM securities

     5,224        1        37        5,188  

Total Investment securities

   $ 72,493      $ 44      $ 590      $ 71,947  

 

1.

U.S. agency securities consist mainly of agency-issued debt, agency mortgage pass-through pool securities and collateralized mortgage obligations.

2.

Amounts are backed by a guarantee from the U.S. Department of Education of at least 95% of the principal balance and interest on such loans.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   136  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Investment Securities in an Unrealized Loss Position

 

     At December 31, 2016  
     Less than 12 Months      12 Months or Longer      Total  
$ in millions    Fair Value      Gross
Unrealized
Losses
     Fair Value      Gross
Unrealized
Losses
     Fair Value      Gross
Unrealized
Losses
 

AFS debt securities

                 

U.S. government and agency securities:

                 

U.S. Treasury securities

   $ 25,323      $ 545      $      $      $ 25,323      $ 545  

U.S. agency securities

     16,760        278        125               16,885        278  

Total U.S. government and agency securities

     42,083        823        125               42,208        823  

Corporate and other debt:

                 

Commercial mortgage-backed securities:

                 

Agency

     1,245        44                      1,245        44  

Non-agency

     763        11        594        5        1,357        16  

Auto loan asset-backed securities

     659        1        123               782        1  

Corporate bonds

     2,050        21        142        1        2,192        22  

Collateralized loan obligations

     178               239        1        417        1  

FFELP student loan asset-backed securities

     2,612        61                      2,612        61  

Total corporate and other debt

     7,507        138        1,098        7        8,605        145  

Total AFS debt securities

     49,590        961        1,223        7        50,813        968  

AFS equity securities

     6        9                      6        9  

Total AFS securities

     49,596        970        1,223        7        50,819        977  

HTM securities

                 

U.S. government and agency securities:

                 

U.S. Treasury securities

     5,057        283                      5,057        283  

U.S. agency securities

     10,612        188                      10,612        188  

Total HTM securities

     15,669        471                      15,669        471  

Total Investment securities

   $ 65,265      $ 1,441      $ 1,223      $ 7      $ 66,488      $ 1,448  

 

  137   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

     At December 31, 2015  
     Less than 12 Months      12 Months or Longer      Total  
$ in millions    Fair Value      Gross
Unrealized
Losses
     Fair Value      Gross
Unrealized
Losses
     Fair Value      Gross
Unrealized
Losses
 

AFS debt securities

                 

U.S. government and agency securities:

                 

U.S. Treasury securities

   $ 25,994      $ 126      $ 2,177      $ 17      $ 28,171      $ 143  

U.S. agency securities

     14,242        135        639        21        14,881        156  

Total U.S. government and agency securities

     40,236        261        2,816        38        43,052        299  

Corporate and other debt:

                 

Commercial mortgage-backed securities:

                 

Agency

     1,185        44        422        16        1,607        60  

Non-agency

     1,479        21        305        4        1,784        25  

Auto loan asset-backed securities

     1,644        7        881        2        2,525        9  

Corporate bonds

     2,149        19        525        11        2,674        30  

Collateralized loan obligations

     352        5        143        2        495        7  

FFELP student loan asset-backed securities

     2,558        79        929        36        3,487        115  

Total corporate and other debt

     9,367        175        3,205        71        12,572        246  

Total AFS debt securities

     49,603        436        6,021        109        55,624        545  

AFS equity securities

     7        8                      7        8  

Total AFS securities

     49,610        444        6,021        109        55,631        553  

HTM securities

                 

U.S. government and agency securities:

                 

U.S. Treasury securities

     898        3                      898        3  

U.S. agency securities

     3,677        34                      3,677        34  

Total HTM securities

     4,575        37                      4,575        37  

Total Investment securities

   $ 54,185      $ 481      $ 6,021      $ 109      $ 60,206      $ 590  

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   138  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

The Firm believes there are no securities in an unrealized loss position that are other-than-temporarily-impaired at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015 for the reasons discussed herein.

For AFS debt securities, the Firm does not intend to sell the securities and is not likely to be required to sell the securities prior to recovery of amortized cost basis. For AFS and HTM debt securities, the securities have not experienced credit losses as the net unrealized losses reported in the previous table are primarily due to higher interest rates since those securities were purchased.

Additionally, the Firm does not expect to experience a credit loss based on consideration of the relevant information (as discussed in Note 2), including for U.S. government and agency securities, the existence of an explicit and implicit guarantee provided by the U.S. government. The risk of credit loss on securities in an unrealized loss position is considered minimal because the Firm’s agency securities, as well as ABS, CMBS and CLOs, are highly rated and because corporate bonds are all investment grade.

For AFS equity securities, the Firm has the intent and ability to hold these securities for a period of time sufficient to allow for any anticipated recovery in market value.

See Note 13 for additional information on securities issued by VIEs, including U.S. agency mortgage-backed securities, non-agency CMBS, auto loan ABS, CLO and FFELP student loan ABS.

Investment Securities by Contractual Maturity

 

     At December 31, 2016  
$ in millions    Amortized
Cost
     Fair Value      Average
Yield
 

AFS debt securities

        

U.S. government and agency securities:

 

U.S. Treasury securities:

        

Due within 1 year

   $         2,162      $           2,160        0.8%  

After 1 year through 5 years

     20,280        20,089        1.1%  

After 5 years through 10 years

     5,929        5,578        1.4%  

Total

     28,371        27,827           

U.S. agency securities:

        

Due within 1 year

     36        36        0.7%  

After 1 year through 5 years

     3,581        3,570        0.7%  

After 5 years through 10 years

     1,255        1,251        2.0%  

After 10 years

     17,476        17,227        1.8%  

Total

     22,348        22,084           

Total U.S. government and agency securities

     50,719        49,911        1.4%  
     At December 31, 2016  
$ in millions    Amortized
Cost
     Fair Value      Average
Yield
 

Corporate and other debt:

        

Commercial mortgage-backed securities:

 

Agency:

        

Due within 1 year

     116        116        1.1%  

After 1 year through 5 years

     267        267        1.2%  

After 5 years through 10 years

     546        546        1.2%  

After 10 years

     921        879        1.6%  

Total

     1,850        1,808           

Non-agency:

        

After 5 years through 10 years

     35        34        2.5%  

After 10 years

     2,215        2,211        2.0%  

Total

     2,250        2,245           

Auto loan asset-backed securities:

 

Due within 1 year

     84        84        1.3%  

After 1 year through 5 years

     1,363        1,363        1.4%  

After 5 years through 10 years

     62        62        1.6%  

Total

     1,509        1,509           

Corporate bonds:

        

Due within 1 year

     860        859        1.3%  

After 1 year through 5 years

     2,270        2,265        2.0%  

After 5 years through 10 years

     706        697        2.4%  

Total

     3,836        3,821           

Collateralized loan obligations:

        

After 5 years through 10 years

     362        361        1.5%  

After 10 years

     178        178        2.4%  

Total

     540        539           

FFELP student loan asset-backed securities:

        

After 1 year through 5 years

     70        70        0.7%  

After 5 years through 10 years

     806        785        0.9%  

After 10 years

     2,511        2,476        1.0%  

Total

     3,387        3,331           

Total corporate and other debt

     13,372        13,253        1.6%  

Total AFS debt securities

     64,091        63,164        1.4%  

AFS equity securities

     15        6        — %  

Total AFS securities

     64,106        63,170        1.4%  

HTM securities

        

U.S. government securities:

        

U.S. Treasury securities:

        

Due within 1 year

     500        500        0.7%  

After 1 year through 5 years

     2,013        2,003        1.3%  

After 5 years through 10 years

     2,600        2,433        1.6%  

After 10 years

     726        621        2.3%  

Total

     5,839        5,557           

U.S. agency securities:

        

After 10 years

     11,083        10,896        2.4%  

Total

     11,083        10,896           

Total HTM securities

     16,922        16,453        2.1%  

Total Investment securities

   $ 81,028      $ 79,623        1.6%  
 

 

  139   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Gross Realized Gains and Losses on Sales of AFS Securities

 

$ in millions    2016     2015     2014  

Gross realized gains

   $ 133     $ 116     $ 41  

Gross realized (losses)

     (21     (32     (1

Total

   $ 112     $ 84     $ 40  

Gross realized gains and losses are recognized in Other revenues in the consolidated income statements.

6. Collateralized Transactions

The Firm enters into securities purchased under agreements to resell, securities sold under agreements to repurchase, securities borrowed and securities loaned transactions to, among other things, acquire securities to cover short positions and settle other securities obligations, to accommodate customers’ needs and to finance its inventory positions.

The Firm manages credit exposure arising from such transactions by, in appropriate circumstances, entering into master netting agreements and collateral agreements with counterparties that provide the Firm, in the event of a counterparty default (such as bankruptcy or a counterparty’s failure to pay or perform), with the right to net a counterparty’s rights and obligations under such agreement and liquidate and set off collateral held by the Firm against the net amount owed by the counterparty.

The Firm’s policy is generally to take possession of securities purchased or borrowed in connection with securities purchased under agreements to resell and securities borrowed transactions, respectively, and to receive cash and securities delivered under securities sold under agreements to repurchase or securities loaned transactions (with rights of rehypothecation). In certain cases, the Firm may be permitted to post collateral to a third-party custodian under a tri-party arrangement that enables the Firm to take control of such collateral in the event of a counterparty default.

The Firm also monitors the fair value of the underlying securities as compared with the related receivable or payable, including accrued interest, and, as necessary, requests additional collateral as provided under the applicable agreement to ensure such transactions are adequately collateralized or the return of excess collateral.

The risk related to a decline in the market value of collateral (pledged or received) is managed by setting appropriate market-based haircuts. Increases in collateral margin calls on secured financing due to market value declines may be mitigated by increases in collateral margin calls on securities purchased under agreements to resell and securities borrowed transactions with similar quality collateral. Additionally, the Firm may request lower quality collateral pledged be replaced

with higher quality collateral through collateral substitution rights in the underlying agreements.

The Firm actively manages its secured financing in a manner that reduces the potential refinancing risk of secured financing for less liquid assets. The Firm considers the quality of collateral when negotiating collateral eligibility with counterparties, as defined by its fundability criteria. The Firm utilizes shorter-term secured financing for highly liquid assets and has established longer tenor limits for less liquid assets, for which funding may be at risk in the event of a market disruption.

Offsetting of Certain Collateralized Transactions

 

    At December 31, 2016  
$ in millions   Gross
Amounts1
   

Amounts

Offset

    Net
Amounts
Presented
    Amounts
Not Offset2
    Net
Amounts
 

Assets

         

Securities purchased under agreements to resell

  $   182,888     $     (80,933   $ 101,955     $     (93,365   $ 8,590  

Securities borrowed

    129,934       (4,698     125,236       (118,974     6,262  

Liabilities

         

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

  $ 135,561     $ (80,933   $ 54,628     $ (47,933   $ 6,695  

Securities loaned

    20,542       (4,698     15,844       (15,670     174  

 

    At December 31, 2015  
$ in millions   Gross
Amounts1
   

Amounts

Offset

    Net
Amounts
Presented
    Amounts
Not Offset2
    Net
Amounts
 

Assets

         

Securities purchased under agreements to resell

  $   135,714     $     (48,057   $ 87,657     $     (84,752   $ 2,905  

Securities borrowed

    147,445       (5,029     142,416       (134,250     8,166  

Liabilities

         

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

  $ 84,749     $ (48,057   $ 36,692     $ (31,604   $ 5,088  

Securities loaned

    24,387       (5,029     19,358       (18,881     477  

 

1.

Amounts include transactions that are either not subject to master netting agreements or are subject to such agreements but the Firm has not determined the agreements to be legally enforceable as follows: $7.8 billion of Securities purchased under agreements to resell, $2.6 billion of Securities borrowed, $6.5 billion of Securities sold under agreements to repurchase and $0.2 billion of Securities loaned at December 31, 2016 and $2.6 billion of Securities purchased under agreements to resell, $3.0 billion of Securities borrowed and $4.9 billion of Securities sold under agreements to repurchase at December 31, 2015.

2.

Amounts relate to master netting agreements that have been determined by the Firm to be legally enforceable in the event of default but where certain other criteria are not met in accordance with applicable offsetting accounting guidance.

For information related to offsetting of derivatives, see Note 4.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   140  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Maturities and Collateral Pledged

Gross Secured Financing Balances by Remaining Contractual Maturity

 

    At December 31, 2016  
$ in millions  

Overnight

and
Open

   

Less
than

30 Days

    30-90
Days
   

Over

90 Days

    Total  

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase1

  $   41,549     $   36,703     $   24,648     $   32,661     $   135,561  

Securities loaned1

    9,487       851       2,863       7,341       20,542  

Gross amount of secured financing included in the offsetting disclosure

  $   51,036     $   37,554     $   27,511     $   40,002     $   156,103  

Trading liabilities—Obligation to return securities received as collateral

    20,262                         20,262  

Total

  $   71,298     $   37,554     $   27,511     $   40,002     $   176,365  

 

    At December 31, 2015  
$ in millions  

Overnight

and
Open

   

Less
than

30 Days

    30-90
Days
   

Over

90 Days

    Total  

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase1

  $   20,410     $   25,245     $   13,221     $   25,873     $   84,749  

Securities loaned1

    12,247       478       2,156       9,506       24,387  

Gross amount of secured financing included in the offsetting disclosure

  $   32,657     $   25,723     $   15,377     $   35,379     $   109,136  

Trading liabilities—Obligation to return securities received as collateral

    19,316                         19,316  

Total

  $   51,973     $   25,723     $   15,377     $   35,379     $   128,452  

 

1.

Amounts are presented on a gross basis, prior to netting in the consolidated balance sheets.

Gross Secured Financing Balances by Class of Collateral Pledged

 

$ in millions   

At

December 31,
2016

    

At

December 31,
2015

 

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase1

 

U.S. government and agency securities

   $ 56,372      $ 36,609  

State and municipal securities

     1,363        173  

Other sovereign government obligations

     42,790        24,820  

Asset-backed securities

     1,918        441  

Corporate and other debt

     9,086        4,020  

Corporate equities

     23,152        18,473  

Other

     880        213  

Total securities sold under agreements to repurchase

   $ 135,561      $ 84,749  

Securities loaned1

     

U.S. government and agency securities

   $ 1      $  

Other sovereign government obligations

     4,762        7,336  

Corporate and other debt

     73        71  

Corporate equities

     15,693        16,972  

Other

     13        8  

Total securities loaned

   $ 20,542      $ 24,387  

Gross amount of secured financing included in the offsetting disclosure

   $ 156,103      $ 109,136  

Trading liabilities—Obligation to return securities received as collateral

 

Corporate and other debt

   $      $ 3  

Corporate equities

     20,247        19,313  

Other

     15         

Total Trading liabilities—obligation to return securities received as collateral

   $ 20,262      $ 19,316  

Total

   $           176,365      $           128,452  

 

1.

Amounts are presented on a gross basis, prior to netting in the consolidated balance sheets.

 

 

  141   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Trading Assets Pledged

The Firm pledges its trading assets to collateralize securities sold under agreements to repurchase, securities loaned and other secured financings. Pledged financial instruments that can be sold or repledged by the secured party are identified as Trading assets (pledged to various parties) in the consolidated balance sheets. At December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, the carrying value of Trading assets that have been loaned or pledged to counterparties, where those counterparties do not have the right to sell or repledge the collateral, was $41.4 billion and $35.0 billion, respectively.

Collateral Received

The Firm receives collateral in the form of securities in connection with securities purchased under agreements to resell, securities borrowed and derivative transactions, customer margin loans and securities-based lending. In many cases, the Firm is permitted to sell or repledge these securities held as collateral and use the securities to secure securities sold under agreements to repurchase, to enter into securities lending and derivative transactions or for delivery to counterparties to cover short positions.

The Firm additionally receives securities as collateral in connection with certain securities-for-securities transactions. In instances where the Firm is the lender and permitted to sell or repledge these securities, it reports the fair value of the collateral received and the related obligation to return the collateral included in Trading assets and Trading liabilities, respectively, in its consolidated balance sheets. At December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, the total fair value of financial instruments received as collateral where the Firm is permitted to sell or repledge the securities was $561.2 billion and $522.6 billion, respectively, and the fair value of the portion that had been sold or repledged was $430.9 billion and $398.1 billion, respectively.

Concentration Risk

The Firm is subject to concentration risk by holding large positions in certain types of securities, loans or commitments to purchase securities of a single issuer, including sovereign governments and other entities, issuers located in a particular country or geographic area, public and private issuers involving developing countries or issuers engaged in a particular industry.

Trading assets owned by the Firm include U.S. government and agency securities and securities issued by other sovereign governments (principally the United Kingdom (“U.K.”), Brazil and Japan), which, in the aggregate, represented approximately 8% and 7% of the Firm’s total assets at

December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively. In addition, substantially all of the collateral held by the Firm for resale agreements or bonds borrowed, which together represented approximately 18% and 15% of the Firm’s total assets at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively, consists of securities issued by the U.S. government, federal agencies or other sovereign government obligations.

Positions taken and commitments made by the Firm, including positions taken and underwriting and financing commitments made in connection with its private equity, principal investment and lending activities, often involve substantial amounts and significant exposure to individual issuers and businesses, including non-investment grade issuers. In addition, the Firm may originate and/or purchase certain residential and commercial mortgage loans that could contain certain terms and features that may result in additional credit risk as compared with more traditional types of mortgages. Such terms and features may include loans made to borrowers subject to payment increases or loans with high loan-to-value ratios.

Customer Margin Lending

The Firm engages in margin lending to clients that allows the client to borrow against the value of qualifying securities. Margin loans are included within Customer and other receivables in the consolidated balance sheets. Under these agreements and transactions, the Firm receives collateral, including U.S. government and agency securities, other sovereign government obligations, corporate and other debt, and corporate equities. Customer receivables generated from margin lending activities are collateralized by customer-owned securities held by the Firm. The Firm monitors required margin levels and established credit terms daily and, pursuant to such guidelines, requires customers to deposit additional collateral, or reduce positions, when necessary.

Margin loans are extended on a demand basis and are not committed facilities. Factors considered in the review of margin loans are the amount of the loan, the intended purpose, the degree of leverage being employed in the account, and overall evaluation of the portfolio to ensure proper diversification or, in the case of concentrated positions, appropriate liquidity of the underlying collateral or potential hedging strategies to reduce risk.

Underlying collateral for margin loans is reviewed with respect to the liquidity of the proposed collateral positions, valuation of securities, historic trading range, volatility analysis and an evaluation of industry concentrations. For these transactions, adherence to the Firm’s collateral policies significantly limits its credit exposure in the event of a customer default. The Firm may request additional margin collateral from customers, if appropriate, and, if necessary,

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   142  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

may sell securities that have not been paid for or purchase securities sold but not delivered from customers. At December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, the amounts related to margin lending were approximately $24.4 billion and $25.3 billion, respectively.

Other secured financings include the liabilities related to transfers of financial assets that are accounted for as financings rather than sales, consolidated VIEs where the Firm is deemed to be the primary beneficiary, and certain equity-linked notes (“ELN”) and other secured borrowings. These liabilities are generally payable from the cash flows of the related assets accounted for as Trading assets (see Notes 11 and 13).

Cash and Securities Deposited with Clearing Organizations or Segregated

 

$ in millions   

At

December 31,
2016

    

At

December 31,

2015

 

Securities1

   $ 23,756      $ 14,390  

Other assets—Cash deposited with clearing organizations or segregated under federal and other regulations or requirements

     33,979        31,469  

Total

   $           57,735      $ 45,859  

 

1.

Securities deposited with clearing organizations or segregated under federal and other regulations or requirements are sourced from Securities purchased under agreements to resell and Trading assets in the consolidated balance sheets.

7. Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses

Loans

The Firm’s loan portfolio consists of the following:

 

 

Corporate.    Corporate loans primarily include commercial and industrial lending used for general corporate purposes, working capital and liquidity, event-driven loans and asset-backed lending products. Event-driven loans support client merger, acquisition, recapitalization, or project finance activities. Corporate loans are structured as revolving lines of credit, letter of credit facilities, term loans and bridge loans. Risk factors considered in determining the allowance for corporate loans include the borrower’s financial strength, seniority of the loan, collateral type, volatility of collateral value, debt cushion, covenants and counterparty type.

 

 

Consumer.    Consumer loans include unsecured loans and securities-based lending that allows clients to borrow money against the value of qualifying securities for any suitable purpose other than purchasing, trading, or carrying securities or refinancing margin debt. The majority of

   

consumer loans are structured as revolving lines of credit and letter of credit facilities and are primarily offered through the Firm’s Portfolio Loan Account (“PLA”) and Liquidity Access Line (“LAL”) programs. The allowance methodology for unsecured loans considers the specific attributes of the loan as well as the borrower’s source of repayment. The allowance methodology for securities-based lending considers the collateral type underlying the loan (e.g., diversified securities, concentrated securities or restricted stock).

 

 

Residential Real Estate.    Residential real estate loans mainly include non-conforming loans and home equity lines of credit. The allowance methodology for non-conforming residential mortgage loans considers several factors, including, but not limited to, loan-to-value ratio, FICO score, home price index and delinquency status. The methodology for home equity lines of credit considers credit limits and utilization rates in addition to the factors considered for non-conforming residential mortgages.

 

 

Wholesale Real Estate.    Wholesale real estate loans include owner-occupied loans and income-producing loans. The principal risk factors for determining the allowance for wholesale real estate loans are the underlying collateral type, loan-to-value ratio and debt service ratio.

Loans Held for Investment and Held for Sale

 

     At December 31, 2016  
$ in millions    Loans
Held for
Investment
    Loans Held
for Sale
     Total
Loans1, 2
 

Loans by Product Type

       

Corporate loans

   $ 25,025     $ 10,710      $ 35,735  

Consumer loans

     24,866              24,866  

Residential real estate loans

     24,385       61        24,446  

Wholesale real estate loans

     7,702       1,773        9,475  

Total loans, gross

     81,978       12,544        94,522  

Allowance for loan losses

     (274            (274

Total loans, net

   $ 81,704     $ 12,544      $ 94,248  

 

     At December 31, 2015  
$ in millions    Loans
Held for
Investment
    Loans
Held for
Sale
     Total
Loans1, 2
 

Loans by Product Type

       

Corporate loans

   $ 23,554     $ 11,924      $ 35,478  

Consumer loans

     21,528              21,528  

Residential real estate loans

     20,863       104        20,967  

Wholesale real estate loans

     6,839       1,172        8,011  

Total loans, gross

     72,784       13,200        85,984  

Allowance for loan losses

     (225            (225

Total loans, net

   $ 72,559     $ 13,200      $ 85,759  
 

 

  143   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

1.

Amounts include loans that are made to non-U.S. borrowers of $9,388 million and $9,789 million at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively.

2.

Loans at fixed interest rates and floating or adjustable interest rates were $11,895 million and $82,353 million at December 31, 2016, respectively, and $8,471 million and $77,288 million, at December 31, 2015, respectively.

See Note 3 for further information regarding Loans and lending commitments held at fair value.

Credit Quality

The Credit Risk Management Department evaluates new obligors before credit transactions are initially approved and at least annually thereafter for corporate and wholesale real estate loans. For corporate loans, credit evaluations typically involve the evaluation of financial statements; assessment of leverage, liquidity, capital strength, asset composition and quality; market capitalization and access to capital markets; cash flow projections and debt service requirements; and the adequacy of collateral, if applicable. The Credit Risk Management Department also evaluates strategy, market position, industry dynamics, obligor’s management and other factors that could affect an obligor’s risk profile. For wholesale real estate loans, the credit evaluation is focused on property and transaction metrics, including property type, loan-to-value ratio, occupancy levels, debt service ratio, prevailing capitalization rates and market dynamics. For residential real estate and consumer loans, the initial credit evaluation typically includes, but is not limited to, review of the obligor’s income, net worth, liquidity, collateral, loan-to-value ratio and credit bureau information. Subsequent credit monitoring for residential real estate loans is performed at the portfolio level. Consumer loan collateral values are monitored on an ongoing basis.

The Firm utilizes the following credit quality indicators, which are consistent with U.S. banking regulators’ definitions of criticized exposures, in its credit monitoring process for loans held for investment:

 

 

Pass.    A credit exposure rated pass has a continued expectation of timely repayment, all obligations of the borrower are current, and the obligor complies with material terms and conditions of the lending agreement.

 

 

Special Mention.    Extensions of credit that have potential weakness that deserve management’s close attention and, if left uncorrected, may, at some future date, result in the deterioration of the repayment prospects or collateral position.

 

 

Substandard.    Obligor has a well-defined weakness that jeopardizes the repayment of the debt and has a high probability of payment default with the distinct possibility that

   

the Firm will sustain some loss if noted deficiencies are not corrected.

 

 

Doubtful.    Inherent weakness in the exposure makes the collection or repayment in full, based on existing facts, conditions and circumstances, highly improbable, and the amount of loss is uncertain.

 

 

Loss.    Extensions of credit classified as loss are considered uncollectible and are charged off.

Loans considered as doubtful or loss are considered impaired. Substandard loans are regularly reviewed for impairment. When a loan is impaired, the impairment is measured based on the present value of expected future cash flows discounted at the loan’s effective interest rate or, as a practical expedient, the observable market price of the loan or the fair value of the collateral if the loan is collateral dependent. For further information, see Note 2.

Loans Held for Investment before Allowance by Credit Quality

 

    At December 31, 2016  
$ in millions   Corporate     Consumer    

Residential

Real
Estate

   

Wholesale

Real
Estate

    Total  

Pass

  $ 23,409     $ 24,853     $ 24,345     $ 7,294     $ 79,901  

Special mention

    288       13             218       519  

Substandard

    1,259             40       190       1,489  

Doubtful

    69                         69  

Loss

                             

Total loans

  $ 25,025     $ 24,866     $ 24,385     $ 7,702     $ 81,978  

 

    At December 31, 2015  
$ in millions   Corporate     Consumer    

Residential

Real
Estate

   

Wholesale

Real
Estate

    Total  

Pass

  $ 22,040     $ 21,528     $ 20,828     $ 6,839     $ 71,235  

Special mention

    300                         300  

Substandard

    1,202             35             1,237  

Doubtful

    12                         12  

Loss

                             

Total loans

  $ 23,554     $ 21,528     $ 20,863     $ 6,839     $ 72,784  

Impaired Loans Before Allowance by Product Type

 

     At December 31, 2016  
$ in millions    Corporate     

Residential

Real
Estate

     Total  

Impaired loans with allowance

   $ 104      $      $ 104  

Impaired loans without allowance1

     206        35        241  

Impaired loans unpaid principal balance2

     316        38        354  
 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   144  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

     At December 31, 2015  
$ in millions    Corporate     

Residential

Real
Estate

     Total  

Impaired loans with allowance

   $ 39      $      $ 39  

Impaired loans without allowance1

     89        17        106  

Impaired loans unpaid principal balance2

     130        19        149  

 

1.

At December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, no allowance was recorded for these loans as the present value of the expected future cash flows (or, alternatively, the observable market price of the loan or the fair value of the collateral held) equaled or exceeded the carrying value.

2.

The impaired loans unpaid principal balance differs from the aggregate amount of impaired loan balances with and without allowance due to various factors, including charge-offs and net deferred loan fees or costs.

Select Loan Information by Region

 

     At December 31, 2016  
$ in millions    Americas      EMEA      Asia-
Pacific
     Total  

Impaired loans

   $ 320      $ 9      $ 16      $ 345  

Allowance for loan losses

     245        28        1        274  
     At December 31, 2015  
$ in millions    Americas      EMEA      Asia-
Pacific
     Total  

Impaired loans

   $ 108      $ 12      $ 25      $ 145  

Allowance for loan losses

     183        34        8        225  

EMEA—Europe, Middle East and Africa

 

 

Allowance for Credit Losses on Lending Activities

Allowance for Loan Losses

 

$ in millions   Corporate     Consumer    

Residential

Real
Estate

    Wholesale
Real
Estate
    Total  

Rollforward

         

Balance at December 31, 2015

  $ 166     $ 5     $ 17     $ 37     $ 225  

Gross charge-offs

    (16           (1           (17

Gross recoveries

    3                         3  

Net recoveries/(charge-offs)

    (13           (1           (14

Provision for (release of) loan losses

    110       (1     4       18       131  

Other1

    (68                       (68

Balance at December 31, 2016

  $ 195     $ 4     $ 20     $ 55     $ 274  

Allowance by Impairment Methodology

 

 

Inherent

  $ 133     $ 4     $ 20     $ 55     $ 212  

Specific

    62                         62  

Total allowance at December 31, 2016

  $ 195     $ 4     $ 20     $ 55     $ 274  

Loans by Impairment Methodology2

 

 

Inherent

  $ 24,715     $ 24,866     $ 24,350     $ 7,702     $ 81,633  

Specific

    310             35             345  

Total loans at December 31, 2016

  $ 25,025     $ 24,866     $ 24,385     $ 7,702     $ 81,978  
$ in millions   Corporate     Consumer    

Residential

Real
Estate

    Wholesale
Real
Estate
    Total  

Rollforward

         

Balance at December 31, 2014

  $ 118     $ 2     $ 8     $ 21     $ 149  

Gross charge-offs

                (1           (1

Gross recoveries

    1                         1  

Net recoveries/(charge-offs)

    1             (1            

Provision for loan losses

    58       3       10       16       87  

Other

    (11                       (11

Balance at December 31, 2015

  $ 166     $ 5     $ 17     $ 37     $ 225  

Allowance by Impairment Methodology

 

     

Inherent

  $ 156     $ 5     $ 17     $ 37     $ 215  

Specific

    10                         10  

Total allowance at December 31, 2015

  $ 166     $ 5     $ 17     $ 37     $ 225  

Loans by Impairment Methodology2

 

     

Inherent

  $ 23,426     $ 21,528     $ 20,846     $ 6,839     $ 72,639  

Specific

    128             17             145  

Total loans at December 31, 2015

  $ 23,554     $ 21,528     $ 20,863     $ 6,839     $ 72,784  
 

 

 

  145   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Allowance for Lending Commitments

 

$ in millions   Corporate     Consumer    

Residential

Real
Estate

    Wholesale
Real
Estate
    Total  

Rollforward

         

Balance at December 31, 2015

  $ 180     $ 1     $     $ 4     $ 185  

Provision for lending commitments

    13                         13  

Other

    (8                       (8

Balance at December 31, 2016

  $ 185     $ 1     $     $ 4     $ 190  

Allowance by Impairment Methodology

 

   

Inherent

  $ 185     $ 1     $     $ 4     $ 190  

Specific

                             

Total allowance at December 31, 2016

  $ 185     $ 1     $     $ 4     $ 190  

Lending Commitments by Impairment Methodology2

 

   

Inherent

  $ 63,078     $ 6,031     $ 322     $ 527     $ 69,958  

Specific

    89                         89  

Total lending commitments at December 31, 2016

  $ 63,167     $ 6,031     $ 322     $ 527     $   70,047  
$ in millions   Corporate     Consumer    

Residential

Real
Estate

    Wholesale
Real
Estate
    Total  

Rollforward

         

Balance at December 31, 2014

  $ 147     $     $     $ 2     $ 149  

Provision for lending commitments

    33       1             2       36  

Balance at December 31, 2015

  $ 180     $ 1     $     $ 4     $ 185  

Allowance by Impairment Methodology

 

 

Inherent

  $ 173     $ 1     $     $ 4     $ 178  

Specific

    7                         7  

Total allowance at December 31, 2015

  $ 180     $ 1     $     $ 4     $ 185  

Lending Commitments by Impairment Methodology2

 

   

Inherent

  $ 63,873     $ 4,856     $ 312     $ 381     $ 69,422  

Specific

    126                         126  

Total lending commitments at December 31, 2015

  $ 63,999     $ 4,856     $ 312     $ 381     $   69,548  
 

 

1.

Reduction related to loans of $492 million that were transferred to loans held for sale during 2016.

2.

Loan balances are gross of the allowance for loan losses, and lending commitments are gross of the allowance for lending commitments.

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   146  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

 

Troubled Debt Restructurings

At December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, the impaired loans and lending commitments classified as held for investment include troubled debt restructurings of $67.4 million and $44.0 million related to loans, respectively, and $13.9 million and $34.8 million related to lending commitments, respectively, within corporate loans. At December 31, 2016 the Firm did not record an allowance related to these troubled debt restructurings. At December 31, 2015, an allowance of $5.1 million was recorded. These restructurings typically include modifications of interest rates, collateral requirements, other loan covenants and payment extensions.

Employee Loans

Employee loans are granted in conjunction with a program established in the Wealth Management business segment to retain and recruit certain employees. These loans are recorded in Customer and other receivables in the consolidated balance sheets. These loans are full recourse, generally require periodic payments and have repayment terms ranging from 1 to 12 years. The Firm establishes an allowance for loan amounts it does not consider recoverable, which is recorded in Compensation and benefits expense. At December 31, 2016, the Firm had $4,715 million of employee loans, net of an allowance of approximately $89 million. At December 31, 2015, the Firm had $4,923 million of employee loans, net of an allowance of approximately $108 million.

8. Equity Method Investments

Overview

The Firm has investments accounted for under the equity method of accounting (see Note 1) of $2,837 million and $3,144 million at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively, included in Other Assets—Other investments in the consolidated balance sheets. Income (loss) from equity method investments was $(79) million, $114 million and $156 million for 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively, and is included in Other revenues in the consolidated income statements.

Japanese Securities Joint Venture

The Firm holds a 40% voting interest (“40% interest”) and Mitsubishi UFJ Financial Group, Inc. (“MUFG”) holds a 60% voting interest in Mitsubishi UFJ Morgan Stanley Securities Co., Ltd. (“MUMSS”). The Firm accounts for its equity method investment in MUMSS within the Institutional Securities business segment. During 2016, 2015 and 2014, the Firm recorded income from its 40% interest of $93 million, $220 million and $224 million, respectively, within Other revenues in the consolidated income statements. At December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, the book value of this investment was $1,581 million and $1,457 million, respectively. The book value of this investee exceeds the Firm’s share of net assets, reflecting equity method intangible assets and equity method goodwill.

 

 

  147   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Summarized Financial Data for MUMSS

 

     At December 31,  
$ in millions    2016      2015  

Total assets

   $ 120,991      $ 135,398  

Total liabilities

     117,798        132,492  

Noncontrolling interests

     29        29  

 

$ in millions    2016      2015      2014  

Net revenues

   $ 2,527      $ 2,961      $ 2,961  

Income from continuing operations before income taxes

     369        845        908  

Net income

     246        589        595  

Net income applicable to MUMSS

     233        565        582  

In addition to MUMSS, the Firm held other equity method investments that were not individually significant.

9. Goodwill and Intangible Assets

Goodwill

The Firm completed its annual goodwill impairment testing as of July 1, 2016 and July 1, 2015. The Firm’s impairment testing for each period did not indicate any goodwill impairment as each of the Firm’s reporting units with goodwill had a fair value that was substantially in excess of its carrying value.

Goodwill Rollforward

 

$ in millions   Institutional
Securities
    Wealth
Management
    Investment
Management
    Total  

At December 31, 20141

  $ 286     $ 5,533     $ 769     $ 6,588  

Foreign currency and other

    (15                 (15

Acquired

    11                   11  

At December 31, 20151

  $ 282     $ 5,533     $ 769    

$

6,584

 

Foreign currency and other

    (7                 (7

At December 31, 20161

  $ 275     $ 5,533     $ 769     $ 6,577  

 

1.

The amount of the Firm’s goodwill before accumulated impairments of $700 million, which included $673 million related to the Institutional Securities business segment and $27 million related to the Investment Management business segment, was $7,277 million and $7,284 million at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively.

Intangible Assets

 

$ in millions   Institutional
Securities
    Wealth
Management
    Investment
Management
    Total  

Amortizable intangibles

  $ 327     $ 2,632     $ 20     $ 2,979  

Mortgage servicing rights

          5             5  

At December 31, 2015

  $ 327     $ 2,637     $ 20     $ 2,984  

Amortizable intangibles

  $ 346     $ 2,361     $ 11     $ 2,718  

Mortgage servicing rights

          3             3  

At December 31, 2016

  $ 346     $ 2,364     $ 11     $   2,721  

Gross Amortizable Intangible Assets by Type

 

     At December 31, 2016      At December 31, 2015  
$ in millions    Gross
Carrying
Amount
     Accumulated
Amortization
     Gross
Carrying
Amount
     Accumulated
Amortization
 

Trademarks

   $ 1      $      $ 1      $  

Tradename

     283        40        280        31  

Customer relationships

     4,059        1,939        4,059        1,686  

Management contracts

     467        275        478        250  

Other

     329        167        291        163  

Total

   $ 5,139      $ 2,421      $ 5,109      $ 2,130  

Amortization expense associated with intangible assets is estimated to be approximately $298 million per year over the next five years.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   148  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Net Amortizable Intangible Assets Rollforward

 

$ in millions   Institutional
Securities
    Wealth
Management
    Investment
Management
    Total  

At December 31, 2014

  $ 221     $ 2,905     $ 27     $   3,153  

Acquired1

    160                   160  

Amortization expense

    (26     (273     (7     (306

Other

    (28                 (28

At December 31, 2015

  $ 327     $ 2,632     $ 20     $ 2,979  

Acquired

    43                   43  

Disposals

    (11                 (11

Amortization expense

    (11     (271     (9     (291

Impairment losses

    (2                 (2

At December 31, 2016

  $         346     $         2,361     $         11     $   2,718  

 

1.

Includes a $159 million net increase in Intangible assets related to a Commodities division transaction, which also resulted in a gain of $78  million recorded in Other revenues in the consolidated income statements.

10. Deposits

Deposits

 

$ in millions   At December 31,
2016
1
    At December 31,
20151
 

Savings and demand deposits

  $ 154,559     $ 153,346  

Time deposits2

    1,304       2,688  

Total3

  $ 155,863     $ 156,034  

 

1.

Total deposits subject to FDIC insurance at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015 were $128 billion and $113 billion, respectively. Of the total time deposits subject to FDIC insurance at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, $46 million and $14 million, respectively, met or exceeded the FDIC insurance limit.

2.

Certain time deposit accounts are carried at fair value under the fair value option (see Note 3).

3.

Deposits were primarily held in the U.S.

Interest bearing deposits at December 31, 2016 included $154,529 million of savings deposits payable upon demand and $1,204 million of time deposits maturing in 2017 and $43 million of time deposits maturing in 2018.

The vast majority of deposits in MSBNA and MSPBNA (collectively, “U.S. Bank Subsidiaries”) are sourced from the Firm’s retail brokerage accounts.

11. Borrowings and Other Secured Financings

Short-Term Borrowings

At December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, the Firm had $941 million and $2,173 million, respectively, of Short-term borrowings. These borrowings included primarily structured notes, bank loans and bank notes with original maturities of 12 months or less. Certain structured short-term borrowings are carried at fair value under the fair value option (see Note 3).

 

 

  149   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Long-Term Borrowings

Maturities and Terms of Long-Term Borrowings

 

     Parent Company     Subsidiaries      At
December 31,
2016
3
    At
December 31,
2015
 
$ in millions   

Fixed

Rate1

    Variable
Rate2
    Fixed
Rate1
    Variable
Rate2
      

Due in 2016

   $     $     $     $      $     $ 22,396  

Due in 2017

     14,120       7,369       16       4,622        26,127       22,266  

Due in 2018

     12,942       4,698       13       1,639        19,292       17,937  

Due in 2019

     13,049       8,340       38       970        22,397       18,568  

Due in 2020

     11,128       4,570       13       1,025        16,736       17,005  

Due in 2021

     13,614       2,044       17       1,504        17,179       9,142  

Thereafter

     43,076       15,385       244       4,339        63,044       46,454  

Total

   $ 107,929     $ 42,406     $ 341     $ 14,099      $ 164,775     $ 153,768  

Weighted average coupon at period-end4

     4.1     1.4     6.0     N/M        3.7     4.0

N/M—Not Meaningful

1.

Amounts include an increase of approximately $1.1 billion at December 31, 2016 to the carrying amount of certain of the long-term borrowings associated with fair value hedges. The increase to the carrying value associated with fair value hedges by year due was approximately $0.2 billion due in 2017, $0.2 billion due in 2018, $0.3 billion due in 2019, $0.3 billion due in 2020, $0.2 billion due in 2021 and ($0.1) billion due thereafter.

2.

Variable rate borrowings bear interest based on a variety of money market indices, including LIBOR and federal funds rates. Amounts include borrowings that are linked to equity, credit, commodity or other indices.

3.

Amounts include a decrease of approximately $0.7 billion at December 31, 2016 to the carrying amounts of certain of the long-term borrowings for which the fair value option was elected (see Note 3).

4.

Weighted average coupon was calculated utilizing U.S. and non-U.S. dollar interest rates and excludes financial instruments for which the fair value option was elected. Virtually all of the variable rate notes issued by subsidiaries are carried at fair value so a weighted average coupon is not meaningful.

 

Long-Term Borrowings by Type

 

$ in millions   

At

December 31,
2016

    

At

December 31,
2015

 

Senior debt

   $ 154,472      $ 140,494  

Subordinated debt

     10,303        10,404  

Junior subordinated debentures

            2,870  

Total

   $ 164,775      $ 153,768  

During 2016 and 2015, the Firm issued notes with a principal amount of approximately $43.6 billion and $34.2 billion, respectively, and approximately $30.4 billion and $27.3 billion, respectively, in aggregate long-term borrowings matured or retired.

Certain senior debt securities are denominated in various non-U.S. dollar currencies and may be structured to provide a return that is linked to equity, credit, commodity or other indices (e.g., the consumer price index). Senior debt also may be structured to be callable by the Firm or extendible at the option of holders of the senior debt securities.

Debt containing provisions that effectively allow the holders to put the notes aggregated $3,156 million at December 31, 2016 and $2,902 million at December 31, 2015. In addition, in certain circumstances, certain purchasers may be entitled to cause the repurchase of the notes. The aggregated value of notes subject to these arrangements was $1,117 million at December 31, 2016 and $650 million at December 31, 2015. Subordinated debt and junior subordinated debentures generally are issued to meet the capital requirements of the Firm or

its regulated subsidiaries and primarily are U.S. dollar denominated.

The weighted average maturity of long-term borrowings, based upon stated maturity dates, was approximately 5.9 years and 6.1 years at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively.

Trust Preferred Securities

During 2016, Morgan Stanley Capital Trust III, Morgan Stanley Capital Trust IV, Morgan Stanley Capital Trust V and Morgan Stanley Capital Trust VIII redeemed all of their issued and outstanding Capital Securities pursuant to the optional redemption provisions provided in the respective governing documents. In the aggregate, $2.8 billion was redeemed. The Firm concurrently redeemed the related underlying junior subordinated debentures.

During 2015, Morgan Stanley Capital Trusts VI and VII redeemed all of their issued and outstanding 6.60% Capital Securities, respectively, and the Firm concurrently redeemed the related underlying junior subordinated debentures.

Senior Debt—Structured Borrowings

The Firm’s index-linked, equity-linked or credit-linked borrowings include various structured instruments whose payments and redemption values are linked to the performance of a specific index (e.g., Standard & Poor’s 500), a basket of stocks, a specific equity security, a credit exposure or basket of credit exposures. To minimize the exposure from such instruments, the Firm has entered into various swap

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   150  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

contracts and purchased options that effectively convert the borrowing costs into floating rates based upon LIBOR. The Firm generally carries the entire structured borrowings at fair value. The swaps and purchased options used to economically hedge the embedded features are derivatives and also are carried at fair value. Changes in fair value related to the notes and economic hedges are reported in Trading revenues. See Note 3 for further information on structured borrowings.

Subordinated Debt

Subordinated notes included in long-term borrowings have a contractual weighted average coupon of 4.5% at both December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015. Maturities of subordinated notes range from 2022 to 2027.

Asset and Liability Management

In general, other than securities inventories financed by secured funding sources, the majority of the Firm’s assets are financed with a combination of deposits, short-term funding, floating rate long-term debt or fixed rate long-term debt swapped to a floating rate. The Firm uses interest rate swaps to more closely match these borrowings to the duration, holding period and interest rate characteristics of the assets being funded and to manage interest rate risk. These swaps effectively convert certain of the Firm’s fixed rate borrowings into floating rate obligations. In addition, for non-U.S. dollar currency borrowings that are not used to fund assets in the same currency, the Firm has entered into currency swaps that effectively convert the borrowings into U.S. dollar obligations.

The Firm’s use of swaps for asset and liability management affected its effective average borrowing rate.

Rates for Long-Term Borrowings at Period End

 

      2016     2015     2014  

Weighted average coupon1

     3.7     4.0     4.2

Effective average after swaps1

     2.5     2.1     2.3

 

1.

Weighted average coupon was calculated utilizing U.S. and non-U.S. dollar interest rates and excludes financial instruments for which the fair value option was elected.

Other Secured Financings

Other secured financings include the liabilities related to transfers of financial assets that are accounted for as financings rather than sales, consolidated VIEs where the Firm is deemed to be the primary beneficiary, pledged commodities, certain equity-linked notes and other secured borrowings. See Note 13 for further information on other secured financings related to VIEs and securitization activities.

 

Other Secured Financings by Type

 

$ in millions   

At

December 31,
2016

    

At

December 31,
2015

 

Secured Financings

     

Original maturities greater than one year

   $ 9,404      $ 7,629  

Original maturities one year or less1

     1,429        1,435  

Failed sales2

     285        400  

Total

   $ 11,118      $ 9,464  

 

1.

Amounts include approximately $1,389 million of variable rate financings and approximately $40 million in fixed rate financings at December 31, 2016 and approximately $1,401 million of variable rate financings and approximately $34 million in fixed rate financings at December 31, 2015.

2.

For more information on failed sales, see Note 13.

Secured Financings with Original Maturities Greater than One Year by Maturity and Rate Type

 

     At December 31, 2016    

At

December 31,
2015

 
$ in millions    Fixed
Rate
    Variable
Rate1
    Total    

Due in 2016

   $     $     $     $ 2,333  

Due in 2017

     86       3,291       3,377       2,122  

Due in 2018

           2,738       2,738       1,553  

Due in 2019

     1       2,812       2,813       1,148  

Due in 2020

     58       212       270       142  

Due in 2021

                        

Thereafter

     94       112       206       331  

Total

   $ 239     $ 9,165     $ 9,404     $ 7,629  

Weighted average coupon rate at period-end2

     2.5     1.0     1.0     1.2

 

1.

Variable rate borrowings bear interest based on a variety of indices, including LIBOR. Amounts include borrowings that are equity-linked, credit-linked, commodity-linked or linked to some other index.

2.

Weighted average coupon was calculated utilizing U.S. and non-U.S. dollar interest rates and excludes secured financings that are linked to non-interest indices and for which fair value option was elected.

Failed Sales by Maturity

 

$ in millions   

At

December 31,
2016

    

At

December 31,
2015

 

Due in 2016

   $      $ 69  

Due in 2017

     112        168  

Due in 2018

     17        1  

Due in 2019

     53        54  

Due in 2020

     55        104  

Due in 2021

     28         

Thereafter

     20        4  

Total

   $ 285      $ 400  

For more information on failed sales, see Note 13.

 

 

  151   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

12. Commitments, Guarantees and Contingencies

 

Commitments

The Firm’s commitments are summarized in the following table by years to maturity. Since commitments associated with these instruments may expire unused, the amounts shown do not necessarily reflect the actual future cash funding requirements.

Commitments

 

     Years to Maturity at December 31, 2016         
$ in millions    Less
than 1
         1-3          3-5          Over 5      Total  

Letters of credit and other financial guarantees

   $ 83      $      $ 1      $ 39      $ 123  

Investment activities

     517        132        13        246        908  

Corporate lending1

     15,156        24,144        47,725        4,421        91,446  

Consumer lending

     6,024        3               4        6,031  

Residential real estate lending

     88        10        100        220        418  

Wholesale real estate lending

     79        368        32        68        547  

Forward-starting secured financing receivables2

     71,194                             71,194  

Underwriting

     1,845                             1,845  

Total

   $ 94,986      $ 24,657      $ 47,871      $ 4,998      $ 172,512  

 

1.

Due to the nature of the Firm’s obligations under the commitments, these amounts include certain commitments participated to third parties of $5.6 billion.

2.

Represents forward-starting securities purchased under agreements to resell and securities borrowed agreements, of which $68.8 billion settled within three business days.

Types of Commitments

Letters of Credit and Other Financial Guarantees.    The Firm has outstanding letters of credit and other financial guarantees issued by third-party banks to certain of the Firm’s counterparties. The Firm is contingently liable for these letters of credit and other financial guarantees, which

are primarily used to provide collateral for securities and commodities borrowed and to satisfy various margin requirements in lieu of depositing cash or securities with these counterparties.

Investment Activities.    The Firm sponsors several non-consolidated investment management funds for third-party investors where it typically acts as general partner of, and investment advisor to, these funds and typically commits to invest a minority of the capital of such funds, with subscribing third-party investors contributing the majority. The Firm’s employees, including its senior officers as well as the Firm’s Board of Directors (the “Board”), may participate on the same terms and conditions as other investors in certain of these funds that the Firm sponsors primarily for client investment, except that the Firm may waive or lower applicable fees and charges for its employees. The Firm has contractual capital commitments, guarantees and counterparty arrangements with respect to these investment management funds.

Lending Commitments.    Lending commitments represent the notional amount of legally binding obligations to provide funding to clients for different types of loan transactions. For syndications led by the Firm, the lending commitments accepted by the borrower but not yet closed are net of the amounts agreed to by counterparties that will participate in the syndication. For syndications that the Firm participates in and does not lead, lending commitments accepted by the borrower but not yet closed include only the amount that the Firm expects it will be allocated from the lead syndicate bank. Due to the nature of the Firm’s obligations under the commitments, these amounts include certain commitments participated to third parties. See Note 7 for further information.

Forward-Starting Secured Financing Receivables.    The Firm has entered into forward-starting securities purchased under agreements to resell and securities borrowed (agreements that have a trade date at or prior to December 31, 2016 and settle subsequent to period-end) that are primarily secured by collateral from U.S. government agency securities and other sovereign government obligations.

Underwriting Commitments.    The Firm provides underwriting commitments in connection with its capital raising sources to a diverse group of corporate and other institutional clients.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   152  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Premises and Equipment.    The Firm has non-cancelable operating leases covering premises and equipment. At December 31, 2016, future minimum rental commitments under such leases (net of sublease commitments, principally on office rentals) were as follows:

Operating Premises Leases

 

$ in millions   

At

December 31,

2016

 

2017

   $ 649  

2018

     627  

2019

     549  

2020

     505  

2021

     444  

Thereafter

     2,958  

Total

   $                     5,732  

The total of minimum rental income to be received in the future under non-cancelable operating subleases at December 31, 2016 was $22 million.

Occupancy lease agreements, in addition to base rentals, generally provide for rent and operating expense escalations resulting from increased assessments for real estate taxes and other charges. Total rent expense was $689 million, $705 million and $715 million for the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

 

 

Guarantees

Obligations under Guarantee Arrangements at December 31, 2016

 

     Maximum Potential Payout/Notional      Carrying
Amount
(Asset)/
Liability
    Collateral/
Recourse
 
     Years to Maturity              
$ in millions    Less than 1      1-3      3-5      Over 5      Total       

Credit derivatives1

   $         166,685      $         140,987      $ 91,784      $ 30,274      $ 429,730      $ (1,049   $  

Other credit contracts

     49        6               215        270               

Non-credit derivatives1

     1,466,131        779,057                325,616                541,369                3,112,173                55,476        

Standby letters of credit and other financial guarantees issued2

     1,052        753        1,472        5,611        8,888        (164             7,009  

Market value guarantees

     38        133        71        8        250        2       4  

Liquidity facilities

     2,812                             2,812        (5     4,854  

Whole loan sales guarantees

                   2        23,321        23,323        8        

Securitization representations and warranties

                          59,704        59,704        103        

General partner guarantees

     3        30        124        237        394        44        

 

1.

Carrying amounts of derivative contracts are shown on a gross basis prior to cash collateral or counterparty netting. For further information on derivative contracts, see Note 4.

2.

These amounts include certain issued standby letters of credit participated to third parties totaling $0.9 billion due to the nature of the Firm’s obligations under these arrangements.

 

  153   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

The Firm has obligations under certain guarantee arrangements, including contracts and indemnification agreements, that contingently require the Firm to make payments to the guaranteed party based on changes in an underlying measure (such as an interest or foreign exchange rate, security or commodity price, an index, or the occurrence or non-occurrence of a specified event) related to an asset, liability or equity security of a guaranteed party. Also included as guarantees are contracts that contingently require the Firm to make payments to the guaranteed party based on another entity’s failure to perform under an agreement, as well as indirect guarantees of the indebtedness of others.

Types of Guarantees

Derivative Contracts.    Certain derivative contracts meet the accounting definition of a guarantee, including certain written options, contingent forward contracts and credit default swaps (see Note 4 regarding credit derivatives in which the Firm has sold credit protection to the counterparty). The Firm has disclosed information regarding all derivative contracts that could meet the accounting definition of a guarantee and has used the notional amount as the maximum potential payout for certain derivative contracts, such as written interest rate caps and written foreign currency options.

In certain situations, collateral may be held by the Firm for those contracts that meet the definition of a guarantee. Generally, the Firm sets collateral requirements by counterparty so that the collateral covers various transactions and products and is not allocated specifically to individual contracts. Also, the Firm may recover amounts related to the underlying asset delivered to the Firm under the derivative contract.

The Firm records derivative contracts at fair value. Aggregate market risk limits have been established, and market risk measures are routinely monitored against these limits. The Firm also manages its exposure to these derivative contracts through a variety of risk mitigation strategies, including, but not limited to, entering into offsetting economic hedge positions. The Firm believes that the notional amounts of the derivative contracts generally overstate its exposure.

Standby Letters of Credit and Other Financial Guarantees Issued.    In connection with its corporate lending business and other corporate activities, the Firm provides standby letters of credit and other financial guarantees to counterparties. Such arrangements represent obligations to make payments to third parties if the counterparty fails to fulfill its obligation under a borrowing arrangement or other contractual obligation. A majority of the Firm’s standby letters of credit are provided on behalf of counterparties that are investment grade.

Market Value Guarantees.    Market value guarantees are issued to guarantee timely payment of a specified return to investors in certain affordable housing tax credit funds. These guarantees are designed to return an investor’s contribution to a fund and the investor’s share of tax losses and tax credits expected to be generated by a fund. From time to time, the Firm may also guarantee return of principal invested, potentially including a specified rate of return, to fund investors.

Liquidity Facilities.    The Firm has entered into liquidity facilities with special purpose entities (“SPEs”) and other counterparties, whereby the Firm is required to make certain payments if losses or defaults occur. Primarily, the Firm acts as liquidity provider to municipal bond securitization SPEs and for standalone municipal bonds in which the holders of beneficial interests issued by these SPEs or the holders of the individual bonds, respectively, have the right to tender their interests for purchase by the Firm on specified dates at a specified price. The Firm often may have recourse to the underlying assets held by the SPEs in the event payments are required under such liquidity facilities, as well as make-whole or recourse provisions with the trust sponsors. Primarily all of the underlying assets in the SPEs are investment grade. Liquidity facilities provided to municipal tender option bond trusts are classified as derivatives.

Whole Loan Sales Guarantees.    The Firm has provided, or otherwise agreed to be responsible for, representations and warranties regarding certain whole loan sales. Under certain circumstances, the Firm may be required to repurchase such assets or make other payments related to such assets if such representations and warranties are breached. The Firm maximum potential payout related to such representations and warranties is equal to the current unpaid principal balance (“UPB”) of such loans. The Firm has information on the current UPB only when it services the loans. The amount included in the previous table for the maximum potential payout of $23.3 billion includes the current UPB when known of $4.4 billion and the UPB at the time of sale of $18.9 billion when the current UPB is not known. The UPB at the time of the sale of all loans covered by these representations and warranties was approximately $42.7 billion. The related liability primarily relates to sales of loans to the federal mortgage agencies.

Securitization Representations and Warranties.    As part of the Firm’s Institutional Securities business segment’s securitization and related activities, the Firm has provided, or otherwise agreed to be responsible for, representations and warranties regarding certain assets transferred in securitization transactions sponsored by the Firm. The extent and nature of the representations and warranties, if any, vary among different securitizations. Under certain circumstances, the Firm may be required to repurchase such assets or make other payments

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   154  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

related to such assets if such representations and warranties are breached. The maximum potential amount of future payments the Firm could be required to make would be equal to the current outstanding balances of, or losses associated with, the assets subject to breaches of such representations and warranties. The amount included in the previous table for the maximum potential payout includes the current UPB where known and the UPB at the time of sale when the current UPB is not known.

At December 31, 2016, there were approximately $147.9 billion of outstanding RMBS primarily containing U.S. residential loans that the Firm had sponsored between 2004 and 2016. Of that amount, the Firm made representations and warranties relating to approximately $47.0 billion of loans and agreed to be responsible for the representations and warranties made by third-party sellers, many of which are now insolvent, on approximately $21.0 billion of loans. At December 31, 2016, the Firm had reserved $103 million in its consolidated financial statements for payments owed as a result of breach of representations and warranties made in connection with these residential mortgages. At December 31, 2016, the current UPB for all the residential assets subject to such representations and warranties was approximately $11.6 billion, and the cumulative losses associated with U.S. RMBS were approximately $15.2 billion. The Firm did not make, or otherwise agree to be responsible for, the representations and warranties made by third-party sellers on approximately $79.9 billion of residential loans that it securitized during that time period.

The Firm also made representations and warranties in connection with its role as an originator of certain commercial mortgage loans that it securitized in CMBS. At December 31, 2016, there were outstanding Firm sponsored CMBS in which the Firm had originated and placed between 2004 and 2016, U.S. and non-U.S. commercial mortgage loans of approximately $37.3 billion and $6.2 billion, respectively. At December 31, 2016, the Firm had not accrued any amounts in the consolidated financial statements for payments owed as a result of breach of representations and warranties made in connection with these commercial mortgages. At December 31, 2016, the current UPB for all U.S. commercial mortgage loans subject to such representations and warranties was $31.7 billion. For the non-U.S. commercial mortgage loans, the amount included in the previous table for the maximum potential payout includes the current UPB when known of $0.8 billion and the UPB at the time of sale of $0.4 billion when the current UPB is not known.

General Partner Guarantees.    As a general partner in certain investment management funds, the Firm receives certain distributions from the partnerships related to achieving certain return hurdles according to the provisions of the partnership agreements. The Firm may be required to

return all or a portion of such distributions to the limited partners in the event the limited partners do not achieve a certain return as specified in the various partnership agreements, subject to certain limitations.

Other Guarantees and Indemnities

In the normal course of business, the Firm provides guarantees and indemnifications in a variety of transactions. These provisions generally are standard contractual terms. Certain of these guarantees and indemnifications related to indemnities, exchange/clearinghouse member guarantees and merger and acquisition guarantees are described below:

 

 

Indemnities.    The Firm provides standard indemnities to counterparties for certain contingent exposures and taxes, including U.S. and foreign withholding taxes, on interest and other payments made on derivatives, securities and stock lending transactions, certain annuity products and other financial arrangements. These indemnity payments could be required based on a change in the tax laws, a change in interpretation of applicable tax rulings or a change in factual circumstances. Certain contracts contain provisions that enable the Firm to terminate the agreement upon the occurrence of such events. The maximum potential amount of future payments that the Firm could be required to make under these indemnifications cannot be estimated.

 

 

Exchange/Clearinghouse Member Guarantees.    The Firm is a member of various U.S. and non-U.S. exchanges and clearinghouses that trade and clear securities and/or derivative contracts. Associated with its membership, the Firm may be required to pay a certain amount as determined by the exchange or the clearinghouse in case of a default of any of its members or pay a proportionate share of the financial obligations of another member that may default on its obligations to the exchange or the clearinghouse. While the rules governing different exchange or clearinghouse memberships and the forms of these guarantees may vary, in general the Firm’s obligations under these rules would arise only if the exchange or clearinghouse had previously exhausted its resources.

In addition, some clearinghouse rules require members to assume a proportionate share of losses resulting from the clearinghouse’s investment of guarantee fund contributions and initial margin, and of other losses unrelated to the default of a clearing member, if such losses exceed the specified resources allocated for such purpose by the clearinghouse.

The maximum potential payout under these rules cannot be estimated. The Firm has not recorded any contingent liability in its consolidated financial statements for these agreements and believes that any potential requirement to make payments under these agreements is remote.

 

 

  155   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

 

Merger and Acquisition Guarantees.    The Firm may, from time to time, in its role as investment banking advisor be required to provide guarantees in connection with certain European merger and acquisition transactions. If required by the regulating authorities, the Firm provides a guarantee that the acquirer in the merger and acquisition transaction has or will have sufficient funds to complete the transaction and would then be required to make the acquisition payments in the event the acquirer’s funds are insufficient at the completion date of the transaction. These arrangements generally cover the time frame from the transaction offer date to its closing date and, therefore, are generally short term in nature. The Firm believes the likelihood of any payment by the Firm under these arrangements is remote given the level of its due diligence with its role as investment banking advisor.

In addition, in the ordinary course of business, the Firm guarantees the debt and/or certain trading obligations (including obligations associated with derivatives, foreign exchange contracts and the settlement of physical commodities) of certain subsidiaries. These guarantees generally are entity or product specific and are required by investors or trading counterparties. The activities of the Firm’s subsidiaries covered by these guarantees (including any related debt or trading obligations) are included in the consolidated financial statements.

Contingencies

Legal.    In the normal course of business, the Firm has been named, from time to time, as a defendant in various legal actions, including arbitrations, class actions and other litigation, arising in connection with its activities as a global diversified financial services institution. Certain of the actual or threatened legal actions include claims for substantial compensatory and/or punitive damages or claims for indeterminate amounts of damages. In some cases, the entities that would otherwise be the primary defendants in such cases are bankrupt or are in financial distress. These actions have included, but are not limited to, residential mortgage and credit-crisis related matters.

Over the last several years, the level of litigation and investigatory activity (both formal and informal) by governmental and self-regulatory agencies has increased materially in the financial services industry. As a result, the Firm expects that it will continue to be the subject of elevated claims for damages and other relief and, while the Firm has identified below any individual proceedings where the Firm believes a material loss to be reasonably possible and reasonably estimable, there can be no assurance that material losses will not be incurred from claims that have not yet been asserted or are not yet determined to be probable or possible and reasonably estimable losses.

The Firm contests liability and/or the amount of damages as appropriate in each pending matter. Where available information indicates that it is probable a liability had been incurred at the date of the consolidated financial statements and the Firm can reasonably estimate the amount of that loss, the Firm accrues the estimated loss by a charge to income. The Firm incurred legal expenses of $263 million in 2016, $563 million in 2015 and $3,364 million in 2014. The Firm’s future legal expenses may fluctuate from period to period, given the current environment regarding government investigations and private litigation affecting global financial services firms, including the Firm.

In many proceedings and investigations, however, it is inherently difficult to determine whether any loss is probable or even possible or to estimate the amount of any loss. In addition, even where a loss is possible or an exposure to loss exists in excess of the liability already accrued with respect to a previously recognized loss contingency, it is not always possible to reasonably estimate the size of the possible loss or range of loss.

For certain legal proceedings and investigations, the Firm cannot reasonably estimate such losses, particularly for proceedings and investigations where the factual record is being developed or contested or where plaintiffs or governmental entities seek substantial or indeterminate damages, restitution, disgorgement or penalties. Numerous issues may need to be resolved, including through potentially lengthy discovery and determination of important factual matters, determination of issues related to class certification and the calculation of damages or other relief, and by addressing novel or unsettled legal questions relevant to the proceedings or investigations in question, before a loss or additional loss or range of loss or additional range of loss can be reasonably estimated for a proceeding or investigation.

For certain other legal proceedings and investigations, the Firm can estimate reasonably possible losses, additional losses, ranges of loss or ranges of additional loss in excess of amounts accrued, but does not believe, based on current knowledge and after consultation with counsel, that such losses will have a material adverse effect on the Firm’s consolidated financial statements as a whole, other than the matters referred to in the following paragraphs.

On July 15, 2010, China Development Industrial Bank (“CDIB”) filed a complaint against the Firm, styled China Development Industrial Bank v. Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated et al., which is pending in the Supreme Court of the State of New York, New York County (“Supreme Court of NY”). The complaint relates to a $275 million credit default swap referencing the super senior portion of the STACK 2006-1 CDO. The complaint asserts claims for common law

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   156  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

fraud, fraudulent inducement and fraudulent concealment and alleges that the Firm misrepresented the risks of the STACK 2006-1 CDO to CDIB, and that the Firm knew that the assets backing the CDO were of poor quality when it entered into the credit default swap with CDIB. The complaint seeks compensatory damages related to the approximately $228 million that CDIB alleges it has already lost under the credit default swap, rescission of CDIB’s obligation to pay an additional $12 million, punitive damages, equitable relief, fees and costs. On February 28, 2011, the court denied the Firm’s motion to dismiss the complaint. Based on currently available information, the Firm believes it could incur a loss in this action of up to approximately $240 million plus pre- and post-judgment interest, fees and costs.

On August 7, 2012, U.S. Bank, in its capacity as trustee, filed a complaint on behalf of Morgan Stanley Mortgage Loan Trust 2006-4SL and Mortgage Pass-Through Certificates, Series 2006-4SL against the Firm styled Morgan Stanley Mortgage Loan Trust 2006-4SL, et al. v. Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital Inc., pending in the Supreme Court of NY. The complaint asserts claims for breach of contract and alleges, among other things, that the loans in the trust, which had an original principal balance of approximately $303 million, breached various representations and warranties. The complaint seeks, among other relief, rescission of the mortgage loan purchase agreement underlying the transaction, specific performance and unspecified damages and interest. On August 8, 2014, the court granted in part and denied in part the Firm’s motion to dismiss the complaint. On December 2, 2016, the Firm moved for summary judgment and the plaintiff moved for partial summary judgment. Based on currently available information, the Firm believes that it could incur a loss in this action of up to approximately $149 million, the total original unpaid balance of the mortgage loans for which the Firm received repurchase demands that it did not repurchase, plus pre- and post-judgment interest, fees and costs, but plaintiff is seeking to expand the number of loans at issue and the possible range of loss could increase.

On August 8, 2012, U.S. Bank, in its capacity as trustee, filed a complaint on behalf of Morgan Stanley Mortgage Loan Trust 2006-14SL, Mortgage Pass-Through Certificates, Series 2006-14SL, Morgan Stanley Mortgage Loan Trust 2007-4SL and Mortgage Pass-Through Certificates, Series 2007-4SL against the Firm styled Morgan Stanley Mortgage Loan Trust 2006-14SL, et al. v. Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital Holdings LLC, as successor in interest to Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital Inc., pending in the Supreme Court of NY. The complaint asserts claims for breach of contract and alleges, among other things, that the loans in the trusts, which had original principal balances of approximately $354 million and $305 million respectively, breached various representations

and warranties. The complaint seeks, among other relief, rescission of the mortgage loan purchase agreements underlying the transactions, specific performance and unspecified damages and interest. On August 16, 2013, the court granted in part and denied in part the Firm’s motion to dismiss the complaint. On August 16, 2016, the Firm moved for summary judgment and the plaintiffs moved for partial summary judgment. Based on currently available information, the Firm believes that it could incur a loss in this action of up to approximately $527 million, the total original unpaid balance of the mortgage loans for which the Firm received repurchase demands that it did not repurchase, plus pre- and post-judgment interest, fees and costs, but plaintiff is seeking to expand the number of loans at issue and the possible range of loss could increase.

On September 28, 2012, U.S. Bank, in its capacity as trustee, filed a complaint on behalf of Morgan Stanley Mortgage Loan Trust 2006-13ARX against the Firm styled Morgan Stanley Mortgage Loan Trust 2006-13ARX v. Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital Holdings LLC, as successor in interest to Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital Inc., pending in the Supreme Court of NY. The plaintiff filed an amended complaint on January 17, 2013, which asserts claims for breach of contract and alleges, among other things, that the loans in the trust, which had an original principal balance of approximately $609 million, breached various representations and warranties. The amended complaint seeks, among other relief, declaratory judgment relief, specific performance and unspecified damages and interest. By order dated September 30, 2014, the court granted in part and denied in part the Firm’s motion to dismiss the amended complaint, which plaintiff appealed. On August 11, 2016, the Appellate Division, First Department reversed in part the trial court’s order that granted the Firm’s motion to dismiss. On December 13, 2016, the Appellate Division granted the Firm’s motion for leave to appeal to the New York Court of Appeals. The Firm filed its opening letter brief with the Court of Appeals on February 6, 2017. Based on currently available information, the Firm believes that it could incur a loss in this action of up to approximately $170 million, the total original unpaid balance of the mortgage loans for which the Firm received repurchase demands that it did not repurchase, plus pre- and post-judgment interest, fees and costs, but plaintiff is seeking to expand the number of loans at issue and the possible range of loss could increase.

On January 10, 2013, U.S. Bank, in its capacity as trustee, filed a complaint on behalf of Morgan Stanley Mortgage Loan Trust 2006-10SL and Mortgage Pass-Through Certificates, Series 2006-10SL against the Firm styled Morgan Stanley Mortgage Loan Trust 2006-10SL, et al. v. Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital Holdings LLC, as successor in interest to Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital Inc., pending in

 

 

  157   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

the Supreme Court of NY. The complaint asserts claims for breach of contract and alleges, among other things, that the loans in the trust, which had an original principal balance of approximately $300 million, breached various representations and warranties. The complaint seeks, among other relief, an order requiring the Firm to comply with the loan breach remedy procedures in the transaction documents, unspecified damages, and interest. On August 8, 2014, the court granted in part and denied in part the Firm’s motion to dismiss the complaint. Based on currently available information, the Firm believes that it could incur a loss in this action of up to approximately $197 million, the total original unpaid balance of the mortgage loans for which the Firm received repurchase demands that it did not repurchase, plus pre- and post-judgment interest, fees and costs, but plaintiff is seeking to expand the number of loans at issue and the possible range of loss could increase.

On May 3, 2013, plaintiffs in Deutsche Zentral-Genossenschaftsbank AG et al. v. Morgan Stanley et al. filed a complaint against the Firm, certain affiliates, and other defendants in the Supreme Court of NY. The complaint alleges that defendants made material misrepresentations and omissions in the sale to plaintiffs of certain mortgage pass-through certificates backed by securitization trusts containing residential mortgage loans. The total amount of certificates allegedly sponsored, underwritten and/or sold by the Firm to plaintiff was approximately $644 million. The complaint alleges causes of action against the Firm for common law fraud, fraudulent concealment, aiding and abetting fraud, negligent misrepresentation, and rescission and seeks, among other things, compensatory and punitive damages. On June 10, 2014, the court granted in part and denied in part the Firm’s motion to dismiss the complaint. The Firm perfected its appeal from that decision on June 12, 2015. At December 25, 2016, the current unpaid balance of the mortgage pass-through certificates at issue in this action was approximately $247 million, and the certificates had incurred actual losses of approximately $86 million. Based on currently available information, the Firm believes it could incur a loss in this action up to the difference between the $247 million unpaid balance of these certificates (plus any losses incurred) and their fair market value at the time of a judgment against the Firm, or upon sale, plus pre- and post-judgment interest, fees and costs. The Firm may be entitled to be indemnified for some of these losses.

On July 8, 2013, U.S. Bank National Association, in its capacity as trustee, filed a complaint against the Firm styled U.S. Bank National Association, solely in its capacity as Trustee of the Morgan Stanley Mortgage Loan Trust 2007-2AX (MSM 2007-2AX) v. Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital Holdings LLC, as Successor-by-Merger to Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital Inc. and GreenPoint Mortgage Funding, Inc.,

pending in the Supreme Court of NY. The complaint asserts claims for breach of contract and alleges, among other things, that the loans in the trust, which had an original principal balance of approximately $650 million, breached various representations and warranties. The complaint seeks, among other relief, specific performance of the loan breach remedy procedures in the transaction documents, unspecified damages and interest. On August 22, 2013, the Firm filed a motion to dismiss the complaint, which was granted in part and denied in part on November 24, 2014. Based on currently available information, the Firm believes that it could incur a loss in this action of up to approximately $240 million, the total original unpaid balance of the mortgage loans for which the Firm received repurchase demands that it did not repurchase, plus pre- and post-judgment interest, fees and costs, but plaintiff is seeking to expand the number of loans at issue and the possible range of loss could increase.

On December 30, 2013, Wilmington Trust Company, in its capacity as trustee for Morgan Stanley Mortgage Loan Trust 2007-12, filed a complaint against the Firm styled Wilmington Trust Company v. Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital Holdings LLC et al., pending in the Supreme Court of NY. The complaint asserts claims for breach of contract and alleges, among other things, that the loans in the trust, which had an original principal balance of approximately $516 million, breached various representations and warranties. The complaint seeks, among other relief, unspecified damages, attorneys’ fees, interest and costs. On February 28, 2014, the defendants filed a motion to dismiss the complaint, which was granted in part and denied in part on June 14, 2016. Based on currently available information, the Firm believes that it could incur a loss in this action of up to approximately $152 million, the total original unpaid balance of the mortgage loans for which the Firm received repurchase demands that it did not repurchase, plus attorney’s fees, costs and interest, but plaintiff is seeking to expand the number of loans at issue and the possible range of loss could increase.

On April 28, 2014, Deutsche Bank National Trust Company, in its capacity as trustee for Morgan Stanley Structured Trust I 2007-1, filed a complaint against the Firm styled Deutsche Bank National Trust Company v. Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital Holdings LLC, pending in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York. The complaint asserts claims for breach of contract and alleges, among other things, that the loans in the trust, which had an original principal balance of approximately $735 million, breached various representations and warranties. The complaint seeks, among other relief, specific performance of the loan breach remedy procedures in the transaction documents, unspecified compensatory and/or rescissory damages, interest and costs. On April 3, 2015, the court granted in part and denied in part the Firm’s motion to dismiss the complaint. Based on

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   158  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

currently available information, the Firm believes that it could incur a loss in this action of up to approximately $292 million, the total original unpaid balance of the mortgage loans for which the Firm received repurchase demands that it did not repurchase, plus pre- and post-judgment interest, fees and costs, but plaintiff is seeking to expand the number of loans at issue and the possible range of loss could increase.

On September 19, 2014, Financial Guaranty Insurance Company (“FGIC”) filed a complaint against the Firm in the Supreme Court of NY, styled Financial Guaranty Insurance Company v. Morgan Stanley ABS Capital I Inc. et al. relating to a securitization issued by Basket of Aggregated Residential NIMS 2007-1 Ltd. The complaint asserts claims for breach of contract and alleges, among other things, that the net interest margin securities (“NIMS”) in the trust breached various representations and warranties. FGIC issued a financial guaranty policy with respect to certain notes that had an original balance of approximately $475 million. The complaint seeks, among other relief, specific performance of the NIMS breach remedy procedures in the transaction documents, unspecified damages, reimbursement of certain payments made pursuant to the transaction documents, attorneys’ fees and interest. On November 24, 2014, the Firm filed a motion to dismiss the complaint, which the court denied on January 19, 2017. Based on currently available information, the Firm believes that it could incur a loss in this action of up to approximately $126 million, the unpaid balance of these notes, plus pre- and post-judgment interest, fees and costs, as well as claim payments that FGIC has made and will make in the future.

On September 23, 2014, FGIC filed a complaint against the Firm in the Supreme Court of NY styled Financial Guaranty Insurance Company v. Morgan Stanley ABS Capital I Inc. et al. relating to the Morgan Stanley ABS Capital I Inc. Trust 2007-NC4. The complaint asserts claims for breach of contract and fraudulent inducement and alleges, among other things, that the loans in the trust breached various representations and warranties and defendants made untrue statements and material omissions to induce FGIC to issue a financial guaranty policy on certain classes of certificates that had an original balance of approximately $876 million. The complaint seeks, among other relief, specific performance of the loan breach remedy procedures in the transaction documents, compensatory, consequential and punitive damages, attorneys’ fees and interest. On January 23, 2017, the court denied the Firm’s motion to dismiss the complaint. Based on currently available information, the Firm believes that it could incur a loss in this action of up to approximately $277 million, the total original unpaid balance of the mortgage loans for which the Firm received repurchase demands from a certificate holder and FGIC that the Firm did not repurchase, plus pre- and post-judgment interest, fees and

costs, as well as claim payments that FGIC has made and will make in the future. In addition, plaintiff is seeking to expand the number of loans at issue and the possible range of loss could increase.

On January 23, 2015, Deutsche Bank National Trust Company, in its capacity as trustee, filed a complaint against the Firm styled Deutsche Bank National Trust Company solely in its capacity as Trustee of the Morgan Stanley ABS Capital I Inc. Trust 2007-NC4 v. Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital Holdings LLC as Successor-by-Merger to Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital Inc., and Morgan Stanley ABS Capital I Inc., pending in the Supreme Court of NY. The complaint asserts claims for breach of contract and alleges, among other things, that the loans in the trust, which had an original principal balance of approximately $1.05 billion, breached various representations and warranties. The complaint seeks, among other relief, specific performance of the loan breach remedy procedures in the transaction documents, compensatory, consequential, rescissory, equitable and punitive damages, attorneys’ fees, costs and other related expenses, and interest. On December 11, 2015, the court granted in part and denied in part the Firm’s motion to dismiss the complaint. On February 11, 2016, plaintiff filed a notice of appeal of that order. Based on currently available information, the Firm believes that it could incur a loss in this action of up to approximately $277 million, the total original unpaid balance of the mortgage loans for which the Firm received repurchase demands from a certificate holder and a monoline insurer that the Firm did not repurchase, plus pre- and post-judgment interest, fees and costs, but plaintiff is seeking to expand the number of loans at issue and the possible range of loss could increase.

In May 2016, the Austrian state of Land Salzburg filed a claim against the Firm in Germany (the “German Proceedings”) seeking €209 million (approximately $220 million) relating to certain fixed income and commodities derivative transactions which Land Salzburg entered into with the Firm between 2005 and 2012. Land Salzburg has alleged that it had neither the capacity nor authority to enter into such transactions, which should be set aside, and that the Firm breached certain advisory and other duties which the Firm had owed to it. In April 2016, the Firm filed a pre-emptive claim against Land Salzburg in the English courts (the “English Proceedings”) in which the Firm is seeking declarations that Land Salzburg had both the capacity and authority to enter into the transactions, and that the Firm has no liability to Land Salzburg arising from them. In July 2016, the Firm filed an application with the German court to stay the German Proceedings on the basis that the English court was first seized of the dispute between the parties and, pending determination of that application, filed its statement of defense on December 23, 2016. On December 8, 2016,

 

 

  159   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Land Salzburg filed an application with the English court challenging its jurisdiction to determine the English Proceedings. Based on currently available information, the Firm believes that it could incur a loss in this action of up to approximately €209 million, plus interest and costs.

 

13. Variable Interest Entities and Securitization Activities

Overview

The Firm is involved with various SPEs in the normal course of business. In most cases, these entities are deemed to be VIEs.

The Firm’s variable interests in VIEs include debt and equity interests, commitments, guarantees, derivative instruments and certain fees. The Firm’s involvement with VIEs arises primarily from:

 

 

Interests purchased in connection with market-making activities, securities held in its Investment securities portfolio and retained interests held as a result of securitization activities, including re-securitization transactions.

 

 

Guarantees issued and residual interests retained in connection with municipal bond securitizations.

 

 

Loans made to and investments in VIEs that hold debt, equity, real estate or other assets.

 

 

Derivatives entered into with VIEs.

 

 

Structuring of CLNs or other asset-repackaged notes designed to meet the investment objectives of clients.

 

 

Other structured transactions designed to provide tax-efficient yields to the Firm or its clients.

The Firm determines whether it is the primary beneficiary of a VIE upon its initial involvement with the VIE and reassesses whether it is the primary beneficiary on an ongoing basis as long as it has any continuing involvement with the VIE. This determination is based upon an analysis of the design of the VIE, including the VIE’s structure and activities, the power to make significant economic decisions held by the Firm and by other parties, and the variable interests owned by the Firm and other parties.

The power to make the most significant economic decisions may take a number of different forms in different types of VIEs. The Firm considers servicing or collateral management decisions as representing the power to make the most significant economic decisions in transactions such as securitizations or CDOs. As a result, the Firm does not consolidate

securitizations or CDOs for which it does not act as the servicer or collateral manager unless it holds certain other rights to replace the servicer or collateral manager or to require the liquidation of the entity. If the Firm serves as servicer or collateral manager, or has certain other rights described in the previous sentence, the Firm analyzes the interests in the VIE that it holds and consolidates only those VIEs for which it holds a potentially significant interest of the VIE.

The structure of securitization vehicles and CDOs is driven by several parties, including loan seller(s) in securitization transactions, the collateral manager in a CDO, one or more rating agencies, a financial guarantor in some transactions and the underwriter(s) of the transactions, that serve to reflect specific investor demand. In addition, subordinate investors, such as the “B-piece” buyer (i.e., investors in most subordinated bond classes) in commercial mortgage-backed securitizations or equity investors in CDOs, can influence whether specific loans are excluded from a CMBS transaction or investment criteria in a CDO.

For many transactions, such as re-securitization transactions, CLNs and other asset-repackaged notes, there are no significant economic decisions made on an ongoing basis. In these cases, the Firm focuses its analysis on decisions made prior to the initial closing of the transaction and at the termination of the transaction. Based upon factors, which include an analysis of the nature of the assets, including whether the assets were issued in a transaction sponsored by the Firm and the extent of the information available to the Firm and to investors, the number, nature and involvement of investors, other rights held by the Firm and investors, the standardization of the legal documentation and the level of continuing involvement by the Firm, including the amount and type of interests owned by the Firm and by other investors, the Firm concluded in most of these transactions that decisions made prior to the initial closing were shared between the Firm and the initial investors. The Firm focused its control decision on any right held by the Firm or investors related to the termination of the VIE. Most re-securitization transactions, CLNs and other asset-repackaged notes have no such termination rights.

Consolidated VIEs

Except for consolidated VIEs included in other structured financings and managed real estate partnerships in the tables below, the Firm accounts for the assets held by the entities primarily in Trading assets and the liabilities of the entities in Other secured financings in its consolidated balance sheets. For consolidated VIEs included in other structured financings, the Firm accounts for the assets held by the entities primarily in Premises, equipment and software costs, and

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   160  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Other assets in its consolidated balance sheets. For consolidated VIEs included in managed real estate partnerships, the Firm accounts for the assets held by the entities primarily in Trading assets in its consolidated balance sheets. Except for consolidated VIEs included in other structured financings, the assets and liabilities are measured at fair value, with changes in fair value reflected in earnings.

As part of the Institutional Securities business segment’s securitization and related activities, the Firm has provided, or otherwise agreed to be responsible for, representations and warranties regarding certain assets transferred in securitization transactions sponsored by the Firm (see Note 12).

As a result of adopting the accounting update Amendments to the Consolidation Analysis on January 1, 2016, certain consolidated entities are now considered VIEs and are included in the balances at December 31, 2016. See Note 2 for further information.

Assets and Liabilities by Type of Activity

 

     At December 31, 2016      At December 31, 2015  
$ in millions    VIE Assets      VIE
 Liabilities 
     VIE Assets      VIE
 Liabilities  
 

Credit-linked notes

   $ 501      $      $ 900      $ —   

Other structured financings

     602        10        787        13   

Asset-backed securitizations1

     397        283        668        423   

Other2

     910        25        245        —   

Total

   $             2,410      $             318      $             2,600      $             436   

 

1.

Asset-backed securitizations include transactions backed by residential mortgage loans, commercial mortgage loans and other types of assets, including consumer or commercial assets. The value of assets is determined based on the fair value of the liabilities of and the interests owned by the Firm in such VIEs because the fair values for the liabilities and interests owned are more observable.

2.

Other primarily includes certain operating entities, investment funds and structured transactions.

Assets and Liabilities by Balance Sheet Caption

 

$ in millions    At December 31,
2016
    

At December 31, 

2015

 

Assets

     

Cash and due from banks

   $ 74      $ 14   

Trading assets at fair value

     1,295        1,842   

Customer and other receivables

     13         

Goodwill

     18        —   

Intangible assets

     177        —   

Other assets

     833        741   

Total

   $ 2,410      $ 2,600   

Liabilities

     

Other secured financings at fair value

   $ 289      $ 431   

Other liabilities and accrued expenses

     29         

Total

   $ 318      $ 436   

Consolidated VIE assets and liabilities are presented in the previous tables after intercompany eliminations. The assets owned by many consolidated VIEs cannot be removed unilaterally by the Firm and are not generally available to the Firm. The related liabilities issued by many consolidated VIEs are non-recourse to the Firm. In certain other consolidated VIEs, the Firm either has the unilateral right to remove assets or provide additional recourse through derivatives such as total return swaps, guarantees or other forms of involvement.

In general, the Firm’s exposure to loss in consolidated VIEs is limited to losses that would be absorbed on the VIE’s net assets recognized in its financial statements, net of amounts absorbed by third-party variable interest holders. At December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, noncontrolling interests in the consolidated financial statements related to consolidated VIEs were $228 million and $37 million, respectively. The Firm also had additional maximum exposure to losses of approximately $78 million and $72 million at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively, primarily related to certain derivatives, commitments, guarantees and other forms of involvement.

Non-consolidated VIEs

The following tables include all VIEs in which the Firm has determined that its maximum exposure to loss is greater than specific thresholds or meets certain other criteria and exclude exposure to loss from liabilities due to immateriality. Most of the VIEs included in the following tables are sponsored by unrelated parties; the Firm’s involvement generally is the result of its secondary market-making activities, securities held in its Investment securities portfolio (see Note 5) and certain investments in funds.

 

 

  161   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Non-consolidated VIE Assets, Maximum and Carrying Value of Exposure to Loss

 

     At December 31, 2016  
$ in millions   

Mortgage and

Asset-Backed

Securitizations

    

 Collateralized 

Debt

Obligations

    

     Municipal     

Tender

Option

Bonds

    

Other

Structured

    Financings    

              Other           

VIE assets that the Firm does not consolidate

(unpaid principal balance)

   $ 101,916      $ 11,341      $ 4,857      $ 4,293      $ 39,077   

Maximum exposure to loss

              

Debt and equity interests

   $ 11,243      $ 1,245      $ 50      $ 1,570      $ 4,877   

Derivative and other contracts

                   2,812               45   

Commitments, guarantees and other

     684        99               187        228   

Total

   $ 11,927      $ 1,344      $ 2,862      $ 1,757      $ 5,150   

Carrying value of exposure to loss—Assets

              

Debt and equity interests

   $ 11,243      $ 1,245      $ 49      $ 1,183      $ 4,877   

Derivative and other contracts

                   5               18   

Total

   $ 11,243      $ 1,245      $ 54      $ 1,183      $ 4,895   

 

     At December 31, 2015  
$ in millions    Mortgage and
Asset-Backed
Securitizations
    

 Collateralized 

Debt

Obligations

    

     Municipal     

Tender

Option

Bonds

    

Other

Structured

    Financings    

              Other           

VIE assets that the Firm does not consolidate

(unpaid principal balance)

   $ 126,872      $ 8,805      $ 4,654      $ 2,201      $ 20,775   

Maximum exposure to loss

              

Debt and equity interests

   $ 13,361      $ 1,259      $ 1      $ 1,129      $ 3,854   

Derivative and other contracts

                   2,834               67   

Commitments, guarantees and other

     494        231               361        222   

Total

   $ 13,855      $ 1,490      $ 2,835      $ 1,490      $ 4,143   

Carrying value of exposure to loss—Assets

              

Debt and equity interests

   $ 13,361      $ 1,259      $ 1      $ 685      $ 3,854   

Derivative and other contracts

                   5               13   

Total

   $ 13,361      $ 1,259      $ 6      $ 685      $ 3,867   

 

Non-consolidated VIE Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Securitization Assets

 

     At December 31, 2016      At December 31, 2015  
$ in millions   

Unpaid

Principal

Balance

    

Debt and

Equity

Interests

    

Unpaid

Principal

Balance

    

Debt and

Equity

Interests

 

Residential mortgages

   $ 4,775      $ 458      $ 13,787      $ 1,012   

Commercial mortgages

     54,021        2,656        57,313        2,871   

U.S. agency collateralized mortgage obligations

     14,796        2,758        13,236        2,763   

Other consumer or commercial loans

     28,324        5,371        42,536        6,715   

Total

   $     101,916      $       11,243      $     126,872      $       13,361   

The Firm’s maximum exposure to loss often differs from the carrying value of the variable interests held by the Firm. The maximum exposure to loss is dependent on the nature of the

Firm’s variable interest in the VIEs and is limited to the notional amounts of certain liquidity facilities, other credit support, total return swaps, written put options, and the fair value of certain other derivatives and investments the Firm has made in the VIEs. Liabilities issued by VIEs generally are non-recourse to the Firm. Where notional amounts are utilized in quantifying maximum exposure related to derivatives, such amounts do not reflect fair value write-downs already recorded by the Firm.

The Firm’s maximum exposure to loss does not include the offsetting benefit of any financial instruments that the Firm may utilize to hedge these risks associated with its variable interests. In addition, the Firm’s maximum exposure to loss is not reduced by the amount of collateral held as part of a transaction with the VIE or any party to the VIE directly against a specific exposure to loss.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   162  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Securitization transactions generally involve VIEs. Primarily as a result of its secondary market-making activities, the Firm owned additional VIE assets mainly issued by securitization SPEs for which the maximum exposure to loss is less than specific thresholds. These additional assets totaled $11.7 billion and $12.9 billion at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively. These assets were either retained in connection with transfers of assets by the Firm, acquired in connection with secondary market-making activities or held as AFS securities in its Investment securities portfolio (see Note 5) or held as investments in funds. At December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, these assets consisted of securities backed by residential mortgage loans, commercial mortgage loans or other consumer loans, such as credit card receivables, automobile loans and student loans, CDOs or CLOs, and investment funds. The Firm’s primary risk exposure is to the securities issued by the SPE owned by the Firm, with the risk highest on the most subordinate class of beneficial interests. These assets generally are included in Trading assets—Corporate and other debt, Trading assets—Investments or AFS securities within its Investment securities portfolio and are measured at fair value (see Note 3). The Firm does not provide additional support in these transactions through contractual facilities, such as liquidity facilities, guarantees or similar derivatives. The Firm’s maximum exposure to loss generally equals the fair value of the assets owned.

Securitization Activities

In a securitization transaction, the Firm transfers assets (generally commercial or residential mortgage loans or U.S. agency securities) to an SPE, sells to investors most of the beneficial interests, such as notes or certificates, issued by the SPE, and, in many cases, retains other beneficial interests. In many securitization transactions involving commercial mortgage loans, the Firm transfers a portion of the assets to the SPE with unrelated parties transferring the remaining assets.

The purchase of the transferred assets by the SPE is financed through the sale of these interests. In some of these transactions, primarily involving residential mortgage loans in the U.S., the Firm serves as servicer for some or all of the transferred loans. In many securitizations, particularly involving residential mortgage loans, the Firm also enters into derivative transactions, primarily interest rate swaps or interest rate caps, with the SPE.

Although not obligated, the Firm generally makes a market in the securities issued by SPEs in these transactions. As a market maker, the Firm offers to buy these securities from, and sell these securities to, investors. Securities purchased through these market-making activities are not considered to be retained interests, although these beneficial interests generally are included in Trading assets—Corporate and other debt and are measured at fair value.

The Firm enters into derivatives, generally interest rate swaps and interest rate caps, with a senior payment priority in many securitization transactions. The risks associated with these and similar derivatives with SPEs are essentially the same as similar derivatives with non-SPE counterparties and are managed as part of the Firm’s overall exposure. See Note 4 for further information on derivative instruments and hedging activities.

Available for Sale Securities

In the AFS securities within the Investment securities portfolio, the Firm holds securities issued by VIEs not sponsored by the Firm. These securities include government-guaranteed securities issued in transactions sponsored by the federal mortgage agencies and the most senior securities issued by VIEs in which the securities are backed by student loans, automobile loans, commercial mortgage loans or CLOs (see Note 5).

Municipal Tender Option Bond Trusts

In a municipal tender option bond transaction, the Firm, generally on behalf of a client, transfers a municipal bond to a trust. The trust issues short-term securities that the Firm, as the remarketing agent, sells to investors. The client retains a residual interest. The short-term securities are supported by a liquidity facility pursuant to which the investors may put their short-term interests. In some programs, the Firm provides this liquidity facility; in most programs, a third-party provider will provide such liquidity facility. The Firm may purchase short-term securities in its role either as remarketing agent or as liquidity provider. The client can generally terminate the transaction at any time. The liquidity provider can generally terminate the transaction upon the occurrence of certain events. When the transaction is terminated, the municipal bond is generally sold or returned to the client. Any losses suffered by the liquidity provider upon the sale of the bond are the responsibility of the client. This obligation generally is collateralized. Liquidity facilities provided to municipal tender option bond trusts are classified as derivatives. The Firm consolidates any municipal tender option bond trusts in which it holds the residual interest.

Credit Protection Purchased through CLNs

In a CLN transaction, the Firm transfers assets (generally high-quality securities or money market investments) to an SPE, enters into a derivative transaction in which the SPE writes protection on an unrelated reference asset or group of assets, through a credit default swap, a total return swap or similar instrument, and sells to investors the securities issued by the SPE. In some transactions, the Firm may also enter into interest rate or currency swaps with the SPE. Upon the

 

 

  163   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

occurrence of a credit event related to the reference asset, the SPE will deliver collateral securities as payment to the Firm. The Firm is generally exposed to price changes on the collateral securities in the event of a credit event and subsequent sale. These transactions are designed to provide investors with exposure to certain credit risk on the reference asset. In some transactions, the assets and liabilities of the SPE are recognized in the Firm’s consolidated balance sheets. In other transactions, the transfer of the collateral securities is accounted for as a sale of assets, and the SPE is not consolidated. The structure of the transaction determines the accounting treatment.

The derivatives in CLN transactions consist of total return swaps, credit default swaps or similar contracts in which the Firm has purchased protection on a reference asset or group of assets. Payments by the SPE are collateralized. The risks associated with these and similar derivatives with SPEs are essentially the same as similar derivatives with non-SPE counterparties and are managed as part of the Firm’s overall exposure.

Other Structured Financings

The Firm primarily invests in equity interests issued by entities that develop and own low-income communities (including low-income housing projects) and entities that construct and own facilities that will generate energy from renewable resources. The equity interests entitle the Firm to its share of tax credits and tax losses generated by these projects. In addition, the Firm has issued guarantees to investors in certain low-income housing funds. The guarantees are designed to return an investor’s contribution to a fund and the investor’s share of tax losses and tax credits expected to be generated by the fund. The Firm is also involved with entities designed to provide tax-efficient yields to the Firm or its clients.

Collateralized Loan and Debt Obligations

A CLO or a CDO is an SPE that purchases a pool of assets, consisting of corporate loans, corporate bonds, asset-backed securities or synthetic exposures on similar assets through derivatives, and issues multiple tranches of debt and equity securities to investors. The Firm underwrites the securities issued in CLO transactions on behalf of unaffiliated sponsors and provides advisory services to these unaffiliated sponsors. The Firm sells corporate loans to many of these SPEs, in some cases representing a significant portion of the total assets purchased. If necessary, the Firm may retain unsold securities issued in these transactions. Although not obligated, the Firm generally makes a market in the securities issued by SPEs in these transactions. These beneficial interests are included in Trading assets and are measured at fair value.

Equity-Linked Notes

In an ELN transaction, the Firm typically transfers to an SPE either (1) a note issued by the Firm, the payments on which are linked to the performance of a specific equity security, equity index, or other index or (2) debt securities issued by other companies and a derivative contract, the terms of which will relate to the performance of a specific equity security, equity index or other index. These transactions are designed to provide investors with exposure to certain risks related to the specific equity security, equity index or other index. ELN transactions with SPEs were not consolidated at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015.

Transactions with SPEs in which the Firm, acting as principal, transferred financial assets with continuing involvement and received sales treatment are shown below.

Transfers of Assets with Continuing Involvement

 

    At December 31, 2016  
$ in millions   Residential
Mortgage
Loans
    Commercial
Mortgage
Loans
    U.S. Agency
Collateralized
Mortgage
Obligations
   

Credit-
Linked
Notes and

Other1

 

SPE assets (unpaid principal balance)2

  $ 19,381     $ 43,104     $ 11,092     $ 11,613  

Retained interests (fair value)

 

Investment grade

  $     $ 22     $ 375     $  

Non-investment grade

    4       79             826  

Total

  $ 4     $ 101     $ 375     $ 826  

Interests purchased in the secondary market (fair value)

 

Investment grade

  $     $ 30     $ 26     $  

Non-investment grade

    23       75              

Total

  $ 23     $ 105     $ 26     $  

Derivative assets (fair value)

  $     $ 261     $     $ 89  

Derivative liabilities (fair value)

                      459  
    At December 31, 2015  
$ in millions   Residential
Mortgage
Loans
    Commercial
Mortgage
Loans
    U.S. Agency
Collateralized
Mortgage
Obligations
   

Credit-
Linked
Notes and

Other1

 

SPE assets (unpaid principal balance)2

  $ 22,440     $ 72,760     $ 17,978     $ 12,235  

Retained interests (fair value)

 

Investment grade

  $     $ 238     $ 649     $  

Non-investment grade

    160       63             1,136  

Total

  $ 160     $ 301     $ 649     $ 1,136  

Interests purchased in the secondary market (fair value)

 

Investment grade

  $     $ 88     $ 99     $  

Non-investment grade

    60       63             10  

Total

  $ 60     $ 151     $ 99     $ 10  

Derivative assets (fair value)

  $     $ 343     $     $ 151  

Derivative liabilities (fair value)

                      449  

 

1.

Amounts include CLO transactions managed by unrelated third parties.

2.

Amounts include assets transferred by unrelated transferors.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   164  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

     At December 31, 2016  
$ in millions    Level 2      Level 3      Total  

Retained interests (fair value)

        

Investment grade

   $ 385      $ 12      $ 397  

Non-investment grade

     14        895        909  

Total

   $ 399      $         907      $     1,306  

Interests purchased in the secondary market (fair value)

 

Investment grade

   $ 56      $      $ 56  

Non-investment grade

     84        14        98  

Total

   $         140      $ 14      $ 154  

Derivative assets (fair value)

   $ 348      $ 2      $ 350  

Derivative liabilities (fair value)

     98        361        459  
     At December 31, 2015  
$ in millions    Level 2      Level 3      Total  

Retained interests (fair value)

        

Investment grade

   $ 886      $ 1      $ 887  

Non-investment grade

     17        1,342        1,359  

Total

   $         903      $         1,343      $     2,246  

Interests purchased in the secondary market (fair value)

 

Investment grade

   $ 187      $      $ 187  

Non-investment grade

     112        21        133  

Total

   $ 299      $ 21      $ 320  

Derivative assets (fair value)

   $ 466      $ 28      $ 494  

Derivative liabilities (fair value)

     110        339        449  

Transferred assets are carried at fair value prior to securitization, and any changes in fair value are recognized in the consolidated income statements. The Firm may act as underwriter of the beneficial interests issued by these securitization vehicles. Investment banking underwriting net revenues are recognized in connection with these transactions. The Firm may retain interests in the securitized financial assets as one or more tranches of the securitization. These retained interests are included in the consolidated balance sheets. Any changes in the fair value of such retained interests are recognized in the consolidated income statements.

Proceeds from New Securitization Transactions and Retained Interests in Securitization Transactions

 

$ in millions    2016      2015      2014  

New transactions

   $     18,975      $     21,243      $     20,553  

Retained interests

     2,701        3,062        3,041  

Net gains on sale of assets in securitization transactions at the time of the sale were not material for all periods presented.

The Firm has provided, or otherwise agreed to be responsible for, representations and warranties regarding certain assets transferred in securitization transactions sponsored by the Firm (see Note 12).

Proceeds from Sales to CLO Entities Sponsored by Non-Affiliates

 

$ in millions    2016      2015      2014  

Proceeds from sale of corporate loans sold to those SPEs

   $     475      $     1,110      $     2,388  

Net gains on sale of corporate loans to CLO transactions at the time of sale were not material for all periods presented.

The Firm also enters into transactions in which it sells equity securities and contemporaneously enters into bilateral OTC equity derivatives with the purchasers of the securities, through which it retains the exposure to the securities as shown in the following table.

Carrying and Fair Value of Assets Sold and Retained Interest Exposure

 

$ in millions   

At December 31,

2016

   

At December 31,

2015

 

Carrying value of assets derecognized at the time of sale and gross cash proceeds

   $ 11,209     $ 7,878  

Fair value of assets sold

     11,301       7,935  

Fair value of derivative assets recognized in the consolidated balance sheets

     128       97  

Fair value of derivative liabilities recognized in the consolidated balance sheets

     36       40  

Failed Sales

For transfers that fail to meet the accounting criteria for a sale, the Firm continues to recognize the assets in Trading assets at fair value, and the Firm recognizes the associated liabilities in Other secured financings at fair value in the consolidated balance sheets (see Note 11).

The assets transferred to certain unconsolidated VIEs in transactions accounted for as failed sales cannot be removed unilaterally by the Firm and are not generally available to the Firm. The related liabilities are also non-recourse to the Firm. In certain other failed sale transactions, the Firm has the right to remove assets or provide additional recourse through derivatives such as total return swaps, guarantees or other forms of involvement.

Carrying Value of Assets and Liabilities Related to Failed Sales

 

    

At

December 31, 2016

    

At

December 31, 2015

 
$ in millions    Assets      Liabilities      Assets      Liabilities  

Failed sales

   $         285      $         285      $         400      $         400  
 

 

  165   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

14. Regulatory Requirements

Regulatory Capital Framework

The Firm is a financial holding company under the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended, and is subject to the regulation and oversight of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (the “Federal Reserve”). The Federal Reserve establishes capital requirements for the Firm, including well-capitalized standards, and evaluates the Firm’s compliance with such capital requirements. The Office of the Comptroller of the Currency establishes similar capital requirements and standards for the Firm’s U.S. Bank Subsidiaries. The regulatory capital requirements are largely based on the Basel III capital standards established by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision and also implement certain provisions of the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act.

Regulatory Capital Requirements

The Firm is required to maintain minimum risk-based and leverage capital ratios under the regulatory capital requirements. A summary of the calculations of regulatory capital, risk-weighted assets (“RWAs”) and transition provisions follows.

Regulatory Capital

Minimum risk-based capital ratio requirements apply to Common Equity Tier 1 capital, Tier 1 capital and Total capital. Certain adjustments to and deductions from capital are required for purposes of determining these ratios, such as goodwill, intangibles, certain deferred tax assets, other amounts in AOCI and investments in the capital instruments of unconsolidated financial institutions. Certain of these adjustments and deductions are also subject to transitional provisions.

In addition to the minimum risk-based capital ratio requirements, on a fully phased-in basis by 2019, the Firm will be subject to:

 

 

A greater than 2.5% Common Equity Tier 1 capital conservation buffer;

 

 

The Common Equity Tier 1 global systemically important bank capital surcharge, currently at 3%; and

 

Up to a 2.5% Common Equity Tier 1 countercyclical capital buffer, currently set by banking regulators at zero (collectively, the “buffers”).

In 2016, the phase-in amount for each of the buffers is 25% of the fully phased-in buffer requirement. Failure to maintain the buffers will result in restrictions on the Firm’s ability to make capital distributions, including the payment of dividends and the repurchase of stock, and to pay discretionary bonuses to executive officers.

Risk-Weighted Assets

RWAs reflect both the Firm’s on- and off-balance sheet risk, as well as capital charges attributable to the risk of loss arising from the following:

 

 

Credit risk: The failure of a borrower, counterparty or issuer to meet its financial obligations to the Firm;

 

 

Market risk: Adverse changes in the level of one or more market prices, rates, indices, implied volatilities, correlations or other market factors, such as market liquidity; and

 

 

Operational risk: Inadequate or failed processes or systems, human factors or from external events (e.g., fraud, theft, legal and compliance risks, cyber attacks or damage to physical assets).

The Firm’s binding risk-based capital ratios for regulatory purposes are the lower of the capital ratios computed under the (i) standardized approaches for calculating credit risk RWAs and market risk RWAs (the “Standardized Approach”) and (ii) applicable advanced approaches for calculating credit risk, market risk and operational risk RWAs (the “Advanced Approach”).

The methods for calculating each of the Firm’s risk-based capital ratios will change through January 1, 2022 as aspects of the capital rules are phased in. These changes may result in differences in the Firm’s reported capital ratios from one reporting period to the next that are independent of changes to its capital base, asset composition, off-balance sheet exposures or risk profile.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   166  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

The Firm’s Regulatory Capital and Capital Ratios

At December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, the Firm’s binding ratios are based on the Advanced Approach transitional rules.

Regulatory Capital

 

    At December 31, 2016  
$ in millions   Amount      Ratio     Minimum
Ratio1
 

Regulatory capital and capital ratios

      

Common Equity Tier 1 capital

  $ 60,398        16.9     5.9%  

Tier 1 capital

    68,097        19.0     7.4%  

Total capital

    78,642        22.0     9.4%  

Tier 1 leverage2

           8.4     4.0%  

Assets

      

Total RWAs

  $     358,141        N/A       N/A  

Adjusted average assets3

    811,402        N/A       N/A  

 

    At December 31, 2015  
$ in millions   Amount      Ratio     Minimum
Ratio1
 

Regulatory capital and capital ratios

      

Common Equity Tier 1 capital

  $ 59,409        15.5     4.5%  

Tier 1 capital

    66,722        17.4     6.0%  

Total capital

    79,403        20.7     8.0%  

Tier 1 leverage2

           8.3     4.0%  

Assets

      

Total RWAs

  $     384,162        N/A       N/A  

Adjusted average assets3

    803,574        N/A       N/A  

N/A—Not Applicable

1.

Percentages represent minimum regulatory capital ratios under the transitional rules.

2.

Tier 1 leverage ratios are calculated under the Standardized Approach transitional rules.

3.

Adjusted average assets represent the denominator of the Tier 1 leverage ratio and are composed of the average daily balance of consolidated on-balance sheet assets under U.S. GAAP during the calendar quarter ended December 31 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively, adjusted for disallowed goodwill, transitional intangible assets, certain deferred tax assets, certain investments in the capital instruments of unconsolidated financial institutions and other adjustments.

U.S. Bank Subsidiaries’ Regulatory Capital and Capital Ratios

The Firm’s U.S. Bank Subsidiaries are subject to similar regulatory capital requirements as the Firm. Failure to meet minimum capital requirements can initiate certain mandatory and discretionary actions by regulators that, if undertaken, could have a direct material effect on the U.S. Bank Subsidiaries’ financial statements. Under capital adequacy guidelines and the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action, each of the U.S. Bank Subsidiaries must meet specific capital guidelines that involve quantitative measures of its assets, liabilities and certain off-balance sheet items as calculated under regulatory accounting practices.

Each U.S. depository institution subsidiary of the Firm must be well-capitalized in order for the Firm to continue to

qualify as a financial holding company and to continue to engage in the broadest range of financial activities permitted for financial holding companies. Under regulatory capital requirements adopted by the U.S. federal banking agencies, U.S. depository institutions must maintain certain minimum capital ratios in order to be considered well-capitalized. At December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, the Firm’s U.S. Bank Subsidiaries maintained capital at levels sufficiently in excess of the universally mandated well-capitalized requirements to address any additional capital needs and requirements identified by the U.S. federal banking regulators.

At December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, the U.S. Bank Subsidiaries’ binding ratios are based on the Standardized Approach transitional rules.

MSBNA’s Regulatory Capital

     At December 31, 2016  
$ in millions    Amount      Ratio     Required
Capital
Ratio1
 

Common Equity Tier 1 capital

   $     13,398        16.9     6.5%  

Tier 1 capital

     13,398        16.9     8.0%  

Total capital

     14,858        18.7     10.0%  

Tier 1 leverage

     13,398        10.5     5.0%  
     At December 31, 2015  
$ in millions    Amount      Ratio     Required
Capital
Ratio1
 

Common Equity Tier 1 capital

   $ 13,333        15.1     6.5%  

Tier 1 capital

     13,333        15.1     8.0%  

Total capital

     15,097        17.1     10.0%  

Tier 1 leverage

     13,333        10.2     5.0%  

 

1.

Capital ratios that are required in order to be considered well-capitalized for U.S. regulatory purposes.

MSPBNA’s Regulatory Capital

     At December 31, 2016  
$ in millions    Amount      Ratio     Required
Capital
Ratio1
 

Common Equity Tier 1 capital

   $ 5,589        26.1     6.5%  

Tier 1 capital

     5,589        26.1     8.0%  

Total capital

     5,626        26.3     10.0%  

Tier 1 leverage

     5,589        10.6     5.0%  
     At December 31, 2015  
$ in millions    Amount      Ratio     Required
Capital
Ratio1
 

Common Equity Tier 1 capital

   $     4,197        26.5     6.5%  

Tier 1 capital

     4,197        26.5     8.0%  

Total capital

     4,225        26.7     10.0%  

Tier 1 leverage

     4,197        10.5     5.0%  

 

1.

Capital ratios that are required in order to be considered well-capitalized for U.S. regulatory purposes.

 

 

  167   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Broker-Dealer Regulatory Capital Requirements

MS&Co. is a registered U.S. broker-dealer and registered futures commission merchant and, accordingly, is subject to the minimum net capital requirements of the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”) and the U.S. Commodity Futures Trading Commission (“CFTC”). MS&Co. has consistently operated with capital in excess of its regulatory capital requirements. MS&Co.’s net capital totaled $10,311 million and $10,254 million at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively, which exceeded the amount required by $8,034 million and $8,458 million, respectively. MS&Co. is required to hold tentative net capital in excess of $1 billion and net capital in excess of $500 million in accordance with the market and credit risk standards of Appendix E of SEC Rule 15c3-1. In addition, MS&Co. is required to notify the SEC in the event that its tentative net capital is less than $5 billion. At December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, MS&Co. had tentative net capital in excess of the minimum and the notification requirements.

MSSB LLC is a registered U.S. broker-dealer and introducing broker for the futures business and, accordingly, is subject to the minimum net capital requirements of the SEC. MSSB LLC has consistently operated with capital in excess of its regulatory capital requirements. MSSB LLC’s net capital totaled $3,946 million and $3,613 million at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively, which exceeded the amount required by $3,797 million and $3,459 million, respectively.

MSIP, a London-based broker-dealer subsidiary, is subject to the capital requirements of the Prudential Regulation Authority, and MSMS, a Tokyo-based broker-dealer subsidiary, is subject to the capital requirements of the Financial Services Agency. MSIP and MSMS have consistently operated with capital in excess of their respective regulatory capital requirements.

Other Regulated Subsidiaries

Certain other U.S. and non-U.S. subsidiaries of the Firm are subject to various securities, commodities and banking regulations, and capital adequacy requirements promulgated by the regulatory and exchange authorities of the countries in which they operate. These subsidiaries have consistently operated with capital in excess of their local capital adequacy requirements.

The regulatory capital requirements referred to above, and certain covenants contained in various agreements governing indebtedness of the Firm, may restrict the Firm’s ability to withdraw capital from its subsidiaries. At December 31, 2016

and December 31, 2015, approximately $25.3 billion and $28.6 billion, respectively, of net assets of consolidated subsidiaries may be restricted as to the payment of cash dividends and advances to the Parent Company.

15. Total Equity

Morgan Stanley Shareholders’ Equity

Common Stock

Changes in Shares of Common Stock Outstanding

 

in millions    2016     2015  

Shares outstanding at beginning of period

     1,920       1,951  

Treasury stock purchases1

     (133     (78

Other2

     65       47  

Shares outstanding at end of period

     1,852       1,920  

 

1.

In addition to the Firm’s share repurchase program, Treasury stock purchases include repurchases of common stock for employee tax withholding.

2.

Other includes net shares issued to and forfeited from Employee stock trusts and issued for RSU conversions.

Dividends and Share Repurchases

The Firm repurchased approximately $3,500 million of its outstanding common stock as part of its share repurchase program during 2016, and the Firm repurchased approximately $2,125 million during 2015.

In June 2016, the Firm received a conditional non-objection from the Federal Reserve to its 2016 capital plan. The capital plan included a share repurchase of up to $3.5 billion of the Firm’s outstanding common stock during the period beginning July 1, 2016 through June 30, 2017. Additionally, the capital plan included an increase in the quarterly common stock dividend to $0.20 per share from $0.15 per share during the period beginning with the dividend declared on July 20, 2016.

Pursuant to the share repurchase program, the Firm considers, among other things, business segment capital needs as well as stock-based compensation and benefit plan requirements. Share repurchases under the program will be exercised from time to time at prices the Firm deems appropriate subject to various factors, including the Firm’s capital position and market conditions. The share repurchases may be effected through open market purchases or privately negotiated transactions, including through Rule 10b5-1 plans, and may be suspended at any time. Share repurchases by the Firm are subject to regulatory approval.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   168  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Employee Stock Trusts

The Firm has established Employee stock trusts to provide common stock voting rights to certain employees who hold outstanding RSUs. The assets of the Employee stock trusts are consolidated with those of the Firm, and the value of the stock held in the Employee stock trusts is classified in Morgan Stanley shareholders’ equity and generally accounted for in a manner similar to treasury stock.

Preferred Stock

Dividends declared on the Firm’s outstanding preferred stock were $468 million, $452 million and $311 million in 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively. On December 15, 2016, the Firm announced that the Board declared quarterly dividends for preferred stock shareholders of record on December 30, 2016 that were paid on January 17, 2017. The Firm is authorized to issue 30 million shares of preferred stock. The preferred stock has a preference over the common stock upon liquidation. The Firm’s preferred stock qualifies as Tier 1 capital in accordance with regulatory capital requirements (see Note 14).

Series K Preferred Stock. In January 2017, the Firm issued 40,000,000 Depositary Shares, for an aggregate price of $1,000 million. Each Depositary Share represents a 1/1,000th interest in a share of Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series K, $0.01 par value (“Series K Preferred Stock”). The Series K Preferred Stock is redeemable at the Firm’s option, (i) in whole or in part, from time to time, on any dividend payment date on or after April 15, 2027 or (ii) in whole but not in part at any time

within 90 days following a regulatory capital treatment event (as described in the terms of that series), in each case at a redemption price of $25,000 per share (equivalent to $25 per Depositary Share), plus any declared and unpaid dividends to, but excluding, the date fixed for redemption, without accumulation of any undeclared dividends. The Series K Preferred Stock also has a preference over the Firm’s common stock upon liquidation. The Series K Preferred Stock offering (net of related issuance costs) resulted in proceeds of approximately $969 million.

Preferred Stock Outstanding

 

$ in millions,
except per

share data

  Shares
Outstanding
    Liquidation
Preference
per Share
    Carrying Value  
  At December 31,
2016
      At December 31,
2016
    At December 31,
2015
 

Series

                       

A

    44,000     $ 25,000     $ 1,100     $ 1,100  

C1

    519,882       1,000       408       408  

E

    34,500       25,000       862       862  

F

    34,000       25,000       850       850  

G

    20,000       25,000       500       500  

H

    52,000       25,000       1,300       1,300  

I

    40,000       25,000       1,000       1,000  

J

    60,000       25,000       1,500       1,500  

Total

 

  $ 7,520     $ 7,520  

 

1.

Series C is composed of the issuance of 1,160,791 shares of Series C Preferred Stock to MUFG for an aggregate purchase price of $911 million, less the redemption of 640,909 shares of Series C Preferred Stock of $503 million, which were converted to common shares of approximately $705 million.

 

 

  169   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Preferred Stock Issuance Description

 

Series    Issuance Date    Preferred Stock Issuance Description   

Redemption
Price

per Share1

     Redeemable on
or after Date
     Dividend
per Share2
 

A3

   July 2006    44,000,000 Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/1,000th of a share of Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, $0.01 par value    $ 25,000        July 15, 2011      $ 255.56  

C3, 4

   October 13, 2008    10% Perpetual Non-Cumulative Non-Voting Preferred Stock      1,100        October 15, 2011        25.00  

E5

   September 30, 2013    34,500,000 Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/1,000th interest in a share of perpetual Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, $0.01 par value      25,000        October 15, 2023        445.31  

F5

   December 10, 2013    34,000,000 Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/1,000th interest in a share of perpetual Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, $0.01 par value      25,000        January 15, 2024        429.69  

G5

   April 29, 2014    20,000,000 Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/1,000th interest in a share of perpetual 6.625% Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, $0.01 par value      25,000        July 15, 2019        414.06  

H5, 6

   April 29, 2014    1,300,000 Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/25th interest in a share of perpetual Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, $0.01 par value      25,000        July 15, 2019        681.25  

I5

   September 18, 2014    40,000,000 Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/1,000th interest in a share of perpetual Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, $0.01 par value      25,000        October 15, 2024        398.44  

J5, 7

   March 19, 2015    1,500,000 Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/25th interest in a share of perpetual Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, $0.01 par value      25,000        July 15, 2020        693.75  

 

1.

The redemption price per share for Series A, E, F, G and I is equivalent to $25.00 per Depositary Share. The redemption price per share for Series H and J is equivalent to $1,000 per Depositary Share.

2.

Quarterly (unless noted otherwise) dividends declared in December 2016 were paid on January 17, 2017 to preferred shareholders of record on December 30, 2016.

3.

The preferred stock is redeemable at the Firm’s option, in whole or in part, on or after the redemption date.

4.

Dividends on the Series C preferred stock are payable, on a non-cumulative basis, as and if declared by the Board, in cash, at the rate of 10% per annum of the liquidation preference of $1,000 per share.

5.

The preferred stock is redeemable at the Firm’s option (i) in whole or in part, from time to time, on any dividend payment date on or after the redemption date or (ii) in whole but not in part at any time within 90 days following a regulatory capital treatment event (as described in the terms of that series).

6.

Dividend on Series H preferred stock is payable semiannually until July 15, 2019 and quarterly thereafter.

7.

Dividend on Series J preferred stock is payable semiannually until July 15, 2020 and quarterly thereafter. In addition to the redemption price per share, the redemption price includes any declared and unpaid dividends up to, but excluding, the date fixed for redemption, without accumulation of any undeclared dividends.

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   170  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss)

 

$ in millions   Foreign
Currency
Translation
Adjustments
    AFS
Securities
    Pensions,
Postretirement
and Other
    DVA     Total  

December 31, 2013

  $ (266   $ (282   $ (545   $     $ (1,093

OCI during the period1

    (397     209       33             (155

December 31, 2014

    (663     (73     (512           (1,248

OCI during the period1

    (300     (246     138             (408

December 31, 2015

    (963     (319     (374           (1,656

Cumulative adjustment for accounting change related to DVA2

                      (312     (312

OCI during the period1

    (23     (269     (100     (283     (675

December 31, 2016

  $ (986   $ (588   $ (474   $     (595   $     (2,643

 

1.

Amounts net of tax and noncontrolling interests.

2.

In accordance with the early adoption of a provision of the accounting update Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities, a cumulative catch-up adjustment was recorded as of January 1, 2016 to move the cumulative unrealized DVA amount, net of noncontrolling interest and tax, related to outstanding liabilities under the fair value option election from Retained earnings into AOCI. See Note 2 for further information.

Period Changes in OCI Components

 

    20161  
$ in millions   Pre-tax
gain (loss)
    Income tax
benefit
(provision)
    After-tax
gain (loss)
   

Non-

controlling
interest

    Net  

Foreign currency translation adjustments

 

OCI activity

  $ (24   $ 9     $ (15   $ 12     $ (27

Reclassified to earnings

    4             4             4  

Net OCI

    (20     9       (11     12       (23

Change in net unrealized gains (losses) on AFS securities

 

OCI activity

  $ (313   $ 116     $ (197   $     $ (197

Reclassified to earnings2

    (113     41       (72           (72

Net OCI

    (426     157       (269           (269

Pension, postretirement and other

 

OCI activity

  $ (162   $ 64     $ (98   $     $ (98

Reclassified to earnings2

    (3     1       (2           (2

Net OCI

    (165     65       (100             (100

Change in net DVA

         

OCI activity

  $ (429   $ 153     $ (276   $ (13   $ (263

Reclassified to earnings2

    (31     11       (20           (20

Net OCI

    (460     164       (296     (13     (283
    2015  
$ in millions   Pre-tax
gain (loss)
    Income
tax benefit
(provision)
    After-tax
gain (loss)
    Non-
controlling
interest
    Net  

Foreign currency translation adjustments

 

OCI activity

  $ (119   $ (185   $ (304   $ (4   $ (300

Reclassified to earnings

                             

Net OCI

    (119     (185     (304     (4     (300

Change in net unrealized gains (losses) on AFS securities

 

OCI activity

  $ (305   $ 112     $ (193   $     $ (193

Reclassified to earnings2

    (84     31       (53           (53

Net OCI

    (389     143       (246           (246

Pension, postretirement and other

 

OCI activity

  $ 202     $ (70   $ 132     $     $ 132  

Reclassified to earnings2

    9       (3     6             6  

Net OCI

    211       (73     138             138  

 

    2014  
$ in millions   Pre-tax
gain (loss)
    Income
tax benefit
(provision)
    After-tax
gain (loss)
    Non-
controlling
interest
    Net  

Foreign currency translation adjustments

 

OCI activity

  $ (139   $ (352   $ (491   $ (94   $ (397

Reclassified to earnings

                             

Net OCI

    (139     (352     (491     (94     (397

Change in net unrealized gains (losses) on AFS securities

 

OCI activity

  $ 391     $ (158   $ 233     $     $ 233  

Reclassified to earnings2

    (40     16       (24           (24

Net OCI

    351       (142     209             209  

Pension, postretirement and other

 

OCI activity

  $ 41     $ (17   $ 24     $     $ 24  

Reclassified to earnings2

    12       (3     9             9  

Net OCI

    53       (20     33             33  

 

1.

Exclusive of 2016 cumulative adjustment for accounting change related to DVA.

2.

Amounts reclassified to earnings related to: realized gains and losses from sales of AFS securities are classified within Other revenues in the consolidated income statements; Pension, postretirement and other are classified within Compensation and benefits expenses in the consolidated income statements; and realization of DVA are classified within Trading revenues in the consolidated income statements.

 

 

  171   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Cumulative Foreign Currency Translation Adjustments

Cumulative foreign currency translation adjustments include gains or losses resulting from translating foreign currency financial statements from their respective functional currencies to U.S. dollars, net of hedge gains or losses and related tax effects. The Firm uses foreign currency contracts to manage the currency exposure relating to its net investments in non-U.S. dollar functional currency subsidiaries. Increases or decreases in the value of net foreign investments generally are tax deferred for U.S. purposes, but the related hedge gains and losses are taxable currently. The Firm may elect not to hedge its net investments in certain foreign operations due to market conditions or other reasons, including the availability of various currency contracts at acceptable costs. Information at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015 relating to the effects on cumulative foreign currency translation adjustments that resulted from the translation of foreign currency financial statements and from gains and losses from hedges of the Firm’s net investments in non-U.S. dollar functional currency subsidiaries is summarized in the following table.

Cumulative Foreign Currency Translation Adjustments

 

$ in millions    At
December 31,
2016
    At
December 31,
2015
 

Resulting from net investments in subsidiaries with a non-U.S. dollar functional currency

   $ (2,018   $ (1,996

Resulting from realized or unrealized losses on hedges, net of tax

     1,032       1,033  

Total

   $ (986   $ (963

Net investments in non-U.S. dollar functional currency subsidiaries subject to hedges were $8,856 million and $8,170 million at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively.

Noncontrolling Interests

Noncontrolling interests were $1,127 million and $1,002 million at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively. The increase in noncontrolling interests was primarily due to the consolidation of certain investment management funds sponsored by the Firm and the increase in net income attributable to noncontrolling interests. See Note 2 for further information on the adoption of the accounting update Amendments to the Consolidation Analysis.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   172  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

16. Earnings per Common Share

Calculation of Basic and Diluted EPS

 

in millions, except for per share data    2016     2015     2014  

Basic EPS

      

Income from continuing operations

   $ 6,122     $ 6,295     $ 3,681  

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

     1       (16     (14

Net income

     6,123       6,279       3,667  

Net income applicable to noncontrolling interests

     144       152       200  

Net income applicable to Morgan Stanley

     5,979       6,127       3,467  

Less: Preferred stock dividends

     (468     (452     (311

Less: Allocation of (earnings) loss to participating RSUs1

     (3     (4     (4

Earnings applicable to Morgan Stanley common shareholders

   $       5,508     $       5,671     $       3,152  

Weighted average common shares outstanding

     1,849       1,909       1,924  

Earnings per basic common share

      

Income from continuing operations

   $ 2.98     $ 2.98     $ 1.65  

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

           (0.01     (0.01

Earnings per basic common share

   $ 2.98     $ 2.97     $ 1.64  

Diluted EPS

      

Earnings applicable to Morgan Stanley common shareholders

   $ 5,508     $ 5,671     $ 3,152  

Weighted average common shares outstanding

     1,849       1,909       1,924  

Effect of dilutive securities:

      

Stock options and RSUs1

     38       44       47  

Weighted average common shares outstanding and common stock equivalents

     1,887       1,953       1,971  

Earnings per diluted common share

      

Income from continuing operations

   $ 2.92     $ 2.91     $ 1.61  

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

           (0.01     (0.01

Earnings per diluted common share

   $ 2.92     $ 2.90     $ 1.60  

 

1.

RSUs that are considered participating securities are treated as a separate class of securities in the computation of basic EPS, and, therefore, such RSUs are not included as incremental shares in the diluted EPS computations. The diluted EPS computations also do not include weighted average antidilutive RSUs and antidilutive stock options of 13 million shares during 2016, 12 million shares during 2015 and 15 million shares during 2014.

17. Interest Income and Interest Expense

 

$ in millions    2016     2015     2014  

Interest income1

      

Investment securities

   $ 1,142     $ 876     $ 613  

Loans

     2,724       2,163       1,690  

Interest bearing deposits with banks

     170       108       109  

Securities purchased under agreements to resell and Securities borrowed2

     (374     (560     (298

Trading assets, net of Trading liabilities3

     2,131       2,262       2,109  

Customer receivables and Other4

     1,223       986       1,190  

Total interest income

   $       7,016     $       5,835     $       5,413  

Interest expense1

      

Deposits

   $ 83     $ 78     $ 106  

Short-term and Long-term borrowings

     3,606       3,497       3,613  

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase and Securities loaned5

     977       1,024       1,216  

Customer payables and Other6

     (1,348     (1,857     (1,257

Total interest expense

   $ 3,318     $ 2,742     $ 3,678  

Net interest

   $ 3,698     $ 3,093     $ 1,735  

 

1.

Interest income and Interest expense are recorded within the consolidated income statements depending on the nature of the instrument and related market conventions. When interest is included as a component of the instrument’s fair value, interest is included within Trading revenues or Investments revenues. Otherwise, it is included within Interest income or Interest expense.

2.

Includes fees paid on Securities borrowed.

3.

Interest expense on Trading liabilities is reported as a reduction to Interest income on Trading assets.

4.

Includes interest from customer receivables and cash deposited with clearing organizations or segregated under federal and other regulations or requirements.

5.

Includes fees received on Securities loaned.

6.

Includes fees received from prime brokerage customers for stock loan transactions incurred to cover customers’ short positions.

18. Deferred Compensation Plans

The Firm maintains various deferred stock-based and cash-based compensation plans for the benefit of certain current and former employees.

Stock-Based Compensation Plans

The components of the Firm’s stock-based compensation expense (net of cancellations) are presented in the following table:

Stock-Based Compensation Expense

 

$ in millions    2016      2015     2014  

Restricted stock units

   $ 1,054      $ 1,080     $ 1,212  

Stock options

     2        (3     5  

Performance-based stock units

     81        26       45  

Total1

   $       1,137      $       1,103     $       1,262  

 

1.

Amounts for 2016, 2015 and 2014 include $73 million, $68 million and $31 million, respectively, related to stock-based awards that were granted in 2017, 2016 and 2015, respectively, to employees who satisfied retirement-eligible requirements under award terms that do not contain a service period.

 

 

  173   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

The tax benefit related to stock-based compensation expense was $381 million, $369 million and $404 million for 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

At December 31, 2016, the Firm had $619 million of unrecognized compensation cost related to unvested stock-based awards. Absent forfeitures or cancellations, this amount of unrecognized compensation cost will be recognized as $415 million in 2017, $175 million in 2018 and $29 million thereafter. These amounts do not include 2016 performance year awards granted in January 2017, which will begin to be amortized in 2017 (see “2016 Performance Year Deferred Compensation Awards” herein).

In connection with awards under its stock-based compensation plans, the Firm is authorized to issue shares of its common stock held in treasury or newly issued shares. At December 31, 2016, approximately 103 million shares were available for future grants under these plans.

The Firm generally uses treasury shares, if available, to deliver shares to employees and has an ongoing repurchase authorization that includes repurchases in connection with awards granted under its stock-based compensation plans. Share repurchases by the Firm are subject to regulatory approval. See Note 15 for additional information on the Firm’s share repurchase program.

Restricted Stock Units

RSUs are generally subject to vesting over time, generally three years from the date of grant, contingent upon continued employment and subject to restrictions on sale, transfer or assignment until conversion to common stock. All or a portion of an award may be canceled if employment is terminated before the end of the relevant vesting period and after the relevant vesting period in certain situations. Recipients of RSUs may have voting rights, at the Firm’s discretion, and generally receive dividend equivalents.

Vested and Unvested RSU Activity

 

     2016  
shares in millions    Number of
Shares
   

Weighted
Average Grant
Date

Fair Value

 

RSUs at beginning of period

     105     $ 29.26  

Granted

     38       25.48  

Conversions to common stock

     (40     25.42  

Canceled

     (3     29.57  

RSUs at end of period1

     100       29.35  

 

1.

At December 31, 2016, approximately 98 million RSUs with a weighted average grant date fair value of $29.35 were vested or expected to vest.

The weighted average grant date fair value for RSUs granted during 2015 and 2014 was $34.76 and $32.58, respectively. At December 31, 2016, the weighted average remaining term until delivery for the Firm’s outstanding RSUs was approximately 1.3 years.

At December 31, 2016, the intrinsic value of RSUs vested or expected to vest was $4,159 million.

The total intrinsic value of RSUs converted to common stock during 2016, 2015 and 2014 was $1,068 million, $1,646 million and $1,461 million, respectively.

Unvested RSU Activity

 

     2016  
shares in millions    Number of
Shares
   

Weighted
Average Grant
Date

Fair Value

 

Unvested RSUs at beginning of period

     70     $ 29.91  

Granted

     38       25.48  

Vested

     (40     27.70  

Canceled

     (3     29.58  

Unvested RSUs at end of period1

     65       28.70  

 

1.

Unvested RSUs represent awards where recipients have yet to satisfy either the explicit vesting terms or retirement-eligible requirements. At December 31, 2016, approximately 63 million unvested RSUs with a weighted average grant date fair value of $28.68 were expected to vest.

The aggregate fair value of awards that vested during 2016, 2015 and 2014 was $1,088 million, $1,693 million and $1,517 million, respectively.

Stock Options

Stock options generally have an exercise price not less than the fair value of the Firm’s common stock on the date of grant, vest and become exercisable over a three-year period and expire five to 10 years from the date of grant, subject to accelerated expiration upon certain terminations of employment. Stock options have vesting, restriction and cancellation provisions that are generally similar to those of RSUs.

No stock options were granted during 2016, 2015 or 2014.

The Firm’s expected option life has been determined based upon historical experience. The expected stock price volatility assumption was determined using the implied volatility of exchange-traded options, in accordance with accounting guidance for share-based payments. The risk-free interest rate was determined based on the yields available on U.S. Treasury zero-coupon issues.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   174  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Stock Option Activity

 

     2016  
options in millions    Number of
Options
   

Weighted
Average

Exercise Price

 

Options outstanding at beginning of period

     17     $ 52.26  

Exercised

     (4     26.90  

Expired

     (11     65.45  

Options outstanding at end of period1

     2       28.20  

Options exercisable at end of period

     2       28.20  

 

1.

At December 31, 2016, approximately 2 million options with a weighted average exercise price of $28.20 were vested.

The aggregate intrinsic value of stock options exercised was $41 million in 2016 and $2 million per year in 2015 and 2014, with a weighted average exercise price of $26.90, $30.01 and $24.68 for 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively. Cash received from the exercise of stock options was $66 million for 2016. The income tax benefits realized from the exercise of the stock options was $3 million for 2016. At December 31, 2016, the intrinsic value of exercisable stock options was $26 million.

Stock Options Outstanding and Exercisable

 

     At December 31, 2016  
options in millions    Options Outstanding and Exercisable  
Range of Exercise
Prices
   Number
Outstanding
    

Weighted
Average

Exercise Price

     Average
Remaining Life
(Years)
 

$20.00 - $24.99

     1      $ 22.98        1.1  

$25.00 - $34.99

     1        30.01        1.1  

Total

     2                    

Performance-Based Stock Units

PSUs will vest and convert to shares of common stock at the end of the performance period only if the Firm satisfies predetermined performance and market-based conditions over the three-year performance period that began on January 1 of the grant year and ends three years later on December 31. Under the terms of the award, the number of PSUs that will actually vest and convert to shares will be based on the extent to which the Firm achieves the specified performance goals during the performance period. PSUs have vesting, restriction and cancellation provisions that are generally similar to those of RSUs.

One-half of the award will be earned based on the Firm’s average return on equity, excluding the impact of DVA, certain gains or losses associated with the sale of specified businesses, specified goodwill impairments, certain gains or losses associated with specified legal settlements related to business activities conducted prior to January 1, 2011 and specified cumulative catch-up adjustments resulting from

changes in an existing, or application of a new accounting principle that are not applied on a fully retrospective basis (“MS Adjusted Average ROE”). The number of PSUs ultimately earned for this portion of the awards will be determined by applying a multiplier within the following ranges:

 

Minimum    Maximum  

MS Adjusted

Average ROE

   Multiplier    MS Adjusted
Average ROE
   Multiplier  

Less than 5%

   0.0    11.5% or more      1.5  

On the date of award, the fair value per share of this portion was $25.19, $34.58 and $32.81 for 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

One-half of the award will be earned based on the Firm’s total shareholder return, relative to the total shareholder return of the S&P 500 Financial Sectors Index (“Relative MS TSR”). The number of PSUs ultimately earned for this portion of the award will be determined by applying a multiplier within the following ranges:

 

Minimum    Maximum  
Relative MS TSR    Multiplier    Relative MS TSR    Multiplier  

Less than -50%

   0.0    25% or more      1.5  

On the date of award, the fair value per share of this portion was $24.51, $38.07 and $37.72 for 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively, estimated using a Monte Carlo simulation and the following assumptions:

 

Grant
Year
   Risk-Free Interest
Rate
     Expected Stock
Price Volatility
     Expected Dividend
Yield
 

2016

     1.1%        25.4%        0.0%  

2015

     0.9%        29.6%        0.0%  

2014

     0.8%        44.2%        0.0%  

The risk-free interest rate was determined based on the yields available on U.S. Treasury zero-coupon issues. The expected stock price volatility was determined using historical volatility. The expected dividend yield is equivalent to reinvesting dividends. A correlation coefficient was developed based on historical price data of the Firm and the S&P 500 Financial Sectors Index.

PSU Activity

 

     2016  
in millions    Number of Shares  

PSUs at beginning of period

     4  

Awarded

     2  

Conversions to common stock

     (2

PSUs at end of period

     4  
 

 

  175   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Deferred Cash-Based Compensation Plans

Deferred cash-based compensation plans generally provide a return to the plan participants based upon the performance of various referenced investments.

The components of the Firm’s deferred compensation expense (net of cancellations) are presented as follows:

Deferred Compensation Expense

 

$ in millions    2016      2015      2014  

Deferred cash-based awards1

   $ 950      $ 660      $ 1,757  

Return on referenced investments

     228        112        408  

Total

   $ 1,178      $ 772      $ 2,165  

 

1.

Amounts for 2016, 2015 and 2014 include $151 million, $144 million and $92 million, respectively, related to deferred cash-based awards that were granted in 2017, 2016 and 2015, respectively, to employees who satisfied retirement-eligible requirements under award terms that do not contain a service period.

At December 31, 2016, the Firm had approximately $688 million of unrecognized compensation cost related to unvested deferred cash-based awards (excluding unrecognized expense for returns on referenced investments). Absent forfeitures or cancellations and any future return on referenced investments, this amount of unrecognized compensation cost will be recognized as $394 million in 2017, $111 million in 2018 and $183 million thereafter. These amounts do not include 2016 performance year awards granted in January 2017, which will begin to be amortized in 2017 (see below).

2016 Performance Year Deferred Compensation Awards

In January 2017, the Firm granted approximately $763 billion of stock-based awards and $895 billion of deferred cash-based awards related to the 2016 performance year that contain a future service requirement. Absent forfeitures or cancellations or accelerations, and any future return on referenced investments, the annual compensation cost for these awards will be recognized as follows:

Annual Compensation Cost for 2016 Performance Year Awards

 

$ in millions    2017      2018      Thereafter      Total  

Stock-based awards

   $ 440      $ 174      $ 149      $ 763  

Deferred cash-based awards

     518        263        114        895  

Total

   $ 958      $ 437      $ 263      $ 1,658  

19. Employee Benefit Plans

The Firm sponsors various retirement plans for the majority of its U.S. and non-U.S. employees. The Firm provides certain other postretirement benefits, primarily health care and life insurance, to eligible U.S. employees.

Pension and Other Postretirement Plans

Substantially all of the U.S. employees of the Firm and its U.S. affiliates who were hired before July 1, 2007 are covered by the U.S. pension plan, a non-contributory, defined benefit pension plan that is qualified under Section 401(a) of the Internal Revenue Code (the “U.S. Qualified Plan”). The U.S. Qualified Plan has ceased future benefit accruals.

Unfunded supplementary plans (the “Supplemental Plans”) cover certain executives. Liabilities for benefits payable under the Supplemental Plans are accrued by the Firm and are funded when paid. The Morgan Stanley Supplemental Executive Retirement and Excess Plan (the “SEREP”), a non-contributory defined benefit plan that is not qualified under Section 401(a) of the Internal Revenue Code, ceased future benefit accruals after September 30, 2014. Any benefits earned under the SEREP prior to October 1, 2014 will be payable in the future based on the SEREP’s provisions. The amendment did not have a material impact on the consolidated financial statements.

Certain of the Firm’s non-U.S. subsidiaries also have defined benefit pension plans covering substantially all of their employees.

The Firm’s pension plans generally provide pension benefits that are based on each employee’s years of credited service and on compensation levels specified in the plans.

The Firm has an unfunded postretirement benefit plan that provides medical and life insurance for eligible U.S. retirees and medical insurance for their dependents. The Morgan Stanley Medical Plan was amended to change the health care plans offered after December 31, 2014 for retirees who are Medicare-eligible and age 65 or older. The amendment did not have a material impact on the consolidated financial statements.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   176  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Components of the Net Periodic Benefit Expense (Income)

 

     Pension Plans  
$ in millions    2016     2015     2014  

Service cost, benefits earned during the period

   $ 17     $ 19     $ 20  

Interest cost on projected benefit obligation

     150       152       154  

Expected return on plan assets

     (122     (120     (110

Net amortization of prior service credit

           (1      

Net amortization of actuarial loss

     12       26       22  

Curtailment loss

                 3  

Settlement loss

           2       2  

Net periodic benefit expense (income)

   $ 57     $ 78     $ 91  
     Other Postretirement Plan  
$ in millions      2016         2015         2014    

Service cost, benefits earned during the period

   $ 1     $ 1     $ 2  

Interest cost on projected benefit obligation

     4       3       5  

Net amortization of prior service credit

     (17     (18     (14

Net periodic benefit expense (income)

   $ (12   $ (14   $ (7

Pre-tax Amounts Recognized in Other Comprehensive Income (Loss)

 

     Pension Plans  
$ in millions    2016     2015     2014  

Net gain (loss)

   $ (149   $ 212     $ (18

Prior service credit (cost)

     1       1       (2

Amortization of prior service credit

           (1      

Amortization of net loss

     12       28       27  

Total

   $ (136   $ 240     $ 7  
     Other Postretirement Plan  
$ in millions      2016         2015         2014    

Net gain (loss)

   $ (2   $ (3   $ (9

Prior service credit (cost)

           (9     64  

Amortization of prior service credit

     (17     (18     (14

Total

   $ (19   $ (30   $ 41  

The Firm generally amortizes into net periodic benefit expense (income) the unrecognized net gains and losses exceeding 10% of the greater of the projected benefit obligation or the market-related value of plan assets. The amortization of the unrecognized net gains and losses is generally over the future service of active participants. The U.S. Qualified Plan and, effective October 1, 2014, the SEREP amortize the unrecognized net gains and losses over the average life expectancy of participants.

Weighted Average Assumptions Used to Determine Net Periodic Benefit Expense (Income)

 

     Pension Plans  
      2016      2015      2014  

Discount rate

     4.27%        3.86%        4.74%  

Expected long-term rate of return on plan assets

     3.61%        3.59%        3.75%  

Rate of future compensation increases

     3.19%        2.85%        1.06%  
     Other Postretirement Plan  
        2016          2015          2014    

Discount rate

     4.13%        3.77%        3.77%  

The accounting for pension and postretirement plans involves certain assumptions and estimates. The expected long-term rate of return on plan assets is a long-term assumption that generally is expected to remain the same from one year to the next unless there is a significant change in the target asset allocation, the fees and expenses paid by the plan or market conditions. The expected long-term rate of return for the U.S. Qualified Plan was estimated by computing a weighted average of the underlying long-term expected returns based on the investment managers’ target allocations. The U.S. Qualified Plan is primarily invested in fixed income securities and related derivative instruments, including interest rate swap contracts. This asset allocation is expected to help protect the plan’s funded status and limit volatility of the Firm’s contributions. Total U.S. Qualified Plan investment portfolio performance is assessed by comparing actual investment performance to changes in the estimated present value of the U.S. Qualified Plan’s benefit obligation.

 

 

  177   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Benefit Obligation and Funded Status

Rollforward of the Benefit Obligation and Fair Value of Plan Assets

 

     Pension Plans     Other Postretirement
Plan
 
$ in millions    2016     2015     2016     2015  

Rollforward of benefit obligation

 

     

Benefit obligation at beginning of year

   $ 3,604     $ 4,007     $ 87     $ 75  

Service cost

     17       19       1       1  

Interest cost

     150       152       4       3  

Actuarial loss (gain)1

     159       (267           4  

Plan amendments

     (1     (1           9  

Plan curtailments

           (9            

Plan settlements

     (19     (29            

Change in mortality assumptions2

     64       (46     1       (1

Benefits paid

     (219     (194     (5     (4

Other, including foreign currency exchange rate changes

     (44     (28            

Benefit obligation at end of year

   $ 3,711     $ 3,604     $ 88     $ 87  

Rollforward of fair value of plan assets

 

   

Fair value of plan assets at beginning of year

   $ 3,497     $ 3,705     $     $  

Actual return on plan assets

     196       9              

Employer contributions

     38       31       5       4  

Benefits paid

     (219     (194     (5     (4

Plan settlements

     (19     (29            

Other, including foreign currency exchange rate changes

     (62     (25            

Fair value of plan assets at end of year

   $ 3,431     $ 3,497     $     $  

Funded (unfunded) status

   $ (280   $ (107   $ (88   $ (87

 

1.

Amounts primarily reflect the impact of year-over-year discount rate fluctuations.

2.

Amounts represent adoption of new mortality tables published by the Society of Actuaries.

Summary of Funded Status

 

    Pension Plans     Other Postretirement Plan  
$ in millions   At
December 31,
2016
    At
December 31,
2015
    At
December 31,
2016
    At
December 31,
2015
 

Amounts recognized in the consolidated balance sheets

 

Assets

  $ 230     $ 382     $     $  

Liabilities

    (510     (489     (88     (87

Net amount recognized

  $ (280   $ (107   $ (88   $ (87

Amounts recognized in accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)

 

Prior service credit (cost)

  $ 2     $ 1     $ 17     $ 34  

Net gain (loss)

    (763     (626           2  

Net gain (loss) recognized

  $ (761   $ (625   $ 17     $ 36  

The estimated prior service credit that will be amortized from accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) into net periodic benefit expense over 2017 is approximately $17 million for the other postretirement plan. The estimated net loss that will be amortized from accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) into net periodic benefit expense (income) over 2017 is approximately $17 million for defined benefit pension plans.

The accumulated benefit obligation for all defined benefit pension plans was $3,696 million and $3,592 million at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   178  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Pension Plans with Projected Benefit Obligation in Excess of the Fair Value of Plan Assets

 

$ in millions   

At

December 31,
2016

     At
December 31,
2015
 

Projected benefit obligation

   $ 566      $ 543  

Fair value of plan assets

     56        54  

Pension Plans with Accumulated Benefit Obligation in Excess of the Fair Value of Plan Assets

 

$ in millions    At December 31,
2016
     At December 31,
2015
 

Accumulated benefit obligation

   $ 552      $ 531  

Fair value of plan assets

     56        54  

Weighted Average Assumptions Used to Determine Benefit Obligation

 

    Pension Plans     Other Postretirement Plan  
     At
December 31,
2016
    At
December 31,
2015
    At
December 31,
2016
    At
December 31,
2015
 

Discount rate

    4.01%       4.27%       4.01%       4.13%  

Rate of future compensation increase

    3.10%       3.19%       N/A       N/A  

 

N/A—Not

Applicable

The discount rates used to determine the benefit obligation for the U.S. pension and postretirement plans were selected by the Firm, in consultation with its independent actuaries, using a pension discount yield curve based on the characteristics of the plans, each determined independently. The pension discount yield curve represents spot discount yields based on duration implicit in a representative broad-based Aa rated corporate bond universe of high-quality fixed income investments. For all non-U.S. pension plans, the Firm set the assumed discount rates based on the nature of liabilities, local economic environments and available bond indices.

Assumed Health Care Cost Trend Rates Used to Determine the U.S. Postretirement Benefit Obligation

 

     

At

December 31,
2016

   

At

December 31,
2015

 

Health care cost trend rate assumed for next year

 

Medical

     5.96     6.25%  

Prescription

     9.32     11.00%  

Rate to which the cost trend rate is assumed to decline (ultimate trend rate)

     4.50     4.50%  

Year that the rate reaches the ultimate trend rate

     2038       2038      

Assumed health care cost trend rates can have a significant effect on the amounts reported for the Firm’s postretirement benefit plan.

Effect of Changes in Assumed Health Care Cost Trend Rates

 

$ in millions    One-Percentage
Point Increase
     One-Percentage
Point Decrease
 

Total 2016 postretirement service and interest cost

     N/M        N/M  

December 31, 2016 postretirement benefit obligation

   $ 6      $ (5

 

N/M—Not

Meaningful

Plan Assets

The U.S. Qualified Plan assets represent 88% of the Firm’s total pension plan assets. The U.S. Qualified Plan uses a combination of active and risk-controlled fixed income investment strategies. The fixed income asset allocation consists primarily of fixed income securities and related derivative instruments designed to approximate the expected cash flows of the plan’s liabilities in order to help reduce plan exposure to interest rate variation and to better align assets with the obligation. The longer-duration fixed income allocation is expected to help protect the plan’s funded status and maintain the stability of plan contributions over the long run.

Derivative instruments are permitted in the U.S. Qualified Plan’s investment portfolio only to the extent that they comply with all of the plan’s investment policy guidelines and are consistent with the plan’s risk and return objectives. In addition, any investment in derivatives must meet the following conditions:

 

 

May be used only if derivative instruments are deemed by the investment manager to be more attractive than a similar direct investment in the underlying cash market or if the vehicle is being used to manage risk of the portfolio.

 

 

May not be used in a speculative manner or to leverage the portfolio under any circumstances.

 

 

May not be used as short-term trading vehicles. The investment philosophy of the U.S. Qualified Plan is that investment activity is undertaken for long-term investment rather than short-term trading.

 

 

May be used in the management of the U.S. Qualified Plan’s portfolio only when the derivative instruments’ possible effects can be quantified, shown to enhance the risk-return profile of the portfolio, and reported in a meaningful and understandable manner.

 

 

  179   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

As a fundamental operating principle, any restrictions on the underlying assets apply to a respective derivative product. This includes percentage allocations and credit quality. Derivatives are used solely for the purpose of enhancing investment in the underlying assets and not to circumvent portfolio restrictions.

Plan assets are measured at fair value using valuation techniques that are consistent with the valuation techniques applied to the Firm’s major categories of assets and liabilities as described in Notes 2 and 3. OTC derivative contracts consist of investments in interest rate swaps.

Other investments consist of pledged insurance annuity contracts held by non-U.S.-based plans. The pledged insurance annuity contracts are valued based on the premium reserve of the insurer for a guarantee that the insurer has given to the employee benefit plan that approximates fair value. The pledged insurance annuity contracts are categorized in Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy.

Commingled trust funds are privately offered funds that are regulated, supervised and subject to periodic examination by a U.S. federal or state agency and available to institutional clients. The trust must be maintained for the collective investment or reinvestment of assets contributed to it from U.S.

tax-qualified employee benefit plans maintained by more than one employer or controlled group of corporations. The sponsor of the commingled trust funds values the funds based on the fair value of the underlying securities. The underlying securities of the commingled trust funds held by the U.S. Qualified Plan consist mainly of long-duration fixed income instruments. Commingled trust funds are redeemable at NAV at the measurement date or in the near future.

Some non-U.S.-based plans hold foreign funds that consist of investments in fixed income funds, target cash flow funds and liquidity funds. Fixed income funds invest in individual securities quoted on a recognized stock exchange or traded in a regulated market. Certain fixed income funds aim to produce returns consistent with certain Financial Times Stock Exchange indexes. Target cash flow funds are designed to provide a series of fixed annual cash flows achieved by investing in government bonds and derivatives. Liquidity funds place a high priority on capital preservation, stable value and a high liquidity of assets. Foreign funds are readily redeemable at NAV.

The Firm generally considers the NAV of commingled trust funds and foreign funds provided by the fund manager to be the best estimate of fair value.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   180  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Fair Value of Plan Assets and Liabilities

 

    At December 31, 2016  
$ in millions   Level 1     Level 2     Level 3     Total  

Assets

       

Investments:

       

Cash and cash equivalents1

  $ 55     $     $     $ 55  

U.S. government and agency securities:

       

U.S. Treasury securities

    1,493                   1,493  

U.S. agency securities

          423             423  

Total U.S. government and
agency
securities

    1,493       423             1,916  

Corporate and other debt:

       

Collateralized debt obligation

          13             13  

Total corporate and other debt

          13             13  

Derivative contracts

          159             159  

Derivative-related cash collateral receivable

          76             76  

Other investments

                38       38  

Total assets2

  $     1,548     $ 671     $ 38     $     2,257  

Liabilities

       

Derivative contracts

  $     $ 225     $     $ 225  

Total liabilities

  $     $ 225     $     $ 225  

 

    At December 31, 2015  
$ in millions   Level 1     Level 2     Level 3     Total  

Assets

       

Investments:

       

Cash and cash equivalents1

  $ 28     $     $     $ 28  

U.S. government and agency securities:

       

U.S. Treasury securities

    1,398                   1,398  

U.S. agency securities

          263             263  

Total U.S. government and agency securities

    1,398       263             1,661  

Corporate and other debt:

       

State and municipal securities

          2             2  

Collateralized debt obligation

          22             22  

Total corporate and other debt

          24             24  

Derivative contracts

          224             224  

Other investments

                35       35  

Receivables:

       

Other receivables1

          54             54  

Total assets2

  $   1,426     $ 565     $ 35     $   2,026  

Liabilities

       

Derivative contracts

  $     $ 65     $     $ 65  

Other liabilities1

          100             100  

Total liabilities

  $     $ 165     $     $ 165  

 

1.

Cash and cash equivalents, other receivables and other liabilities are valued at their carrying value, which approximates fair value.

2.

Amounts exclude Commingled trust funds and Foreign funds measured at fair value using the NAV per share, which are not classified in the fair value hierarchy. Commingled trust funds consist of investments in fixed income funds and money market funds of $999 million and $86 million, respectively, at December 31, 2016 and $1,239 million and $59 million, respectively, at December 31, 2015. Foreign funds include investments in fixed income funds, liquidity funds and targeted cash flow funds of $111 million, $9 million and $194 million, respectively, at December 31, 2016 and $149 million, $98 million and $91 million, respectively, at December 31, 2015. Fund amounts as of December 31, 2015 have been excluded from the table to conform to the current presentation.

 

 

  181   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

There were no transfers between levels during 2016 and 2015.

Changes in Level 3 Pension Assets

 

$ in millions    2016      2015  

Balance at beginning of period

   $ 35      $ 36  

Actual return on plan assets related to assets held at end of period

            (4

Purchases, sales, other settlements and issuances, net

     3        3  

Balance at end of period

   $ 38      $ 35  

Expected Contributions

The Firm’s policy is to fund at least the amount sufficient to meet minimum funding requirements under applicable employee benefit and tax laws. At December 31, 2016, the Firm expected to contribute approximately $50 million to its pension and postretirement benefit plans in 2017 based upon the plans’ current funded status and expected asset return assumptions for 2017.

Expected Future Benefit Payments

 

     At December 31, 2016  
$ in millions    Pension
Plans
     Other
Postretirement
Plan
 

2017

   $         149      $ 5  

2018

     135        6  

2019

     139        6  

2020

     145        6  

2021

     153        7  

2022-2026

     867        31  

Morgan Stanley 401(k) Plan

U.S. employees meeting certain eligibility requirements may participate in the Morgan Stanley 401(k) Plan. Eligible U.S. employees receive discretionary 401(k) matching cash contributions as determined annually by the Firm. For 2016 and 2015, the Firm made a $1 for $1 Firm match up to 4% of eligible pay, up to the Internal Revenue Service (“IRS”) limit. Matching contributions for 2016 and 2015 were invested according to each participant’s investment direction. Eligible U.S. employees with eligible pay less than or equal to $100,000 also received a fixed contribution under the 401(k) Plan that equaled 2% of eligible pay. Transition contributions are allocated to certain eligible employees. The Firm match, fixed contribution and transition contribution are included in the Firm’s 401(k) expense. The Firm’s 401(k) expense for 2016, 2015 and 2014 was $250 million, $255 million and $256 million, respectively.

Defined Contribution Pension Plans

The Firm maintains separate defined contribution pension plans that cover substantially all employees of certain non-U.S. subsidiaries. Under such plans, benefits are determined based on a fixed rate of base salary with certain vesting requirements. In 2016, 2015 and 2014, the Firm’s expense related to these plans was $101 million, $111 million and $117 million, respectively.

20. Income Taxes

Provision for (Benefit from) Income Taxes

Components of Provision for (Benefit from) Income Taxes

 

$ in millions    2016     2015     2014  

Current

      

U.S. federal

   $ 330     $ 239     $ (604

U.S. state and local

     221       144       260  

Non-U.S.

      

U.K.

     196       247       88  

Japan

     28       19       114  

Hong Kong

     14       24       34  

Other1

     359       333       258  

Total

   $ 1,148     $ 1,006     $     150  

Deferred

      

U.S. federal

   $ 1,336     $ 1,031     $ (207

U.S. state and local

     74       43       (56

Non-U.S.

      

U.K.

     56       (56     (31

Japan

     127       58       56  

Hong Kong

     31       50       9  

Other1

     (46     68       (11

Total

   $ 1,578     $ 1,194     $ (240

Provision for (benefit from) income taxes from continuing operations

   $     2,726     $     2,200     $ (90

Provision for (benefit from) income taxes from discontinued operations

   $ 1     $ (7   $ (5

 

1.

For 2016, significant Non-U.S. other jurisdictions included total tax provisions of $125 million, $46 million and $38 million from Brazil, India and France, respectively. For 2015, significant Non-U.S. other jurisdictions included total tax provisions of $68 million, $62 million, $58 million, $45 million and $42 million from Mexico, Brazil, Netherlands, India and France, respectively. For 2014, significant Non-U.S. other jurisdictions included total tax provisions of $44 million, $38 million and $38 million from Brazil, India and Mexico, respectively.

The Firm recorded a net income tax provision (benefit) to Additional paid-in capital related to employee stock-based compensation transactions of $24 million, $(203) million and $(6) million in 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   182  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Effective Income Tax Rate

Reconciliation of the U.S. Federal Statutory Income Tax Rate to the Effective Income Tax Rate

 

      2016     2015     2014  

U.S. federal statutory income tax rate

     35.0     35.0     35.0%  

U.S. state and local income taxes, net of U.S. federal income tax benefits

     2.2       1.4       6.5  

Domestic tax credits

     (2.5     (1.5     (5.0

Tax exempt income

     (0.1     (0.2     (3.5

Non-U.S. earnings

      

Foreign tax rate differential

     (3.1     (8.7     (22.5

Change in reinvestment assertion

           0.2       1.4  

Change in foreign tax rates

     0.1              

Wealth Management legal entity restructuring

                 (38.7

Non-deductible legal expenses

                 25.5  

Other

     (0.8     (0.3     (1.2

Effective income tax rate

     30.8     25.9     (2.5)%  

The Firm’s effective tax rate from continuing operations for 2016 included net discrete tax benefits of $68 million. These net discrete tax benefits were primarily related to the remeasurement of reserves and related interest due to new information regarding the status of a multi-year tax authority examination, partially offset by adjustments for other tax matters. Excluding these net discrete tax benefits, the effective tax rate from continuing operations for 2016 would have been 31.6%.

The Firm’s effective tax rate from continuing operations for 2015 included net discrete tax benefits of $564 million. These net discrete tax benefits were primarily associated with the repatriation of non-U.S. earnings at a cost lower than originally estimated due to an internal restructuring to simplify the Firm’s legal entity organization in the U.K. Excluding these net discrete tax benefits, the effective tax rate from continuing operations for 2015 would have been 32.5%.

The Firm’s effective tax rate from continuing operations for 2014 included net discrete tax benefits of $2,226 million. These net discrete tax benefits consisted of: $1,380 million primarily due to the release of a deferred tax liability, previously established as part of the acquisition of Smith Barney in 2009 through a charge to Additional paid-in capital, as a result of the legal entity restructuring that included a change in tax status of Morgan Stanley Smith Barney Holdings LLC from a partnership to a corporation; $609 million principally associated with remeasurement of reserves and related interest due to new information regarding the status of a multi-year tax authority examination; and $237 million primarily associated with the repatriation of non-U.S. earnings at a cost lower than originally estimated. Excluding these net discrete tax benefits, the effective tax rate from continuing operations for 2014 would have been 59.5%,

which is primarily attributable to approximately $900 million of tax provision from non-deductible expenses for litigation and regulatory matters.

Deferred Tax Assets and Liabilities

Deferred income taxes reflect the net tax effects of temporary differences between the financial reporting and tax bases of assets and liabilities and are measured using the enacted tax rates and laws that will be in effect when such differences are expected to reverse.

Deferred Tax Assets and Liabilities

 

$ in millions    At
December 31,
2016
     At
December 31,
2015
 

Gross deferred tax assets

     

Tax credits and loss carryforwards

   $ 731      $ 1,987  

Employee compensation and benefit plans

     3,504        3,514  

Valuation and liability allowances

     656        846  

Valuation of inventory, investments and receivables

     1,062        738  

Other

     21        35  

Total deferred tax assets

     5,974        7,120  

Deferred tax assets valuation allowance

     164        139  

Deferred tax assets after valuation allowance

   $ 5,810      $ 6,981  

Gross deferred tax liabilities

     

Non-U.S. operations

   $ 270      $ 269  

Fixed assets

     773        716  

Total deferred tax liabilities

   $ 1,043      $ 985  

Net deferred tax assets

   $             4,767      $             5,996  

The Firm had tax credit carryforwards for which a related deferred tax asset of $465 million and $1,647 million was recorded at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively. These carryforwards are subject to annual limitations on utilization, with the earliest expiration beginning in 2030, if not utilized.

The Firm believes the recognized net deferred tax asset (after valuation allowance) of $4,767 million at December 31, 2016 is more likely than not to be realized based on expectations as to future taxable income in the jurisdictions in which it operates.

The Firm had $12,006 million and $10,209 million of cumulative earnings at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively, attributable to foreign subsidiaries for which no U.S. provision has been recorded for income tax

 

 

  183   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

that could occur upon repatriation. Accordingly, $1,111 million and $893 million of deferred tax liabilities were not recorded with respect to these earnings at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively. The increase in indefinitely reinvested earnings is attributable to regulatory and other capital requirements in foreign jurisdictions.

Unrecognized Tax Benefits

The total amount of unrecognized tax benefits was approximately $1.9 billion, $1.8 billion and $2.2 billion at December 31, 2016, December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, respectively. Of this total, approximately $1.1 billion, $1.1 billion and $1.0 billion, respectively (net of federal benefit of state issues, competent authority and foreign tax credit offsets), represent the amount of unrecognized tax benefits that, if recognized, would favorably affect the effective tax rate in future periods.

Interest and penalties related to unrecognized tax benefits are classified as provision for income taxes. The Firm recognized $28 million, $18 million and $(35) million of interest expense (benefit) (net of federal and state income tax benefits) in the consolidated income statements for 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively. Interest expense accrued at December 31, 2016, December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014 was approximately $150 million, $122 million and $258 million, respectively, net of federal and state income tax benefits. Penalties

related to unrecognized tax benefits for the years mentioned above were immaterial.

Rollforward of Unrecognized Tax Benefits

 

$ in millions   Unrecognized
Tax Benefits
 

Balance at December 31, 2013

  $ 4,096  

Increase based on tax positions related to the current period

    135  

Increase based on tax positions related to prior periods

    100  

Decrease based on tax positions related to prior periods

    (2,080)  

Decrease related to settlements with taxing authorities

    (19)  

Decrease related to a lapse of applicable statute of limitations

    (4)  

Balance at December 31, 2014

  $ 2,228  

Increase based on tax positions related to the current period

  $ 230  

Increase based on tax positions related to prior periods

    114  

Decrease based on tax positions related to prior periods

    (753)  

Decrease related to settlements with taxing authorities

    (7)  

Decrease related to a lapse of applicable statute of limitations

    (8)  

Balance at December 31, 2015

  $ 1,804  

Increase based on tax positions related to the current period

  $ 172  

Increase based on tax positions related to prior periods

    14  

Decrease based on tax positions related to prior periods

    (134)  

Decrease related to settlements with taxing authorities

     

Decrease related to a lapse of applicable statute of limitations

    (5)  

Balance at December 31, 2016

  $ 1,851  
 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   184  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Tax Authority Examinations

The Firm is under continuous examination by the IRS and other tax authorities in certain countries, such as Japan and the U.K., and in states in which it has significant business operations, such as New York. The Firm is currently at various levels of field examination with respect to audits by the IRS, as well as New York State and New York City, for tax years 2009-2012 and 2007-2013, respectively. The Firm believes that the resolution of these tax matters will not have a material effect on the consolidated balance sheets, although a resolution could have a material impact on the consolidated income statements for a particular future period and the effective tax rate for any period in which such resolution occurs.

In April 2016, the Firm received a notification from the IRS that the Congressional Joint Committee on Taxation approved the final report of an Appeals Office review of matters from tax years 1999-2005, and the Revenue Agent’s Report reflecting agreed closure of the 2006-2008 tax years. The Firm has reserved the right to contest certain items, associated with tax years 1999-2005, the resolution of which is not expected to have a material impact on the effective tax rate or the consolidated financial statements.

During 2017, the Firm expects to reach a conclusion with the U.K. tax authorities on substantially all issues through tax year 2010, the resolution of which is not expected to have a material impact on the effective tax rate or the consolidated financial statements.

The Firm has established a liability for unrecognized tax benefits that it believes is adequate in relation to the potential for additional assessments. Once established, the Firm adjusts liabilities for unrecognized tax benefits only when new information is available or when an event occurs necessitating a change.

The Firm periodically evaluates the likelihood of assessments in each taxing jurisdiction resulting from the expiration of the applicable statute of limitations or new information regarding the status of current and subsequent years’ examinations. As part of the Firm’s periodic review, federal and state unrecognized tax benefits were released or remeasured.

It is reasonably possible that significant changes in the balance of unrecognized tax benefits may occur within the next 12 months related to certain tax authority examinations referred to herein. At this time, however, it is not possible to

reasonably estimate the expected change to the total amount of unrecognized tax benefits and the impact on the Firm’s effective tax rate over the next 12 months.

Earliest Tax Year Subject to Examination in Major Tax Jurisdictions

 

Jurisdiction    Tax Year  

U.S.

     1999  

New York State and New York City

     2007  

Hong Kong

     2010  

U.K.

     2010  

Japan

     2013  

Income from Continuing Operations before Income Tax Expense (Benefit)

 

$ in millions    2016      2015      2014  

U.S.

   $         5,694      $         5,360      $         1,805  

Non-U.S.1

     3,154        3,135        1,786  
     $ 8,848      $ 8,495      $ 3,591  

 

1.

Non-U.S. income is defined as income generated from operations located outside the U.S.

21. Segment and Geographic Information

Segment Information

The Firm structures its segments primarily based upon the nature of the financial products and services provided to customers and its management organization. The Firm provides a wide range of financial products and services to its customers in each of the business segments: Institutional Securities, Wealth Management and Investment Management. For a further discussion of the business segments, see Note 1.

Revenues and expenses directly associated with each respective business segment are included in determining its operating results. Other revenues and expenses that are not directly attributable to a particular business segment are allocated based upon the Firm’s allocation methodologies, generally based on each business segment’s respective net revenues, non-interest expenses or other relevant measures.

As a result of revenues and expenses from transactions with other operating segments being treated as transactions with external parties, the Firm includes an Intersegment Eliminations category to reconcile the business segment results to the consolidated results.

 

 

  185   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Selected Financial Information by Business Segment

 

     2016  
$ in millions    Institutional
Securities1, 2
    Wealth
Management2
     Investment
Management3
    Intersegment
Eliminations
    Total  

Total non-interest revenues

   $ 17,294     $ 11,821      $ 2,108     $ (290   $ 30,933  

Interest income

     4,005       3,888        5       (882     7,016  

Interest expense

     3,840       359        1       (882     3,318  

Net interest

     165       3,529        4             3,698  

Net revenues

   $ 17,459     $ 15,350      $ 2,112     $ (290   $   34,631  

Income from continuing operations before income taxes

   $ 5,123     $ 3,437      $ 287     $ 1     $ 8,848  

Provision for income taxes4

     1,318       1,333        75             2,726  

Income from continuing operations

     3,805       2,104        212       1       6,122  

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of income taxes

     (1            2             1  

Net income

     3,804       2,104        214       1       6,123  

Net income (loss) applicable to noncontrolling interests

     155              (11           144  

Net income applicable to Morgan Stanley

   $ 3,649     $ 2,104      $ 225     $ 1     $ 5,979  

 

     2015  
$ in millions    Institutional
Securities1
    Wealth
Management
     Investment
Management3
    Intersegment
Eliminations
    Total  

Total non-interest revenues

   $ 17,800     $ 12,144      $ 2,331     $ (213   $ 32,062  

Interest income

     3,190       3,105        2       (462     5,835  

Interest expense

     3,037       149        18       (462     2,742  

Net interest

     153       2,956        (16           3,093  

Net revenues

   $ 17,953     $ 15,100      $ 2,315     $ (213   $ 35,155  

Income from continuing operations before income taxes

   $ 4,671     $ 3,332      $ 492     $     $ 8,495  

Provision for income taxes4

     825       1,247        128             2,200  

Income from continuing operations

     3,846       2,085        364             6,295  

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of income taxes

     (17            1             (16

Net income

     3,829       2,085        365             6,279  

Net income applicable to noncontrolling interests

     133              19             152  

Net income applicable to Morgan Stanley

   $ 3,696     $ 2,085      $ 346     $     $ 6,127  

 

     2014  
$ in millions    Institutional
Securities1, 5
    Wealth
Management
    Investment
Management3
    Intersegment
Eliminations
    Total  

Total non-interest revenues6

   $ 17,463     $ 12,549     $ 2,728     $ (200   $ 32,540  

Interest income

     3,389       2,516       2       (494     5,413  

Interest expense

     3,981       177       18       (498     3,678  

Net interest

     (592     2,339       (16     4       1,735  

Net revenues

   $ 16,871     $ 14,888     $ 2,712     $ (196   $ 34,275  

Income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes

   $ (58   $ 2,985     $ 664     $     $ 3,591  

Provision for (benefit from) income taxes4

     (90     (207     207             (90

Income from continuing operations

     32       3,192       457             3,681  

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of income taxes

     (19           5             (14

Net income

     13       3,192       462             3,667  

Net income applicable to noncontrolling interests

     109             91             200  

Net income (loss) applicable to Morgan Stanley

   $ (96   $ 3,192     $ 371     $     $ 3,467  

 

1.

In 2016, in accordance with the early adoption of a provision of the accounting update Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities, unrealized DVA gains (losses) are recorded within OCI and, when realized, in Trading revenues. In 2015 and in 2014, the realized and unrealized DVA gains (losses) are recorded in Trading revenues. See Notes 2 and 15 for further information.

2.

Effective July 1, 2016, the Institutional Securities and Wealth Management business segments entered into an agreement, whereby Institutional Securities assumed management of Wealth Management’s fixed income client-driven trading activities and employees. Institutional Securities now pays fees to Wealth Management based on distribution activity (collectively, the “Fixed Income Integration”). Prior periods have not been recast for this new intersegment agreement due to immateriality.

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   186  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

3.

The Firm waives a portion of its fees from certain registered money market funds that comply with the requirements of Rule 2a-7 of the Investment Company Act of 1940. These fee waivers resulted in a reduction of fees of approximately $91 million for 2016, $197 million for 2015 and $195 million for 2014.

4.

The Firm’s effective tax rate from continuing operations included net discrete tax benefits of $68 million in 2016, primarily within Institutional Securities. The Firm’s effective tax rate from continuing operations included net discrete tax benefits of $564 million in 2015 within Institutional Securities. The Firm’s effective tax rate from continuing operations included net discrete tax benefits of $1,390 million and $839 million in 2014 within Wealth Management and Institutional Securities business segments, respectively (see Note 20).

5.

The Institutional Securities business segment Net loss in 2014 was primarily driven by higher legal expenses (see Note 12).

6.

In September 2014, the Firm sold a retail property space resulting in a gain on sale of $141 million (within Institutional Securities $84 million, Wealth Management $40 million and Investment Management $17 million), which was included within Other revenues on the consolidated income statements.

 

Total Assets by Business Segment

 

$ in millions    At December 31,
2016
     At December 31,
2015
 

Institutional Securities

   $ 629,149      $ 602,714  

Wealth Management

     181,135        179,708  

Investment Management1

     4,665        5,043  

Total2

   $ 814,949      $ 787,465  

 

1.

During 2015, the Firm deconsolidated approximately $244 million in net assets previously attributable to nonredeemable noncontrolling interests that were primarily related to or associated with real estate funds sponsored by the Firm (see Note 13).

2.

Corporate assets have been fully allocated to the business segments.

Geographic Information

The Firm operates in both U.S. and non-U.S. markets. The Firm’s non-U.S. business activities are principally conducted and managed through EMEA and Asia-Pacific locations. The net revenues disclosed in the following table reflect the regional view of the Firm’s consolidated net revenues on a managed basis, based on the following methodology:

Institutional Securities:    advisory and equity underwriting—client location, debt underwriting—revenue recording location, sales and trading—trading desk location.

Wealth Management:    Wealth Management representatives operate in the Americas.

Investment Management:    client location, except certain closed-end funds, which are based on asset location.

Net Revenues by Region

 

$ in millions    2016      2015      2014  

Americas

   $         25,487      $         25,080      $         25,140  

EMEA

     4,994        5,353        4,772  

Asia-Pacific

     4,150        4,722        4,363  

Net revenues

   $ 34,631      $ 35,155      $ 34,275  

Total Assets by Region

 

$ in millions    At December 31,
2016
     At December 31,
2015
 

Americas

   $ 581,750      $ 569,369  

EMEA

     158,819        146,177  

Asia-Pacific

     74,380        71,919  

Total

   $ 814,949      $ 787,465  

22. Parent Company

Parent Company Only—Condensed Income Statements and Comprehensive Income Statements

 

$ in millions    2016     2015     2014  

Revenues

      

Dividends from non-bank subsidiaries

   $ 2,448     $ 4,942     $ 2,641  

Trading

     96       574       601  

Investments

                 (1

Other

     38       53       10  

Total non-interest revenues

     2,582       5,569       3,251  

Interest income

     3,008       3,055       2,594  

Interest expense

     4,036       4,073       3,970  

Net interest

     (1,028     (1,018     (1,376

Net revenues

     1,554       4,551       1,875  

Non-interest expenses

      

Non-interest expenses

     126       (195     214  

Income before income taxes

     1,428       4,746       1,661  

Provision for (benefit from) income taxes

     (383     (83     (423

Net income before undistributed gain of subsidiaries

     1,811       4,829       2,084  

Undistributed gain of subsidiaries

     4,168       1,298       1,383  

Net income

     5,979       6,127       3,467  

Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax:

      

Foreign currency translation adjustments

     (23     (300     (397

Change in net unrealized gains (losses) on AFS securities

     (269     (246     209  

Pensions, postretirement and other

     (100     138       33  

Change in net DVA

     (283            

Comprehensive income

   $ 5,304     $ 5,719     $ 3,312  

Net income

   $ 5,979     $ 6,127     $ 3,467  

Preferred stock dividends and other

     471       456       315  

Earnings applicable to Morgan Stanley common shareholders

   $ 5,508     $ 5,671     $ 3,152  
 

 

  187   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Parent Company Only—Condensed Balance Sheets

 

$ in millions, except share data  

At

December 31,
2016

   

At

December 31,
2015

 

Assets

   

Cash and due from banks

  $ 119     $ 5,169  

Deposits with banking subsidiaries

    3,600       4,311  

Interest bearing deposits with banks

          2,421  

Trading assets at fair value

    139       354  

Securities purchased under agreement to resell with affiliates

    57,906       47,060  

Advances to subsidiaries:

Bank and bank holding company

    28,186       18,380  

Non-bank

    95,684       106,192  

Equity investments in subsidiaries: Bank and bank holding company

    34,329       25,787  

Non-bank

    31,246       34,927  

Other assets

    4,613       6,259  

Total assets

  $ 255,822     $ 250,860  

Liabilities

   

Short-term borrowings

  $ 1     $ 40  

Trading liabilities at fair value

    49       138  

Payables to subsidiaries

    26,957       29,220  

Other liabilities and accrued expenses

    2,040       2,189  

Long-term borrowings

    150,725       144,091  

Total liabilities

    179,772       175,678  

Commitments and contingent liabilities (see Note 12)

Equity

 

 

 

Preferred stock (see Note 15)

    7,520       7,520  

Common stock, $0.01 par value: Shares authorized: 3,500,000,000; Shares issued: 2,038,893,979; Shares outstanding: 1,852,481,601 and 1,920,024,027

    20       20  

Additional paid-in capital

    23,271       24,153  

Retained earnings

    53,679       49,204  

Employee stock trusts

    2,851       2,409  

Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)

    (2,643     (1,656

Common stock held in treasury at cost, $0.01 par value (186,412,378 and 118,869,952)

    (5,797     (4,059

Common stock issued to employee stock trusts

    (2,851     (2,409

Total shareholders’ equity

    76,050       75,182  

Total liabilities and equity

  $ 255,822     $ 250,860  

Parent Company Only—Condensed Cash Flow Statements

 

$ in millions    2016     2015     2014  

Cash flows from operating activities

      

Net income

   $ 5,979     $ 6,127     $ 3,467  

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by (used for) operating activities:

      

Undistributed gain of subsidiaries

     (4,168     (1,298     (1,383

Other operating activities

     1,367       1,084       1,176  

Changes in assets and liabilities

     (212     (3,195     2,305  

Net cash provided by operating activities

     2,966       2,718       5,565  

Cash flows from investing activities

      

Advances to and investments in subsidiaries

     (2,502     1,364       (7,790

Securities purchased under agreement to resell with affiliates

     (10,846     (5,459     (7,853

Net cash used for investing activities

     (13,348     (4,095     (15,643

Cash flows from financing activities

      

Net proceeds from (payments for) short-term borrowings

     (39     (655     189  

Proceeds from:

      

Excess tax benefits associated with stock-based awards

     61       211       101  

Issuance of preferred stock, net of issuance costs

           1,493       2,782  

Issuance of long-term borrowings

     32,795       28,575       33,031  

Payments for:

      

Long-term borrowings

     (24,754     (22,803     (28,917

Repurchases of common stock and employee tax withholdings

     (3,933     (2,773     (1,458

Cash dividends

     (1,746     (1,455     (904

Other financing activities

     66              

Net cash provided by financing activities

     2,450       2,593       4,824  

Effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents

     (250     (65     (208

Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

     (8,182     1,151       (5,462

Cash and cash equivalents, at beginning of period

     11,901       10,750       16,212  

Cash and cash equivalents, at end of period

   $ 3,719     $ 11,901     $ 10,750  

Cash and cash equivalents include:

      

Cash and due from banks

   $ 119     $ 5,169     $ 5,068  

Deposits with banking subsidiaries

     3,600       4,311       4,556  

Interest bearing deposits with banks

           2,421       1,126  

Cash and cash equivalents, at end of period

   $ 3,719     $ 11,901     $ 10,750  
 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   188  


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

Supplemental Disclosure of Cash Flow Information

Cash payments for interest were $3,650 million, $3,959 million and $3,652 million for 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

Cash payments for income taxes, net of refunds, were $201 million, $255 million and $187 million for 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

Transactions with Subsidiaries

The Parent Company has transactions with its consolidated subsidiaries determined on an agreed-upon basis and has guaranteed certain unsecured lines of credit and contractual obligations on certain of its consolidated subsidiaries.

Parent Company’s Long-Term Borrowings

 

$ in millions    At
December 31,
2016
     At
December 31,
2015
 

Senior debt

   $ 140,422      $ 130,817  

Subordinated debt

     10,303        13,274  

Total

   $ 150,725      $ 144,091  

Guarantees

In the normal course of its business, the Parent Company guarantees certain of its subsidiaries’ obligations under derivative and other financial arrangements. The Parent Company records Trading assets and Trading liabilities, which include derivative contracts, at fair value on its condensed balance sheets.

The Parent Company also, in the normal course of its business, provides standard indemnities to counterparties on behalf of its subsidiaries for taxes, including U.S. and foreign withholding taxes, on interest and other payments made on derivatives, securities and stock lending transactions, and certain annuity products. These indemnity payments could be required based on a change in the tax laws or change in interpretation of applicable tax rulings. Certain contracts contain provisions that enable the Parent Company to terminate the agreement upon the occurrence of such events. The maximum

potential amount of future payments that the Parent Company could be required to make under these indemnifications cannot be estimated. The Parent Company has not recorded any contingent liability in its condensed financial statements for these indemnifications and believes that the occurrence of any events that would trigger payments under these contracts is remote.

The Parent Company has issued guarantees on behalf of its subsidiaries to various U.S. and non-U.S. exchanges and clearinghouses that trade and clear securities and/or futures contracts. Under these guarantee arrangements, the Parent Company may be required to pay the financial obligations of its subsidiaries related to business transacted on or with the exchanges and clearinghouses in the event of a subsidiary’s default on its obligations to the exchange or the clearinghouse. The Parent Company has not recorded any contingent liability in its condensed financial statements for these arrangements and believes that any potential requirements to make payments under these arrangements are remote.

The Parent Company guarantees certain debt instruments and warrants issued by subsidiaries. The debt instruments and warrants totaled $11.5 billion and $9.1 billion at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively. In connection with subsidiary lease obligations, the Parent Company has issued guarantees to various lessors. The Parent Company had $1.1 billion of guarantees outstanding under subsidiary lease obligations, primarily in the U.K. at both December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015.

Finance Subsidiary

The Parent Company fully and unconditionally guarantees the securities issued by Morgan Stanley Finance LLC, a 100%-owned finance subsidiary.

Resolution and Recovery Planning

At December 31, 2016, Advances to subsidiaries that met certain criteria were pledged to certain subsidiaries.

 

 

 

  189   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements   LOGO

 

23. Quarterly Results (Unaudited)

 

     2016 Quarter1      2015 Quarter1  
$ in millions, except per share data    First     Second     Third      Fourth2, 3      First4     Second     Third     Fourth5  

Total non-interest revenues

   $ 6,893     $ 7,996     $ 7,906      $ 8,138      $ 9,311     $ 9,045     $ 7,005     $ 6,701  

Net interest

     899       913       1,003        883        596       698       762       1,037  

Net revenues

     7,792       8,909       8,909        9,021        9,907       9,743       7,767       7,738  

Total non-interest expenses

     6,054       6,426       6,528        6,775        7,052       7,016       6,293       6,299  

Income from continuing operations before income taxes

     1,738       2,483       2,381        2,246        2,855       2,727       1,474       1,439  

Provision for income taxes

     578       833       749        566        387       894       423       496  

Income from continuing operations

     1,160       1,650       1,632        1,680        2,468       1,833       1,051       943  

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

     (3     (4     8               (5     (2     (2     (7

Net income

     1,157       1,646       1,640        1,680        2,463       1,831       1,049       936  

Net income applicable to noncontrolling interests

     23       64       43        14        69       24       31       28  

Net income applicable to Morgan Stanley

   $ 1,134     $ 1,582     $ 1,597      $ 1,666      $ 2,394     $ 1,807     $ 1,018     $ 908  

Preferred stock dividends and other

     79       157       79        156        80       142       79       155  

Earnings applicable to Morgan Stanley common shareholders

   $ 1,055     $ 1,425     $ 1,518      $ 1,510      $ 2,314     $ 1,665     $ 939     $ 753  

Earnings (loss) per basic common share6:

                  

Income from continuing operations

   $ 0.56     $ 0.77     $ 0.82      $ 0.84      $ 1.21     $ 0.87     $ 0.49     $ 0.40  

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

           (0.01     0.01               (0.01                  

Earnings per basic common share

   $ 0.56     $ 0.76     $ 0.83      $ 0.84      $ 1.20     $ 0.87     $ 0.49     $ 0.40  

Earnings (loss) per diluted common share6:

                  

Income from continuing operations

   $ 0.55     $ 0.75     $ 0.80      $ 0.81      $ 1.18     $ 0.85     $ 0.48     $ 0.39  

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

                 0.01                                  

Earnings per diluted common share

   $ 0.55     $ 0.75     $ 0.81      $ 0.81      $ 1.18     $ 0.85     $ 0.48     $ 0.39  

Dividends declared per common share7

   $ 0.15     $ 0.15     $ 0.20      $ 0.20      $ 0.10     $ 0.15     $ 0.15     $ 0.15  

Book value per common share

   $ 35.34     $ 36.29     $ 37.11      $ 36.99      $ 33.80     $ 34.52     $ 34.97     $ 35.24  

 

1.

In 2016, in accordance with the early adoption of a provision of the accounting update Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities, unrealized DVA gains (losses) are recorded within OCI and, when realized, in Trading revenues. In 2015, the realized and unrealized DVA gains (losses) were recorded in Trading revenues.

2.

The fourth quarter of 2016 included net discrete tax benefits of $135 million, primarily related to the remeasurement of reserves and related interest due to new information regarding the status of a multi-year tax authority examination (see Note 20).

3.

During the fourth quarter of 2016, net revenues included losses of approximately $60 million on sales and markdowns of legacy limited partnership investments in third-party-sponsored funds within the Investment Management business segment. The fourth quarter of 2016 also included a $70 million provision within the Wealth Management business segment related to certain brokerage service reporting activities.

4.

The first quarter of 2015 included net discrete tax benefits of $564 million, primarily associated with the repatriation of non-U.S. earnings at a cost lower than originally estimated due to an internal restructuring to simplify the Firm’s legal entity organization in the U.K. (see Note 20).

5.

During the fourth quarter of 2015, the Firm incurred specific severance costs of approximately $155 million, which is included in Compensation and benefits expenses in the consolidated income statements, associated with the Firm’s restructuring actions, which were recorded in the business segments, approximately, as follows: Institutional Securities: $125 million, Wealth Management: $20 million and Investment Management: $10 million.

6.

Summation of the quarters’ earnings per common share may not equal the annual amounts due to the averaging effect of the number of shares and share equivalents throughout the year.

7.

Beginning with the dividend declared on July 20, 2016, the Firm increased the quarterly common stock dividend to $0.20 per share from $0.15 per share.

 

24. Subsequent Events

The Firm has evaluated subsequent events for adjustment to or disclosure in the consolidated financial statements through the date of this report and has not identified any recordable or disclosable events, not otherwise reported in these consolidated financial statements or the notes thereto.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   190  


Table of Contents

Financial Data Supplement (Unaudited)

Average Balances and Interest Rates and Net Interest Income

  LOGO

 

     2016     2015     2014  
$ in millions   

Average

Daily
Balance

     Interest     Average
Rate
   

Average

Daily
Balance

     Interest     Average
Rate
   

Average

Daily
Balance

     Interest     Average
Rate
 

Assets

                     

Interest earning assets

                     

Investment securities1

   $ 78,562      $ 1,142       1.5   $ 67,993      $ 876       1.3   $ 62,240      $ 613       1.0

Loans1

     89,875        2,724       3.0       75,110        2,163       2.9       53,567        1,690       3.2  

Interest bearing deposits with banks1

     25,960        170       0.7       26,650        108       0.4       32,226        109       0.3  

Securities purchased under agreements to resell and Securities borrowed2:

                     

U.S.

     144,744        (172     (0.1     172,481        (618     (0.4     177,444        (507     (0.3

Non-U.S.

     86,622        (202     (0.2     80,490        58       0.1       77,139        209       0.3  

Trading assets, net of Trading liabilities3:

                     

U.S.

     45,268        1,894       4.2       33,589        1,874       5.6       43,040        1,643       3.8  

Non-U.S.

     17,321        237       1.4       25,612        388       1.5       29,933        466       1.6  

Customer receivables and Other4:

                     

U.S.

     48,253        944       2.0       53,887        857       1.6       73,244        655       0.9  

Non-U.S.

     22,386        279       1.2       26,836        129       0.5       18,635        535       2.9  

Total

   $ 558,991      $ 7,016       1.3   $ 562,648      $ 5,835       1.0   $ 567,468      $ 5,413       1.0

Liabilities and Equity

                     

Interest bearing liabilities

 

                  

Deposits1

   $ 155,143      $ 83       0.1   $ 141,502      $ 78       0.1   $ 119,819      $ 106       0.1

Short-term and Long- term borrowings1, 5

     163,647        3,606       2.2       159,781        3,497       2.2       153,813        3,613       2.3  

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase and Securities loaned6:

                     

U.S.

     32,359        555       1.7       51,115        437       0.9       86,063        548       0.6  

Non-U.S.

     31,491        422       1.3       34,306        587       1.7       50,843        668       1.3  

Customer payables and Other7:

                     

U.S.

     112,159        (1,187     (1.1     117,358        (1,529     (1.3     119,153        (1,366     (1.1

Non-U.S.

     72,475        (161     (0.2     63,759        (328     (0.5     49,555        109       0.2  

Total

   $ 567,274      $ 3,318       0.6     $ 567,821      $ 2,742       0.5     $ 579,246      $ 3,678       0.6  

Net interest income and net interest rate spread

            $ 3,698       0.7            $ 3,093       0.5            $ 1,735       0.4

 

1.

Amounts include primarily U.S. balances.

2.

Includes fees paid on Securities borrowed.

3.

Trading assets, net of Trading liabilities exclude non-interest earning assets and non-interest bearing liabilities, such as equity securities.

4.

Includes interest from customer receivables and cash deposited with clearing organizations or segregated under federal and other regulations or requirements.

5.

The Firm also issues structured notes that have coupon or repayment terms linked to the performance of debt or equity securities, indices, currencies or commodities, which are recorded within Trading revenues (see Note 3 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8).

6.

Includes fees received on Securities loaned.

7.

Includes fees received from prime brokerage customers for stock loan transactions incurred to cover customers’ short positions.

 

  191   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

Financial Data Supplement (Unaudited)

Rate/Volume Analysis

  LOGO

 

Effect of Volume and Rate Changes on Net Interest Income

 

     2016 versus 2015     2015 versus 2014  
    

Increase (decrease)

due to change in:

         

Increase (decrease)

due to change in:

       
$ in millions    Volume     Rate     Net Change     Volume     Rate     Net Change  

Interest earning assets

            

Investment securities

   $ 136     $ 130     $ 266     $ 57     $ 206     $ 263  

Loans

     426       135       561       651       (178     473  

Interest bearing deposits with banks

     (3     65       62       (31     30       (1

Securities purchased under agreements to resell and Securities borrowed:

            

U.S.

     99       347       446       14       (125     (111

Non-U.S.

     4       (264     (260     9       (160     (151

Trading assets, net of Trading liabilities:

            

U.S.

     652       (632     20       (361     592       231  

Non-U.S.

     (126     (25     (151     (67     (11     (78

Customer receivables and Other:

            

U.S.

     (90     177       87       (173     375       202  

Non-U.S.

     (21     171       150       235       (641     (406

Change in interest income

   $ 1,077     $ 104     $ 1,181     $ 334     $ 88     $ 422  

Interest bearing liabilities

            

Deposits

     8       (3     5       26       (54     (28

Short-term and Long-term borrowings

     85       24       109       170       (286     (116

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase and Securities loaned:

            

U.S.

     (160     278       118       (223     112       (111

Non-U.S.

     (48     (117     (165     (217     136       (81

Customer payables and Other:

            

U.S.

     64       278       342       21       (184     (163

Non-U.S.

     (45     212       167       31       (468     (437

Change in interest expense

   $ (96   $ 672     $ 576     $ (192   $ (744   $ (936

Change in net interest income

   $ 1,173     $ (568   $ 605     $ 526     $ 832     $ 1,358  

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   192  


Table of Contents
Financial Data Supplement (Unaudited)   LOGO

 

Deposits

 

    Average Deposits1  
    2016      2015      2014  
$ in millions   Average
Amount
1
    Average
Rate
     Average
Amount1
    Average
Rate
     Average
Amount1
    Average
Rate
 

Deposits2:

                   

Savings deposits

  $ 153,387               —%      $ 139,169               0.1%      $ 118,086               0.1%  

Time deposits

    1,756               2.4%        2,333               0.6%        1,733               0.7%  

Total

  $ 155,143               0.1%      $ 141,502               0.6%      $ 119,819               0.1%  

 

1.

In 2016 and 2015, the Firm calculated its average balances based upon daily amounts. In 2014, the Firm calculated its average balances based upon weekly amounts, except where weekly balances were unavailable, month-end balances were used.

2.

The Firm’s deposits were primarily held in U.S. offices.

Ratios

 

      2016     2015     2014  

Net income to average assets

     0.7     0.7     0.4

Return on average common equity1

     8.0     8.5     4.8

Return on total equity2

     7.8     8.3     4.9

Dividend payout ratio3

     24.0     19.0     21.9

Total average common equity to average assets

     8.5     8.0     7.9

Total average equity to average assets

     9.4     8.9     8.5

 

1.

Percentage is based on net income applicable to Morgan Stanley less preferred dividends as a percentage of average common equity.

2.

Percentage is based on net income as a percentage of average total equity.

3.

Percentage is based on dividends declared per common share as a percentage of net income per diluted share.

Short-Term Borrowings

 

$ in millions    2016     2015     2014  

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

 

   

Period-end balance

   $ 54,628     $ 36,692     $ 69,949  

Average balance1, 2

     47,376       61,338       103,640  

Maximum balance at any month-end

     57,655       81,346       129,265  

Weighted average interest rate during the period3

     0.8     0.9     0.8

Weighted average interest rate on period-end balance4

     (0.3 )%      0.8     0.7

Securities loaned

      

Period-end balance

   $ 15,844     $ 19,358     $ 25,219  

Average balance1, 2

     16,474       24,083       33,266  

Maximum balance at any month-end

     18,851       29,674       35,700  

Weighted average interest rate during the period3

     3.7     2.1     1.3

Weighted average interest rate on period-end balance3

     3.6     2.4     1.6
1.

In 2016 and 2015, the Firm calculated its average balances based upon daily amounts. In 2014, the Firm calculated its average balances based upon weekly amounts, except where weekly balances were unavailable, month-end balances were used.

2.

At December 31, 2016, the differences between period end balances and average balances were not significant.

3.

The weighted average interest rate was calculated using (a) interest expense incurred on all securities sold under agreements to repurchase and securities loaned transactions, whether or not such transactions were reported in the consolidated balance sheets and (b) net average or period-end balances when applicable. In addition, off-balance sheet securities-for-securities transactions were not included in the average or period-end balances.

Cross-Border Outstandings

Cross-border outstandings are based upon the Federal Financial Institutions Examination Council’s (“FFIEC”) regulatory guidelines for reporting cross-border risk. Claims include cash, customer and other receivables, securities purchased under agreements to resell, securities borrowed and cash trading instruments, but exclude commitments. Securities purchased under agreements to resell and securities borrowed are presented based on the domicile of the counterparty, without reduction for related securities collateral held. For information regarding the Firm’s country risk exposure, see “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk—Risk Management—Credit Risk—Country Risk Exposure” in Part II, Item 7A.

The following tables set forth cross-border outstandings for each country, excluding derivative exposure, in which cross-border outstandings exceed 1% of the Firm’s consolidated assets or 20% of the Firm’s total capital, whichever is less, at December 31, 2016, December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, respectively, in accordance with the FFIEC guidelines:

 

     At December 31, 2016  
$ in millions   Banks     Governments     Non-banking
Financial
Institutions
    Other     Total  
Country:          

Japan

  $ 12,478     $ 10,821     $ 32,618     $ 8,602     $ 64,519  

United Kingdom

    6,127       3,064       32,143       10,219       51,553  

France

    6,295       5,201       15,618       5,649       32,763  

Cayman Islands

    5             16,783       3,085       19,873  

Germany

    3,853       3,546       4,797       2,452       14,648  

Ireland

    457       11       7,045       4,444       11,957  

Canada

    3,566       850       2,562       2,832       9,810  
 

 

  193   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
Financial Data Supplement (Unaudited)   LOGO

 

     At December 31, 2015  
$ in millions   Banks     Governments     Non-banking
Financial
Institutions
    Other     Total  
Country:          

United Kingdom

  $ 9,556     $ 36     $ 53,039     $ 11,273     $ 73,904  

Japan

    6,784       9,903       18,432       9,076       44,195  

France

    15,321       18       7,217       6,087       28,643  

Cayman Islands

    349             19,582       4,848       24,779  

Germany

    5,089       6,516       4,240       6,158       22,003  

Ireland

    411       3       7,058       5,387       12,859  

Switzerland

    1,430       501       719       7,794       10,444  

Canada

    2,667       2,328       3,068       2,354       10,417  

India

    2,514       355       770       5,620       9,259  

Singapore

    2,185       5,980       36       770       8,971  

Netherlands

    669             4,244       3,542       8,455  

China

    1,999       1,134       914       4,431       8,478  
     At December 31, 2014  
$ in millions   Banks     Governments     Non-banking
Financial
Institutions
    Other     Total  
Country:          

United Kingdom

  $ 8,514     $ 948     $ 50,855     $ 9,170     $ 69,487  

Cayman Islands

    144             38,223       5,249       43,616  

Japan

    14,860       5,645       15,814       7,162       43,481  

France

    18,838       218       2,349       5,591       26,996  

Germany

    6,650       6,679       3,991       3,304       20,624  

Singapore

    2,117       7,761       18       788       10,684  

China

    1,738       3,259       64       5,546       10,607  

Canada

    2,741       286       4,261       2,694       9,982  

South Korea

    149       6,081       721       3,012       9,963  

Ireland

    304       20       5,793       3,203       9,320  

Netherlands

    910             3,509       3,890       8,309  

For cross-border exposure including derivative contracts that exceeds 0.75% but does not exceed 1% of the Firm’s consolidated assets, South Korea, Singapore and Brazil had a total cross-border exposure of $22,927 million at December 31, 2016; South Korea, Spain and Australia had a total cross-border exposure of $20,527 million at December 31, 2015; and Saudi Arabia, Switzerland, Luxembourg and Australia had a total cross-border exposure of $28,637 million at December 31, 2014.

 

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   194  


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

Item 9. Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure

None.

Item 9A. Controls and Procedures

Conclusion Regarding the Effectiveness of Disclosure Controls and Procedures

Under the supervision and with the participation of our management, including our Chief Executive Officer and our Chief Financial Officer, we conducted an evaluation of our disclosure controls and procedures, as such term is defined under Exchange Act Rule 13a-15(e). Based on this evaluation, our Chief Executive Officer and our Chief Financial Officer concluded that our disclosure controls and procedures were effective as of the end of the period covered by this annual report.

Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

Our management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting. The Firm’s internal control over financial reporting is designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles in the United States of America (“U.S. GAAP”).

Our internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that:

 

 

Pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the Firm;

 

 

Provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with U.S. GAAP, and that our receipts and expenditures are being made only in accordance with authorizations of the Firm’s management and directors; and

 

 

Provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of our assets that could have a material effect on our financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

Management assessed the effectiveness of the Firm’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2016. In making this assessment, management used the criteria set forth by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO) in Internal Control-Integrated Framework (2013). Based on management’s assessment and those criteria, management believes that the Firm maintained effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2016.

The Firm’s independent registered public accounting firm has audited and issued a report on the Firm’s internal control over financial reporting, which appears below.

 

 

  195   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

 

To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of Morgan Stanley:

We have audited the internal control over financial reporting of Morgan Stanley and subsidiaries (the “Firm”) as of December 31, 2016, based on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. The Firm’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Firm’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit.

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed by, or under the supervision of, the company’s principal executive and principal financial officers, or persons performing similar functions, and effected by the company’s board of directors, management, and other personnel to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally

accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of the inherent limitations of internal control over financial reporting, including the possibility of collusion or improper management override of controls, material misstatements due to error or fraud may not be prevented or detected on a timely basis. Also, projections of any evaluation of the effectiveness of the internal control over financial reporting to future periods are subject to the risk that the controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

In our opinion, the Firm maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2016, based on the criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission.

We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated financial statements of the Firm as of and for the year ended December 31, 2016 and our report dated February 27, 2017 expressed an unqualified opinion on those financial statements.

 

 

/s/ Deloitte & Touche LLP

New York, New York

February 27, 2017

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   196  


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

Changes in Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

No change in the Firm’s internal control over financial reporting (as such term is defined in Exchange Act Rule 13a-15(f)) occurred during the quarter ended December 31, 2016 that materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the Firm’s internal control over financial reporting.

Item 9B. Other Information

None.

Part III

Item 10. Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance

Information relating to the Firm’s directors and nominees in the Firm’s definitive proxy statement for its 2017 annual meeting of shareholders (“Morgan Stanley’s Proxy Statement”) is incorporated by reference herein.

Information relating to the Firm’s executive officers is contained in Part I, Item 1 of this report under “Executive Officers of Morgan Stanley.”

Morgan Stanley’s Code of Ethics and Business Conduct applies to all directors, officers and employees, including its Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer and Deputy Chief Financial Officer. You can find our Code of Ethics and Business Conduct on our internet site, www.morganstanley.com/about-us-governance/ethics.html. We will post any amendments to the Code of Ethics and Business Conduct, and any waivers that are required to be disclosed by the rules of either the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission or the New York Stock Exchange LLC, on our internet site.

Item 11. Executive Compensation

Information relating to director and executive officer compensation in Morgan Stanley’s Proxy Statement is incorporated by reference herein.

Item 12. Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters

Information relating to equity compensation plans and security ownership of certain beneficial owners and management in Morgan Stanley’s Proxy Statement is incorporated by reference herein.

Item 13. Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence

Information regarding certain relationships and related transactions in Morgan Stanley’s Proxy Statement is incorporated by reference herein.

Information regarding director independence in Morgan Stanley’s Proxy Statement is incorporated by reference herein.

Item 14. Principal Accountant Fees and Services

Information regarding principal accountant fees and services in Morgan Stanley’s Proxy Statement is incorporated by reference herein.

 

 

  197   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

Part IV

 

Item 15. Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules

Documents filed as part of this report

 

 

The consolidated financial statements required to be filed in this Annual Report on Form 10-K are included in Part II, Item 8 hereof.

 

 

An exhibit index has been filed as part of this report beginning on page E-1 and is incorporated by reference herein.

Item 16. Form 10-K Summary

None.

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   198  


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

Signatures

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, on February 27, 2017.

 

MORGAN STANLEY

(REGISTRANT)

 By:   /S/ JAMES P. GORMAN
 

(James P. Gorman)

Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer

POWER OF ATTORNEY

We, the undersigned, hereby severally constitute Jonathan Pruzan, Eric F. Grossman and Martin M. Cohen, and each of them singly, our true and lawful attorneys with full power to them and each of them to sign for us, and in our names in the capacities indicated below, any and all amendments to the Annual Report on Form 10-K filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission, hereby ratifying and confirming our signatures as they may be signed by our said attorneys to any and all amendments to said Annual Report on Form 10-K.

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the Registrant and in the capacities indicated on the 27th day of February, 2017.

 

Signature

  

Title

/S/ JAMES P. GORMAN

(James P. Gorman)

  

Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer

(Principal Executive Officer)

/S/ JONATHAN PRUZAN

(Jonathan Pruzan)

  

Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer

(Principal Financial Officer)

/S/ PAUL C. WIRTH

(Paul C. Wirth)

  

Deputy Chief Financial Officer

(Principal Accounting Officer)

/S/ ERSKINE B. BOWLES

(Erskine B. Bowles)

   Director

/S/ ALISTAIR DARLING

(Alistair Darling)

   Director

/S/ THOMAS H. GLOCER

(Thomas H. Glocer)

   Director

/S/ ROBERT H. HERZ

(Robert H. Herz)

   Director

/S/ NOBUYUKI HIRANO

(Nobuyuki Hirano)

   Director

/S/ KLAUS KLEINFELD

(Klaus Kleinfeld)

   Director

/S/ JAMI MISCIK

(Jami Miscik)

   Director

/S/ DENNIS M. NALLY

(Dennis M. Nally)

   Director

 

  S-1   December 2016 Form 10-K


Table of Contents
  LOGO

 

Signature

  

Title

/S/ DONALD T. NICOLAISEN

(Donald T. Nicolaisen)

   Director

/S/ HUTHAM S. OLAYAN

(Hutham S. Olayan)

   Director

/S/ JAMES W. OWENS

(James W. Owens)

   Director

/S/ RYOSUKE TAMAKOSHI

(Ryosuke Tamakoshi)

   Director

/S/ PERRY M. TRAQUINA

(Perry M. Traquina)

   Director

/S/ RAYFORD WILKINS, JR.

(Rayford Wilkins, Jr.)

   Director

 

December 2016 Form 10-K   S-2  


Table of Contents

 

 

 

 

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

EXHIBITS TO FORM 10-K

For the year ended December 31, 2016

Commission File No. 1-11758

 

LOGO

 

 

 

 

 


Table of Contents

Exhibit Index

Certain of the following exhibits, as indicated parenthetically, were previously filed as exhibits to registration statements filed by Morgan Stanley or its predecessor companies under the Securities Act or to reports or registration statements filed by Morgan Stanley or its predecessor companies under the Exchange Act and are hereby incorporated by reference to such statements or reports. Morgan Stanley’s Exchange Act file number is 1-11758. The Exchange Act file number of Morgan Stanley Group Inc., a predecessor company (“MSG”), was 1-9085.(1)

 

Exhibit No.  

Description

3.1*   Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of Morgan Stanley, as amended to date.
3.2   Amended and Restated Bylaws of Morgan Stanley, as amended to date (Exhibit 3.1 to Morgan Stanley’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated October 29, 2015).
4.1   Indenture dated as of February 24, 1993 between Morgan Stanley and The Bank of New York, as trustee (Exhibit 4 to Morgan Stanley’s Registration Statement on Form S-3 (No. 33-57202)).
4.2   Amended and Restated Senior Indenture dated as of May 1, 1999 between Morgan Stanley and The Bank of New York, as trustee (Exhibit 4-e to Morgan Stanley’s Registration Statement on Form S-3/A (No. 333-75289) as amended by Fourth Supplemental Senior Indenture dated as of October 8, 2007 (Exhibit 4.3 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2007).
4.3   Senior Indenture dated as of November 1, 2004 between Morgan Stanley and The Bank of New York, as trustee (Exhibit 4-f to Morgan Stanley’s Registration Statement on Form S-3/A (No. 333-117752), as amended by First Supplemental Senior Indenture dated as of September 4, 2007 (Exhibit 4.5 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2007), Second Supplemental Senior Indenture dated as of January 4, 2008 (Exhibit 4.1 to Morgan Stanley’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated January 4, 2008), Third Supplemental Senior Indenture dated as of September 10, 2008 (Exhibit 4 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended August 31, 2008), Fourth Supplemental Senior Indenture dated as of December 1, 2008 (Exhibit 4.1 to Morgan Stanley’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated December 1, 2008), Fifth Supplemental Senior Indenture dated as of April 1, 2009 (Exhibit 4 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2009), Sixth Supplemental Senior Indenture dated as of September 16, 2011 (Exhibit 4.1 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2011), Seventh Supplemental Senior Indenture dated as of November 21, 2011 (Exhibit 4.4 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2011), Eighth Supplemental Senior Indenture dated as of May 4, 2012 (Exhibit 4.1 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2012), Ninth Supplemental Senior Indenture dated as of March 10, 2014 (Exhibit 4.1 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2014) and Tenth Supplemental Senior Indenture dated as of January 11, 2017 (Exhibit 4.1 to Morgan Stanley’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated January 11, 2017).
4.4   The Unit Agreement Without Holders’ Obligations, dated as of August 29, 2008, between Morgan Stanley and The Bank of New York Mellon, as Unit Agent, as Trustee and Paying Agent under the Senior Indenture referred to therein and as Warrant Agent under the Warrant Agreement referred to therein (Exhibit 4.1 to Morgan Stanley’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated August 29, 2008).
4.5   Amended and Restated Subordinated Indenture dated as of May 1, 1999 between Morgan Stanley and The Bank of New York, as trustee (Exhibit 4-f to Morgan Stanley’s Registration Statement on Form S-3/A (No. 333-75289)).
4.6   Subordinated Indenture dated as of October 1, 2004 between Morgan Stanley and The Bank of New York, as trustee (Exhibit 4-g to Morgan Stanley’s Registration Statement on Form S-3/A (No. 333-117752)).
4.7   Junior Subordinated Indenture dated as of March 1, 1998 between Morgan Stanley and The Bank of New York, as trustee (Exhibit 4.1 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended February 28, 1998).

 

(1)

For purposes of this Exhibit Index, references to “The Bank of New York” mean in some instances the entity successor to JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. or J.P. Morgan Trust Company, National Association; references to “JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.” mean the entity formerly known as The Chase Manhattan Bank, in some instances as the successor to Chemical Bank; references to “J.P. Morgan Trust Company, N.A.” mean the entity formerly known as Bank One Trust Company, N.A., as successor to The First National Bank of Chicago.

 

E-1


Table of Contents

Exhibit No.

  

Description

4.8

   Junior Subordinated Indenture dated as of October 1, 2004 between Morgan Stanley and The Bank of New York, as trustee (Exhibit 4-ww to Morgan Stanley’s Registration Statement on Form S-3/A (No. 333-117752)).

4.9

   Junior Subordinated Indenture dated as of October 12, 2006 between Morgan Stanley and The Bank of New York, as trustee (Exhibit 4.1 to Morgan Stanley’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated October 12, 2006).

4.10

   Deposit Agreement dated as of July 6, 2006 among Morgan Stanley, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. and the holders from time to time of the depositary receipts described therein (Exhibit 4.3 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended May 31, 2006).

4.11

   Form of Deposit Agreement among Morgan Stanley, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. and the holders from time to time of the depositary receipts representing interests in the Series A Preferred Stock described therein (Exhibit 2.4 to Morgan Stanley’s Registration Statement on Form 8-A dated July 5, 2006).

4.12

   Depositary Receipt for Depositary Shares, representing Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series A (included in Exhibit 4.11 hereto).

4.13

   Form of Deposit Agreement among Morgan Stanley, The Bank of New York Mellon and the holders from time to time of the depositary receipts representing interests in the Series E Preferred Stock described therein (Exhibit 2.6 to Morgan Stanley’s Registration Statement on Form 8-A dated September 27, 2013).

4.14

   Depositary Receipt for Depositary Shares, representing Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series E (included in Exhibit 4.13 hereto).

4.15

   Form of Deposit Agreement among Morgan Stanley, The Bank of New York Mellon and the holders from time to time of the depositary receipts representing interests in the Series F Preferred stock described therein (Exhibit 2.4 to Morgan Stanley’s Registration Statement on Form 8-A dated December 9, 2013).

4.16

   Depositary Receipt for Depositary Shares, representing Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series F (included in Exhibit 4.15 hereto).

4.17

   Form of Deposit Agreement among Morgan Stanley, The Bank of New York Mellon and the holders from time to time of the depositary receipts representing interests in the Series G Preferred stock described therein (Exhibit 2.4 to Morgan Stanley’s Registration Statement on Form 8-A dated April 28, 2014).

4.18

   Depositary Receipt for Depositary Shares, representing 6.625% Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series G (included in Exhibit 4.17 hereto).

4.19

   Form of Deposit Agreement among Morgan Stanley, The Bank of New York Mellon and the holders from time to time of the depositary receipts representing interests in the Series H Preferred stock described therein (Exhibit 4.6 to Morgan Stanley’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated April 29, 2014).

4.20

   Depositary Receipt for Depositary Shares, representing Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series H (included in Exhibit 4.19 hereto).

4.21

   Form of Deposit Agreement among Morgan Stanley, The Bank of New York Mellon and the holders from time to time of the depositary receipts representing interests in the Series I Preferred stock described therein (Exhibit 2.4 to Morgan Stanley’s Registration Statement on Form 8-A dated September 17, 2014).

4.22

   Depositary Receipt for Depositary Shares, representing Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series I (included in Exhibit 4.21 hereto).

4.23

   Form of Deposit Agreement among Morgan Stanley, The Bank of New York Mellon and the holders from time to time of the depositary receipts representing interests in the Series J Preferred Stock described therein (Exhibit 4.3 to Morgan Stanley’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated March 18, 2015).

4.24

   Depositary Receipt for Depositary Shares, representing Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series J (included in Exhibit 4.23 hereto).

4.25

   Form of Deposit Agreement among Morgan Stanley, The Bank of New York Mellon and the holders from time to time of the depositary receipts representing interests in the Series K Preferred Stock described therein (Exhibit 2.4 to Morgan Stanley’s Current Report on Form 8-A dated January 30, 2017).

4.26

   Depositary Receipt for Depositary Shares, representing Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series K (included in Exhibit 4.25 hereto).

 

E-2


Table of Contents

Exhibit No.

  

Description

4.27  

   Instruments defining the Rights of Security Holders, Including Indentures—Except as set forth in Exhibits 4.1 through 4.18 above, the instruments defining the rights of holders of long-term debt securities of Morgan Stanley and its subsidiaries are omitted pursuant to Section (b)(4)(iii) of Item 601 of Regulation S-K. Morgan Stanley hereby agrees to furnish copies of these instruments to the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission upon request.

10.1    

   Amended and Restated Trust Agreement dated as of October 18, 2011 by and between Morgan Stanley and State Street Bank and Trust Company (Exhibit 10.1 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2011).

10.2    

   Amended and Restated Investor Agreement dated as of June 30, 2011 by and between Morgan Stanley and Mitsubishi UFJ Financial Group, Inc. (Exhibit 10.1 to Morgan Stanley’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated June 30, 2011), as amended by Third Amendment, dated October 3, 2013 (Exhibit 10.1 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2013) and Fourth Amendment, dated April 6, 2016 (Exhibit 10.1 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2016).

10.3†  

   Morgan Stanley 401(k) Plan, amended and restated as of January 1, 2013 (Exhibit 10.6 to Morgan Stanley Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2012), as amended by Amendment (Exhibit 10.5 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2013), Amendment (Exhibit 10.6 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2013). Amendment (Exhibit 10.5 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2014) and Amendment (Exhibit 10.5 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2015).

10.4†*

   Amendment to Morgan Stanley 401(k) Plan, dated as of December 13, 2016.

10.5†  

   Tax Deferred Equity Participation Plan as amended and restated as of November 26, 2007 (Exhibit 10.9 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2007).

10.6†  

   Directors’ Equity Capital Accumulation Plan as amended and restated as of August 1, 2016 (Exhibit 10.1 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2016).

10.7†  

   Employees’ Equity Accumulation Plan as amended and restated as of November 26, 2007 (Exhibit 10.12 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2007).

10.8†  

   Employee Stock Purchase Plan as amended and restated as of February 1, 2009 (Exhibit 10.20 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2008).

10.9†  

   Morgan Stanley Supplemental Executive Retirement and Excess Plan, amended and restated effective December 31, 2008 (Exhibit 10.2 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2009) as amended by Amendment (Exhibit 10.5 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2009), Amendment (Exhibit 10.19 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2010), Amendment (Exhibit 10.3 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2011) and Amendment (Exhibit 10.1 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2014).

10.10†

   1995 Equity Incentive Compensation Plan (Annex A to MSG’s Proxy Statement for its 1996 Annual Meeting of Stockholders) as amended by Amendment (Exhibit 10.39 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2000), Amendment (Exhibit 10.5 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended August 31, 2005), Amendment (Exhibit 10.3 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended February 28, 2006), Amendment (Exhibit 10.24 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2006) and Amendment (Exhibit 10.22 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2007).

10.11†

   Form of Management Committee Equity Award Certificate for Discretionary Retention Award of Stock Units and Stock Options (Exhibit 10.30 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2006).

10.12†

   Form of Deferred Compensation Agreement under the Pre-Tax Incentive Program 2 (Exhibit 10.12 to MSG’s Annual Report for the fiscal year ended November 30, 1996).

10.13†

   Key Employee Private Equity Recognition Plan (Exhibit 10.43 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2000).

 

E-3


Table of Contents

Exhibit No.

  

Description

10.14†

   Morgan Stanley Financial Advisor and Investment Representative Compensation Plan as amended and restated as of November 26, 2007 (Exhibit 10.34 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2007).

10.15†

   Morgan Stanley UK Share Ownership Plan (Exhibit 4.1 to Morgan Stanley’s Registration Statement on Form S-8 (No. 333-146954)).

10.16†

   Supplementary Deed of Participation for the Morgan Stanley UK Share Ownership Plan, dated as of November 5, 2009 (Exhibit 10.36 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2009).

10.17†

   Aircraft Time Sharing Agreement, dated as of January 1, 2010, by and between Corporate Services Support Corp. and James P. Gorman (Exhibit 10.1 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2010).

10.18†

   Agreement between Morgan Stanley and James P. Gorman, dated August 16, 2005, and amendment dated December 17, 2008 (Exhibit 10.2 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2010), as amended by Amendment (Exhibit 10.25 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2013).

10.19†

   Form of Restrictive Covenant Agreement (Exhibit 10 to Morgan Stanley’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated November 22, 2005).

10.20†

   Morgan Stanley Performance Formula and Provisions (Exhibit 10.2 to Morgan Stanley’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated May 14, 2013).

10.21†

   2007 Equity Incentive Compensation Plan, as amended and restated as of March 24, 2016 (Exhibit 10.1 to Morgan Stanley’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated May 17, 2016).

10.22†

   Morgan Stanley 2006 Notional Leveraged Co-Investment Plan, as amended and restated as of November 28, 2008 (Exhibit 10.47 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2008).

10.23†

   Form of Award Certificate under the 2006 Notional Leveraged Co-Investment Plan (Exhibit 10.7 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended February 29, 2008).

10.24†

   Morgan Stanley 2007 Notional Leveraged Co-Investment Plan, amended as of June 4, 2009 (Exhibit 10.6 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2009).

10.25†

   Form of Award Certificate under the 2007 Notional Leveraged Co-Investment Plan for Certain Management Committee Members (Exhibit 10.8 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended February 29, 2008).

10.26†

   Morgan Stanley Compensation Incentive Plan (Exhibit 10.54 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2008).

10.27†

   Morgan Stanley 2009 Replacement Equity Incentive Compensation Plan for Morgan Stanley Smith Barney Employees (Exhibit 4.2 to Morgan Stanley’s Registration Statement on Form S-8 (No. 333-159504)).

10.28†

   Form of Award Certificate for Special Discretionary Retention Awards of Stock Options (Exhibit 10.4 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2011).

10.29†

   Morgan Stanley Schedule of Non-Employee Directors Annual Compensation, effective as of August 1, 2016 (Exhibit 10.2 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2016).

10.30†

   Memorandum to Colm Kelleher Regarding Repatriation to London (Exhibit 10.4 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2012).

10.31†

   Morgan Stanley U.S. Tax Equalization Program (Exhibit 10.5 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2012).

10.32†

   Morgan Stanley UK Limited Alternative Retirement Plan, dated as of October 8, 2009 (Exhibit 10.2 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2013).

10.33†

   Form of Award Certificate for Discretionary Retention Awards of Stock Options (Exhibit 10.5 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2013).

 

E-4


Table of Contents

Exhibit No.

  

Description

10.34†  

   Agreement between Morgan Stanley and Colm Kelleher, dated January 5, 2015 (Exhibit 10.1 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2015).

10.35†  

   Description of Operating Committee Medical Coverage (Exhibit 10.2 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2015).

10.36†  

   Form of Award Certificate for Discretionary Retention Awards of Stock Units (Exhibit 10.38 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report for the year ended December 31, 2015).

10.37†  

   Form of Award Certificate for Discretionary Retention Awards under the Morgan Stanley Compensation Incentive Plan (Exhibit 10.39 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report for the year ended December 31, 2015).

10.38†  

   Form of Award Certificate for Long-Term Incentive Program Awards (Exhibit 10.40 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report for the year ended December 31, 2015).

10.39†  

   Agreement between Morgan Stanley and Gregory J. Fleming, dated January 22, 2016 (Exhibit 10.41 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report for the year ended December 31, 2015).

10.40†  

   Memorandum to Colm Kelleher Regarding Relocation to New York, dated February 25, 2016 (Exhibit 10.2 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2016).

10.41†*

   Agreement between Morgan Stanley and James A. Rosenthal, dated January 17, 2017.

12*       

   Statement Re: Computation of Ratio of Earnings to Fixed Charges and Computation of Ratio of Earnings to Fixed Charges and Preferred Stock Dividends.

21*      

   Subsidiaries of Morgan Stanley.

23.1*   

   Consent of Deloitte & Touche LLP.

24       

   Powers of Attorney (included on signature page).

31.1*   

   Rule 13a-14(a) Certification of Chief Executive Officer.

31.2*   

   Rule 13a-14(a) Certification of Chief Financial Officer.

32.1** 

   Section 1350 Certification of Chief Executive Officer.

32.2** 

   Section 1350 Certification of Chief Financial Officer.

101       

   Interactive data files pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T: (i) the Consolidated Income Statements—Twelve Months Ended December 31, 2016, December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, (ii) the Consolidated Comprehensive Income Statements—Twelve Months Ended December 31, 2016, December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, (iii) the Consolidated Balance Sheets—December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, (iv) the Consolidated Statements of Changes in Total Equity—Twelve Months Ended December 31, 2016, December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, (iv) the Consolidated Cash Flow Statements—Twelve Months Ended December 31, 2016, December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, and (vi) Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

*

Filed herewith.

**

Furnished herewith.

Management contract or compensatory plan or arrangement required to be filed as an exhibit to this Form 10-K pursuant to Item 15(b).

 

E-5